US Navy Course NAVEDTRA 14310 - Aviation Boatswain's Mate E
US Navy Course NAVEDTRA 14310 - Aviation Boatswain's Mate E
TRAINING
                                COURSE
                                     July 2001
Aviation Boatswain's
Mate E
NAVEDTRA 14310
By enrolling in this self-study course, you have demonstrated a desire to improve yourself and the
Navy. Remember, however, this self-study course is only one part of the total Navy training
program. Practical experience, schools, selected reading, and your desire to succeed are also
necessary to successfully round out a fully meaningful training program.
COURSE OVERVIEW: When you complete this course you will be familiar with common
maintenance tools and their uses, measuring tools and techniques, aircraft recovery equipment,
steam catapults, and associated launching equipment. You will also learn about the aircraft
launch and recovery equipment maintenance program (ALREMP) and maintenance planning
and administration.
THE COURSE: This self-study course is organized into subject matter areas, each containing
learning objectives to help you determine what you should learn along with text and illustrations
to help you understand the information. The subject matter reflects day-to-day requirements and
experiences of personnel in the rating or skill area. It also reflects guidance provided by Enlisted
Community Managers (ECMs) and other senior personnel, technical references, instructions,
etc., and either the occupational or naval standards, which are listed in the Manual of Navy
Enlisted Manpower Personnel Classifications and Occupational Standards, NAVPERS 18068.
THE QUESTIONS: The questions that appear in this course are designed to help you
understand the material in the text.
VALUE: In completing this course, you will improve your military and professional knowledge.
Importantly, it can also help you study for the Navy-wide advancement in rate examination. If
you are studying and discover a reference in the text to another publication for further
information, look it up.
                                     Published by
                           NAVAL EDUCATION AND TRAINING
                            PROFESSIONAL DEVELOPMENT
                              AND TECHNOLOGY CENTER
                                                 i
          Sailor’s Creed
                   ii
                                           TABLE OF CONTENTS
CHAPTER PAGE
6. The Aircraft Launch and Recovery Equipment Maintenance Program ................... 6-1
APPENDIX
                                                                         iii
               INSTRUCTIONS FOR TAKING THE COURSE
Read each question carefully, then select the BEST                      COMMANDING OFFICER
answer. You may refer freely to the text. The answers                   NETPDTC N331
must be the result of your own work and decisions. You                  6490 SAUFLEY FIELD ROAD
are prohibited from referring to or copying the answers                 PENSACOLA FL 32559-5000
of others and from giving answers to anyone else taking
the course.                                                     Answer Sheets: All courses include one "scannable"
                                                                answer sheet for each assignment. These answer sheets
SUBMITTING YOUR ASSIGNMENTS                                     are preprinted with your SSN, name, assignment
                                                                number, and course number. Explanations for
To have your assignments graded, you must be enrolled           completing the answer sheets are on the answer sheet.
in the course with the Nonresident Training Course
Administration Branch at the Naval Education and                Do not use answer sheet reproductions: Use only the
Training Professional Development and Technology                original answer sheets that we provide—reproductions
Center (NETPDTC). Following enrollment, there are               will not work with our scanning equipment and cannot
two ways of having your assignments graded: (1) use             be processed.
the Internet to submit your assignments as you
complete them, or (2) send all the assignments at one           Follow the instructions for marking your answers on
time by mail to NETPDTC.                                        the answer sheet. Be sure that blocks 1, 2, and 3 are
                                                                filled in correctly. This information is necessary for
Grading on the Internet: Advantages to Internet                 your course to be properly processed and for you to
grading are:                                                    receive credit for your work.
                                                           iv
PASS/FAIL ASSIGNMENT PROCEDURES                                     For subject matter questions:
If your overall course score is 3.2 or higher, you will             E-mail:      [email protected]
pass the course and will not be required to resubmit                Phone:       Comm: (850) 452-1001, ext. 1777
assignments. Once your assignments have been graded                              DSN: 922-1001, ext. 1777
you will receive course completion confirmation.                                 FAX: (850) 452-1370
                                                                                 (Do not fax answer sheets.)
If you receive less than a 3.2 on any assignment and                Address:     COMMANDING OFFICER
your overall course score is below 3.2, you will be                              NETPDTC N315
given the opportunity to resubmit failed assignments.                            6490 SAUFLEY FIELD ROAD
You may resubmit failed assignments only once.                                   PENSACOLA FL 32509-5237
Internet students will receive notification when they
have failed an assignment—they may then resubmit                    For enrollment, shipping, grading, or completion
failed assignments on the web site. Internet students               letter questions
may view and print results for failed assignments from
the web site. Students who submit by mail will receive              E-mail:      [email protected]
a failing result letter and a new answer sheet for                  Phone:       Toll Free: 877-264-8583
resubmission of each failed assignment.                                          Comm: (850) 452-1511/1181/1859
                                                                                 DSN: 922-1511/1181/1859
COMPLETION CONFIRMATION                                                          FAX: (850) 452-1370
                                                                                 (Do not fax answer sheets.)
After successfully completing this course, you will                 Address:     COMMANDING OFFICER
receive a letter of completion.                                                  NETPDTC (CODE N331)
                                                                                 6490 SAUFLEY FIELD ROAD
ERRATA                                                                           PENSACOLA FL 32559-5000
Errata are used to correct minor errors or delete                   NAVAL RESERVE RETIREMENT CREDIT
obsolete information in a course. Errata may also be
used to provide instructions to the student. If a course            If you are a member of the Naval Reserve, you will
has an errata, it will be included as the first page(s) after       receive retirement points if you are authorized to
the front cover. Errata for all courses can be accessed             receive them under current directives governing
and viewed/downloaded at:                                           retirement of Naval Reserve personnel. For Naval
                                                                    Reserve retirement, this course is evaluated at 8
http://www.advancement.cnet.navy.mil                                points. (Refer to Administrative Procedures for Naval
                                                                    Reservists on Inactive Duty, BUPERSINST 1001.39,
STUDENT FEEDBACK QUESTIONS                                          for more information about retirement points.)
                                                                v
(THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK.)
                   vi
                                  Student Comments
Course Title:     Aviation Boatswain's Mate E
Privacy Act Statement: Under authority of Title 5, USC 301, information regarding your military status is
requested in processing your comments and in preparing a reply. This information will not be divulged without
written authorization to anyone other than those within DOD for official use in determining performance.
NETPDTC 1550/41 (Rev 4-00)
                                                     vii
                                                  CHAPTER 1
    Tools are designed to make a job easier and enable            toolbox is not actually at the work site, it should be
you to work more efficiently. If they are not properly            locked and stored in a designated area.
used and cared for, their advantages are lost to you.
    Regardless of the type of work to be done, you must                                   NOTE
have, choose, and use the correct tools in order to do                    An inventory list is kept in every toolbox to
your work quickly, accurately, and safely. Without the                be checked before and after each job or
proper tools and the knowledge of how to use them, you                maintenance action, to ensure that all tools are
waste time, reduce your efficiency, and may even injure               available to do your work, and to ensure that
yourself.                                                             they are accounted for after you have
    This chapter explains the specific purposes, correct              completed your work.
use, and proper care of the more common tools you will                 USE EACH TOOL ONLY FOR THE JOB IT WAS
encounter as an ABE. Also discussed briefly are other             DESIGNED TO DO. Each particular type of tool has a
aids to maintenance, such as blueprints and schematics.           specific purpose. If you use the wrong tool when
                                                                  performing maintenance or repairs, you may cause
              TOOL WORK HABITS                                    damage to the equipment you're working on or damage
                                                                  the tool itself. Remember, improper use of tools results
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Describe the
                                                                  in improper maintenance. Improper maintenance
    Tool Control Program. List several good tool
                                                                  results in damage to equipment and possible injury or
    work habits.
                                                                  death to you or others.
     "A place for everything and everything in its place"
                                                                      SAFE MAINTENANCE PRACTICES. Always
is just good common sense. You can't do an efficient
                                                                  avoid placing tools on or above machinery or an
repair job if you have to stop and look around for each
                                                                  electrical apparatus. Never leave tools unattended
tool you need. The following rules will make your job
                                                                  where machinery or aircraft engines are running.
easier and safer.
                                                                      NEVER USE DAMAGED TOOLS. A battered
   KEEP EACH TOOL IN ITS PROPER STOWAGE
                                                                  screwdriver may slip and spoil the screw slot, damage
PLACE. All V-2 divisions have incorporated a Tool
                                                                  other parts, or cause painful injury. A gauge strained
Control Program as directed by the Aircraft Launch
                                                                  out of shape will result in inaccurate measurements.
and Recovery Equipment Maintenance Program
(ALREMP).                                                             Remember, the efficiency of craftsmen and the
                                                                  tools they use are determined to a great extent by the
    The Tool Control Program is based on the concept
                                                                  way they keep their tools. Likewise, they are frequently
of a family of specialized toolboxes and pouches
                                                                  judged by the manner in which they handle and care for
configured for instant inventory before and after each
                                                                  them. Anyone watching skilled craftsmen at work
maintenance action. The content and configuration of
                                                                  notices the care and precision with which they use the
each container is tailored to the task, work center, and
                                                                  tools of their trade.
equipment maintained. Work center containers are
assigned to and maintained within a work center. Other                The care of hand tools should follow the same
boxes and specialized tools are checked out from the              pattern as for personal articles; that is, always keep
tool control center (tool room).                                  hand tools clean and free from dirt, grease, and foreign
                                                                  matter. After use, return tools promptly to their proper
    KEEP YOUR TOOLS IN GOOD CONDITION.
                                                                  place in the toolbox. Improve your own efficiency by
Protect them from rust, nicks, burrs, and breakage.
                                                                  organizing your tools so that those used most
   KEEP YOUR TOOL ALLOWANCE COM-                                  frequently can be reached easily without digging
PLETE. When you are issued a toolbox, each tool                   through the entire contents of the box. Avoid
should be placed in it when not in use. When the                  accumulating unnecessary junk.
                                                            1-1
               REVIEW QUESTIONS                                         Other safety shoes are designed for use where
                                                                   danger from sparking could cause an explosion. Such
 Q1.      Describe the Tool Control Program.
                                                                   danger is minimized by elimination of all metallic nails
 Q2.      List several good tool work habits.                      and eyelets and by the use of soles that do not cause
 Q3.      What are inspection mirrors used for?                    static electricity.
                                                                   GOGGLES
             CARE OF HAND TOOLS
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: List several                                  Proper eye protection is of the utmost importance
    principles that apply to the care of hand tools.               for all personnel. Eye protection is necessary because
                                                                   of hazards posed by infrared and ultraviolet radiation,
    Tools are expensive; tools are vital equipment.                or by flying objects such as sparks, globules of molten
When the need for their use arises, common sense plus              metal, or chipped concrete and wood. These hazards
a little preventive maintenance prolongs their                     are ever-present during welding, cutting, soldering,
usefulness. The following precautions for the care of              chipping, grinding, and a variety of other operations. It
tools should be observed:                                          is IMPERATIVE for you to use eye protection devices,
                                                                   such as helmets, face shields, and goggles (fig. 1-1),
    • Clean tools after each use. Oily, dirty, and greasy
                                                                   during eye-hazard operations.
      tools are slippery and dangerous to use.
                                                                       Appropriate use of goggles will limit eye hazards.
    • NEVER hammer with a wrench.
                                                                   Some goggles have plastic lenses that resist shattering
    • NEVER leave tools scattered about. When they                 upon impact. Others are designed to limit harmful
      are not in use, stow them neatly on racks or in              infrared and ultraviolet radiation from arcs or flames by
      toolboxes.                                                   use of appropriate filter lenses.
    • Apply a light film of oil after cleaning to prevent              Remember, eye damage can be excruciatingly
      rust on tools.                                               painful. PROTECT YOUR EYES.
                                                             1-2
                                             Figure 1-1.—Eye-protection devices.
shape) on the body belt. When you are at working                     be placed around any part of a structure that is being
position, you unsnap one end of the safety strap, pass it            removed.
around the supporting structure so there is no danger of
                                                                         Before placing your weight on the strap, determine
its slipping (at least 18 inches from the top of the part on
                                                                     VISUALLY that the snap and D-ring are properly
which it is fastened), and hook it to the right D-ring on
                                                                     engaged. Do not rely on the click of the snap-tongue as
the body belt.
                                                                     an indication that the fastening is secure.
    The safety strap must be placed around a part of the
                                                                         The body belt and safety strap require inspection
structure that is of sufficient strength to sustain an ABs
                                                                     before use. Look for loose or broken rivets; cracks,
weight and his or her equipment, and must rest flat
                                                                     cuts, nicks, tears or wear in leather; broken or otherwise
against the surface without twists or turns. It must not
                                                                     defective buckles, such as enlarged tongue-holes,
                                                                     defects in safety-belt snap hooks and body belt D-rings.
                                                                     If you discover any of these or other defects, turn in
                                                                     your equipment and replace it.
                                                                         Perform maintenance periodically according to
                                                                     applicable procedures. Remember that leather and
                                                                     nylon belts are treated in different manners.
                                                               1-3
                REVIEW QUESTION                                         The title block also includes the name and address
                                                                    of the Government agency or organization preparing
 Q5.      Identify the different types of personal safety
                                                                    the drawing, the scale, drafting record, authentication,
          equipment.
                                                                    and the date (fig. 1-4).
                                                              1-4
      Figure 1-4.—Blueprint title blocks. (A) Naval Ship's Systems Command; (B) Naval Facilities Engineering Command.
diameter, around the dash number, and carry a leader               Drawing Lines
line to the part.
                                                                       The lines used in working drawings are more than a
     A dash and number are used to identify modified or
                                                                   means of showing a picture of an object for the purpose
improved parts, and also to identify right-hand and
                                                                   of building or repairing. The way a line is drawn has a
left-hand parts. Many aircraft parts on the left-hand side
                                                                   definite meaning.
of an aircraft are exactly like the corresponding parts on
the right-hand side but in reverse. The left-hand parts                 Thick lines are used for the visible outline of the
are usually shown in the drawing.                                  object being drawn. Medium lines are used for the
                                                                   dotted lines representing hidden features and for
    Above the title block on some prints you may see a
                                                                   cutting-plane,     short-break,    adjacent-part,   and
notation such as "159674 LH shown; 159674-1 RH
                                                                   alternate-position lines. Center lines, dimension lines,
opposite." Both parts carry the same number. But the
                                                                   long-break lines, ditto lines, extension lines, and
part called for is distinguished by a dash and number.
                                                                   section lines are represented by thin lines.
(LH means left-hand, and RH means right-hand.) Some
companies use odd numbers for right-hand parts and                     To understand blueprint reading, you must know
even numbers for left-hand parts.                                  the different types of lines used in general drawing
                                                                   practice and the information conveyed by each. Some
                                                                   of the lines of major importance are illustrated in
                                                             1-5
figures 1-5-A and 1-5-B. The correct uses are                     of blueprint shows the position, location, and use of the
illustrated in figure 1-6.                                        various parts of the ship; for example, to find the
                                                                  battlestations sickbay, barbershop, or other parts of the
    Blueprints make it possible to understand, in a
                                                                  ship. In addition to plan views, other blueprints, called
comparatively small space, what is to be made or
                                                                  assembly prints, unit or subassembly prints, and detail
repaired. Of the many types of blueprints you will use
                                                                  prints, show various kinds of machinery and
aboard ship, the simplest one is the plan view. This type
                                                                  mechanical equipment.
                                                            1-6
                                        Figure 1-5-B.—Standard lines—continued.
    Assembly prints show the various parts of the                 with its dimensions and all the information needed to
mechanism, how the parts fit together, and their relation         make a new part as a replacement. Assembly and
to each other. Subassembly prints show the location,              subassembly prints may be used to learn operation and
shape, size, and relationships of the parts of the                maintenance of machines, systems, and equipment.
subassembly or unit. Detail prints show a single part
                                                            1-7
                                                                                              EXTENSION LINE
PHANTOM LINE
                                                    DIMENSION LINE
                                CENTER LINE                                               LEADER LINE
                                                           A
                                                                                                               SECTIONING LINE
                                                                            BREAK LINE
                                                                                              SECTION - AA
                                                           A
                  OUTLINE
                                  HIDDEN LINE
                                       CUTTING PLANE LINE                                                    ABEf0175
    Many prints and drawings are procured in the form                Schematic diagrams are also used to depict
of 16- and 35-mm microfilm. Microfilm prints and                 electrical systems. They are basically the same as the
drawings are available mounted on aperture (viewer)
cards, as well as in roll form. A reader or some type of                                 COOLING PANEL
projector is required to enlarge the microfilm for
reading. Activities are provided with a microfilm                                        8                                  9
reader-printer, which as its name implies, enlarges the
microfilm for reading and also has the capability of                                                7          10
printing a working copy in a matter of a few seconds.                                                    P
Piping 13
                                                           1-8
piping diagrams except they use electrical symbols                                                                                                                           Schematic diagrams are especially helpful when
instead of piping symbols. Figure 1-8 is an example of                                                                                                                   you are learning a hydraulic system or pinpointing a
an electrical system schematic.                                                                                                                                          malfunction in an electrical system. For more
                                                                                                                                                                         information on diagrams, drawings, and blueprints, and
                                                                                                                                                                         their interpretation, study Blueprint Reading and
                                                                                    BL25
                                                                                                                                                                         Sketching, NAVEDTRA 12014.
                                                                                           P1
                                                                              CR2
                                                                                    BL26
                                                                                                                                                                                         REVIEW QUESTION
                           TSR
BL2
                                                                                                                                                        ABEf0177
                                         BL15                                                                 BL21
                                                                                                                                                                          Q6.      Where is the title block located on all
                                                                                                                                                                                   blueprints and drawings prepared to military
                                 BAL15
                                                                                                                                                                                   standards?
BL1
                                                                                      G
                                                                      TSR
                                                                              B130
                                                    B122
                                                                                                                                                                                      METAL-CUTTING TOOLS
                                                                                      G
                                                                              B123
                                           SW#4
                                           LOW
                                                                                      R
                                                                      TSR
                                                   B124
                                                                              B131
                                                                                                                                                                             LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Identify the
                                                                                                                                                                             different types of metal-cutting tools. Describe
                                                                                      R
                                                                              B125
                                                   TSR
                                           B126
                             S4
                                                             B120
                                                                        SW#1 SW#2
                                                                        HIGH LOW
                                                                                           M
                                           B126
                                           B129
                                                             B121
                                                                                                                                                                         acquainted with the ABE rating, you will probably
                                  B TSR
                                       S3
                                           B127
                                                                                                                                                                         discover many tools that you use for cutting metal that
                              BAL8 BAL4
BL2
                                                                      B108
                                                                                                                                                                         are not described in this text. In this text, only the basic
                                                                                                                                                                         hand metal-cutting tools will be considered.
                             B
                                                                      B107
                                                                               TSR
                                                                      B114
                                                        BAL7
                                                                      B113          B112
                                                                                                                                                                         and steel of various thickness and shapes. Normally, the
                                                                              TSR
                                                                                      B106
                                                  R
                                                                      B111
                                                                                                                                                                             One of the handiest tools for cutting light (up to
                                                                                                           PS1
                                                                      B110          B109
                                                                              TSR
                                                                                                                                                BL23
                                                                                                                            BL21
                             PB1
                                                                                                                     BL24
                                                  C
                                                        BAL9
                             PB2
                                                                                             LS1
                                                  TSR
CR1
                                         B105
                                         B104           B103                   B102
                                                                                                                                  LS4
                                                                                                                                            LS3
      BL13
BL12
                                                                      S2
                                                                                                                                  BL22
                                                                                                                                         BL23
      BL14
                                                                                                                            TSR
             LS4
                   LS3
CR1
                                                                                                                                  BL2
                                                                                        SV
      BL1
B101
S1
115 VOLTS, 60 AC
                                                                                                                                                                   1-9
have blades that are straight and cutting edges that are
sharpened to an 85-degree angle. Snips like this can be
obtained in different sizes, ranging from the small,
6-inch, to the large, 14-inch, snip. Tin snips will also
work on slightly heavier gauges of soft metals, such as
aluminum alloys.
    Snips will not remove any metal when a cut is
made. There is danger, though, of causing minute metal
fractures along the edges of the metal during the
shearing process. For this reason, it is better to cut just
outside the layout line. This procedure will allow you to
dress the cutting edge while keeping the material within
required dimensions.
    Cutting extremely heavy gauge metal always                             Figure 1-10.—Cutting an inside hole with snips.
presents the possibility of springing the blades. Once
the blades are sprung, hand snips are useless. When                  final cut just outside the layout line. This will permit
cutting heavy material, use the rear portion of the                  you to see the scribed line while you are cutting and will
blades. This procedure not only avoids the possibility               cause the scrap to curl up below the blade of the snips,
of springing the blades but also gives you greater                   where it will be out of the way while the complete cut is
cutting leverage.                                                    being made.
    Many snips have small serrations (notches) on the                    To make straight cuts, place the sheet metal on a
cutting edges of the blades. These serrations tend to                bench with the marked guideline over the edge of the
prevent the snips from slipping backwards when a cut is              bench and hold the sheet down with one hand. With the
being made. Although this feature does make the actual               other hand, hold the snips so that the flat sides of the
cutting easier, it mars the edges of the metal slightly.             blades are at right angles to the surface of the work. If
You can remove these small cutting marks if you allow                the blades are not at right angles to the surface of the
proper clearance for dressing the metal to size. There               work, the edges of the cut will be slightly bent and
are many other types of hand snips used for special                  burred. The bench edge will also act as a guide when
jobs, but the snips discussed here can be used for almost            you are cutting with the snips. The snips will force the
any common type of work.                                             scrap metal down so that it does not interfere with
                                                                     cutting. Any of the hand snips may be used for straight
Cutting Sheet Metal with Snips                                       cuts. When notches are too narrow to be cut out with a
                                                                     pair of snips, make the side cuts with the snips and cut
    It is hard to cut circles or small arcs with straight            the base of the notch with a cold chisel.
snips. There are snips especially designed for circular
cutting. They are called CIRCLE SNIPS,
HAWKS-BILL SNIPS, TROJAN SNIPS, and AVIA-
TION SNIPS (fig. 1-9).
    To cut large holes in the lighter gauges of sheet
metal, start the cut by punching or otherwise making a
hole in the center of the area to be cut out. With an
aviation snips, or some other narrow-bladed snips,
make a spiral cut from the starting hole out toward the
scribed circle, as shown in figure 1-10, and continue
cutting until the scrap falls away.
    To cut a disk in the lighter gauges of sheet metal,
use a combination snips or a straight-blade snips, as
shown in figure 1-11. First, cut away any surplus
material outside the scribed circle, leaving only a
narrow piece to be removed by the final cut. Make the                      Figure 1-11.—Cutting a disk out of sheet metal.
                                                              1-10
Safety and Care                                                   distance between the two pins that hold the blade in
                                                                  place.
    Learn to use snips properly. They should always be
                                                                       Hacksaw blades are made of high-grade tool steel,
oiled and adjusted to permit ease of cutting and to
                                                                  hardened and tempered. There are two types, the
produce a surface that is free from burrs. If the blades
                                                                  all-hard and the flexible. All-hard blades are hardened
bind or if they are too far apart, the snips should be
                                                                  throughout, whereas only the teeth of the flexible
adjusted. Remember the following safety tips:
                                                                  blades are hardened. Hacksaw blades are about
    • Never use snips as screwdrivers, hammers, or                1/2-inch wide, have from 14 to 32 teeth per inch, and
      pry bars. They break easily.                                are from 8 to 16 inches long. The blades have a hole at
                                                                  each end, which hooks to a pin in the frame. All
    • Do not attempt to cut heavier materials than the
                                                                  hacksaw frames, which hold the blades either parallel
      snips are designed for. Never use tin snips to cut
                                                                  or at right angles to the frame, are provided with a
      hardened steel wire or other similar objects.
                                                                  wingnut or screw to permit tightening or removing the
      Such use will dent or nick the cutting edges of
                                                                  blade.
      the blades.
                                                                       The SET in a saw refers to how much the teeth are
    • Never toss snips in a toolbox where the cutting             pushed out in opposite directions from the sides of the
      edges can come into contact with other tools.               blade. The four different kinds of set are the
      This dulls the cutting edges and may even break             ALTERNATE set, DOUBLE ALTERNATE set,
      the blades.                                                 RAKER set, and WAVE set. Three of these are shown
    • When snips are not in use, hang them on hooks               in figure 1-13.
      or lay them on an uncrowded shelf or bench.                      The teeth in the alternate set are staggered, one to
                                                                  the left and one to the right throughout the length of the
HACKSAWS                                                          blade. On the double alternate set blade, two adjoining
                                                                  teeth are staggered to the right, two to the left, and so
    Hacksaws are used to cut metal that is too heavy for          on. On the raker set blade, every third tooth remains
snips or bolt cutters. Thus, metal bar stock can be cut           straight and the other two are set alternately. On the
readily with hacksaws.                                            wave (undulated) set blade, short sections of teeth are
    There are two parts to a hacksaw: the frame and the           bent in opposite directions.
blade. Common hacksaws have either an adjustable or a
solid frame (fig. 1-12). Most hacksaws found in the               Using Hacksaws
Navy are of the adjustable-frame type. Adjustable
frames can be made to hold blades from 8 to 16 inches                 The hacksaw is often used improperly. Although it
long, while those with solid frames take only the length          can be used with limited success by an inexperienced
blade for which they are made. This length is the                 person, a little thought and study given to its proper use
                                                                  will result in faster and better work and in less dulling
                                                                  and breaking of blades.
                                                                      Good work with a hacksaw depends not only upon
                                                                  the proper use of the saw but also upon the proper
                                                           1-11
                                                                           Figure 1-16.—Proper way to hold a hacksaw.
Figure 1-15.—Installing a hacksaw blade. Figure 1-17.—Removing a frozen nut with a hacksaw.
                                                            1-12
kerf. Put an adjustable wrench across this new flat and
the one opposite, and again try to remove the frozen
nut. Since very little original metal remains on this one
side of the nut, the nut will either give or break away
entirely and permit its removal.
    To saw a wide kerf in the head of a cap screw or
machine bolt, fit the hand hacksaw frame with two
blades side by side, and with teeth lined up in the same
direction. With slow, steady strokes, saw the slot
approximately one-third the thickness of the head of the
cap screw, as shown in figure 1-18. Such a slot will
permit subsequent holding or turning with a
screwdriver when it is impossible, due to close quarters,
to use a wrench.
Hacksaw Safety
FILES
                                                                 1-13
Grades
Shapes
                                                              1-14
     SQUARE files are tapered on all four sides and are                  When you have finished using a file, it may be
used to enlarge rectangular-shaped holes and slots.                 necessary to use an abrasive cloth or paper to finish the
ROUND files serve the same purpose for round                        product. Whether this is necessary depends on how fine
openings. Small round files are often called "rattail"              a finish you want on the work.
files.
                                                                         CROSSFILING.—Figure 1-21, view A, shows a
     The HALF ROUND file is a general-purpose tool.                 piece of mild steel being crossfiled. This means that the
The rounded side is used for curved surfaces, and the               file is being moved across the surface of the work in
flat face on flat surfaces. When you file an inside curve,          approximately a crosswise direction. For best results,
use a round or half-round file whose curve most nearly              keep your feet spread apart to steady yourself as you
matches the curve of the work.                                      file with slow, full-length, steady strokes. The file cuts
                                                                    as you push it—ease up on the return stroke to keep
    Kits of small files, often called "swiss pattern" or
                                                                    from dulling the teeth. Keep your file clean.
"jewelers'" files, are used to fit parts of delicate
mechanisms and for filing work on instruments. Handle                    View B shows the alternate positions of the file
these small files carefully because they break easily.              when an exceptionally flat surface is required. Using
                                                                    either position first, file across the entire length of the
Filing Operations                                                   stock. Then, using the other position, file across the
                                                                    entire length of the stock again. Because the teeth of the
    Using a file is an operation that is nearly                     file pass over the surface of the stock from two
indispensable when working with metal. You may be                   directions, the high spots and low spots will readily be
crossfiling, drawfiling, using a file card, or even                 visible after filing in both positions. Continue filing
polishing metal. Let's examine these operations.                    first in one position or direction and then the other until
                                                             1-15
the surface has been filed flat. Test the flatness with a           cutting stroke will be toward you. Lift the file away
straightedge or with prussian blue and a surface plate.             from the surface of the work on the return stroke. When
                                                                    drawfiling will no longer improve the surface texture,
    DRAWFILING.—Drawfiling produces a finer
                                                                    wrap a piece of abrasive cloth around the file and polish
surface finish and usually a flatter surface than
                                                                    the surface as shown in figure 1-22, view A.
crossfiling. Small parts, as shown in view C, are best
held in a vise. Hold the file as shown in the figure;                    USE OF FILE CARD.—As you file, the teeth of
notice that the arrow indicates that the cutting stroke is          the file may "clog up" with some of the metal filings
away from you when the handle of the file is held in the            and scratch your work. This condition is known as
right hand. If the handle is held in the left hand, the             PINNING. You can prevent pinning by keeping the file
                                                                    teeth clean. Rubbing chalk between the teeth will help
                                                                    prevent pinning, too, but the best method is to clean the
                                                                    file frequently with a FILE CARD or brush. A file card
                                                                    (fig. 1-23) has fine wire bristles. Brush with a pulling
                                                                    motion, holding the card parallel to the rows of teeth.
                                                                         Always keep the file clean, whether you're filing
                                                                    mild steel or other metals. Use chalk liberally when
                                                                    filing nonferrous metals.
                                                                         FILING ROUND-METAL STOCK.—Figure
                                                                    1-21, view D, shows that as a file is passed over the
                                                                    surface of round work, its angle with the work is
                                                                    changed. This results in a rocking motion of the file as it
                                                                    passes over the work. This rocking motion permits all
                                                                    the teeth on the file to make contact and cut as they pass
                                                                    over the work's surface, thus tending to keep the file
                                                                    much cleaner and thereby doing better work.
                                                                        POLISHING A FLAT-METAL SURFACE.—
                                                                    When polishing a flat metal surface, first draw file the
                                                                    surface as shown in figure 1-21, view C. Then, when the
                                                                    best possible drawfiled surface has been obtained,
                                                                    proceed with abrasive cloth, often called emery cloth.
                                                                    Select a grade of cloth suited to the drawfiling. If the
                                                                    drawfiling was well done, only a fine cloth will be
                                                                    needed to do the polishing.
                                                             1-16
     If your cloth is in a roll and if the job you are                Care of Files
polishing is the size that would be held in a vise, tear off
a 6- or 8-inch length of the 1- or 2-inch width. If you are                A new file should be broken in carefully by using it
using sheets of abrasive cloth, tear off a strip from the             first on brass, bronze, or smooth cast iron. Just a few of
long edge of the 8- by 11-inch sheet.                                 the teeth will cut at first, so use a light pressure to
                                                                      prevent tooth breakage. Do not break in a new file by
    Wrap the cloth around the file (fig. 1-22, view A)
                                                                      using it first on a narrow surface.
and hold the file as you would for drawfiling. Hold the
end of the cloth in place with your thumb. In polishing,                  Protect the file teeth by hanging your files in a rack
apply a thin film of lubricating oil on the surface being             when they are not in use or by placing them in drawers
polished and use a double stroke with pressure on both                with wooden partitions. Your files should not be
the forward and the backward strokes. Note that this is               allowed to rust—keep them away from water and
different from the drawfiling stroke in which you cut                 moisture. Avoid getting the files oily. Oil causes a file to
with the file in only one direction.                                  slide across the work and prevents fast, clean cutting.
                                                                      Files that you keep in your toolbox should be wrapped
    When further polishing does not appear to improve
                                                                      in paper or cloth to protect their teeth and prevent
the surface, you are ready to use the next finer grade of
                                                                      damage to other tools.
cloth. Before changing to the finer grade, however,
reverse the cloth so that its back is toward the surface                   Never use a file for prying or pounding. The tang is
being polished.                                                       soft and bends easily. The body is hard and extremely
                                                                      brittle. Even a slight bend or a fall to the deck may
    Work the reversed cloth back and forth in the
                                                                      cause a file to snap in two. Do not strike a file against
abrasive-laden oil as an intermediate step between
                                                                      the bench or vise to clean it—use a file card.
grades of abrasive cloth. Then, with the solvent
available in your ship, clean the job thoroughly before               Safety
proceeding with the next finer grade of cloth. Careful
cleaning between grades helps to ensure freedom from                       Never use a file unless it is equipped with a
scratches.                                                            tight-fitting handle. If you use a file without the handle
     For the final polish, use a strip of crocus                      and it bumps something or jams to a sudden stop, the
cloth—first the face and then the back—with plenty of                 tang may be driven into your hand. To put a handle on a
oil. When polishing is complete, again carefully clean                file tang, drill a hole in the handle, slightly smaller than
the job with a solvent and protect it with oil or other               the tang. Insert the tang end, and then tap the end of the
means, from rusting.                                                  handle to seat it firmly. Make sure you get the handle on
                                                                      straight.
    In figure 1-22, A of view B shows another way to
polish, in which the abrasive cloth is wrapped around a               TWIST DRILLS
block of wood. In B of view B, the cloth has simply
been folded to form a pad, from which a worn, dull                        Making a hole in a piece of metal is generally a
surface can be removed by simply tearing it off to                    simple operation, but in most cases an important,
expose a new surface.                                                 precise job. A large number of different tools and
    POLISHING ROUND-METAL STOCK.—In                                   machines have been designed so that holes may be
figure 1-22, view C, a piece of round stock is being                  made speedily, economically, and accurately in all
polished with a strip of abrasive cloth, which is                     kinds of material.
"seesawed" back and forth as it is guided over the                         To be able to use these tools efficiently, it is
surface being polished.                                               important that you become acquainted with them. The
    Remember that the selection of grades of abrasive                 most common tool for making holes in metal is the
cloth, the application of oil, and the cleaning between               twist drill. It consists of a cylindrical piece of steel with
grades applies to polishing, regardless of how the cloth              spiral grooves. One end of the cylinder is pointed, while
is held or used.                                                      the other end is shaped so that it may be attached to a
                                                                      drilling machine. The grooves, usually called FLUTES,
                                                                      may be cut into the steel cylinder, or the flutes may be
                                                                      formed by twisting a flat piece of steel into a cylindrical
                                                                      shape.
                                                               1-17
                                                                          The shank is the part of the drill that fits into the
                                                                      socket, spindle, or chuck of the drill press. Several
                                                                      types exist (fig. 1-25).
                                                                         The maintenance of twist drills and more about
                                                                      how to use them on specific jobs are discussed later.
                                                                                     REVIEW QUESTIONS
                                                                       Q7.     Identify the different types of metal-cutting
                                                                               tools.
                                                                       Q8.     What are hawks-bill snips used for?
                                                                       Q9.     What are hacksaws used for?
                                                                      Q10.     What are taps and dies used for?
                                                                                          WRENCHES
                                                                          LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Identify the
                                                                          different types of wrenches. Describe the uses
                                                                          of different types of wrenches. List the safety
                                                                          precautions that apply to wrenches.
                                                                          A wrench is a basic tool that is used to exert a
                                                                      twisting force on bolt heads, nuts, studs, and pipes. The
                                                                      special wrenches designed to do certain jobs are, in
                                                                      most cases, variations of the basic wrenches that are
                                                                      described in this section.
                                                                          The best wrenches are made of chrome vanadium
                                                                      steel. Wrenches made of this material are lightweight
                                                                      and almost unbreakable. This is an expensive material,
                                                                      however, so the most common wrenches found in the
                                                                      Navy are made of forged carbon steel or molybdenum
                                                                      steel. These latter materials make good wrenches, but
                                                                      they are generally built a little heavier and bulkier to
                                                                      achieve the same degree of strength as chrome
                                                                      vanadium steel.
                                                               1-18
     The size of any wrench used on bolt heads or nuts is           phases of hydraulic maintenance it may be impossible
determined by the size of the opening between the jaws              to swing an ordinary wrench because of its length.
of the wrench. The opening of a wrench is                           Ordinary wrenches that are normally available increase
manufactured slightly larger than the bolt head or nut              in length as their size increases. Thus, when a large-size
that it is designed to fit. Hex-nuts (six-sided) and other          wrench is needed, the length of the wrench sometimes
types of nut or bolt heads are measured across opposite             prevents its use, due to the space available to swing the
flats (fig. 1-26). A wrench that is designed to fit a               wrench. The Bonney wrench, shown in figure 1-27, is
3/8-inch nut or bolt usually has a clearance of from 5 to           an open-end wrench that may be used to great
8 thousandths of an inch. This clearance allows the                 advantage because of its thickness and short length.
wrench to slide on and off the nut or bolt with a                   This wrench is normally procured in the larger sizes,
minimum of "play." If the wrench is too large, the                  although it is available in a range of sizes to fit most
points of the nut or bolt head will be rounded and                  hydraulic fittings.
destroyed.
                                                                         Open-end wrenches may have their jaws parallel to
    There are many types of wrenches. Each type is                  the handle or at angles anywhere up to 90 degrees. The
designed for a specific use. Let's discuss some of them.            average angle is 15 degrees (fig. 1-26). This angular
                                                                    displacement variation permits selection of a wrench
OPEN-END WRENCHES                                                   suited for places where there is room to make only a
                                                                    part of a complete turn of a nut or bolt. If the wrench is
     Solid, nonadjustable wrenches with openings in                 turned over after the first swing, it will fit on the same
one or both ends are called open-end wrenches. (See                 flats and turn the nut farther. After two swings on the
fig. 1-26.) Usually they come in sets of from 6 to 10               wrench, the nut is turned far enough so that a new set of
wrenches, with sizes ranging from 5/16 to 1 inch.                   flats are in position for the wrench, as shown in figure
Wrenches with small openings are usually shorter than               1-28.
wrenches with large openings. This proportions the
lever advantage of the wrench to the bolt or stud and                   Handles are usually straight, but may be curved.
helps prevent wrench breakage or damage to the bolt or              Those with curved handles are called S-wrenches.
stud. One exception exists.                                         Other open-end wrenches may have offset handles.
                                                                    This allows the head to reach nut or bolt heads that are
    Hydraulic piping installations for catapult and                 sunk below the surface.
arresting gear are often in close spaces. During certain
                                                             1-19
    1                                          2
3 4
5 6
                                                                      ABEf0105
        Figure 1-28.—Use of open-end wrench.
                       1-20
    The non-adjustable union nut wrench (fig. 1-29) is
used to assemble and disassemble launch valve piping
union nuts. These special open-end wrenches are
designed to pass over the piping and then slide onto the
union nut to fully engage five of the six flats, thus
reducing the probability of damaging the nuts.                                Figure 1-30.—12-point box-end wrench.
    One advantage of the 12-point construction is the                   When you have to pull hard on the wrench, as in
thin wall. It is more suitable for turning nuts that are            loosening a tight nut, make sure the wrench is seated
hard to get at with an open-end wrench. Another                     squarely on the flats of the nut.
advantage is that the wrench will operate between                        Pull on the wrench—DO NOT PUSH. Pushing a
obstructions where the space for handle swing is                    wrench is a good way to skin your knuckles if the
limited. A very short swing of the handle will turn the             wrench slips or the nut breaks loose unexpectedly. If it
nut far enough to allow the wrench to be lifted and the             is impossible to pull the wrench and you must push, do
next set of points fitted to the corners of the nut.                it with the palm of your hand and hold your palm open.
    One disadvantage of the box-end wrench is the                        Only actual practice will tell you if you are using
time loss that occurs whenever a craftsman has to lift              the right amount of force on the wrench. The best way
the wrench off and place it back on the nut in another              to tighten a nut is to turn it until the wrench has a firm,
                                                                    solid "feel." This will turn the nut to proper tightness
                                                                    without stripping the threads or twisting off the bolt.
                                                                    This "feel" is developed by experience alone. Practice
                                                                    until you have mastered the "feel."
ABEf0106
                                                             1-21
                                        Figure 1-32.—Socket set components.
SOCKET WRENCH                                                    and electrical work. When used for the latter purpose, it
                                                                 must have an insulated handle.
    The socket wrench is one of the most versatile
                                                                     A complete socket wrench set consists of several
wrenches in the toolbox. Basically, it consists of a
                                                                 types of handles along with bar extensions, adapters,
handle and a socket-type wrench that can be attached to
                                                                 and a variety of sockets (fig. 1-32).
the handle.
    The "Spintite" wrench, shown in figure 1-32, is a            Sockets
special type of socket wrench. It has a hollow shaft to
accommodate a bolt protruding through a nut, has a                   A socket (fig. 1-33) has a square opening cut in one
hexagonal head, and is used like a screwdriver. It is            end to fit a square drive lug on a detachable handle. In
supplied in small sizes only and is useful for assembly          the other end of the socket is a 6-point or 12-point
                                                          1-22
opening, very much like the opening in the box-end                    at right angles to the socket. This gives the greatest
wrench. The 12-point socket needs to be swung only                    possible leverage. After loosening the nut to the point
half as far as the 6-point socket before it has to be lifted          where it turns easily, move the handle into the vertical
and fitted on the nut for a new grip. It can therefore be             position and then turn the handle with the fingers.
used in closer quarters where there is less room to move
                                                                          SLIDING T-BAR HANDLE.—When you are
the handle. (A ratchet handle eliminates the necessity of
                                                                      using the sliding bar or T-handle, the head can be
lifting the socket and refitting it on the nut again and
                                                                      positioned anywhere along the sliding bar. Select the
again.)
                                                                      position that is needed for the job at hand.
     Sockets are classified by size according to two
                                                                          SPEED HANDLE.—The speed handle is worked
factors. One is the size of the square opening, which fits
                                                                      like the woodworker's brace. After the nuts are first
on the square drive lug of the handle. This size is known
                                                                      loosened with the sliding bar handle or the ratchet
as the drive size. The other is the size of the opening in
                                                                      handle, the speed handle can be used to remove the nuts
the opposite end, which fits the nut or bolt. The
                                                                      more quickly. In many instances the speed handle is not
standard toolbox can be outfitted with sockets having
                                                                      strong enough to be used for breaking loose or
1/4-, 3/8-, and 1/2-inch-square drive lugs. Larger sets
                                                                      tightening the nut. The speed socket wrench should be
are usually available in the tool room for temporary
                                                                      used carefully to avoid damaging the nut threads.
checkout. The openings that fit onto the bolt or nut are
usually graduated in 1/16-inch sizes. Sockets are also
                                                                      Accessories
made in deep lengths to fit over spark plugs and long
bolt ends.                                                                 Several accessory items complete the socket
                                                                      wrench set. Extension bars of different lengths are
Socket Handles
                                                                      made to extend the distance from the socket to the
                                                                      handle. A universal joint allows the nut to be turned
     There are four types of handles used with these
                                                                      with the wrench handle at an angle. Universal sockets
sockets. (See fig. 1-32.) Each type has special
                                                                      are also available. The use of universal joints, bar
advantages, and the experienced worker chooses the
                                                                      extensions, and universal sockets in combination with
one best suited for the job at hand. The square driving
                                                                      appropriate handles makes it possible to form a variety
lug on the socket wrench handles has a spring-loaded
                                                                      of tools that will reach otherwise inaccessible nuts and
ball that fits into a recess in the socket receptacle. This
                                                                      bolts.
mated ball-recess feature keeps the socket engaged
with the drive lug during normal usage. A slight pull on                  Another accessory item is an adapter, which allows
the socket, however, disassembles the connection.                     you to use a handle having one size of drive and a socket
                                                                      having a different size drive. For example, a 3/8- by
     RATCHET.—The ratchet handle has a reversing
                                                                      1/4-inch adapter makes it possible to turn all
lever that operates a pawl (or dog) inside the head of the
                                                                      1/4-inch-square drive sockets with any 3/8-inch-square
tool. Pulling the handle in one direction causes the pawl
                                                                      drive handle.
to engage the ratchet teeth and turn the socket. Moving
the handle in the opposite direction causes the pawl to               TORQUE WRENCHES
slide over the teeth, permitting the handle to back up
without moving the socket. This allows rapid turning of                   There are times when, for engineering reasons, a
the nut or bolt after each partial turn of the handle. With           definite force must be applied to a nut or bolt head. In
the reversing lever in one position, the handle can be                such cases a torque wrench must be used. For example,
used for tightening. In the other position, it can be used            equal force must be applied to all the head bolts of an
for loosening.                                                        engine. Otherwise, one bolt may bear the brunt of the
    HINGED HANDLE.—The hinged handle is also                          force of internal combustion and ultimately cause
very convenient. To loosen tight nuts, swing the handle               engine failure.
                                                               1-23
    The three most commonly used torque wrenches                      the manufacturer specifies a thread lubricant, it must be
are the deflecting beam, dial indicating, and                         used to obtain the most accurate torque reading. When
micrometer setting types (fig. 1-34). When using the                  using the deflecting beam or dial indicating wrenches,
deflecting beam and the dial indicating torque                        hold the torque at the desired value until the reading is
wrenches, read the torque visually on a dial or scale                 steady.
mounted on the handle of the wrench.
                                                                          Torque wrenches are delicate and expensive tools.
    To use the micrometer setting type, unlock the grip               The following precautions should be observed when
and adjust the handle to the desired setting on the                   using them:
micrometer-type scale, then relock the grip. Install the
                                                                          1. When using the micrometer setting type, do not
required socket or adapter to the square drive of the
                                                                             move the setting handle below the lowest
handle. Place the wrench assembly on the nut or bolt
                                                                             torque setting. However, it should be placed at
and pull in a clockwise direction with a smooth, steady
                                                                             its lowest setting before it is returned to
motion. (A fast or jerky motion will result in an
                                                                             storage.
improperly torqued unit.) When the torque applied
reaches the torque value, which is indicated on the                       2. Do not use the torque wrench to apply greater
handle setting, a signal mechanism will automatically                        amounts of torque than its rated capacity.
issue an audible click, and the handle will release or                    3. Do not use the torque wrench to loosen bolts
"break," and move freely for a short distance. The                           that have been previously tightened.
release and free travel is easily felt, so there is no doubt
about when the torquing process is complete.                              4. Do not drop the wrench. If a torque wrench is
                                                                             dropped, its accuracy will be affected.
     Manufacturers' and technical manuals generally
specify the amount of torque to the applied. To assure                    5. Do not apply a torque wrench to a nut that has
getting the correct amount of torque on the fasteners, it                    been tightened. Back off the nut one turn with a
is important that the wrench be used properly according                      nontorque wrench and retighten to the correct
to manufacturer's instructions.                                              torque with the indicating torque wrench.
     Use the torque wrench that will read about                           6. Calibration intervals have been established for
mid-range for the amount of torque to be applied. BE                         all torque tools used in the Navy. When a tool is
SURE THE TORQUE WRENCH HAS BEEN                                              calibrated by a qualified calibration activity at
CALIBRATED BEFORE YOU USE IT. Remember,                                      a shipyard, tender, or repair ship, a label
too, that the accuracy of torque-measuring depends a                         showing the next calibration due date is
lot on how the threads are cut and the cleanliness of the                    attached to the handle. This date should be
threads. Make sure you inspect and clean the threads. If                     checked before a torque tool is used to ensure
                                                                             that it is not overdue for calibration.
                                                               1-24
ADJUSTABLE WRENCHES
a bloody hand. Second, be sure the jaws of the                                     Figure 1-37.—Union nut wrench.
correct-size wrench are adjusted to fit snugly on the nut.
Third, position the wrench around the nut until the nut
                                                                      not used in this manner, the result is apt to be as bloody
is all the way into the throat of the jaws. If the wrench is
                                                                      as before. Fourth, pull the handle toward the side
                                                                      having the adjustable jaw (fig. 1-36). This will prevent
                                                                      the adjustable jaw from springing open and slipping off
                                                                      the nut. If the location of the work will not allow for all
                                                                      four steps to be followed when using an adjustable
                                                                      wrench, then select another type of wrench for the job.
                                                               1-25
movable jaw on a pipe wrench is pivoted to permit a
gripping action on the work. This tool must be used
with discretion, as the jaws are serrated and always
make marks on the work unless adequate precautions
are observed. The jaws should be adjusted so the bite on
the work will be taken at about the center of the jaws.
Strap Wrench
SPANNER WRENCHES
                                                             1-26
                                                                              important, it eliminates the possibility of leaving
                                                                              them where they can cause injury to personnel or
                                                                              damage to equipment.
                                                                        • Determine which way a nut should be turned
                                                                          before trying to loosen it. Most nuts are turned
                                                                          counterclockwise for removal. This may seem
                                                                          obvious, but even experienced people have been
      Figure 1-41.—Allen- and Bristol-type wrenches.                      observed straining at the wrench in the
                                                                          tightening direction when they wanted to loosen
bars of tool steel (fig. 1-41). They generally range in                   the nut.
size up to 3/4 inch. When using the Allen-type wrench,
make sure you use the correct size to prevent rounding                  • Learn to select your wrenches to fit the type of
or spreading the head of the screw. A snug fit within the                 work you are doing. If you are not familiar with
recessed head of the screw is an indication that you                      these wrenches, make arrangements to visit a
have the correct size.                                                    shop that has most of them, and get acquainted.
SAFETY RULES FOR WRENCHES                                            Q12.       Describe the uses of different types of
                                                                                wrenches.
   There are a few basic rules that you should keep in               Q13.       List the safety precautions that apply to
mind when using wrenches. They are as follows:                                  wrenches.
    • Always use a wrench that fits the nut properly.
                                                                                               PLIERS
    • Keep wrenches clean and free from oil.
      Otherwise they may slip, resulting in possible                    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Identify the
      serious injury to you or damage to the work.                      different types of pliers. Describe the uses of
                                                                        different types of pliers. Describe the proper
    • Do not increase the leverage of a wrench by                       care of pliers.
      placing a pipe over the handle. Increased
      leverage may damage the wrench or the work.                        Pliers are made in many styles and sizes and are
                                                                     used to perform many different operations. Pliers are
    • Provide some sort of kit or case for all wrenches.             used for cutting purposes, as well as holding and
      Return them to the case at the completion of                   gripping small articles in situations where it may be
      each job. This saves time and trouble and aids                 inconvenient or impossible to use hands. Figure 1-42
      selection of tools for the next job. Most                      shows several different kinds.
Figure 1-42.—Pliers.
                                                              1-27
                                                                     additional feature of a side cutter at the junction of the
                                                                     jaws. This cutter consists of a pair of square-cut
                                                                     notches, one on each jaw, which act like a pair of shears
                                                                     when an object is placed between them and the jaws
                                                                     closed.
WRENCH PLIERS
    2. Do not use pliers to turn nuts. In just a few                         Wrench pliers should be used with care,
       seconds, a pair of pliers can damage a nut.                       since the teeth in the jaws tend to damage the
       Pliers must not be substituted for wrenches.                      object on which they are clamped. They should
                                                                         not be used on nuts, bolts, tube fittings, or other
SLIP-JOINT PLIERS                                                        objects that must be reused.
    Slip-joint pliers (fig. 1-43) are pliers with straight,          WATER-PUMP PLIERS
serrated (grooved) jaws, and pivot where the jaws are
fastened together to move to either of two positions to                  Water-pump pliers were originally designed for
grasp small- or large-sized objects better.                          tightening or removing water-pump packing nuts. They
                                                                     were excellent for this job because they have a jaw
    Slip-joint combination pliers are pliers similar to              adjustable to seven different positions. Water-pump
the slip-joint pliers just described but with the                    pliers (fig. 1-45) are easily identified by their size, jaw
                                                                     teeth, and adjustable slip joint. The inner surface of the
                                                                     jaws consists of a series of coarse teeth formed by deep
                                                              1-28
grooves, a surface adapted to grasping cylindrical                  SIDE-CUTTING PLIERS
objects.
                                                                        Side-cutting pliers (sidecutters) are principally
GROOVE-JOINT PLIERS                                                 used for holding, bending, and cutting thin materials or
                                                                    small gauge wire. Sidecutters vary in size and are
     Groove-joint pliers (fig. 1-46) are another version            designated by their overall length. The jaws are
of water-pump pliers and are easily identified by the               hollowed out on one side just forward of the pivot point
extra-long handles, which make them a very powerful                 of the pliers. Opposite the hollowed out portion of the
gripping tool. They are shaped approximately the same               jaws are the cutting edges (fig. 1-42).
as the pliers just described, but the jaw opening
                                                                        When holding or bending light metal surfaces, the
adjustment is effected differently. Groove-joint pliers
                                                                    jaw tips are used to grasp the object. When holding
have grooves on one jaw and lands on the other. The
                                                                    wire, grasp it as near one end as possible because the
adjustment is effected by changing the position of the
                                                                    jaws will mar the wire. To cut small-diameter wire, the
grooves and lands. The groove-joint pliers are less
                                                                    side-cutting edge of the jaws near the pivot is used.
likely to slip from the adjustment setting when gripping
                                                                    Never use sidecutters to grasp large objects, tighten
an object. The groove-joint pliers will only be used
                                                                    nuts, or bend heavy gauge metal, since such operations
where it is impossible to use a more adapted wrench or
                                                                    will spring the jaws.
holding device. Many nuts and bolts and surrounding
parts have been damaged by improper use of                              Sidecutters are often called electrician or lineman
groove-joint pliers.                                                pliers. They are used extensively for stripping
                                                                    insulation from wire and for twisting wire when
DIAGONAL PLIERS                                                     making a splice.
    Diagonal cutting pliers (fig. 1-42) are used for                DUCKBILL PLIERS
cutting small, light material, such as wire and cotter
pins in areas that are inaccessible to the larger cutting               Duckbill pliers (fig. 1-47, view A) have long wide
tools. Also, since they are designed for cutting only,              jaws and slender handles. Duckbills are used in
larger objects can be cut than with the slip-joint pliers.          confined areas where the fingers cannot be used. The
                                                                    jaw faces of the pliers are scored to aid in holding an
    Because the cutting edges are diagonally offset
                                                                    item securely. Duckbills are ideal for twisting the safety
approximately 15 degrees, diagonal pliers are adapted
                                                                    wire used in securing nuts, bolts, and screws.
to cutting small objects flush with a surface. The inner
jaw surface is a diagonal straight cutting edge.
Diagonal pliers should never be used to hold objects,
because they exert a greater shearing force than other
types of pliers of a similar size. The sizes of the
diagonal cutting pliers are designated by the overall
length of the pliers.
                                                             1-29
NEEDLE-NOSE PLIERS                                                   vise and the serrations recut by using a small
                                                                     three-corner file.
    Needle-nose pliers (fig. 1-47, view B) are used in                   Pliers should be coated with light oil when they are
the same manner as duckbill pliers. However, there is a              not in use. They should be stored in a toolbox in such a
difference in the design of the jaws. Needle-nose jaws               manner that the jaws cannot be injured by striking hard
are tapered to a point, which makes them adapted to                  objects. Keep the pin or bolt at the hinge just tight
installing and removing small cotter pins. They have                 enough to hold the two parts of the pliers in contact, and
serrations at the nose end and a side cutter near the                always keep the pivot pin lubricated with a few drops of
throat. Needle-nose pliers may be used to hold small                 light oil.
items steady, to cut and bend safety wire, or to do
numerous other jobs that are too intricate or too difficult                         REVIEW QUESTIONS
to be done by hand alone.                                            Q14.      Identify the different types of pliers.
                         NOTE
         When jaws on pliers do not open enough to
    permit grinding, remove the pin that attaches
    the two halves of the pliers, so that the jaws can
    be separated.
  The serrations on the jaws of pliers must be sharp.
When they become dull, the pliers should be held in a                       Figure 1-48.—Hammers, mallets, and sledges.
                                                              1-30
HAMMERS                                                              common fault is holding the handle too close to the
                                                                     head. This is known as choking the hammer, and
    A toolkit for nearly every rating in the Navy would              reduces the force of the blow. It also makes it harder to
not be complete without at least one hammer. In most                 hold the head in an upright position. Except for light
cases, two or three are included, since they are                     blows, hold the handle close to the end to increase
designated according to weight (without the handle)                  leverage and produce a more effective blow. Hold the
and style or shape. The shape will vary according to the             handle with the fingers underneath and the thumb along
intended work.                                                       side or on top of the handle. The thumb should rest on
                                                                     the handle and never overlap the fingers. Try to hit the
Machinists' Hammers                                                  object with the full force of the hammer. Hold the
                                                                     hammer at such an angle that the face of the hammer
   Machinists' hammers are mostly used by people                     and the surface of the object being hit will be parallel.
who work with metal or around machinery. These                       This distributes the force of the blow over the full face
hammers are distinguished from carpenter hammers by                  and prevents damage to both the surface being struck
a variable-shaped peen, rather than a claw, at the                   and the face of the hammer.
opposite end of the face (fig. 1-48). The ball-peen
hammer is probably most familiar to you.                             MALLETS AND SLEDGES
     The ball-peen hammer, as its name implies, has a
ball that is smaller in diameter than the face. It is                      The mallet is a short-handled tool used to drive
therefore useful for striking areas that are too small for           wooden-handled chisels, gouges, and wooden pins, or
the face to enter.                                                   to form or shape sheet metal where hard-faced
                                                                     hammers would mar or damage the finished work.
    Ball-peen hammers are made in different weights,                 Mallet heads are made from a soft material, usually
usually 4, 6, 8, and 12 ounces and 1, 1 1/2, and 2                   wood, rawhide, or rubber. For example, a rubber-faced
pounds. For most work a 1 1/2 pound and a 12-ounce                   mallet is used for knocking out dents in an automobile.
hammer will suffice. However, a 4- or 6-inch hammer                  It is cylindrically shaped with two flat driving faces that
will often be used for light work such as tapping a                  are reinforced with iron bands. (See fig. 1-48.) Never
punch to cut gaskets out of sheet gasket material.                   use a mallet to drive nails, screws, or any other object
     Machinists' hammers may be further divided into                 that can damage the face of the mallet.
hard-face and soft-face classifications. The hard-faced
hammer is made of forged tool steel, while the
soft-faced hammers have a head made of brass, lead, or
a tightly rolled strip of rawhide. Plastic-faced hammers
or solid plastic hammers with a lead core for added
weight are becoming increasingly popular.
    Soft-faced hammers (fig. 1-48) should be used
when there is danger of damaging the surface of the
work, as when pounding on a machined surface. Most
soft-faced hammers have heads that can be replaced as
the need arises. Lead-faced hammers, for instance,
quickly become battered and must be replaced, but have
the advantage of striking a solid, heavy nonrebounding
blow that is useful for such jobs as driving shafts into or
out of tight holes. If a soft-faced hammer is not
available, the surface to be hammered may be protected
by covering it with a piece of soft brass, copper, or hard
wood.
Using Hammers
                                                              1-31
     The sledge is a steel-headed, heavy-duty driving                      punches and chisels is slightly softer than that of
tool that can be used for a number of purposes.                            the hammerhead.
Short-handled sledges are used to drive driftpins, and
large nails, and to strike cold chisels and small                                  REVIEW QUESTIONS
hand-held rock drills. Long-handled sledges are used to
break rock and concrete, to drive spikes or stakes, and             Q18.     Identify the different types of striking tools.
to strike rock drills and chisels.                                  Q19.     Describe the uses of different types of striking
    The head of a sledge is generally made of a                              tools.
high-carbon steel and may weigh from 2 to 16 pounds.                Q20.     Describe the proper care of striking tools.
The shape of the head will vary according to the job for
which the sledge is designed.                                       Q21.     List the safety precautions that apply to
                                                                             striking tools.
MAINTENANCE OF STRIKING TOOLS
                                                                                          PUNCHES
    Hammers, sledges, or mallets should be cleaned
and repaired if necessary before they are stored. Before                LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Identify the
using them, make sure the faces are free from oil or                    different types of punches. Describe the uses of
other material that would cause the tool to glance off                  different types of punches.
nails, spikes, or stakes. The heads should be dressed to                 A hand punch is a tool that is held in the hand and
remove any battered edges.                                          struck on one end with a hammer. There are many kinds
     Never leave a wooden or rawhide mallet in the sun,             of punches designed to do a variety of jobs. Figure 1-50
as it will dry out and may cause the head to crack. A               shows several types of punches. Most punches are
light film of oil should be left on the mallet to maintain          made of tool steel. The part held in the hand is usually
a little moisture in the head.                                      octagonal in shape, or it may be knurled. This prevents
                                                                    the tool from slipping around in the hand. The other end
    The hammer handle should always be tight in the                 is shaped to do a particular job.
head. If it is loose, the head may fly off and cause an
injury.                                                                When you use a punch, there are two things to
                                                                    remember:
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
                                                             1-32
    1. When you hit the punch, you do not want it to               They are made that way to withstand the shock of heavy
       slip sideways over your work.                               blows. They may be used for knocking out rivets after
                                                                   the heads have been chiseled off or for freeing pins that
    2. You do not want the hammer to slip off the
                                                                   are "frozen" in their holes.
       punch and strike your fingers. You can
       eliminate both of these troubles by holding the                  After a pin has been loosened or partially driven
       punch at right angles to the work and striking              out, the drift punch may be too large to finish the job.
       the punch squarely with your hammer.                        The follow-up tool to use is the PIN PUNCH. It is
                                                                   designed to follow through the hole without jamming.
     The center punch, as the name implies, is used for
                                                                   Always use the largest drift or pin punch that will fit the
marking the center of a hole to be drilled. If you try to
                                                                   hole. These punches usually come in sets of three to
drill a hole without first punching the center, the drill
                                                                   five assorted sizes. Both of these punches will have flat
will "wander" or "walk away" from the desired center.
                                                                   ends, never edged or rounded.
     Another use of the center punch is to make
                                                                        To remove a bolt or pin that is extremely tight, start
corresponding marks on two pieces of an assembly to
                                                                   with a drift punch that has an end diameter that is
permit reassembling in the original positions. Before
                                                                   slightly smaller than the diameter of the object you are
taking a mechanism apart, make a pair of center
                                                                   removing. As soon as the bolt or pin loosens, finish
punchmarks in one or more places to help in
                                                                   driving it out with a pin punch. Never use a pin punch
reassembly. To do this, select places, staggered as
                                                                   for starting a pin, because it has a slim shank and a hard
shown in figure 1-51, where matching pieces are
                                                                   blow may cause it to bend or break.
joined. First, clean the places selected. Then, scribe a
line across the joint, and center punch the line on both               For assembling units of a machine, an ALIGN-
sides of the joint, with single and double marks as                MENT (aligning) punch is invaluable. It is usually
shown to eliminate possible errors. In reassembly, refer           about 1-foot long and has a long gradual taper. Its
first to the sets of punchmarks to determine the                   purpose is to line up holes in mating parts.
approximate position of the parts. Then line up the
                                                                       Hollow metal-cutting punches are made from
scribed lines to determine the exact position.
                                                                   hardened tool steel. They are made in various sizes and
    To make the intersection of two layout lines, bring            are used to cut holes in light gauge sheet metal.
the point of the prick punch to the exact point of
                                                                        Other punches have been designed for special uses.
intersection and tap the punch lightly with a hammer. If
                                                                   One of these is the soft-faced drift. It is made of brass or
inspection shows that the exact intersection and the
                                                                   fiber and is used for such jobs as removing shafts,
punchmark do not coincide, as in view A of figure 1-52,
                                                                   bearings, and wrist pins from engines. It is generally
slant the punch as shown in view B and strike again
                                                                   heavy enough to resist damage to itself, but soft enough
with the hammer, thus enlarging the punchmark and
                                                                   not to injure the finished surface on the part that is being
centering it exactly. When the intersection has been
                                                                   driven.
correctly punched, finish off with a light blow on the
punch held in an upright position. View C shows the
corrected punchmark.
   DRIFT punches, sometimes called "starting
punches," have a long taper from the tip to the body.
                                                            1-33
     You may have to make gaskets of rubber, cork,
leather, or composition materials. For cutting holes in
gasket materials, a hollow shank GASKET PUNCH
may be used (fig. 1-50). Gasket punches come in sets of
various sizes to accommodate standard bolts and studs.
The cutting end is tapered to a sharp edge to produce a
clean uniform hole. To use the gasket punch, place the
gasket material to be cut on a piece of hard wood or lead
so that the cutting edge of the punch will not be
damaged. Then strike the punch with a hammer, driving
it through the gasket where holes are required.
               REVIEW QUESTIONS
Q22.      Identify the different types of punches.
Q23.      What is a center punch used for?
Q24.      What is a prick punch used for?
                                                              1-34
                                   TWO-PIECE RECTANGULAR PIPE DIE                         1          2
                                                                                INCHES
                                        ADJUSTING
                                         SCREW
                TWO-PIECE COLLET                SCREW ADJUSTING                       OPEN ADJUSTING
                       DIE                           TYPE                                  TYPE
                                                                                                     ABEf0141
with a socket, box, open-end, or any wrench that will              forces the sides of the die apart or allows them to spring
fit. Rethreading dies are available in sets of 6, 10, 14,          together. The adjustment in the open adjusting type is
and 28 assorted sizes in a case.                                   made by means of three screws in the holder, one for
                                                                   expanding and two for compressing the dies.
    Round split adjustable dies (fig. 1-55) are called
"Burton" dies and can be used in either hand diestocks                 Two piece collet dies (fig. 1-55) are used with a
or machine holders. The adjustment in the screw                    collet cap (fig. 1-56) and collet guide. The die halves
adjusting type is made by a fine-pitch screw, which                are placed in the cap slot and are held in place by the
INCHES
                                                                                                                COLLET
                                                                                                                 CAP
                                                                                                                COLLET
                                                                                                                 GUIDE
                                                            1-35
                                 Figure 1-57.—Adjustable die guide and ratchet diestocks.
guide, which screws into the underside of the cap. The             Q26.   What are taper taps used for?
die is adjusted by setscrews at both ends of the interval
                                                                   Q27.   Identify the different types of dies.
slot. This type of adjustable die is issued in various
sizes to cover the cutting ranges of American Standard             Q28.   What are two-piece rectangular pipe dies
Coarse and Fine and special-form threads. Diestocks to                    used for?
hold the dies come in three different sizes.
    Two-piece rectangular pipe dies (fig. 1-55) are
available to cut American Standard Pipe threads. They
are held in ordinary or ratchet-type diestocks (fig.
1-57).
    Threading sets are available in many different
combinations of taps and dies, together with diestocks,
tap wrenches, guides, and necessary screwdrivers and
wrenches to loosen and tighten adjusting screws and
bolts. Figure 1-58 illustrates typical threading sets for
pipe, bolts, and screws.
     Never attempt to sharpen taps or dies. Sharpening
of taps and dies involves several highly precise cutting
processes that involve the thread characteristics and
chamfer. These sharpening procedures must be done by
experienced personnel to maintain the accuracy and the
cutting effectiveness of taps and dies.
    Keep taps and dies clean and well oiled when not in
use. Store them so that they do not contact each other or
other tools. For long periods of storage, coat taps and
dies with a rust-preventive compound, place in
individual or standard threading set boxes, and store in
a dry place.
               REVIEW QUESTIONS
Q25.     Identify the different types of taps.                             Figure 1-58.—Tap and die thread sets.
                                                            1-36
                    POWER TOOLS                                           If you are going to do heavy work, such as drilling
                                                                      in masonry or steel, then you would probably need to
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Identify the
                                                                      use a drill with a 3/8- or 1/2-inch capacity. If most of
    different types of power tools. Describe the
                                                                      your drilling will be forming holes in wood or small
    uses of different types of power tools. List the
                                                                      holes in sheet metal, then a 1/4-inch drill will probably
    safety precautions that apply to power tools.
                                                                      be adequate.
    List the safety precautions that apply to
    extension cords.                                                       The chuck is the clamping device into which the
                                                                      drill bit is inserted. Nearly all electric drills are
    Power tools have become so commonplace in the
                                                                      equipped with a three-jaw chuck. Some drills have a
Navy that all ratings now use them in the performance
                                                                      hand-type chuck that you tighten or loosen by hand, but
of maintenance at one time or another.
                                                                      most of the drills used in the Navy have gear-type,
    The following paragraphs are devoted to the                       three-jaw chucks, which are tightened and loosened by
identification, general-operating practices, and care of              a chuck key, shown in figure 1-60. Do not apply further
these tools.                                                          pressure with pliers or wrenches after you hand tighten
                                                                      the chuck with the chuck key.
DRILLS
                                                                          Always remove the key IMMEDIATELY after you
     The portable electric drill (fig. 1-59) is probably the          use it. Otherwise the key will fly loose when the drill
most frequently used power tool in the Navy. Although                 motor is started and may cause serious injury to you or
it is especially designed for drilling holes, by adding               one of your shipmates. The chuck key is generally
various accessories you can adapt it for different jobs.              taped on the cord of the drill; but if it is not, make sure
Sanding, sawing, buffing, polishing, screw driving,                   you put it in a safe place where it will not get lost.
wire brushing, and paint mixing are examples of                           All portable electric drills used in the Navy have
possible uses.                                                        controls similar to the ones shown on the 1/4-inch drill
     Portable electric drills commonly used in the Navy               in figure 1-59. This drill has a momentary contact
have capacities for drilling holes in steel from 1/16 inch            trigger switch located in the handle. The switch is
up to 1 inch in diameter. The sizes of portable electric              squeezed to start the electric drill and released to stop it.
drills are classified by the maximum size straight shank                   The trigger latch is a button in the bottom of the
drill it will hold. That is, a 1/4-inch electric drill will           drill handle. It is pushed in while the switch trigger is
hold a straight shank drill bit up to and including                   held down to lock the trigger switch in the ON position.
1/4 inch in diameter.                                                 The trigger latch is released by squeezing and then
     The revolutions per minute (rpm) and power the                   releasing the switch trigger.
drill will deliver are most important when choosing a
drill for a job. You will find that the speed of the drill
motor decreases with an increase in size, primarily
because the larger units are designed to turn larger
cutting tools or to drill in heavy materials, and both of
these factors require slower speed.
Figure 1-59.—1/4-inch portable electric drill. Figure 1-60.—Three-jaw chuck and chuck key.
                                                               1-37
DISK SANDER
    Portable grinders are power tools that are used for            not interchangeable, however, from one wrench to
rough grinding and finishing of metallic surfaces. They            another.
are made in several sizes; however, the one used most in
the Navy uses a grinding wheel with a maximum                           The electric wrench with its accompanying
diameter of 6 inches. See figure 1-62.                             equipment is primarily intended for applying and
                                                                   removing nuts, bolts, and screws. It may also be used to
     The abrasive wheels are easily replaceable so that            drill and tap metal, wood, plastics, and so on, and to
different grain size and grades of abrasives can be used           drive and remove socket-head, Phillips-head, or
for the various types of surfaces to be ground and the             slotted-head wood, machine, or self-tapping screws.
different degrees of finish desired.
                                                                       Before you use an electric impact wrench, depress
    A flexible shaft attachment is available for most              the on-and-off trigger switch and allow the electric
portable grinders. This shaft is attached by removing              wrench to operate a few seconds, noting carefully the
the grinding wheel, then attaching the shaft to the                direction of rotation. Release the trigger switch to stop
grinding wheel drive spindle. The grinding wheel can               the wrench. Turn the reversing ring, located at the rear
then be attached to the end of the flexible shaft. This            of the tool; it should move easily in one direction
attachment is invaluable for grinding surfaces in                  (which is determined by the current direction of
hard-to-reach places.                                              rotation). Depress the on-and-off trigger again to start
                                                                   the electric wrench. The direction of rotation should
ELECTRIC IMPACT WRENCH                                             now be reversed. Continue to operate for a few seconds
                                                                   in each direction to be sure that the wrench and its
    The electric impact wrench (fig. 1-63) is a portable,          reversible features are functioning correctly. When you
hand-type reversible wrench. The one shown has a
1/2-inch-square impact-driving anvil, over which
1/2-inch-square drive sockets can be fitted. Wrenches
also can be obtained that have impact driving anvils
ranging from 3/8 inch to 1 inch. The driving anvils are
                                                            1-38
are sure the wrench operates properly, place the suitable           SAFETY PRECAUTIONS FOR USE WITH
equipment on the impact-driving anvil and go ahead                  EXTENSION CORDS
with the job at hand.
                                                                        You should use the following procedures when
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS FOR USE WITH                                     using extension cords:
PORTABLE ELECTRICAL TOOLS
                                                                       • Only three-wire extension cords that have
    When portable electric tools are used, you should                    three-pronged plugs and three-slot receptacles
use the following procedures:                                            should be used.
    • Before portable electrical tools are used they                   • Because a metal hull ship is a hazardous
      must be inspected and approved for shipboard                       location, personnel who must use portable
      use by the ship's electrical safety officer.                       electric devices connected to extension cords
                                                                         should take the time to plug the device into the
    • Prior to the use of any portable electric tools, you               extension cord before the extension cord is
      should make sure the tools have a current ship's                   inserted into a live bulkhead receptacle.
      inspection mark. Additionally, visually examine                    Likewise, the extension cord should be
      the attached cable with the plug and any                           unplugged from the bulkhead receptacle before
      extension cords for cracks, breaks, or exposed                     the device is unplugged from the extension cord.
      conductors and damaged plugs. When any
      defects are noted, the tools should be turned in to              • Electrical cords shall be cared for as follows:
      the ship's electrical shop for repair before use.                    — Cords should not be allowed to come in
      Before plugging in any tool, be sure the tool is                       contact with sharp objects. They should not
      turned off.                                                            be allowed to kink nor should they be left
                                                                             where they might be damaged by
    • Personnel using portable electric tools are
                                                                             vehicle/foot traffic. When it is necessary to
      required to wear safety glasses/goggles.
                                                                             run electrical leads through doors and
    • Portable electric tools producing hazardous                            hatches, the cords must be protected to
      noise levels in excess of the limits set forth in                      guard against accidental closing of the
      OPNAVINST 5100.19 (Series) are required to                             doors/hatches.
      be conspicuously labeled. Personnel using tools
                                                                           — Cords must not come in contact with oil,
      designated as producing hazardous noise levels
                                                                             grease, hot surfaces, or chemicals.
      are required to wear proper ear protection, as
      issued by the medical department.                                    — Damaged cords must be replaced. They are
                                                                             not to be patched with tape.
    • Only explosion-proof (class I, group D, or
      better) portable electric tools should be used                       — Cords must be stored in a clean, dry place
      where flammable vapors, gases, liquids, or                             where they can be loosely coiled.
      exposed explosives are present.                                      — Cords extending through walkways should
    • Hand-held portable electric tools authorized for                       be elevated so they do not become a tripping
      use on board ship shall be equipped with                               hazard or interfere with safe passage.
      ON/OFF switches, which must be manually held                         — Extension cords should be no longer than 25
      in the closed ON position to maintain operation.                       feet (except repair locker and CV flight deck
    • Rubber gloves must be worn when you are using                          cords, which are 100 feet long). No more
      portable electric tools under hazardous                                than two such cords should be connected
      conditions; for example, wet decks, bilge areas,                       together for the operation of portable
      working over the side, in boats, and so forth.                         equipment.
                                                             1-39
Q31.      List the safety precautions that apply to                       Chipping hammers should not be operated without
          power tools.                                                safety goggles, and all other persons in the immediate
                                                                      vicinity of the work should wear goggles.
Q32.      List the safety precautions that apply to
          extension cords.                                                While working, never point the chipping hammer
                                                                      in such a direction that other personnel might be struck
        PORTABLE PNEUMATIC POWER                                      by an accidentally ejected tool. When chipping alloy
                  TOOLS                                               steel or doing other heavy work, it is helpful to dip the
                                                                      tool in engine lubricating oil about every 6 inches of the
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Identify dif-                                cut and make sure the cutting edge of the tool is sharp
    ferent types of portable pneumatic power tools.                   and clean. This will allow faster and easier cutting and
    Describe the uses of different types of portable                  will reduce the possibility of the tool breaking.
    pneumatic power tools. List the safety
    precautions that apply to portable pneumatic                          When nearing the end of a cut, ease off on the
    power tools.                                                      throttle lever to reduce the intensity of the blows. This
                                                                      will avoid any possibility of the chip or tool flying.
     Portable pneumatic power tools are tools that look
much the same as electric power tools but use the                         If for any reason you have to lay the chipping
energy of compressed air instead of electricity. Because              hammer down, always remove the attachment tool from
of the limited outlets for compressed air aboard ship                 the nozzle. Should the chipping hammer be
and shore stations, the use of pneumatic power tools is               accidentally started when the tool is free, the blow of
not as widespread as electric tools. Portable pneumatic               the piston will drive the tool out of the nozzle with great
tools are used most around a shop where compressed                    force and may damage equipment or injure personnel.
air outlets are readily accessible.
                                                                      ROTARY AND NEEDLE IMPACT
PNEUMATIC CHIPPING HAMMER                                             SCALERS
     The pneumatic chipping hammer (fig. 1-64)                            Rotary and needle scalers (figs. 1-65 and 1-66) are
consists basically of a steel piston that is reciprocated             used to remove rust, scale, and old paint from metallic
(moved backward and forward alternately) in a steel                   and masonry surfaces. You must be especially careful
barrel by compressed air. On its forward stroke the                   when using these tools since they will "chew" up
piston strikes the end of the chisel, which is a sliding fit          anything in their path. Avoid getting the power line or
in a nozzle pressed into the barrel. The rearward stroke              any part of your body in their way.
is cushioned by compressed air to prevent any                             The rotary scaling and chipping tool, sometimes
metal-to-metal contact. Reciprocation of the piston is                called a "jitterbug," has a bundle of cutters or chippers
automatically controlled by a valve located on the rear               for scaling or chipping (fig. 1-65). In use, the tool is
end of the barrel. Located on the rear end of the barrel is           pushed along the surface to be scaled, and the rotating
a grip handle, containing a throttle valve.                           chippers do the work. Replacement bundles of cutters
    The pneumatic hammer may be used for beveling;                    are available when the old ones are worn.
caulking or beading operations; and for drilling in
brick, concrete, and other masonry.
                                                               1-40
                                             Figure 1-66.—Needle impact scaler.
   BE SURE YOU ARE NOT DAYDREAMING                                      of that for which the tools are designed. The
when you use the rotary scaler.                                         wearing of appropriate eye protection equip-
                                                                        ment is mandatory for Navy personnel when
    Needle scalers accomplish their task with an
                                                                        operating pneumatic tools.
assembly of individual needles impacting on a surface
hundreds of times a minute. The advantage of using                   • You should be authorized and trained to operate
individual needles is that irregular surfaces can be                   pneumatic tools.
cleaned readily. See figure 1-66.
                                                                     • Pneumatic tools should be laid down in such a
PORTABLE PNEUMATIC IMPACT WRENCH                                       manner that no harm can be done if the switch is
                                                                       accidentally tripped. No idle tools should be left
     The portable pneumatic impact wrench (fig. 1-67)                  in a standing position.
is designed for installing or removing nuts and bolts.               • Pneumatic tools should be kept in good
The wrench comes in different sizes and is classified by               operating condition. They should be thoroughly
the size of the square anvil on the drive end. The anvil is            inspected at regular intervals with particular
equipped with a socket lock, which provides positive                   attention given to the ON-OFF control valve
locking of the socket wrenches or attachments.                         trigger guard (if installed), hose connections,
     Nearly all pneumatic wrenches operate most                        guide clips on hammers, and the chucks of
efficiently on an air pressure range of 80 to 100 psi.                 reamers and drills.
Lower pressure causes a decrease in the driving speeds,
                                                                     • Pneumatic tools and air lines may be fitted with
while higher pressure causes the wrench to overspeed
                                                                       quick-disconnect fittings. These should
with subsequent abnormal wear of the motor impact
                                                                       incorporate an automatic excess-flow shutoff
mechanisms.
                                                                       valve. This valve automatically shuts off the air
     Before operating the pneumatic impact wrench,
make sure the socket or other attachment you are using
is properly secured to the anvil. It is always a good idea
to operate the wrench free of load in both forward and
reverse directions to see that it operates properly. Check
the installation of the air hose to make sure it is in
accordance with the manufacturer's recommendation.
                                                              1-41
      at the air lines before changing grinding wheels,                 • Open the control valve momentarily before
      needles, chisels, or other cutting or drilling bits.                connecting an air hose to the compressed air
                                                                          outlet. Then, make sure the hose is clear of water
    • The air hose must be suitable to withstand the
                                                                          and other foreign material by connecting it to the
      pressure required for the tool. A leaking or
                                                                          outlet and again opening the valve momentarily.
      defective hose should be removed from service.
      The hose should not be laid over ladders, steps,                  • Stop the flow of air to a pneumatic tool by
      scaffolds, or walkways in such a manner as to                       closing the control valve at the compressed air
      create a tripping hazard. Where the hose is run                     outlet before connecting, disconnecting,
      through doorways, the hose should be protected                      adjusting, or repairing a pneumatic tool.
      against damage by the doors' edges. The air hose
      should generally be elevated over walkways or                               REVIEW QUESTIONS
      working surfaces in a manner to permit clear                  Q33.     Identify different types of portable pneumatic
      passage and to prevent damage to it.                                   power tools.
    • All portable pneumatic grinders must be                       Q34.     What are rotary and needle sanders used for?
      equipped with a safety lock-off device. A safety
      lock-off device is any operating control that                 Q35.     List the safety precautions that apply to
      requires positive action by the operator before                        portable pneumatic power tools.
      the tools can be turned on. The lock-off device
                                                                            SCREW AND TAP EXTRACTORS
      must automatically and positively lock the
      throttle in the OFF position when the throttle is                 LEARNING OBJECTIVE: State the purpose
      released. Two consecutive operations by the                       of screw and tap extractors.
      same hand are required, first to disengage the                    Screw extractors are used to remove broken screws
      lock-off device and then to turn on the throttle.             without damaging the surrounding material or the
      The lock-off device should be integral with the               threaded hole. Tap extractors are used to remove broken
      tool. It should not adversely affect the safety or            taps (fig. 1-68, view A).
      operating characteristics of the tools, and it
      should not be easily removable. Devices, such as
      a "dead-man control," that do not automatically
      and positively lock the throttle in the OFF
      position when the throttle is released are not
      safety lock-off devices.
   For detailed information on safety precautions, see
Navy Occupational Safety and Health (NAVOSH)
Program Manual for Forces Afloat, OPNAVINST
5100.19 (latest series).
                     WARNING
         Before opening the control valve, see that
    nearby personnel are not in the path of the
    airflow. Never point the hose at another person.                         Figure 1-68.—Screw and tap extractors.
                                                             1-42
    Screw extractors (view B) are straight, with                      (fig. 1-69) are used to cut tubing made of iron, steel,
spiraling flutes at one end. These extractors are                     brass, copper, or aluminum. The essential difference
available in sizes to remove broken screws having                     between pipe and tubing is that tubing has considerably
1/4- to 1/2-inch outside diameters (ODs). Spiral tapered              thinner walls. Flaring tools (fig. 1-70) are used to make
extractors are sized to remove screws and bolts from                  flares in the ends of tubing.
3/16 inch to 2 1/8 inches OD.
                                                                          Two sizes of hand pipe cutters are generally used in
     Most sets of extractors include twist drills and a               the Navy. The No. 1 pipe cutter has a cutting capacity of
drill guide. Tap extractors are similar to the screw                  1/8 inch to 2 inches, and the No. 2 pipe cutter has a
extractors and are sized to remove taps ranging from                  cutting capacity of 2 to 4 inches. The pipe cutter (fig.
3/16 inch to 2 1/8 inches OD.                                         1-69) has a special alloy-steel cutting wheel and two
                                                                      pressure rollers, which are adjusted and tightened by
     To remove a broken screw or tap with a spiral
                                                                      turning the handle.
extractor, first drill a hole of proper size in the screw or
tap. The size hole required for each screw extractor is                    Most TUBE CUTTERS closely resemble pipe
stamped on it. The extractor is then inserted in the hole,            cutters, except that they are of lighter construction. A
and turned counterclockwise to remove the defective                   hand screw feed tubing cutter of 1/8-inch to 1 1/4-inch
component.                                                            capacity (fig. 1-69) has two rollers with cutouts located
                                                                      off center so that cracked flares may be held in them
               REVIEW QUESTIONS                                       and cut off without waste of tubing. It also has a
                                                                      retractable cutter blade, which is adjusted by turning a
Q36.      State the purpose of screw and tap extractors.              knob. The other tube cutter shown is designed to cut
                                                                      tubing up to and including 1 inch OD. Rotation of the
       PIPE AND TUBING CUTTERS AND                                    triangular portion of the tube cutter within the tubing
              FLARING TOOLS                                           will eliminate any burrs.
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: State the                                        FLARING TOOLS (fig. 1-70) are used to flare soft
    purpose of pipe cutters, tube cutters, and                        copper, brass, or aluminum. The single flaring tool
    flaring tools.                                                    consists of a split die block, which has holes for 3/16-,
                                                                      1/4-, 5/16-, 3/8-, 7/16-, and 1/2-inch OD tubing; a
    Pipe cutters (fig. 1-69) are used to cut pipe made of             clamp to lock the tube in the die block; and a yoke,
steel, brass, copper, wrought iron, or lead. Tube cutters
                                                               1-43
                                                 Figure 1-70.—Flaring tools.
which slips over the die block and has a compressor                   STANDARD
screw and a cone that forms a 45-degree flare or a bell
shape on the end of the tube. The screw has a T-handle.                    There are three main parts to a standard screw-
A double flaring tool has the additional feature of                   driver. The portion you grip is called the handle, the
adapters, which turn in the edge of the tube before a                 steel portion extending from the handle is the shank,
regular 45-degree double flare is made. It consists of a              and the end that fits into the screw is called the blade
die block with holes for 3/16-, 1/4-, 5/16-, 3/8-, and                (fig. 1-71).
1/2-inch tubing; a yoke with a screw and a flaring cone;                   The steel shank is designed to withstand con-
plus five adapters for different size tubing, all carried in          siderable twisting force in proportion to its size, and the
a metal case.                                                         tip of the blade is hardened to keep it from wearing.
                                                                          Standard screwdrivers are classified by size,
               REVIEW QUESTIONS
                                                                      according to the combined length of the shank and
Q37.      What are pipe cutters used for?                             blade. The most common sizes range in length from
                                                                      2 1/2 to 12 inches. There are many screwdrivers smaller
Q38.      What are tube cutters used for?
                                                                      and some larger for special purposes. The diameter of
Q39.      What are flaring tools used for?                            the shank, and the width and thickness of the blade are
                                                                      generally proportionate to the length, but again there
                  SCREWDRIVERS                                        are special screwdrivers with long thin shanks, short
                                                                      thick shanks, and extra wide or extra narrow blades.
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Identify the
    different types of screwdrivers. List the safety                      When using a screwdriver, you should select the
    precautions that apply to screwdrivers.                           proper size so that the blade fits the screw slot properly.
                                                                      This prevents burring the slot and reduces the force
      A screwdriver is one of the most basic of handtools.            required to hold the driver in the slot. Keep the shank
It is also the most frequently abused of all hand tools. It           perpendicular to the screw head (fig. 1-72).
is designed for one function only—to drive and to
remove screws. A screwdriver should not be used as a
pry bar, a scraper, a chisel, or a punch.
                                                               1-44
                                                                  Figure 1-73.—Comparison of Phillips, Reed and Prince, and
                                                                                  Torq-Set screwheads.
Phillips Screwdriver
           Figure 1-71.—Types of screwdrivers.                       Reed and Prince screwdrivers are not inter-
                                                                 changeable with Phillips screwdrivers. Therefore,
                                                                 always use a Reed and Prince screwdriver with Reed
                                                                 and Prince screws, and a Phillips screwdriver with
RECESSED                                                         Phillips screws, or a ruined tool or ruined screwhead
                                                                 will result.
     Recessed screws are now available in various
shapes. They have a cavity formed in the head and                    To distinguish between these similar screwdrivers,
require a specially shaped screwdriver. The clutch tip           refer to figure 1-74.
(fig. 1-71) is one shape, but the more common include
the Phillips, Reed and Prince, and newer Torq-Set types
(fig. 1-73). The most common type of screw found is
the Phillips head. This requires a Phillips-type
screwdriver (fig. 1-71).
                                                          1-45
    The Phillips screwdriver has about 30-degree                   RATCHET SCREWDRIVER
flukes and a blunt end, while the Reed and Prince has
45-degree flukes and a sharper, pointed end. The                        For fast, easy work, the ratchet screwdriver (fig.
Phillips screw has beveled walls between the slots; the            1-71), is extremely convenient, as it can be used
Reed and Prince, straight, pointed walls. In addition,             one-handed and does not require the bit to be lifted out
the Phillips screw slot is not as deep as the Reed and             of the slot after each turn. It may be fitted with either a
Prince slot.                                                       standard-type bit or a special bit for recessed heads.
                                                                   The ratchet screwdriver is most commonly used by the
    Additional ways to identify the right screwdriver
                                                                   woodworker for driving screws in soft wood.
are as follows:
    1. If the screwdriver tends to stand up unassisted             SAFETY
       when the point is put in the head of a vertical
       screw, it is probably the proper one.                            Screwdrivers, like any other hand tool, are
                                                                   dangerous when not used properly. Therefore, the
    2. The outline of the end of a Reed and Prince                 following safety precautions should always be
       screwdriver is approximately a right angle, as              followed:
       seen in figure 1-74.
                                                                       • Never use a screwdriver to check an electrical
    3. In general, Reed and Prince screws are used for
                                                                         circuit.
       airframe structural applications, while Phillips
       screws are found most often in component                        • Never try to turn a screwdriver with a pair of
       assemblies.                                                       pliers.
     Since a Phillips driver could easily damage a                 Q40.      Identify the different types of screwdrivers.
Torq-Set screwhead, making it difficult if not                     Q41.      List the safety precautions that apply to
impossible to remove the screw even if the proper tool                       screwdrivers.
is later used, maintenance personnel should be alert to
the differences (fig. 1-73) and make sure the proper tool
                                                                                MECHANICAL FINGERS
is used.
                                                                       LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Describe the
OFFSET SCREWDRIVERS                                                    use of mechanical fingers.
     An offset screwdriver (fig. 1-71) may be used                     Small articles that have fallen into places where
where there is not sufficient vertical space for a                 they cannot be reached by hand may be retrieved with
standard or recessed screwdriver. Offset screwdrivers              mechanical fingers. Mechanical fingers, shown in
are constructed with one blade forged in line and                  figure 1-75, have a tube containing flat springs, which
another blade forged at right angles to the shank handle.          extend from the end of the tube to form clawlike
Both blades are bent 90 degrees to the shank handle. By            fingers, much like the screw holder. The springs are
alternating ends, most screws can be seated or loosened            attached to a rod that extends from the outer end of the
even when the swinging space is very restricted. Offset            tube. A plate is attached to the end of the tube, and a
screwdrivers are made for both standard and                        similar plate to be pressed by the thumb is attached to
recessed-head screws.                                              the end of the rod. A coil spring placed around the rod
                                                            1-46
between the two plates holds them apart and retracts the                           REVIEW QUESTIONS
fingers into the tube.
                                                                    Q42.      What are mechanical fingers used for?
     With the bottom plate grasped between the fingers
and enough thumb pressure applied to the top plate to                                   FLASHLIGHT
compress the spring, the tool fingers extend from the
tube in a grasping position. When the thumb pressure is                 LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Identify the
released, the tool fingers retract into the tube as far as              type of flashlight that belongs in every toolbox.
the object they hold will allow. Thus, enough pressure                   Each toolbox should have a standard Navy
is applied on the object to hold it securely. Some                  vaporproof two-cell flashlight. The flashlight is used
mechanical fingers have a flexible end on the tube to               constantly during all phases of maintenance. Installed
permit their use in close quarters or around obstructions           in both ends of the flashlight are rubber seals, which
(fig. 1-75).                                                        keep out all vapors. The flashlight should be inspected
                                                                    periodically for these seals, the spare bulb, and colored
                         NOTE                                       filters, which are contained in the cap.
        The fingers are made of thin sheet metal or
    spring wire and can be easily damaged by                                                  NOTE
    overloading.                                                            Do not throw away the filters; they will be
                                                                        necessary during night operations.
                                                                                    REVIEW QUESTION
                                                                    Q43.      Identify the type of flashlight that belongs in
                                                                              every toolbox.
                                                                                   INSPECTION MIRROR
                                                                        LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Describe the
                                                                        use of inspection mirrors.
                                                                        Several types of inspection mirrors are available for
                                                                    use in maintenance. The mirror is issued in a variety of
                                                                    sizes and may be round or rectangular. The mirror is
                                                                    connected to the end of a rod and may be fixed or
                                                                    adjustable (fig. 1-76).
                                                                         The inspection mirror aids in making detailed
                                                                    inspections where the human eye cannot directly see
                                                                    the inspection area. By angling the mirror, and with the
                                                                    aid of a flashlight, it is possible to inspect most required
                                                                    areas. One model of inspection mirror features a
                                                                    built-in light to aid in viewing those dark places where
                                                                    use of a flashlight is not convenient.
                                                             1-47
                    SUMMARY                                     and arresting gear. Blueprints, electrical prints, piping
                                                                prints, and aperture cards were discussed. By
    This chapter introduced you to the specific
                                                                thoroughly understanding this chapter, you, as an ABE,
purposes, correct uses, and proper care of some of the
                                                                will be able to perform your daily duties more
common hand tools and power tools that you will use as
                                                                efficiently and safely.
an ABE. You should be able to select, maintain, and
safely use tools required for maintenance of catapults
                                                         1-48
                                                  CHAPTER 2
    When performing maintenance and repair tasks on              simplest and most common is the steel or wooden
catapults and arresting gear equipment, you must take            straightedge rule. This rule is usually 6 or 12 inches
accurate measurements during inspection, to determine            long, although other lengths are available. Steel rules
the amount of wear or service life remaining on a                may be flexible or nonflexible, but the thinner the rule
particular item or to make sure replacement parts used           is, the easier it is to measure accurately with it, because
to repair equipment meet established specifications.             the division marks are closer to the work to be
The accuracy of these measurements, often affecting              measured.
the performance and failure rates of the concerned
                                                                      Generally, a rule has four sets of graduated division
equipment, depends on the measuring tool you use and
                                                                 marks, one on each edge of each side of the rule. The
your ability to use it correctly.
                                                                 longest lines represent the inch marks. On one edge,
                                                                 each inch is divided into 8 equal spaces, so each space
        COMMON MEASURING TOOLS                                   represents 1/8 inch. The other edge of this side is
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Identify the                            divided into sixteenths. The 1/4-inch and 1/2-inch
    different types of measuring tools. Describe                 marks are commonly made longer than the smaller
    the uses of different types of measuring tools.              division marks to facilitate counting, but the
    Describe the proper care of measuring tools.                 graduations are not normally numbered individually, as
                                                                 they are sufficiently far apart to be counted without
    You will use many different types of measuring               difficulty. The opposite side of the rule is similarly
tools in the daily performance of your duties. Where             divided into 32 and 64 spaces per inch, and it is
exact measurements are required, use a micrometer                common practice to number every fourth division for
caliper (mike). If you use the micrometer caliper                easier reading.
properly, it will allow you to measure within one
ten-thousandth (0.0001) of an inch accuracy. On the                  There are many variations of the common rule.
other hand, where accuracy is not extremely critical, a          Sometimes the graduations are on one side only,
common straightedge rule or tape rule will suffice for           sometimes a set of graduations is added across one end
most measurements.                                               for measuring in narrow spaces, and sometimes only
                                                                 the first inch is divided into 64ths, with the remaining
RULES AND TAPES                                                  inches divided into 32nds and 16ths.
                                                                      Steel tapes are made from 6 to about 300 feet in
     Figure 2-1 illustrates some of the commonly used            length. The shorter lengths are frequently made with a
straightedge and tape rules. Of all measuring tools, the         curved cross section so that they are flexible enough to
                                                                 roll up, but remain rigid when extended. Long, flat
                                                                 tapes require support over their full length when
                                                                 measuring, or the natural sag will cause an error in
                                                                 reading.
MEASURING PROCEDURES
                                                           2-1
  Figure 2-2.—Measuring with and reading a common rule.
Figure 2-3.—Measuring the length of a bolt or screw. Figure 2-5.—Measuring the inside diameter of a pipe.
                                                                2-2
                                                                    main body of the rule. See figure 2-7. In this illustration
                                                                    the length of the main body of the rule is 13 inches, and
                                                                    the extension is pulled out 3 3/16 inches; the total inside
                                                                    dimension being measured is 16 3/16 inches.
                                                                         Notice in the circled inset in figure 2-8 that the
                                                                    hook at the end of the particular rule shown is attached
                                                                    to the rule so that it is free to move slightly. When an
                                                                    outside dimension is taken by hooking the end of the
                                                                    rule over an edge, the hook will move to locate the end
                                                                    of the rule even with the surface from which the
                                                                    measurement is being taken. By being free to move, the
                                                                    hook will retract toward the end of the rule when an
                                                                    inside dimension is taken. To measure an inside
 Figure 2-6.—Measuring the circumference of a pipe with a           dimension using a tape rule, extend the rule between the
                       tape rule.                                   surfaces as shown, take a reading at the point on the
                                                                    scale where the rule enters the case, and add 2 inches.
                                                                    The 2 inches are the length of the case. The total is the
actual circumference of the pipe. This is extremely                 inside dimension being taken.
important when you are measuring a large diameter
pipe.                                                               Outside Dimensions
     Hold the rule or tape as shown in figure 2-6. Take
the reading, using the 2-inch graduation, for example,                   To measure an outside dimension using a tape rule,
as the reference point. In this case the correct reading is         hook the rule over the edge of the stock. Pull the tape
found by subtracting 2 inches from the actual reading.              out until it projects far enough from the case to permit
In this way the first 2 inches of the tape, serving as a            measuring the required distance. The hook at the end of
handle, will enable you to hold the tape securely.                  the rule is designed so that it will locate the end of the
                                                                    rule at the surface from which the measurement is being
Inside Dimensions                                                   taken. When taking a measurement of length, hold the
                                                                    tape parallel to the lengthwise edge. For measuring
     For an inside measurement such as the inside of a              widths, the tape should be at right angles to the
box, a folding rule that incorporates a 6- or 7-inch                lengthwise edge. Read the dimension of the rule exactly
sliding extension is one of the best measuring tools. To            at the edge of the piece being measured.
take the inside measurement, first unfold the folding                   It may not always be possible to hook the end of the
rule to the approximate dimension. Then, extend the                 tape over the edge of stock being measured. In this case
end of the rule and read the length that it extends,                it may be necessary to butt the end of the tape against
adding the length of the extension to the length on the             another surface or to hold the rule at a starting point
                                                                    from which a measurement is to be taken.
                                                              2-3
Distance Measurements                                             them with hard objects. They should preferably be kept
                                                                  in a wooden box when not in use.
    Steel or fiberglass tapes are generally used for
                                                                      To avoid kinking tapes, pull them straight out from
making long measurements. Secure the hook end of the
                                                                  their cases—do not bend them backward. With the
tape. Hold the tape reel in the hand and allow it to
                                                                  windup type, always turn the crank clockwise—turning
unwind while walking in the direction in which the
                                                                  it backward will kink or break the tape. With the
measurement is to be taken. Stretch the tape with
                                                                  spring-wind type, guide the tape by hand. If it is
sufficient tension to overcome sagging. At the same
                                                                  allowed to snap back, it may be kinked, twisted, or
time make sure the tape is parallel to an edge or the
                                                                  otherwise damaged. Do not use the hook as a stop. Slow
surface being measured. Read the graduation on the
                                                                  down as you reach the end.
tape by noting which line on the tape coincides with the
measurement being taken.
                                                                  SIMPLE CALIPERS
CARE OF RULES AND TAPES
                                                                      Simple calipers are used in conjunction with a scale
                                                                  or rule to determine the thickness or the diameter of a
   Handle rules and tapes carefully and keep metal
                                                                  surface, or the distance between surfaces. The calipers
ones lightly oiled to prevent rust. Never allow the edges
                                                                  you will most commonly use are shown in figure 2-9.
of measuring devices to become nicked by striking
                                                            2-4
     Outside calipers for measuring outside diameters              dimension set up on the caliper. To adjust a caliper to a
are bow-legged; those used for inside diameters have               scale dimension, hold one leg of the caliper firmly
straight legs with the feet turned outward. Calipers are           against one end of the scale and adjust the other leg to
adjusted by pulling or pushing the legs to open or close           the desired dimension. To adjust a caliper to the work,
them. Fine adjustment is made by tapping one leg                   open the legs wider than the work and then bring them
lightly on a hard surface to close them, or by turning             down to the work.
them upside down and tapping on the joint end to open
them.                                                                                     CAUTION
    Spring-joint calipers have the legs joined by a                        Never place a caliper on work that is
strong spring hinge and linked together by a screw and                 revolving in a machine.
adjusting nut. For measuring chamfered cavities
(grooves) or for use over flanges, transfer calipers are           Measuring the Diameter of Round Stock or the
available. They are equipped with a small auxiliary leaf           Thickness of Flat Stock
attached to one of the legs by a screw (fig. 2-9). The                  To measure the diameter of round stock or the
measurement is made as with ordinary calipers; then                thickness of flat stock, adjust the outside caliper so that
the leaf is locked to the leg. The legs may then be                you feel a slight drag as you pass it over the stock. (See
opened or closed as needed to clear the obstruction,               fig. 2-10.) After the proper "feel" has been attained,
then brought back and locked to the leaf again, thus               measure the setting of the caliper with a rule. In reading
restoring them to the original setting.                            the measurement, sight over the leg of the caliper after
     A different type of caliper is the hermaphrodite,             making sure the caliper is set squarely with the face of
sometimes called odd-leg caliper. This caliper has one             the rule.
straight leg ending in a sharp point, sometimes
removable, and one bow leg. The hermaphrodite caliper              Measuring the Distance Between Two Surfaces
is used chiefly for locating the center of a shaft, or for
locating a shoulder.                                                    To measure the distance between two surfaces with
                                                                   an inside caliper, first set the caliper to the approximate
USING CALIPERS                                                     distance being measured. Hold the caliper with one leg
                                                                   in contact with one of the surfaces being measured.
    A caliper is usually used in one of two ways. Either           (See fig. 2-11.) Then, as you increase the setting of the
the caliper is set to the dimension of the work and the            caliper, move the other leg from left to right. Feel for
dimension transferred to a scale, or the caliper is set on         the slight drag indicating the proper setting of the
a scale and the work machined until it checks with the             caliper. Then, remove the caliper and measure the
                                                                   setting with a rule.
                                                             2-5
Figure 2-12.—Measuring the thickness of the bottom of a cup.
figure 2-12. When the proper "feel" is obtained, tighten              Figure 2-14.—Measuring an inside diameter with an inside
the lock joint. Then, loosen the binding nut and open                                        caliper.
the caliper enough to remove it from the cup. Close the
caliper again and tighten the binding nut to seat in the
slot at the end of the auxiliary arm. The caliper is now at
the original setting, representing the thickness of the
bottom of the cup. The caliper setting can now be
measured with a rule.
    To measure a hard-to-reach inside dimension, such
as the internal groove shown in figure 2-13, use an
inside transfer firm-joint caliper. Use the procedure for
measuring a hard-to-reach outside dimension.
 Figure 2-13.—Measuring a hard-to-reach inside dimension                Figure 2-16.—Decreasing and increasing the setting of a
                 with an inside caliper.                                                 firm-joint caliper.
                                                               2-6
  Figure 2-17.—Setting a combination firm-joint caliper for
                   inside measurements.
Figure 2-17 shows how the end of the rule and one leg
of the caliper are rested on the bench top so that they are
exactly even with each other when the reading is taken.
                                                                           Figure 2-19.—Setting an inside spring caliper.
Setting Outside and Inside Spring Calipers
     To set a particular reading on an outside spring               Note that one of the man's fingers is extended to steady
caliper, first open the caliper to the approximate setting.         the point of contact of the two lower caliper legs. In this
Then, as shown in figure 2-18, place one leg over the               figure the inside caliper is being adjusted to the size of
end of the rule, steadying it with the index finger. Make           the outside caliper. As careful measurements with
the final setting by sighting over the other leg of the             calipers depend on one's sense of touch, which is
caliper squarely with the face of the rule at the reading,          spoken of as "feel," calipers are best held lightly. When
and turning the knurled adjusting nut until the desired             you notice a slight drag, the caliper is at the proper
setting is obtained.                                                setting.
                                                              2-7
              REVIEW QUESTIONS                                    the screw thread micrometer; the inside micrometer;
                                                                  and the depth micrometer. (See fig. 2-21.) The outside
 Q1.     Identify the different types of measuring tools.
                                                                  micrometer is used for measuring outside dimensions,
 Q2.     Describe the uses of different types of                  such as the outside diameter of a piece of round stock or
         measuring tools.                                         the thickness of a piece of flat stock. The screw thread
 Q3.     Describe the proper care of measuring tools.             micrometer is used to determine the pitch diameter of
                                                                  screws. The inside micrometer is used to measure the
                                                                  inside diameter of a cylinder or hole. The depth
    PRECISION MEASURING EQUIPMENT                                 micrometer is used for measuring the depth of a hole or
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Identify the                             recess.
    different types of precision measuring tools.
    Describe the uses of different types of                       Outside Micrometer
    precision measuring tools. Describe the proper
    care of measuring tools. Maintain inventory                        The nomenclature of an outside micrometer is
    and accountability of precision equipment.                    illustrated in figure 2-22.
    In much wider use by ABEs than even common                        The sleeve and thimble scales of a micrometer (fig.
calipers are the various types of micrometer calipers.            2-23) have been enlarged and laid out for
As was stated earlier, you can use micrometer calipers            demonstration. To understand these scales, you need to
to take accurate measurements to the nearest one                  know that the threaded section on the spindle, which
ten-thousandth of an inch. However, in most                       revolves, has 40 threads per inch. Therefore, every time
applications a measurement to the nearest one-                    the thimble completes a revolution, the spindle
thousandth of an inch is considered acceptable                    advances or recedes 1/40 inch, or 0.025 inch.
accuracy. These measurements are expressed or written                 Note the horizontal line on the sleeve is divided into
as a decimal (0.0001, 0.001, 0.01), so you must know              40 equal parts per inch. Every fourth graduation is
how to read and write decimals.                                   numbered 1, 2, 3, 4, and so on, representing 0.100 inch,
                                                                  0.200 inch, and so on. When you turn the thimble so its
TYPES OF MICROMETER CALIPERS                                      edge is over the first sleeve line past the 0 on the thimble
                                                                  scale, the spindle has opened 0.025 inch. If you turn the
    There are three types of micrometer calipers,                 spindle to the second mark, it has moved 0.025 inch
commonly called micrometers or simply mikes, used                 plus 0.025 inch, or 0.050 inch.
throughout the Navy: the outside micrometer, including
                                                            2-8
Figure 2-22.—Nomenclature of an outside micrometer caliper.
                                                              2-9
    READING THE VERNIER SCALE ON A
MICROMETER.—Many times you are required to
work to exceptionally precise dimensions. Under these
conditions it is better to use a micrometer that is
accurate to ten-thousandths of an inch. This degree of
accuracy is obtained by the addition of a vernier scale.
    The vernier scale of a micrometer (fig. 2-26)
furnishes the fine readings between the lines on the
thimble rather than requiring you to estimate the
reading. The 10 spaces on the vernier are equivalent to 9
spaces on the thimble. Therefore, each unit on the
vernier scale is equal to 0.0009 inch, and the difference
between the sizes of the units on each scale is 0.0001
inch.
    When a line on the thimble scale does not coincide
with the horizontal reference line on the sleeve, you can
                                                                        Figure 2-27.—Reading a vernier scale micrometer.
determine the additional spaces beyond the readable
thimble mark by finding which vernier mark matches
up with a line on the thimble scale. Add this number, as
that many ten-thousandths of an inch, to the original              Inside Micrometer
reading. In figure 2-27 see how the second line on the
vernier scale matches up with a line on the thimble                     The inside micrometer, as the name implies, is used
scale.                                                             for measuring inside dimensions, such as pump casing
                                                                   wearing rings, cylinder, bearing, and bushing wear.
    This means that the 0.011 mark on the thimble
                                                                   Inside micrometers usually come in a set that includes a
scale has been advanced an additional 0.0002
                                                                   micrometer head, various length spindles (or extension
beyond the horizontal sleeve line. When you add
                                                                   rods) that are interchangeable, and a spacing collar that
this to the other readings, the reading is
                                                                   is 0.500 inch in length. The spindles (or extension rods)
0.200 + 0.075 + 0.011 + 0.0002, or 0.2862, as shown.
                                                                   usually graduate in 1-inch increments of range; for
                                                                   example, 1 to 2 inches, 2 to 3 inches (fig. 2-28).
                                                                       The 0.500 spacing piece is used between the
                                                                   spindle and the micrometer head so the range of the
                                                                   micrometer can be extended. A knurled extension
                                                                   handle is usually furnished for obtaining measurements
                                                                   in hard-to-reach locations.
                                                                       Reading the inside micrometer. To read the inside
                                                                   micrometer, read the micrometer head exactly as you
                                                                   would an outside micrometer, then add the micrometer
                                                                   reading to the rod length (including spacing collar,
                                                                   when installed) to obtain the total measurement.
Depth Micrometer
                                                            2-10
                                          Figure 2-28.—Inside micrometer set.
    Reading a depth micrometer. When reading a                   See figure 2-30; consider the reading shown. The
depth micrometer, you will notice that the graduations           thimble edge is between the numbers 4 and 5. This
on the sleeve are numbered in the opposite direction of          shows a value of at least 0.400 inch on the sleeve's
those on an outside or inside micrometer. When you are           major divisions. The thimble also covers the first minor
reading a depth micrometer, the distance to be                   division on the sleeve; this has a value of 0.025 inch.
measured is the value that is covered by the thimble.            The value shown on the thimble circumference scale is
                                                                 0.010 inch. Adding these three values together results
                                                                 in a total of 0.435 inch, or the total distance that the end
                                                                 of the extension rod has traveled from the base. This
                                                                 measurement added to the length of the extension rod
                                                                 used gives you the total depth of the hole, recess, or
                                                                 groove that was measured.
Figure 2-29.—Using a depth micrometer. Figure 2-30.—Depth micrometer sleeve and thimble scales.
                                                          2-11
SELECTING THE PROPER MICROMETER                                     snap gauges and vernier calipers will normally be
                                                                    maintained in the division's central tool room.
    The types of micrometers commonly used are                      Regardless of the tool's permanent location, it is always
made so that the longest movement that the micrometer               the user's responsibility to maintain, care for and use
spindle or rod can make is 1 inch. This movement is                 the tool properly.
called the range; for example, a 2-inch micrometer has
                                                                        Damage, loss, or an improperly working tool
a range of from 1 inch to 2 inches, and can only measure
                                                                    should be reported immediately. Loss of a tool becomes
work with a thickness or diameter within that range.
                                                                    especially critical when working on or around the
Therefore, it is necessary to first determine the
                                                                    catapult or arresting gear machinery. The tool may be
approximate size, to the nearest inch, of the work to be
                                                                    "lost" in the machinery and, if not found, may cause
measured and then select the proper size micrometer.
                                                                    catastrophic damage to the equipment and serious
The size of a micrometer indicates the size of the largest
                                                                    injury to personnel. Always double-check the inventory
work it can measure.
                                                                    ensuring every tool is accounted for upon job
CARE OF MICROMETERS                                                 completion. The proper tools will help you maintain
                                                                    your equipment but only if you maintain your tools
     Keep micrometers clean and lightly oiled. Make                 properly.
sure they are always stored in a case or box when not in
use, to protect them from damage. Never clean any part                             REVIEW QUESTIONS
of a micrometer with emery cloth or other abrasive. The
                                                                     Q4.     Identify the different types of precision
measuring tools that have been described in this chapter
                                                                             measuring tools.
are the ones that you, as an ABE, will routinely use
while performing your assigned duties. You may,                      Q5.     Describe the uses of different types of
however, occasionally be required to use other less                          precision measuring tools.
commonly used measuring tools. Some of these are the
                                                                     Q6.     Describe the proper care of precision
dial indicator, telescopic (snap) gauge, the vernier
                                                                             measuring tools.
caliper, or screw thread gauge. The description of these
tools and instructions for their use can be found in the             Q7.     All precision measuring tools will be
training manual Use and Care of Hand Tools and                               ________________ in some manner to com-
Measuring Tools, NAVEDTRA 12085.                                             ply with the standard inventory instructions
                                                                             found in NAEC-MISC-51OR732.
INVENTORY AND ACCOUNTABILITY
                                                                                         SUMMARY
    All measuring tools will be marked in some
manner, etched, stenciled, etc., to comply with standard                 This chapter has introduced you to some of the
inventory instructions. These standard instructions                 most often used measuring tools and the techniques for
may be found in Aircraft Launch and Recovery Equip-                 using them. Selecting the proper tool; using and
ment (ALRE) Tool Control Manual, NAEC-                              maintaining the various tools; and inventorying the
MISC-51-OR732.                                                      tools have all been discussed. By thoroughly
                                                                    understanding and comprehending this chapter, you, as
    Some measuring tools such as tapes and calipers
                                                                    an ABE, will be able to perform your daily duties more
may be part of a specific toolbox inventory. Other
                                                                    efficiently and safely.
precision measuring instruments such as micrometers,
                                                             2-12
                                                   CHAPTER 3
                               MK 7 AIRCRAFT RECOVERY
                                      EQUIPMENT
    Present-day aircraft normally require the use of               then opened, allowing fluid to be forced from the
runways that are 5,000 to 8,000 feet long in order to              accumulator back into the engine cylinder, forcing the
land ashore. On an aircraft carrier, these same aircraft           ram out. As the ram moves out of the cylinder, the
are stopped within 350 feet after contacting the deck.             crosshead is forced away from the fixed sheave
This feat is accomplished through the use of aircraft              assembly, pulling the purchase cables back onto the
recovery equipment, including an emergency barricade               engine until the crosshead is returned to its BATTERY
that brings a landing aircraft to a controlled stop by             position and the crossdeck pendant is in its normal
absorbing and dispelling the energy developed by the               position on the flight deck.
landing aircraft. This recovery equipment is commonly
called arresting gear.                                             PRERECOVERY PREPARATIONS
    The sole purpose of an aircraft carrier is to provide              Prior to recovery of aircraft, all recovery equipment
a means of launching a strike against an enemy                     and landing area must be made ready and all personnel
anywhere in the world. After the aircraft complete their           properly positioned. The following is a general listing
mission, the carrier must provide a means of safely                of the events that must be accomplished prior to the
recovering them. The Mk 7 arresting gear provides this             recovery of aircraft:
means.
                                                                       • All operational retractable sheaves raised to the
                                                                         full up position
              AIRCRAFT RECOVERY
    LEARNING OBJECTIVE: Describe aircraft                              • All aft deckedge antennas positioned, as
    arrestments aboard aircraft carriers. Describe                       required
    prerecovery preparations. Describe normal                          • Ready barricade, including deck ramps, in a
    aircraft recovery operations. Describe                               ready status with a clear route to the landing area
    emergency aircraft recovery operations.                              and a tractor with driver standing by
    Aircraft arrestments aboard carriers are classified                • All launching accessories clear of the landing
as either a normal arrestment or an emergency                            area
arrestment. Simply stated, arrestment is accomplished
in the following manner: the arresting hook of the                     • Appropriate catapult shuttle(s) (as applicable)
incoming aircraft engages a wire rope cable, called a                    are aft with the grab latch disengaged and the
deck pendant, that spans the flight deck in the landing                  shuttle spreader cover installed
area. The force of the forward motion of the aircraft is               • The catapult centerdeck hatch and any other
transferred to purchase cables that are reeved around a                  hatches in the waist catapult area closed and
movable crosshead of sheaves and a fixed sheave                          dogged down
assembly of the arresting engine (see fig. 3-1). The
movable crosshead is moved toward the fixed sheave                     • Jet Blast Deflectors (JBDs) completely lowered
assembly as the aircraft pulls the purchase cables off                   and hydraulics secured
the arresting engine, forcing a ram into the cylinder
                                                                       • Waist catapult safety light in the down position,
holding pressurized hydraulic fluid (ethylene glycol).
                                                                         if applicable
This fluid is forced out of the cylinder through a control
valve that meters the flow to an accumulator until the                 • Catapult #3 track slot buttons installed
aircraft is brought to a smooth, controlled arrested
landing (see fig. 3-2).                                                • Waist catapult Integrated Catapult Control
                                                                         Station (ICCS) fully lowered, if applicable
    After arrestment, the aircraft's arresting hook is
disengaged from the deck pendant. A retract valve is
                                                             3-1
                                                                             CROSS DECK PENDANT
      RETRACTABLE
        SHEAVE
AIR FLASKS
ACCUMULATOR
FLUID COOLER
3-2
                             THRU-DECK SHEAVE
                                                                                                                                              CROSSHEAD
                        ANCHOR
                        DAMPER
             FAIRLEAD
             SHEAVES
                                                                                                            CONTROL VALVE DRIVE SYSTEM
                                                   DAMPER SHEAVE
                                                    INSTALLATION
                                                                        ACCUMULATOR
           LEGEND
     AIR
    FLUID ZERO PRESSURE
                                                                                                  CABLE ANCHOR
                                                                                                     DAMPER
                                                          RETRACTION VALVE
       FIXED SHEAVE
                                                                                                      CROSSHEAD
                                      CYLINDER                        RAM
                                                                                                                  ABEf0302
• Landing area clear of aircraft or any other                         • Determine proper aircraft weight setting in
  obstructions                                                          accordance with applicable aircraft recovery
                                                                        bulletin
• Aircraft recovery green rotating beacon on
                                                                      • Direct the engine room operators to set their
• All stations manned and ready with voice
                                                                        respective engine and verify that correct weight
  communication established and reports made to
                                                                        has been set
  the air officer
                                                                      • Pickle switch is actuated, lighting the green clear
• Sheave and anchor damper in the battery
                                                                        deck landing status light
  position
• All engines fully retracted and crossdeck                     NORMAL RECOVERY OPERATIONS
  pendant at the proper height
                                                                     Normal recovery operations involve the recovery of
• Engine fluid levels in the battery range and                  aircraft with no equipment failure or damage that
  accumulator pressure at 400 psi                               precludes the aircraft from recovering at the prescribed
• Received from the air officer; aircraft type to be            air speed or proper landing configuration.
  recovered
                                                          3-3
    Prior to commencing aircraft recovery operations,               ENGINE STRUCTURE
the following considerations apply:
                                                                        The engine structure is a framework for supporting
   All arresting gear equipment is in normal operating
                                                                    the engine and most of its components and for securing
condition and all Maintenance Requirement Cards
                                                                    the entire assembly to the ship's structure. It is
(MRCs) preoperational requirements have been met.
                                                                    composed of a welded steel base made in two
     All personnel involved in recovery operations have             longitudinal box sections with the necessary ties,
completed the applicable Personnel Qualification                    plates, and other structural members. The two sections
Standards (PQS) and are fully qualified to perform their            are bolted together near the center. See figure 3-1.
assigned tasks. Personnel not yet qualified may be
                                                                        Two pairs of saddles are mounted on the base for
utilized, but only if under the direct supervision of a
                                                                    supporting the engine cylinder. Vertical stands are
fully PQS qualified crewmember.
                                                                    welded on these saddles to support the saddles for the
                                                                    accumulator. Between these two stands is a frame of
EMERGENCY RECOVERY OPERATIONS
                                                                    welded channels, angles, and gusset plates to provide
    An emergency arrestment is accomplished in the                  trusses and ties for the frame.
same manner as a normal arrestment except that a                        On the crosshead end of the welded base support
barricade webbing assembly transmits the aircraft's                 plates, webs and gussets support the rails for the
landing force to the purchase cable instead of a                    crosshead. On this end of the base are welded
crossdeck pendant.                                                  longitudinal guides for the accumulator assembly. Near
                                                                    the end of this frame and bolted to it is the crosshead
               ARRESTING ENGINE                                     stop, which is removed when the crosshead is installed
                                                                    or removed.
    LEARNING OBJECTIVE: Describe the
    components of the arresting engine.                             CONSTANT RUNOUT VALVE (CROV)
    The Mk 7 arresting engine is a hydropneumatic                   ASSEMBLY
system composed of the engine structure, a cylinder
and ram assembly, a crosshead and fixed sheaves, a                       The constant runout valve (CROV) is installed at
control valve system, an accumulator system, air flasks,            the fixed sheave end of the Mk 7 arresting engine, as
and a sheave and cable arrangement.                                 illustrated in figure 3-1. It is designed to stop all aircraft
                                                                    with the same amount of runout regardless of the
    Improvements are continuously being made to                     aircraft's weight and speed (within the limits specified
increase the capabilities of carrier-based aircraft. As the         in current recovery bulletins).
capabilities of the aircraft are increased, the weight and
speed also increase. Therefore, the equipment used to                   The CROV is the heart of the equipment. It controls
recover the aircraft aboard carriers must also be                   the flow of fluid from the cylinder of the arresting
improved to keep pace with aircraft advancement. Such               engine to the accumulator. The other components of the
improvements have brought about the recovery                        valve are used either to adjust the initial opening of this
equipment installed on our carriers in the fleet                    valve for aircraft of different weight or to activate the
today—the Mk 7 Mod 3.                                               valve during the arresting stroke.
    All pendant and barricade engines are Mk 7 Mod 3,               CONSTANT RUNOUT VALVE (CROV) DRIVE
except the barricade engines installed on CV-64 and                 SYSTEM
CVN-65, which are Mk 7 Mod 2. For more information
on the Mk 7 Mod 2 refer to Operational and                              When a landing aircraft engages a deck pendant, or
Organizational/Intermediate Maintenance Manual,                     barricade, it withdraws purchase cable from the arrest-
NAVAIR 51-5BBA-2.1 and 2.2. Table 3-1 lists the                     ing engine. This action causes the crosshead to move
leading particulars of the Mk 7 Mod 3 recovery                      toward the fixed sheave end of the engine. In addition to
equipment.                                                          causing fluid displacement from the engine cylinder,
                                                                    the movement of the crosshead causes the CROV drive
                                                              3-4
                        Table 3-1.—Leading Particulars of Mk 7 Mod 3 Recovery Equipment
                                                       3-5
system (fig. 3-3) to rotate the CROV cam. Rotation of              the point of application of force from the cam is
this cam forces a plunger down onto a set of levers (fig.          variable, its greatest length being twice that of the lower
3-4), which in turn forces a valve sleeve and valve stem           lever. The lever arm ratio of each lever, therefore, is
down to mate with a valve seat to close the valve,                 variable between 1:1 and 2:1.
shutting off the flow of fluid from the engine cylinder to
                                                                       When the upper lever is fully extended, the ratio of
the engine accumulator, bringing the aircraft to a stop.
                                                                   each lever is 1:1. In this setting the initial opening of the
     As stated earlier, the CROV is designed to bring all          control valve upon engagement of an aircraft is
aircraft, regardless of weight, to a controlled stop while         maximum. The resulting rotation of the cam, caused by
using approximately the same amount of flight deck                 the crosshead moving inward, forces the plunger
landing area. This is accomplished by adjusting the                downward. A plunger movement of 1 inch, acting
allowable opening of the CROV, a smaller, more                     through the upper lever, would move the lower lever 1
restrictive opening to arrest a heavy aircraft or a large          inch; the lower lever, in turn, would move the valve
valve opening to arrest a light aircraft.                          sleeve and stem 1 inch downward.
                                                                        The cam is a disc plate type with the desired
CONSTANT RUNOUT VALVE (CROV)
                                                                   contour machined on its periphery. As the cam rotates,
WEIGHT SELECTOR
                                                                   it forces the plunger down. The plunger is fitted with
    The aircraft weight selector makes it possible to              rollers, top and bottom.
adjust the CROV for aircraft of different weights by                    The bottom roller on the plunger acts against the
varying the valve opening. See figure 3-4.                         top flat bearing surface of the upper lever. The pivot end
     The size of the initial valve opening is adjusted             of the upper lever has a bushed hole that mates with the
while the arresting engine is in the BATTERY position.             clevis end of the lead screw yoke. The upper lever is
The lead screw receives rotary motion from the motor               connected to the clevis end of the yoke by a pin. This
unit or handwheel and converts it into linear motion.              pin extends beyond the sides of the yoke and acts as a
This linear motion positions the upper lever and drives            shaft and has a bushed roller mounted on each extended
the local and remote indicators.                                   end. The rollers ride inside the guide attached to the
                                                                   housing. The block end of the yoke is connected to the
    In each of the two levers (upper and lower), the               lead screw by two dowel pins. This connection provides
distance between the fulcrum and roller is constant. On            the means by which the lead screw adjusts (moves) the
the upper lever, the distance between the fulcrum and              upper lever.
                  CONTROL
                   VALVE         INDICATOR PLATE
 RAM TRAVEL
  AND DECK
 RUNOUT DIAL
CAM
MOVEABLE CROSSHEAD
                               DRIVE                                                                      ADJUSTABLE
                                                                                          CONTROL VALVE
                               CHAINS                                                                      ANCHOR
                                                                              PULLEYS      DRIVE CABLE
                                                                                                                 PULLEYS
  CONTROL VALVE
    REF (CROV)                                                             PULLEY
                                                                                                                    ABE3f0303
                                                             3-6
     The bottom of the upper lever is fitted with a roller          opening is minimum. A plunger movement of 1 inch,
that bears against the flat surface of the lower lever. One         acting through the upper lever, would move the lower
end of the lower lever has a bushed hole to receive a               lever 1/2 inch; the lower lever, in turn, would move the
pivot pin. The pivot pin passes through the lever and               valve sleeve and stem 1/4 inch downward.
through two mounting holes in the stanchion.
                                                                         A critical point to consider is the position of the
     The bottom of the lower lever is fitted with a roller          levers when the valve stem is seated by cam action at
that bears on the stem screw on top of the valve sleeve.            the termination of each arrestment stroke. The levers
The vertical position of the roller on the lower lever              are so mounted and adjusted that the bearing surfaces of
determines the vertical distance that the valve sleeve              the levers are level when the valve is seated. When the
may move. Thus, it controls the size of the initial                 bearing surfaces are level, the distance across the lever
opening of the control valve.                                       system is the same regardless of the ratio setting.
                                                                    Because of this, the point of closing of the valve is
    The levers are mounted in such a way that, as the
                                                                    independent of the aircraft weight selector. It is a
upper lever is withdrawn, the lever arm ratio of both
                                                                    function of the cam only; therefore, it is constant.
levers is increased by an equal amount. When the upper
lever is fully withdrawn, the ratio of each lever is 2:1,                As the engine is retracted, the upper lever rises a
and the ratio through the lever system (upper and lower             distance equal to the movement of the plunger. If the
levers) is 4:1. In this case the initial control valve              ratio is 1:1, the valve sleeve rises the same distance. In
CAM
                 WEIGHT SELECTOR
                       UNIT             LEAD SCREW
                      LOCAL INDICATOR
                                                                                  PLUNGER
                                                                                      UPPER       VALVE
                                                                                      LEVER       BODY
                                                                                                STANCHION
                                                                                    LOWER
                                                                                                            ARRESTING
                                                                                    LEVER
                                                                                                              VALVE
                  WEIGHT SELECTOR
                        UNIT
                                                                                  LOWER
                              VALVE SLEEVE                                         LEVER
                                                                                 PIVOT PIN
                                                                                 VALVE        VALVE
                                                                                 STEM         BODY
                                                                                 VALVE
                                                                                 SEAT
ABEf0304
                                                              3-7
this case the initial valve opening is maximum. If the              electrical circuits (fig. 3-5) are the control valve weight
ratio is 4:1, however, the valve sleeve rises only                  selector circuit and the indicator circuit.
one-fourth the distance that the plunger moves. In this
case the initial valve opening is minimum.                          AIRCRAFT WEIGHT SELECTOR SYSTEM
                                                                    AND ELECTRICAL CIRCUIT
    The lever setting may be adjusted to any setting
within the two extremes previously discussed; the                       Due to the varying weights and landing speeds of
particular setting used is dependent upon the weight of             carrier-based aircraft, it is necessary to vary the initial
the aircraft to be arrested. The weight setting is made             opening of the CROV and have a smaller initial opening
with the engine in battery position prior to landing the            for heavier aircraft than for lighter aircraft. The
aircraft.                                                           variation of the setting of the CROV is the function of
    Adjustment of the setting determines the position               the aircraft weight selector motor unit. (See fig. 3-5.)
of the valve sleeve. Therefore, it also sets the amount             Normally, the settings are made electrically by
the valve will open at the beginning of the arrestment              depressing an increase or decrease push button located
stroke. Similarly, it determines the rate of closure                at the control valve. The settings can also be
during the stroke so that the valve will always seat at the         accomplished manually by a handwheel at the control
same runout.                                                        valve.
    The valve stem sleeve allows a relatively unloaded                   The aircraft weight selector is motor operated from
and cushioned opening at the beginning of the stroke.               the 440-volt, 60-hertz, 3-phase ship's power supply. A
                                                                    fused switch box or breaker is provided to energize or
     The lever system, if set for a heavy aircraft, reduces
                                                                    de-energize the control circuit. To increase and
the allowable valve stem opening and thus increases the
                                                                    decrease settings, the direction of the aircraft weight
resistance of the valve to the flow of fluid. The energy
                                                                    selector motor rotation is controlled by the motor
of the aircraft is dissipated by forcing fluid through the
                                                                    controller. Should an electrical failure occur, the
restricted valve opening.
                                                                    settings can be made manually by pulling out on the
                                                                    handwheel and turning in either the increase or the
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
                                                                    decrease direction.
    The electrical system provides, controls, and                       Settings on the aircraft weight selector are
safeguards the distribution of electrical energy to the             monitored locally at the control valve motor unit dial
weight selector motor and the synchro indicators. The               and remotely by synchro receivers located at Pri-Fly
                                                                    and the deckedge control station.
                                                                                MAXIMUM             AIRCRAFT WEIGHT
                                                    FUSED SWITCH BOX            SETTING              SELECTOR DIAL
                                                                                              70
                                                                                                   60
                        AWIS AT           MOTOR CIRCUIT                                                 50
                        PRI-FLY           POWER SUPPLY
                       CONTROL             400V, 60 , 30
                                                                                                         40
                       STATION                                                   12
       AWIS
     DECKEDGE                                                             MINIMUM                   30
                                             AIRCRAFT WEIGHT                             20
      STATION                                                             SETTING
                                          SELECTOR PUSHBUTTON                     POINTER
                                                 STATION                         ASSEMBLY
                                                                                                              FUSED SWITCH BOX
                                    SYNCHRO
                                                                                                                    INDICATOR CIRCUIT
                                                                                                                      POWER SUPPLY
                 SYNCHRO                                                                                               110V, 60 , 10
                                                                                                                        ENGINE 440V
                                                                                                                       TERMINAL BOX
                        AIRCRAFT WEIGHT
                        SELECTOR MOTOR
                           UNIT , 440V
                                                                                       ENGINE 110V
                                                    MOTOR CONTROLLER                  TERMINAL BOX
                                                                                                                          ABE30305
                                          Figure 3-5.—Aircraft weight selector system.
                                                              3-8
PUSH-BUTTON STATIONS                                              DECKEDGE CONTROL STATION
     The function of the push-button station is to select             The deckedge control station (fig. 3-6) is located on
the proper contact of the weight selector motor                   the starboard side aft, where the operator has a clear,
controller so as to rotate the shaft of the motor in the          unobstructed view of the landing area.
proper direction to increase or decrease the weight
                                                                      The deckedge control station is equipped with
setting
                                                                  control levers to retract each of the pendant engines and
              INDICATOR ASSEMBLY (AWIS)
                (WITHOUT S/C 417, REFER
                     TO WP 039 00)
                                                               MAIN CIRCUIT              INDICATOR CIRCUIT
                                                            BREAKER ENCLOSURE           BREAKER ENCLOSURE
                                                                                          RETRACTABLE
                                                                                        SHEAVE & DIMMER
                                                                                       SWITCH ENCLOSURE
                                                                LIGHT BOX
                                                              ASSEMBLY (TYP)
        ARRESTING GEAR
       OFFICER ENCLOSURE
            ASSEMBLY
                                                                                              RETRACT VALVE
                                                                                           CONTROL INSTALLATION
                                                                                                  (TYP)
                            INDICATOR &
                             MOUNTING
                             ASSEMBLY
                                                                                                 ABE30306
                                          Figure 3-6.—Deckedge control station.
                                                            3-9
the barricade; a pressure gauge for the barricade                         The retracting valve operates as a check valve
hydraulic system; a control lever to raise or lower the              against the flow of fluid from the accumulator to the
barricade stanchions; push buttons to raise, lower, or               engine cylinder. Fluid at accumulator pressure enters
stop the retractable sheaves; an indicator light to                  the housing and bears on the stem in the direction that
indicate their position; a battery position indicator light          would open the valve; however, the pressure also bears
for the damper sheaves; and synchro receivers to                     against the base of the plunger, which tends to close the
monitor settings on the aircraft weight selector unit of             valve. Since the area of the plunger end is greater than
each engine.                                                         that of the stem, the differential in force keeps the valve
                                                                     closed.
    The deckedge control operator operates the
controls from the gallery walkway and is equipped with                    The retracting valve has piping that provides
sound-powered phones to maintain voice com-                          passage for engine fluid flow from the arresting engine,
munications with the engine-room operator and                        by way of the retracting valve, to the cable anchor
Pri-Fly.                                                             dampers. A discharge port is provided where the
                                                                     retracting valve and pressure valve body are bolted
RETRACTING VALVE                                                     together to allow fluid flow from the accumulator or
                                                                     fluid cooler into the main engine cylinder during
     The retracting valve permits the controlled return              retraction.
of fluid from the accumulator to the cylinder, thereby
returning the engine to the BATTERY position. The                    Retracting Valve Body
general location of the retracting valve is shown in
figure 3-7.                                                              The retracting valve body is a hollow steel casting
                                                                     with an inlet port, connected by piping to the engine
    The retracting valve is a self-contained
                                                                     accumulator/fluid cooler manifold, a discharge port
poppet-valve assembly composed principally of a
                                                                     that is flanged and bolted to the engine cylinder outlet
housing, a plunger, an operating lever, a valve stem, and
                                                                     elbow, and a port connected by piping to the cable
a valve seat.
                                                                     anchor dampers.
                             TO DECKEDGE
                               CONTROL
                                                                                                DECKEDGE
                                                                                                 CONTROL
                                              LOCK NUTS
                         TO ACCUMULATOR
                                                                                   SHOCK
                                                                                  ABSORBER
SEAT
                                           V-RING
                                          PACKINGS
                                                          STEM
                                                                         TO ENGINE
                                                                         CYLINDER
ABEf0307
                                                              3-10
     The valve body is bored and machined smooth                   Plunger
inside to receive the valve seat. O-rings are provided as
a seal between the valve body and the seat. The lower                   The plunger is a round piece of machined steel that
portion of the valve body has an inside machined recess            is blind bored at one end to receive the shank of the
for insertion of a V-ring packing assembly. The V-ring             valve stem. The plunger and valve stem are connected
packing prevents leakage between the stem and valve                by a dowel pin. The opposite end of the plunger has a
body.                                                              machined clevis and is externally threaded just below
                                                                   the clevis. The threaded portion is for an adjusting nut
Valve Seat                                                         and a locknut used to adjust the stroke of the plunger
                                                                   and valve stem. The stroke is adjusted to 0.678 (11/16)
    The valve seat is a hollow, machined, cylindrical              of an inch. The clevis connects the operating lever and
piece of bronze. One end is flanged and is bolted to the           the plunger. The opposite end of the operating lever is
valve body, and the opposite end is machined to form a             connected to a tie rod, a return spring, and a control
mating surface (seat) for the valve stem. Four vertical            cable by another clevis. The control cable is attached to
elongated holes are machined in the seat to allow fluid            the T-shaped retracting handle at the deckedge control
to enter the valve from the accumulator.                           station. See figure 3-7.
    The valve stem is a round piece of machined steel                  There is a retracting lever (fig. 3-8) for each
with a shoulder machined midway between the top and                arresting engine located at the deckedge control station.
bottom. This shoulder mates with the valve seat and                The retracting lever provides a remote means of
blocks fluid flow through the retract valve during                 opening the retracting valve from a location where the
arrestment and from the accumulator to the engine                  operator will have full visibility of recovery operations.
cylinder until retraction is desired.
RETRACT LEVER
PULLEY
                                                                                     CONTROL
                                                                                      CABLE
                    AIR VALVE
                    (PENDANT
                    ENGINES)
RETURN SPRING
TURNBUCKLE
VALVE BODY
                                                                                          ABE30308
                                        Figure 3-8.—Retracting valve and controls.
                                                            3-11
     When the operator pulls down on the retracting                        3. Inspect sheave damper sheaves for proper
lever, the force transmitted through the control cable                        seating of the purchase cable on completion of
lifts the end of the retracting lever that is attached to the                 retraction.
return spring and tie rod. The retracting lever has a pivot
                                                                           A shock absorber like the one found on
point on the block mounting of the valve. As the one
                                                                       automobiles is installed on the operating lever to
end of the retracting lever is lifted, the end connected to
                                                                       eliminate chattering of the retracting valve during
the plunger pushes down on the plunger and valve stem,
                                                                       closing.
allowing fluid flow through the valve from the
accumulator or fluid cooler to the engine cylinder, thus
forcing the ram and crosshead back to their battery                                 ACCUMULATOR SYSTEM
position. After retraction is complete, the retracting                     LEARNING OBJECTIVE: Describe the
lever is released and the return spring pulls down on the                  accumulator system.
retracting lever, which in turn pulls up on the plunger
and valve stem, which closes the valve. See figure 3-7.                     The Mk 7 Mod 3 arresting engine has a
                                                                       recirculating-type hydraulic system. During arrest-
    The ideal condition is that tension be kept on the                 ment, the hydraulic fluid is forced from the main engine
purchase cable from the beginning of the retracting                    cylinder, through the CRO valve, to the accumulator.
stroke until the ram is in its battery position. An                    An initial air charge of 400 psi in the accumulator
interruption of the stroke generally disrupts this                     builds up to approximately 650 psi during arrestment.
condition and creates cable backlash, which results in                 This increased pressure is used to force the fluid from
cable slack on the engine.                                             the accumulator into the fluid cooler, thus forcing fluid
     If an emergency arises involving the safety of                    from the previous arrestment, already cooled by the
personnel or equipment, and an interruption of                         cooler, out of the cooler, through the retracting valve,
full-speed retraction is necessary, the following                      and into the main engine cylinder, returning the engine
procedures are recommended to prevent possible                         to its BATTERY position.
damage, such as a tight kink, to the purchase cable:                       The accumulator (fig. 3-9) is a long, steel cylinder
    1. Resume retracting very slowly at first to rid the               mounted horizontally in saddles on the engine
       cable system of slack.                                          structure, with the fluid end toward the fixed sheaves.
                                                                       Inside the accumulator is a floating piston that
    2. Resume full-speed retraction only after the                     separates the air side of the accumulator from the fluid
       cable slack has been eliminated and the cable                   side. The air end of the accumulator is flanged and
       has tension.
        NOZZLE
     ROD
ABEf0309
                                                                                             CYLINDER
                                                                               SLIPPER AND CAGE ASSEMBLY
                                                                            RETAINER RING
                                                                3-12
bolted to the air expansion flask manifold. The fluid                             FLUID REPLENISHMENT
end of the accumulator is flanged and bolted to the                                      SYSTEM
accumulator nozzle, which contains a fluid-level
                                                                         LEARNING OBJECTIVE: Describe the
indicator, a device used to indicate to the engine-room
                                                                         components of the fluid replenishment system.
operator whether the system has the proper amount of
fluid. The fluid indicator registers the following three                  In any hydraulic system, small amounts of fluid are
conditions—DRAIN (excessive amount of fluid in the                   lost due to leakage. Fluid also contracts when cold and
system), BATTERY (proper amount of fluid in the                      expands when hot. To compensate for leakage and
system), and FILL (insufficient amount of fluid in the               expansion or contraction of the hydraulic fluid in the
system).                                                             hydraulic system of the Mk 7 arresting engines, a fluid
                                                                     replenishment system is provided. See figure 3-10.
     The floating air-fluid separator piston is made of
aluminum alloy and has two sets of V-ring packing (one                    The fluid replenishment system consists of a small
for the air side and one for the fluid side), which prevent          hand pump, mounted on the lower engine frame that is
air from leaking past the piston into the fluid side of the          connected by piping to the engine accumulator and a
accumulator, or fluid from leaking into the air side. Two            6-gallon stowage tank. If, because of leakage or fluid
slipper cages with phenolic slippers are fitted onto the             contraction while the engine crosshead is in BATTERY,
piston to act as a bearing surface between the piston and            the fluid-level indicator reads FILL, the supply valve in
the cylinder wall. The phenolic slippers are replaceable             the piping is opened and the hand pump is operated
and must be replaced when the maximum allowable                      until the indicator reads BATTERY. A fluid filter is
wear has been reached. This is to prevent                            located in the supply line to filter the fluid being
metal-to-metal wear between the piston and the                       pumped into the accumulator. If the fluid-level
accumulator wall. An eyebolt is provided on the air side             indicator reads DRAIN, the return valve located in the
of the piston to aid in removing the piston from the                 return line is opened, and fluid from the accumulator
accumulator when maintenance is required. The fluid                  drains into the replenishment tank. When the fluid-level
side of the piston has a striker rod that actuates a                 indicator reads BATTERY, the return valve is closed.
fluid-level indicator located in the accumulator nozzle.
    The fluid-level indicator has a drive shaft that
extends through the nozzle from side to side and is
secured in place by flanges and bolts. O-rings provide a
seal against leakage of fluid around the drive shaft.
Gears are secured onto the shaft inside the nozzle.                                            VALVE
                                                                       FLUID                 (SUPPLY)
These gears mate with teeth on the actuator rod, which                 LEVEL
                                                                     INDICATOR
extends fore and aft in the nozzle, and the
fluid-indicator rod, which is vertical and extends
through the top of the nozzle. An O-ring prevents
                                                                                                                         HAND
leakage around the indicator rod. When the striker rod                                                                   PUMP
on the piston makes contact with the actuator rod, the
                                                                                                                         TANK
drive shaft rotates, causing the indicator rod to move
down. See figure 3-9.
    An indicator plate is mounted on top of the nozzle.
The plate has the readings DRAIN, BATTERY, and                                                                           ABEf0310
FILL. The indicator rod is a differential rod; and any
                                                                         VALVE                                  FILTER
time the piston striker rod is not in contact with the                 (RETURN)
actuator rod, accumulator pressure working on the                                                  STRAINER
differential area of the indicator rod will cause the
indicator rod to rise to the DRAIN position. The engine
crosshead must always be in its BATTERY position
when the fluid level of the arresting engine is checked.                      Figure 3-10.—Fluid replenishment system.
                                                              3-13
FLUID STOWAGE SYSTEM                                                   fluid reclamation system consists of a stainless steel
                                                                       90-gallon tank located in close proximity to the fluid
    A fluid stowage system (fig. 3-11) is provided to                  stowage tank, a centrifugal 1/3 hp pump, filter and
stow fluid from the arresting engine during                            piping connections. The piping connects the
maintenance and to transfer fluid back to the engine                   reclamation tank to the existing stowage tank line.
after maintenance is complete. The fluid stowage                       During fluid transfer from the reclamation system,
system consists of one common, steel stowage tank that                 hydraulic fluid is filtered to ensure that only clean
serves all the arresting engines installed on a particular             uncontaminated fluid enters the fluid stowage tank.
ship. It is equipped with piping valves from the
accumulator to the stowage tank.                                       FLUID COOLER
     The capacity of the fluid stowage tanks is 700
                                                                            During continuous arresting operations, the engine
gallons. The stowage tank is capable of storing all the
                                                                       fluid temperature rises because of friction of the fluid
fluid in the system of one arresting engine. Ship's
                                                                       moving through the engine, control valve, and piping.
low-pressure air is used to force the fluid to and from
                                                                       To maintain extended pendant engine operation, the
the stowage tank. A pressure relief valve, which is set at
                                                                       fluid temperature is reduced by the fluid cooler. (See
120 psi, is provided to prevent excessive pressure
                                                                       fig. 3-13.) The maximum operating temperature for the
buildup. The relief valve is located on the stowage tank.
                                                                       arresting engines is 170ºF. Prolonged operation at this
In addition, a 90-gallon stowage tank is installed on
                                                                       temperature limit is not recommended.
each side for the port and starboard sheave damper
assemblies. The 90-gallon stowage tank is a repository                     The fluid cooler is mounted in saddles on top of the
to transfer and replenish hydraulic fluid for the sheave               engine structure adjacent to the accumulator.
damper assemblies.                                                         Fluid coolers are used on all Mk 7 arresting engines
                                                                       serving a pendant engine. Engine fluid, as it is returned
FLUID RECLAMATION SYSTEM
                                                                       from the accumulator to the main engine cylinder
                                                                       during retraction of the engine, flows through the fluid
    The fluid reclamation system (fig. 3-12) provides a
                                                                       cooler body. Heat from the engine fluid is transferred to
means of reclaiming hydraulic fluid removed from any
                                                                       cool service water (salt water) flowing at 100 gallons
engine due to venting or through leaks or spills. The
                                                                       per minute through tubes within the cooler body.
                                                                          FROM LOW-PRESSURE
                                                                              AIR SUPPLY
                                                        TO OTHER
                                                        ENGINES
                             MANHOLE
                              COVER            700-GALLON
                                                                          MOISTURE
                   PRESSURE                       TANK
                                                                          SEPARATOR                     TO OTHER
                  RELIEF VALVE
                 (SET AT 120 PSI)                                        AIR STRAINER                    ENGINES
                                                                         FLANGE
                                                            MAIN AIR
                                                            SHUTOFF
                                           AIR STRAINER
                                                            VALVE
                                             MOISTURE
                            CHECK           SEPARATOR
                            VALVE                                                                                  ABEf0311
                             FILTER
                            316077-2
LEGEND
CLOSED VALVE
OPEN VALVE
PLUG COCK
                                                              3-14
                                                                                          FILTER
                                            FROM FLIGHT
                                             DECK FILL
                                             OPTIONAL
                                                                                                         TO FLUID
                                                                                                         STOWAGE
                                                                                                           TANK
                RECLAMATION
                TANK
                   SHUTOFF
                   VALVE (TYP)
                                                                            DRAIN VALVE
                                                                            (TYP)
                                                                                              ABEf0312
                                 Figure 3-12.—Fluid reclamation system
                                                                                                         BYPASS
                                                                                                          VALVE
ANODE
                        SERVICE WATER
                       DISCHARGE VALVE                       (3) FLUID OUTLET
                       OPEN AS NEEDED                              VALVE
OPEN VALVE
CLOSED VALVE
                                                 3-15
    The fluid cooler body is a cylindrical steel shell              discharge, that are used to throttle the flow of salt water
with two flanged ends. The body of the cooler has four              and maintain the desired fluid temperature. Shutoff
equally spaced holes in each end to provide a means of              valves are also provided in the fluid inlet and outlet
draining and venting the cooler. These holes are                    lines to provide a means of isolating the fluid cooler in
normally closed with pipe plugs or vent valves. One                 the event of cooler leakage, and a bypass valve is
end of the cooler has a cooler head assembly that forms             provided to direct the fluid from the accumulator to the
a cap for one end of the body and provides an inlet for             retract valve when the cooler is isolated. To prevent
engine fluid coming from the accumulator. The cooler                corrosion within the cooler, replaceable anodes are
head assembly is a disc-shaped steel casting with an                installed at both the saltwater inlet and outlet
opening in the center, which is flanged to the fluid inlet          manifolds. These anodes are periodically inspected and
piping.                                                             replaced according to the applicable maintenance
                                                                    requirement card (MRC). A fluid temperature indicator
    A copper annealed gasket is used as a seal between
                                                                    is located on the engine control panel.
the cooler head and the body to prevent fluid leakage.
The head is bolted to the body. The coolant (salt-water)
                                                                    AUXILIARY AIR FLASKS
flows through a tube assembly that consists of 107
U-shaped copper tubes supported inside the cooler                        The auxiliary air flask provides a means of storing
body by three circular baffle plates. A tube head is                ship's air at 3,000 psi. In the event of a ship's air system
bolted to the end of the cooler, opposite of the cooler             failure, the air stored in the auxiliary air flask can be
head. A copper annealed gasket is used as a seal against            used to recharge the arresting engine.
fluid leakage between the tube head and the cooler
body. Cooled fluid passes through the center of the tube                 The air flask is a cylindrical container with
head, through piping, to the retract valve. Two                     hemispherical ends. One end of the air flask is provided
kidney-shaped manifolds (one inlet and one outlet                   with a pipe tap for connecting an air line, which is used
manifold for the coolant to flow) are bolted to the outer           for charging and venting. A drainage vent is located on
face of the tube head.                                              the underside of the air flask to drain condensate water.
    Saltwater piping leading to and from the inlet and                  Air can be supplied to the air unit of the arresting
outlet manifolds has shutoff valves, one intake and one             engine from the auxiliary air flask by use of the
                                                                    charging valve mounted on the main control panel.
                                                          TO
                                                         VENT
                                                                                  FROM                          FUSED
                                                                             HIGH-PRESSURE                      SWITCH
                                                                               AIR SUPPLY                        BOX
                                                                                                           FROM
                                                                                                            AIR
        CABLE ANCHOR                                                                                     EXPANSION
           DAMPER                                                                                          FLASK
          LIGHT BOX
           FROM
         AUXILIARY
            AIR                                                                                          ABEf0314
          SUPPLY
                                                             3-16
MAIN CONTROL PANEL                                                  air-charging valves, gauge valves, and a pressure
                                                                    gauge. The auxiliary air flask charging valve allows for
    The control panel is the control center for the                 charging the auxiliary air flasks or emergency charging
arresting engine. (See fig. 3-14.) It provides a means for          of the accumulator from the air flasks. The auxiliary air
the operator to centrally regulate the air pressure in the          flask pressure gauge monitors the air pressure of the
system, keep a check on the fluid temperature, and                  auxiliary air flasks. The accumulator charging valve
energize the electrical system. The control panel is also           allows for charging of the accumulator and air
equipped with a cable anchor damper light box.                      expansion flask. The accumulator pressure gauge
     The control panel is a rectangular sheet of steel              monitors the air pressure of the accumulator and air
mounted on the engine structure on the CRO-valve side               expansion flask.
of the engine.                                                          A fuse switch box is mounted at the end of the
     Three air manifolds are located on the control                 control panel and contains the main switches for
panel: a main air-charging manifold with high-pressure              activating the electrical system of the arresting gear.
air piping leading from the ship's high-pressure air                    The cable anchor damper battery position indicator
supply system; an air manifold for the auxiliary air                light box on the control panel contains a power ON and
flasks; and a manifold for the accumulator. The main                OFF switch and three indicator lights. A white light
air-charging manifold is equipped with an air-charging              indicates the power switch is on. Two green lights give
valve, which is closed except when taking on air from               battery position indication of the cable anchor dampers.
the ship's high-pressure air supply system to charge the
auxiliary air flasks and accumulator.                               CYLINDER AND RAM ASSEMBLIES
     High-pressure air piping is provided from the main
                                                                        The cylinder acts as a receiver for the ram and as a
air-charging manifold to the auxiliary air flask
                                                                    reservoir for the fluid to be displaced by the ram. Figure
manifold and the accumulator manifold. The auxiliary
                                                                    3-15 illustrates the cylinder and ram assembly of the
air flask and accumulator manifolds each have
                                                                    Mod 3 arresting engine.
CYLINDER
                      ELBOW
                      ASSEMBLY
                                                              RAM
                                                      RAM SLIPPER
                                                                            CAGE
                                                                                                       WIPER
                                                                                 RETAINER              RETAINER
                                                                                                             ABEf0315
                                         Figure 3-15.—Cylinder and ram assembly.
                                                             3-17
    The cylinder and ram assembly constitutes the                        The outer (open) end of the hollow steel ram is
actual engine of the arresting gear. It is located within            clamped into a socket on the crosshead by a split flange,
the engine structure between the movable crosshead                   which fits into an annular groove near the end of the
and the cylinder outlet elbow on the engines.                        ram.
    The cylinder is a machined, forged steel,
                                                                     CROSSHEAD AND FIXED SHEAVE
smooth-bore tube, open on both ends and large enough
                                                                     INSTALLATION
to provide a working area for the ram and to house the
fluid necessary for aircraft arrestments. It is supported                The principle involved in the operation of the
within the engine structure by cylinder support saddles.             crosshead and fixed sheaves is that of a block and
One end of the cylinder is clamped and bolted with four              tackle. The purchase cables are reeved around the
cylinder clamps and Allen bolts to the cylinder outlet               sheaves of the crosshead and fixed sheave assemblies.
elbow. The other end receives the ram                                The crosshead is a three-piece welded structure with
    The ram is a large, hollow steel piston that is moved            two hollow steel shafts clamped between its outer
in and out of the cylinder by the crosshead. It is bored to          sections and the center section. The crosshead body is
reduce the weight, although it is not bored completely               clamped to the outer end of the ram by a split flange,
through. The inner end (the end that fits in the mouth of            which fits into an annular groove around the end of the
the cylinder) is solid and provides a working area                   ram. Figure 3-16 illustrates the crosshead.
between the ram and engine fluid during arrestments.                     The crosshead contains two similar banks of
    The inner end of the ram contains a set of V-ring                sheaves, with nine sheaves in each bank. The sheaves
packing to provide a seal for the engine fluid between               located outboard on the crosshead are 33-inch pitch
the cylinder wall and the ram also the inner end of the              diameter, and the sheaves located on the inboard shaft
ram is stepped to accommodate a cage and slippers,                   are 28-inch pitch diameter. The difference in the pitch
which provide a bearing surface for the ram as it slides             diameter of the two banks of sheaves is necessary so
in and out of the cylinder.                                          that the purchase cable reeved around the outboard
FAIRLEAD TUBES
FAIRLEAD
ABEf0316
SLIPPERS
                                                              3-18
(33-inch pitch diameter) sheaves will clear the inboard             phenolic spacers. The sheaves are lubricated through
(28-inch pitch diameter) sheaves.                                   10 zerk fittings located on the end of each of the two
                                                                    hollow steel shafts (20 zerks total).
     The crosshead sheaves are made of an aluminum
alloy casting and have three sections: an inner race, a                 The crosshead is provided with slipper liners as a
cage and roller assembly, and an outer race. All the                bearing surface between the crosshead and the
sheaves in the crosshead and the fixed sheave                       crosshead tracks. There is a total of 16 slipper liners—2
installation rotate on roller bearings with the exception           on each side at the top, to prevent side thrust, and 3 on
of the 28-inch pitch diameter high-speed sheave that                each corner at the bottom, for a bearing surface. Brass
fairleads the purchase cable from the engine to the                 retainers hold the slipper liners in place.
flight deck. This sheave rotates on a ball thrust bearing.
                                                                         The fixed sheave assembly is identical in
The sheaves are separated by two-section concentric
                                                                    construction to the crosshead, and all movable parts are
disc spacers. Each spacer has an inner and an outer disc.
                                                                    interchangeable. The fixed sheave assembly acts as the
The inner disc is made of steel and provides lubrication
                                                                    stationary half of the reeve system and therefore does
channels from the shaft to each cage roller assembly.
                                                                    not require liners. See figure 3-17.
The outer disc is made of phenolic and acts as a bearing
surface for the outer sheave race; it also retains the
grease.                                                                  AUTOMATIC LUBRICATION SYSTEM
    Phenolic spacers are bonded to the sheaves on the                   LEARNING OBJECTIVE: Describe the
high-speed side only. The low-speed side has loose                      automatic lubrication system.
ABEf0317
FORWARD SECTION
                                                             3-19
     An automatic lubrication system (fig. 3-18) ensures            up the hose during retraction. The spring tension on the
that lubricant is automatically provided to the arresting           hose reel must be 9 pounds (±1/2 pound), with the hose
engine crosshead and fixed sheave assembly during                   fully retracted, at all times.
arrestment operations (pendant engines only). The
                                                                        The automatic lubrication controller (fig. 3-19)
ship's low-pressure air, is piped to a regulator, which
                                                                    allows the engine room operator to set both a pulse
reduces the air to the required operating pressure of
                                                                    counter and a timer unit which deliver a predetermined
between 75 and 85 psi. Air is fed through a rubber hose
                                                                    amount of lubricant to every lubrication point. The
to a pump mounted on top of a 120-pound drum of
                                                                    controller signals when the system is ready, when it is
lubricant. Lubricant is pumped from the drum through
                                                                    operation or when a malfunction occurs. The controller
hoses to control valves mounted on the engine
                                                                    can be operated manually to initiate a lubrication cycle
structure. These control valves adjust the rate of flow of
                                                                    without movement of the crosshead and cal reset itself
lubricant to the high-speed sheaves.
                                                                    after a malfunction has been corrected in the lubrication
    The control valves are operated by plunger rollers,             system.
which are cam-actuated at a set position of the engine
                                                                         The 28-inch pitch diameter sheave containing the
crosshead arrestment stroke. An ounce of lubricant is
                                                                    ball thrust bearing is not lubricated with the automatic
pumped to the high-speed sheaves during the
                                                                    lubricating system. The ball thrust bearing eliminates
arrestment and the retraction cycles. A hose reel with a
                                                                    the need for constant lubrication. Lubricating the ball
flexible rubber hose is mounted on the crosshead end of
                                                                    thrust bearing sheave is accomplished with a manually
the engine structure, with the hose connected to metal
                                                                    operated grease gun after every 20 to 30 arrestments.
tubing on the engine crosshead. As the crosshead
                                                                    (See fig. 3-18 for an illustration of the automatic
moves toward the fixed sheaves during arrestment, the
                                                                    lubrication system.)
hose pays out and spring tension in the hose reel takes
    PRIMARY
  DISTRIBUTION
      BLOCK
  (HIGH-SPEED)
                          (FIXED SHEAVE END)
                                                                                        PRESSURE
                                                      LUBRICANT CONTROLLER              REGULATOR
                                                                                                          (CROSSHEAD END)
                                                               ISOLATION
                                                                SHUTOFF                  SECONDARY
                                                                  VALVE                 DISTRIBUTION            PRIMARY
                                                                                           BLOCKS         DISTRIBUTION BLOCK
                                                                                                              (LOW SPEED)
                                                                                                                     HOSE
                                                                                                                     REEL
    SECONDARY
   DISTRIBUTION
      BLOCKS                         MASTER DISTRIBUTION
                                         BLOCK ASSEMBLY
                                                     LUBRICANT
                                                        FILTER
                                                                                              SOLENOID
                                                      LUBRICANT                               VALVE
                                                          PUMP
                                                      LUBRICANT
                                                        GREASE
                                                          DRUM
                                                                                                                 ABEf0318
                                        Figure 3-18.—Automatic lubrication system.
                                                             3-20
                                                                      and the second assembly is overhead mounted (fig.
                                      COUNTER                         3-20). Compartment configuration determines how the
                                     (DETAIL B)
                                                                      units are installed.
   MONITOR
    TIMER                                                                 The purpose of the cable anchor damper is to
  (DETAIL A)                                                          eliminate excessive purchase cable slack between the
                                                                      crosshead and fixed sheave assembly at the beginning
                                                   ON/OFF
                                                   SWITCH             of the arrestment stroke. Through service use and
                                                                      experimental testing, it was found that when this cable
   READY
  (GREEN)                                                             slack was taken up by the landing aircraft, excessive
                                                  FAULT
                                                  (RED)               vibrations occurred in the engines. The cable anchor
                                                                      damper removes this slack as it occurs, thereby
     RESET                                                            eliminating vibration of the purchase cable. The cable
                                                                      anchor damper assembly is used with pendant engines
     LUBE
   (AMBER)                            MANUAL RUN
                                                                      only.
                                                                          Referring to figure 3-20, note that each cable
               LUBRICANT CONTROLLER
                                                                      anchor damper assembly includes a cylinder that
                                                                      connects to an operating end head and a cushioning end
                                                                      head. Piping connects the engine cylinder to the
   ORANGE CYCLE PROGRESS
   POINTER REGISTERS TIME                                             operating end head through a manifold tee. Two lines
    REMAINING TRAVELS TO
      "0" DURING COUNT                                                branch from the manifold tee, one to each damper
                                            BLACK TIME SET            assembly operating head. Each of these lines contains a
                                             POINTER HAS
                                              FULL SCALE              flow control valve. A cover is placed over the operating
                                            ADJUSTABILITY
                                             THROUGH 320
                                                         o
                                                                      piston rod and coupling assembly for safety of
                 LOCKING
                  SCREW                                               operation and protection against foreign matter. Each
                                DETAIL A
                                                                      damper assembly is mounted on a base before
                                                                      installation.
                                                               3-21
                                                                                                                                            OPERATION PISTON         TORQUE RELEASE
                                                                                                                                            ROD                      COUPLING
                                                                                                                         WING NUT                 TRACK
                                                                                                                                                               KEY
GLAND
HINGED COVER
                                                    CYLINDER
                    CUSHIONING PISTON
                    ROD
                             CUSHIONING END
                             HEAD
       COTTER PIN                                                                                                                                                           ROD GUIDE
3-22
                                                                                                                                    REMOVABLE
                                                                                                                                    TRACK
                                                                                                                OPERATING PISTON    SECTION
                                                                                                          VENT VALVE
                                                                                                   SHEAR BLOCK                                                       CAM
LIMIT SWITCH
                                                    CLAMP
                                       GLAND       VENT VALVE
                            AIR CONTAINER
         ABEf0320
                                                                                    TO ACCUMULATOR
                                                                                   HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
                                                                                                        TO ARRESTING ENGINE
                                                                                                        HYDRAULIC CYLINDER
RETRACTING VALVE
1 1
TO ACCUMULATOR
                                                                                                                             TO ENGINE SHEAVES
  TO ENGINE SHEAVES
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
                      2   3     4      5           6                        6      5           4    3              2
                                                        TO 3-WAY
                                                        AIR VALVE
                                                            3-23
BATTERY POSITIONER                                                                ARRESTING ENGINE DRIVE
                                                                                         SYSTEM
    The battery positioner (fig. 3-22) functions to
                                                                          LEARNING OBJECTIVE: Describe the
return the cable anchor damper piston to its BATTERY
                                                                          components of the arresting engine drive
position during the retracting cycle of the arresting
                                                                          system.
engine.
                                                                          The function of the drive system is to provide a
     The battery positioner includes a three-way air
                                                                      means of transferring energy from an arresting aircraft
valve (3), which is connected to a 100-psi air supply
                                                                      to the arresting engine components that provide the
and to the air container mounted on the cushioning end
                                                                      means of dissipating and absorbing that energy. The
of each damper assembly. An air strainer (4) is located
                                                                      drive system consists essentially of sheave damper,
in the supply line ahead of the three-way valve. The
                                                                      purchase cable, fairlead and deck sheaves, crossdeck
three-way air valve is mounted on a base plate (5),
                                                                      pendants, and wire supports (fig. 3-23).
secured to the arresting engine retracting valve, and
operated by means of a cam (1) mounted on the
                                                                      SHEAVE DAMPER
retracting valve actuating lever.
     When the actuating lever is moved to its retract                     Because of the high engaging velocities of modern
position, the cam positions the three-way air valve to                carrier-based aircraft, cable tension and vibration
admit 100-psi air to the air containers. From the air                 would be excessive unless eased by the shock
container, the 100-psi air passes through a hole in the               absorption provided by the sheave damper. The sheave
cushioning piston rod and acts against the operating                  damper reduces peak cable tension and lessens cable
piston, moving it to its fully retracted position. As soon            vibration.
as the actuating lever is released, the air pressure is shut              In figure 3-24, a sheave damper assembly is
off, and the air container is vented through an exhaust               mounted to the ship's structure below each port and
line (2) at the three-way air valve. A line containing a              starboard retractable or fixed horizontal deck sheave.
liquid sight indicator (7) and a drain plug (6) is                    The port and starboard assemblies are identical;
provided at each container. The fluid sight indicator                 therefore, only one will be discussed.
permits detection of fluid leakage into the air container.
                                                                       RETRACTING
                                                                                                           5
                                                                          VALVE                                4
ABEf0322
                                                               3-24
                                                                                            THRU-DECK SHEAVE
                                                                                                                                         RETRACTABLE SHEAVE
THRU-DECK SHEAVE                                                                     CROSS-DECK PENDANT                                  INSTALLATION
                                                                       FORWARD
                             RETRACTABLE SHEAVE
                             INSTALLATION
                                                                                                     FAIRLEAD SHEAVE
                                                                                                            DAMPER SHEAVE
      FAIRLEAD                                                                                                INSTALLATION
      SHEAVE                                                                                                                                    PURCHASE CABLE
                                                                                                               TO OPPOSITE
                                                                                                            ANCHOR DAMPER
    DAMPER SHEAVE                                                                                                                        FAIRLEAD
    INSTALLATION                                                                                                                         SHEAVE
     PURCHASE CABLE
                                         FAIRLEAD
                                         SHEAVES
ABEf0323
                                                                                                    LIMIT
                                                                    ACCUMULATOR                    SWITCH
                                                                                                                                   CAM
         BUFFER
        ASSEMBLY
CROSSHEAD
DAMPING ACCUMULATOR
                              LEGEND
        AIR            HIGH PRESSURE (3000 PSI)
                                                                                             STBD SHEAVE
                                                                                                            POWER ON
        AIR
                      MEDIUM PRESSURE                                                       BATTERY POS
AIR ABEf0324
                                                                                     3-25
Description                                                             The accumulator acts as a fluid stowage tank and
                                                                    has a high-pressure air connection from the upper head
    Each sheave damper assembly consists of a                       to the charging panel. The charging panel has a
movable crosshead assembly, damper cylinder                         charging valve and a gauge valve with a gauge mounted
assembly, damper piston, damper accumulator and                     between them, a high-pressure air supply valve, and a
fluid piping, buffer assembly, and charging panel. The              vent valve. The accumulator is charged to 750 psi and
system is also equipped with a common fluid stowage                 must have a reading of 2 (±1) inches of fluid on the fluid
tank, which provides a stowage space for fluid in the               sight indicator when the sheave damper is in its
sheave damper assembly while maintenance is being                   BATTERY position.
performed. The tank is capable of stowing all the fluid
                                                                        The end of the cylinder opposite the crosshead end
in one sheave damper installation.
                                                                    has a flange threaded on it that mate with a flange on the
    The crosshead assembly consists of one roller                   buffer assembly. The two flanges are bolted together.
bearing sheave mounted between a steel base plate and               The buffer assembly consists of a cylinder, buffer ram,
a side plate that are bolted together. A sheave shaft,              spring, and fluid sight indicator. The purpose of the
mounted through the bottom of the base plate, is                    buffer assembly is to buffer the damper piston when
secured to the side plate by a cap and setscrew. A yoke             returning to its BATTERY position.
is bolted between the side plate and the base plate and
provides a means of connecting the crosshead to a                   Operation
clevis that is screwed onto the end of a piston rod. The
crosshead rides in a track mounted in a horizontal                      An incoming aircraft engages the deck pendant,
position on the bulkhead.                                           causing an increase of tension on the purchase cable.
                                                                    The purchase cable is reeved around the sheave damper
     Phenolic slippers, at all four corners of the base
                                                                    crosshead in a manner that any increased tension
plate, provide a bearing surface between the crosshead
                                                                    experienced by the purchase cable will cause the sheave
and the track. Attached to the crosshead is a cam that
                                                                    damper crosshead to move away from its BATTERY
actuates a limit switch when the crosshead is fully
                                                                    position. As the sheave damper crosshead moves, the
retracted and causes a green light to light at the
                                                                    damper piston moves, forcing fluid from the cylinder,
deckedge control station. This indicates to the
                                                                    through the fluid manifold, flow control valve, and
deckedge operator that the sheave damper is in its
                                                                    fluid piping, into the accumulator. The resulting
BATTERY position.
                                                                    pressure buildup in the accumulator will be equal to the
    The damper cylinder assembly is secured to the                  purchase cable pull.
ship's structure by brackets, which are welded to the
                                                                         Retraction of the sheave damper is automatic and
bulkhead and bolted to the cylinder. A cylinder cap is
                                                                    occurs when accumulator pressure becomes greater
screwed onto the crosshead end of the cylinder and held
                                                                    than cable tension. Retraction normally occurs prior to
in place by setscrews. The cap provides a fluid passage
                                                                    full runout of the aircraft. The pressure buildup in the
between the cylinder and the fluid manifold piping
                                                                    accumulator forces the fluid from the accumulator,
leading to the damper accumulator. The damper piston
                                                                    through the fluid piping, the orifice in the flapper of the
rod extends through the cap at the crosshead end of the
                                                                    flow control valve, the reducing tee, and the fluid
cylinder. The damper piston is secured onto the
                                                                    manifold, to the damper cylinder, therefore forcing the
opposite end of the piston rod and held in place by a
                                                                    damper piston back to its BATTERY position. Just
castle nut and cotter pin.
                                                                    before the damper piston reaches its BATTERY
     The fluid manifold is bolted to the top and bottom             position, the end of the damper piston rod comes in
of the cylinder cap. A reducing tee connects the upper              contact with the buffer ram.
and lower manifold piping and serves to divert fluid
                                                                        The force of the damper piston rod pushing on the
flow from the accumulator equally into the upper and
                                                                    buffer ram compresses a spring inside the buffer
lower manifolds. A flow control valve is located
                                                                    cylinder. The spring is held in place by the buffer
between the reducing tee and the accumulator. The flow
                                                                    cylinder end plug. The compression of the spring
control valve has a flapper-type (swing gate) orifice
                                                                    buffers the return of the damper piston to its BATTERY
plate, which allows free flow of fluid from the cylinder
                                                                    position.
to the accumulator and a restricted flow through an
orifice in the center of the plate from the accumulator to             As the sheave damper crosshead reaches its
the cylinder.                                                       BATTERY position, the battery-position indicator limit
                                                             3-26
             25 WIRES PER STRAND                                                 As a result Q reading, as performed on the sisal-core
             (19 MAJOR WIRES)
                                                                                 purchase cable, are not possible. Inspection and
         6 FILLER WIRES           2                   CORE
                                                   (HEMP, FIBER)                 replacement will be based on broken wire criteria.
                 3
                                                                                     The sisal-core purchase cable is 1 7/16-inch
                                                   1
                                                                                 diameter, 6 × 25 filler wire construction, right-hand lay,
                                                                                 lang lay cables with a minimum breaking strength of
INTERFACE                                                                        195,000 pounds. The 6 × 25 filler wire construction
                                                                                 means that the cable is made up of 6 strands with 19
                                                       6                         major wires and 6 filler wires per strand. (See fig. 3-25.)
                4                                                                The filler wires provide shape and stability to the
                                                       6 STRANDS                 strand. Lang lay denotes cables in which the wires of
                                 5                     PER CABLE                 the strand and the strand are twisted in the same
       MANUFACTURER’S                                                            direction so that the outer wires in the lang lay cables
     IDENTIFICATION TAPE                                   ABEf0325
                                                                                 run diagonally across the longitudinal axis of the
                                                                                 cables.
Figure 3-25.—Cross section of preformed sisal core purchase
                          cable.                                                      The purchase cable is made from high-strength,
                                                                                 uncoated plow steel. A hemp center, made from
switch is engaged, and lights the battery-position                               resilient oil-impregnated hemp, serves as a foundation
indicator light at deck edge.                                                    for the strands, keeps the strands evenly spaced, and
                                                                                 prevents them from bearing against each other. The
Purchase cable                                                                   hemp center also aids in lubrication of the inner wires.
                                                                                 Within the hemp center is buried a paper or plastic strip
    The purchase cable is the wire rope reeved onto the                          bearing the name of the manufacturer. New purchase
arresting engine sheaves and fed through fairlead                                cables are provided on a double reel with each reel
tubing and over the fairlead sheave to the deck gear on                          containing 1100 feet of cable. The purchase cable used
the flight deck. The purchase cable transmits the force                          on a barricade engine is of the same wire rope
of the landing aircraft from the deck gear to the                                construction but is provided as a single cable, 2100 feet
arresting engine.                                                                in length with a poured terminal on one end.
    The polyester-core purchase cable is 1 7/16-inch                                 Poured threaded terminals are fitted on each end of
diameter, 6 × 31 die-formed polyester-core construc-                             the purchase cables. A clevis socket is screwed onto the
tion with no filler wires, all wires are considered                              threaded terminals to connect the purchase cables to the
loading bearing, with a minimum breaking strength of                             crossdeck pendants one end, the other end is connected
215,000 pounds. The die-formed construction is such                              to a coupling on the cable anchor damper operating
that the outer wires present a relatively flat surface,                          piston rod (fig. 3-26.)
giving it the appearance of being worn even when new.
 ANCHOR SCREW
                                 ANCHOR NUT
                                                                                                            CLEVIS
                                                                         ANCHOR                             SOCKET
                                                                         SCREW
ANCHOR NUT
                                      CLEVIS PIN
                                                                                                                                CLEVIS PIN
                     LOCK RING
                                                                                                                                  ABEf0326
                                              Figure 3-26.—Purchase cable attachments.
                                                                          3-27
     The Mk 7 arresting engines have an 18:1 reeve                                                             COVER
ratio, which means for every foot of ram travel there are
18 feet of purchase cable payout. The number of                                                                INSERT
sheaves on the crosshead determines the reeve ratio.
The types of reeves used on the Mk 7 arresting engines
are 18:1 single reeve on pendant engines, and 18:1                                                             INNER
endless reeve on barricade engines. The endless reeve                                                         SPACER
                                                                3-28
                                                                                                              INDICATOR LIGHT
                                                                                                               CIRCUIT SWITCH
                                                                                                                  (OFF-ON)
                RETRACTABLE
                  SHEAVE
                                                                              THRU DECK
                                                                               SHEAVE
                                                                                RED
                                                                                AMBER
                                                                                GREEN
                                                                                                                                        INDICATOR
                  TO POWER                                                                                                              BOX
                   SUPPLY                      MOTOR                                                  PUSHBUTTON
                                             CONTROLLER                                               STATION
                                                      7
                                                                    9
                                                                         15
                                       10                                                                                       25
                                                          8
                                                              16
                                                                                                                                22
                                                                                               13                                23
                                                                                     14
                                                                                                                                   21
                                                                                                                                   20
                            DRIVE
                           SLEEVE
                           BUSHING                                      11
                                                              12               17
                                                                                                 18
                                                                                                                   ABEf0329
                                                               19
1.   Geared limit switch          5.   Lower bevel gear                             9. Tripping plate washer                  13. Torque spring
2.   Motor                        6.   Pinion                                       10. Worm gear                             14. Declutch lever
3.   Housing                      7.   Clutch fork spring                           11. Handwheel                             15. Worm
4.   Sleeve                       8.   Clutch bevel gear                            12. Wormshaft                             16. Torque limit switch
                                            Figure 3-29.—Retractable sheave operating unit.
                                                                             3-29
     The sleeve is directly keyed to the lead screw of the            arresting gear officer from giving a clear deck signal if
retractable sheave so that rotation of the sleeve raises or           one or more of the retractable sheaves is not in the fully
lowers the sheave. The amount of sleeve rotation while                up position.
the sheave is rising is governed by the adjustable geared
                                                                          If a retractable sheave cannot be raised, the
limit switch, which opens the motor circuit when the
                                                                      arresting gear officer directs that the affected deck
sheave is fully up. An adjustable torque limit switch,
                                                                      pendant be removed from the deck. A CLEAR DECK
actuated by the tripping plate washer, opens the motor
                                                                      signal can now be activated by closing the respective
circuit when the sheave is fully lowered and further
                                                                      by-pass switch and thus overriding the shutdown
provides overload protection for the unit. The worm is
                                                                      arresting engine. An amber warning light on the
normally held in position with a heavy torque spring. If
                                                                      by-pass switch and indicator panel visually indicates
an obstruction under the sheave prevents the sheave
                                                                      the by-pass condition. In addition, a three-lamp,
from lowering, the sleeve cannot turn. Then the torque
                                                                      deckedge indicator panel with red, amber, and green
exerted by the worm exceeds the normal torque,
                                                                      lenses, mounted aft of the deckedge control station, will
causing the worm to slide along the wormshaft, pushing
                                                                      indicate the retractable-sheave status. This panel will
the tripping plate washer, and opening the torque
                                                                      illuminate red when any of the retractable sheaves are
switch. A handwheel is provided for manual operation,
                                                                      down and green when all sheaves are up. In case one or
and a declutch lever is provided to change from motor
                                                                      more arresting engine and retractable sheave is
to hand operation.
                                                                      bypassed, the deckedge indicator light will display the
    It is imperative that the deckedge operator knows                 green and amber lights.
whether the retractable sheave is in the UP position
during landing operations. During night operations,                   SEQUENCE OF OPERATION
visual sighting of the retractable sheave is impossible.
                                                                          Energizing the motor to raise the retractable
    An arresting gear SHEAVE-UP and BY-PASS                           sheave, by pressing the RAISE push button, causes the
switch and indicator panel (fig. 3-30) is located aft of              motor to rotate a helical gear keyed to its shaft. This
the arresting gear deckedge control station to indicate               transmits the motor force to another helical gear on the
the status of the retractable sheave. The panel is wired              wormshaft. The wormshaft turns the worm and drives
into the clear/foul deck light and will prevent the
                                                      INDICATOR LIGHTS
ON ON ON ON
                                                                                                       ABEf0330
                               Figure 3-30.—Sheave-up and by-pass switch and indicator panel.
                                                               3-30
the worm gear on the sleeve. The worm gear rotates                   Thru-deck Sheave
freely on the sleeve for part of the rotation, thus
permitting the motor to gain speed before full loading.                  The thru-deck sheave (fig 3-23) is mounted
As the worm gear rotates, the lugs on its face engage the            vertically and it guides the purchase cable between the
lugs on the face of the clutch bevel gear. Rotation of the           sheave damper and the retractable sheave installation.
clutch bevel gear, which is splined to the sleeve, rotates
the sleeve, which is directly connected to the screw of              Fairlead Sheaves
the retractable sheave, thus raising the sheave. When
the sleeve rotates, the limit bevel gear, keyed to the                   Fairlead sheaves (fig. 3-23) are single sheaves that
sleeve, rotates to turn the pinion of the geared limit               are installed at points in the drive system where the
switch. This is the only function of the limit bevel gear.           purchase cable require a change of direction. The
When a predetermined point is reached by the rotor of                number of fairlead sheaves varies based on engine
the geared limit switch, the RAISE circuit is broken and             location in relation to the location of the anchor and
the raising operation ceases. As the geared limit switch             sheave dampers.
is actuated, the green lamp (sheave UP lamp) will light
in the deckedge light box.                                           Crossdeck Pendants
     Energizing the motor to lower the retractable                       The polyester-core crossdeck pendant are made of
sheave, by depressing the LOWER push button, causes                  1 7/16-inch diameter, 6 × 30 flattened strand polyester
the motor and the drive system to operate in the reverse             core construction with no filler wires, all wires are
direction. Again there is free rotation until the lugs on            considered loading bearing with a minimum breaking
the worm gear make a complete revolution before                      strength of 205,000 pounds. To differentiate
striking the other side of the lugs on the clutch bevel              polyester-core CDPs from sisal-core CDPs the
gear. The sheave lowers until it is completely seated and            polyester-core terminals have a groove around the end
opens the torque limit switch to break the motor circuit.            where the cable enters the terminal. The deck pendant
If an obstruction prevents the sheave from descending,               cable ends are equipped with swaged-type terminals.
the worm, which is still rotating because of the force of            These terminals are pinned to the clevis and socket
the motor, does not turn the worm gear. The worm is                  assembly at the purchase cable coupling for quick
driven axially along the wormshaft until the torque                  detachment during replacement.
limit switch is opened by the tripping plate washer. The
torque limit switch may be adjusted to permit the                        The sisal-core crossdeck pendant are made of
sheave to seal with a predetermined force before the                 1 3/8-inch diameter, 6 × 30 flattened strand construc-
circuit is interrupted. The torque spring then absorbs               tion, preformed, uncoated lang lay wire rope with a
the remaining inertia of the system after the circuit is             minimum breaking strength of 188,000 pounds. Each
broken. During the time the sheave is lowered and                    wire rope is made up of 6 steel strands, each of which is
raised up until the time the RAISE geared limit switch               a bundle of 12 major and 12 intermediate wires twisted
is tripped, the red (sheave NOT UP) lamp glows on the                around a triangular core of 3 to 9 wires. (See fig. 3-31.)
deckedge light box.                                                  The strands are twisted about an oiled-hemp center
                                                                           TRIANGULAR                       CORE
    For manual operation, the handwheel must be                               CORE                       (HEMP, FIBER)
mounted on its shaft and secured to the shaft with a                                              2            12 MAJOR
                                                                            INTERFACE
setscrew. The declutch lever must then be thrown in a                                                           WIRES
counterclockwise direction. This movement will slide                                 3
                                                                                                               1
the clutch bevel gear along the splined section of the
sleeve to engage a gear on the handcrank shaft. When
the handcrank is turned, the sleeve turns, rotating the
sheave screw to raise or lower the sheave. The declutch
lever remains in the clutch position until operation                                 4                         6
under motor power is resumed, at which time the
                                                                                                               6 STRANDS
handwheel is disconnected automatically by the clutch                                             5            PER CABLE
trippers. There is no danger to an operator if he or she is                      MANUFACTURER'S           12 INTERMEDIATE
turning the handwheel when the motor is started,                               IDENTIFICATION TAPE              WIRES
                                                                                                                    ABEf0331
because the handwheel is disengaged instantly without
                                                                       Figure 3-31.—Cross section of preformed sisal core 6 × 30
shock or jolt.                                                                          crossdeck pendant.
                                                              3-31
            LOCKSCREW                                               pulling, then block the valve in the closed position to
                                                                    prevent retraction. It may be necessary to clamp a block
                                                                    on the purchase cable to prevent its slipping back due to
                             ANCHOR NUT                             its own weight. If a pendant is badly damaged during an
                                                                    arrestment and must be replaced immediately, either do
                                                                    NOT retract the pendant or retract the pendant only
                                                                    partially so that slack is left in the cable system.
                                                                        Refer to figure 3-32, and perform the following
                                                                    task to replace a deck pendant. Screw the lockscrew
                                        DECK PENDANT
                                          TERMINAL                  into the clevis end socket, remove the anchor nut and
                                                                    pull out the clevis pin. Secure the eye end of the
                                 CLEVIS SOCKET
                                                                    terminal of the new deck pendant to the clevis end
                               CLEVIS PIN
                                                                    socket of the purchase cable socket assembly by means
TACK WELD                                                           of the clevis pin, anchor nut, and the lockscrew.
                                                  ABEf0332
                                                                    Recharge the accumulator and retract the engine.
   Figure 3-32.—Deck pendant terminal and clevis socket
                       assembly.
                                                                        Deck pendants are provided as assemblies—not
                                                                    made up on board ship. Suitable handling facilities
                                                                    should be available. Spare pendants should be
core, within which is contained a paper or plastic tape             conveniently stowed, ready for quick rigging, since
strip bearing the name of the wire rope manufacturer.               replacement of a deck pendant is sometimes an
The function of the oiled hemp center is to provide a               emergency procedure that must be performed quickly.
"cushion" for each strand and also to supply lubrication                The replacement operation can best be performed
when the cable is under tension. The deck pendant                   by four separate crews. One crew is needed to pull out
cable ends are equipped with swaged-type terminals.                 the pendant, one at each of the two couplings, and one
These terminals are pinned to the clevis and socket                 to bring the new pendant on deck and roll it out and in
assembly at the purchase cable coupling for quick                   position.
detachment during replacement.
    To remove a pendant, it is necessary to put slack in            Impact Pads
the cable. If the pendant has been retrieved and must be
replaced, reduce the accumulator pressure to 200 psi                    Impact pads (fig. 3-33) are made up of several
and pull the pendant out a few feet, using a deck tractor.          sections of polyurethane pads laid side by side and
Hold the retracting valve open while the tractor is                 secured within an outer steel frame. The frame is both
IMPACT PADS
                                                                                                 ABEf0333
                                            Figure 3-33.—Terminal impact pads.
                                                             3-32
welded and bolted to the flight deck inboard of each of                These wire supports are actually preshaped leaf
the deck sheaves at an approximate 45 degrees forward              springs that are designed to maintain a crossdeck
facing angle. The bolted section of the frame is                   pendant height of 2 inches minimum, measured from
removable in order to replace worn impact pads as                  the bottom of the pendant to deck at its lowest point,
needed. Upon initial arrestment by an aircraft the                 and 5 1/2 inches maximum, measured from the top of
terminal will impact on the pads instead of the steel              the pendant to the deck at its highest point (fig. 3-34).
deck, minimizing damage to the fittings, purchase                  The crossdeck pendant height is regulated by adjusting
cable, and crossdeck pendants.                                     the wire support's contour height.
                                                                       Each wire support is mounted directly to the flight
Wire Supports
                                                                   deck. The forward end of the wire support spring is
     The wire supports provide a method of raising the             rigidly secured by use of a cam mounted in a deck
crossdeck pendant off the flight deck to ensure arresting          recess and a follower and pin at the end of the wire
(tail) hook engagement of the incoming aircraft.                   support. The forward end of the spring is then held in
2"
ABEf0334
                                                            3-33
the deck recess by the cam-end disc and the cam-end               Q5.     What system transfers energy from an
forward stop (fig. 3-35).                                                 arresting aircraft to the arresting engine?
    Adjustment of the wire support spring height is               Q6.     What reduces peak cable tension?
made at its aft end. The aft end of the wire support is
also pinned, and set between adjustable forward stops                       EMERGENCY RECOVERY
as required (fig. 3-35).                                                        EQUIPMENT
    Wire supports are replaced when they become                      LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Describe the
deformed or damaged or when they fail to maintain the                components of the emergency recovery
required crossdeck pendant height of 2 inches                        equipment. Describe the operation of the
minimum and 5 1/2 inches maximum as measured                         emergency recovery equipment.
using a cable height gauge (fig. 3-34).
                                                                     The emergency recovery equipment (barricade
                                                                 installation) is used when an aircraft cannot make a
               REVIEW QUESTIONS
                                                                 normal (pendant) arrestment. Emergency recovery
 Q1.     What is considered the heart of the arresting           equipment consists of the following:
         engine?
                                                                     • Barricade power package
 Q2.     What permits the return of hydraulic fluid
         from the accumulator to the main engine                     • Pendant and anchor installation
         cylinder?                                                   • Barricade stanchions and controls
 Q3.     What is the capacity of the fluid stowage                   • Barricade webbing assembly
         tank?
                                                                     • Deck ramp installation
 Q4.     What is the pitch diameter of the sheaves on
         the outboard shaft of the crosshead                         The arresting engines used for barricade
         assembly?                                               arrestments are identical to those used for deck pendant
                                                                                CAM-END
                                                                              FORWARD STOP
                                          AFT COVER
                                          PIVOT END BASE
                                                                      SPRING
                                                                           CAM
                                                            LOCK PLATE
                                                                                                       CAM-END DISC
                                                                                             FWD
SPRING SPRING
FORWARD
                                                                                                      ABEf0335
                               Figure 3-35.—Adjusting the wire support leaf spring height.
                                                          3-34
arrestment with four exceptions: (1) no fluid coolers are              • READY— Jet Barricade
installed, (2) barricade engines are endless reeved, (3)
no anchor dampers are installed, and (4) a short-stroke                • STANDBY— Jet Barricade
control valve cam is used on most carriers.                            • PRACTICE— Jet Barricade
BARRICADE WEBBING ASSEMBLY                                              The E2/C2 barricade is also stowed in the stowage
                                                                   room. The storage area for the webbing assemblies
    Since barricade arrestments are emergency                      must be dry and must protect the webbing from
situations, barricade-rigging operations must be swift             exposure to direct sunlight. The effects of water on a
and efficient. The barricade webbing assemblies (fig.              barricade webbing assembly will result in the loss of
3-36) are assembled and stored in an area where the                approximately 10 to 15 percent of the webbing's
webbing assemblies will be readily accessible when an              strength and its weight increases by approximately 40
emergency situation arises. The barricade storage room             to 45 percent. However the strength loss and increase in
is equipped with a rack designed to stow three                     weight are not permanent. When the webbing is dry to
barricades simultaneously:                                         the touch the original barricade strength and weight are
                                                                   regained .
ENGAGING STRAPS
                                                                                                MULTIPLE RELEASE
                                                                                                STRAPS
  ANCHOR
                                                                                                         UPPER TENSIONING
     HOLDDOWN                                                                                            PENDANT
                                                                                                         (DECK GEAR)
DECK RAMP
                              PARALLEL                                                      CONNECTING
                              PENDANT                                                         STRAP
                           FWD
                                   EXTENSION LOOP
                                                    SHACKLE
                                                    ASSEMBLY
EXTENSION PENDANT
                                                              LOWER TENSIONING
                                                                      PENDANT
                                                                   (DECK GEAR)
ABEf0336
                                                            3-35
   Newly constructed barricade webbing assemblies                    the other and bundled together to make up one
may be brought out of storage and used as follows:                   barricade installation (see fig. 3-36).
    • If used for three practice rigs, it can still be used              The polyurethane semicoated barricade uses three
      as a "ready" barricade for engagements.                        separate webbing systems to make one main webbing
                                                                     assembly
    • If used for four or more practice rigs, it cannot be
      used as a "ready" barricade.                                       Each semicoated barricade webbing system is
                                                                     composed of upper and lower horizontal load straps
    When an aircraft is required to make an emergency                (see fig. 3-36) joined together at the ends by nylon
landing, the nose of the aircraft passes through the                 velcro tie-down straps. (The rolled edges of the upper
barricade and allows the vertical (engaging) straps to               and lower load straps are coated with polyurethane to
contact the leading edges of the wings and wrap about                reduce wear and damage caused when the barricade is
the aircraft (fig. 3-37). The barricade installation then            dragged into position for use.)
passes the force of arrestment through the purchase
cable to the arresting engine. After arrestment, the                     Vertical engaging straps, are looped around the
barricade and attached hardware are discarded.                       upper and lower load strap of each webbing system and
                                                                     sewn.. The spacing between the vertical engaging
    Currently, there are two types of barricades (two                straps affords equalized loading of the barricade during
configurations) available to the fleet. Both types consist           arrestment. One webbing assembly, effects equalized
of all-nylon webbing assemblies, placed one on top of                loading every 4 feet along the wing's leading edge
BOOT
VIEW A
                                                                          VELCRO TIE-DOWN
                                                                              STRAPS
                                                                                                                  ANCHOR
                                                               THREE WEBBING
                                                                                                                  ASSEMBLY
                                                               ASSEMBLIES
ENGAGING STRAPS
RELEASE STRAPS
REFER TO VIEW A
          EXTENSION
           PENDANT
                                         PARALLEL
                                         PENDANT
U-SHACKLE
WINCH
                                                                                                               ABE3f0337
                                            Figure 3-37.—Emergency arrestment.
                                                              3-36
because of the staggered arrangement of the vertical                           The purpose of the deck ramps is to secure the
engaging straps.                                                           lower load straps in place and cause the aircraft nose
                                                                           wheel to ride up and into the barricade assembly. This
     The second barricade configuration (fig. 3-38) is
                                                                           protects the lower load straps and also prevents the
the E-2/C-2 barricade. A 40 foot opening in the center
                                                                           aircraft from nosing under them during a barricade
of the webbing is designed so that props of the E-2/C-2
                                                                           arrestment.
aircraft can pass through it with minimal damage to
aircraft during arrestment. The E-2/C-2 barricade                              Deck ramps are normally installed by V-1 division
installation is comprised of an uncoated, double                           personnel during barricade rig evolutions.
webbing assembly which is factory preassembled,
boxed and shipped ready to rig.                                            MULTIPLE-RELEASE ASSEMBLY
LOADING STRAPS
STRAP CLIPS
RELEASE STRAPS
                          ENGAGING STRAPS
                                                                                           BOOT
CONNECTIONS STRAPS
                                                                                                            LOWER TENSIONING
                                                                                                            PENDANT
                                                U-SHACKLE
                                                  EXTENSION
                                                  PENDANT                             EXTENSION LOOPS
              STANCHION
                                                       PURCHASE CABLE
40'
                                   DECK RAMPS
                                                                                                                               ABEf0338
                                        Figure 3-38.—E2/C2 aircraft barricade installation.
                                                                   3-37
the load straps. They are then attached to the tensioning           port stanchions with their actuating apparatus are
pendants by a pelican hook assembly. During an                      described in this chapter. Barricade stanchions (fig.
emergency arrestment, the force of the aircraft                     3-39) are welded steel, tray-shaped assemblies that
engaging the barricade breaks the multiple-release                  consist essentially of a base on which is hinged the
straps, releasing the barricade from the tensioning                 frame. Each barricade frame contains the winches,
pendants allowing it to fall over the aircraft. The energy          sheaves, and pendants used to tension the upper
of the engagement is then transferred from the                      barricade webbing load strap.
barricade through the purchase cable to the arresting
                                                                        Each barricade stanchion is provided with a slot, at
engine.
                                                                    the top of the inboard side, through which passes the
                                                                    upper tensioning pendant. The frame moves as a hinge
BARRICADE STANCHIONS
                                                                    around the two stanchion shafts, the barrel of the hinge
    Barricade stanchions house the winches that                     being the base and the knuckles of the hinge being the
tension and support the barricades. They further                    hubs of the stanchion frame. The two shafts act as the
provide the structure on which the barricade is raised or           pins of the hinge. The actuating arm is keyed and
lowered.                                                            pinned on the outer shaft and is pinned to a holder on
                                                                    the stanchion. Rubber bumper pads are bolted in the
    Except for differences of location and position of              deck recess to cushion the shock of lowering the
the actuating apparatus—deckedge, above or below                    stanchions.
deck—port and starboard stanchions are identical. The
                                                                                                 COUNTERBALANCE
                                                                                                 SPRING ASSEMBLY
STANCHION
                                                                                                      CYLINDER
            POWER                                                                                     ASSEMBLY
          PACKAGE
                                                                                                      ABEf0339
                                                                      PRESSURE GAUGE
                                                                                  DECKEDGE
                                                                              CONTROL VALVE
                                       Figure 3-39.—Barricade stanchion installation.
                                                             3-38
PENDANT AND ANCHOR INSTALLATION                                  lower loading strap of the barricade webbing (see fig.
                                                                 3-40).
    The pendant and anchor installation (fig. 3-40) is
the means by which the barricade webbing is                      Tensioning pendants
suspended and tensioned to maintain its 20-foot
midspan height above the flight deck. Components                     Tensioning pendants provide the link between the
comprising the pendant and anchor installation are:              winches, anchor and loading straps to keep the straps in
four wire rope tensioning pendants, two stanchion                the correct position when a barricade is rigged (see fig.
mounted winches. A deck mounted winch assembly,                  3-40).
and an anchor assembly.
                                                                 STANCHION HYDRAULIC CYLINDER
Stanchion mounted winches
                                                                      The hydraulic cylinder (fig. 3-41) raises and lowers
    One winch is mounted in each barricade stanchion             the barricade stanchion when hydraulic fluid under
and is attached to the tensioning pendant of the upper           pressure is introduced into the cylinder on either the
loading strap of the barricade.                                  raising side of the piston or the lowering side of the
                                                                 piston. A front cap (3) and a rear cap (4) are each
Deck winch                                                       attached to the cylinder ends by bolts and sealed by an
                                                                 O-ring (13) and backup rings. Contained in the cylinder
    The deck winch, through the tensioning pendants              (2) are a piston (1), a piston rod (5), and two plungers
provide a means of tensioning the starboard side lower           (6), one on each side of the piston. The piston and
loading strap of the barricade webbing (see fig. 3-40).          plungers are held in position on the rod by a castellated
                                                                 nut and secured by a cotter pin. The piston and piston
Anchor assembly                                                  rod are sealed by an O-ring (13) and backup rings. The
                                                                 piston is fitted with two packing followers, two sets of
   The anchor assembly, through the tensioning                   V-ring packings (12), four rings each, and two piston
pendants provides a means of tensioning the port side
TENSIONING PENDANTS
                                                           BARRICADE
                                                          INSTALLATION
FWD ANCHOR
                                                              WINCH
                                                             ASSEMBLY
                                                                                            ABEf0340
                                                          3-39
                                                                                                                7
                                                                                                   11
                                                                                               6
                                                     8
                                  3
                                                                                                                                       4
                                                                                                                                  13
                        10                                                                                           1       13
                                                                                                                12
                                                                                                        14
                                                                  13                         ABEf0341
                             14                          13
                                                     9
                                          12
glands (11) secured by bolts, each safety wired. Shims                            and packing. A vent valve assembly (8) and plug (9) are
(14) are provided between the piston face and piston                              located at each end of the hydraulic cylinder to vent air
gland to obtain the proper packing float. The piston rod                          or drain fluid.
is sealed where it extends through the front cap (3) by
four V-ring packings (12), a spacer, and piston rod                               COUNTERBALANCING SPRING
gland (10) secured by bolts and washers. Shims (14) are
provided to obtain proper packing float. A terminal is                                The counterbalancing spring supplements the force
attached to the end of the piston rod and is secured by a                         of the stanchion cylinder in raising the stanchion, and
setscrew. The front cap and rear face are each fitted with                        cushions the contact of the stanchion with the deck.
a tailpiece, an adapter, an orifice plate, a union nut, and                           The counterbalancing spring (fig. 3-42) is a group
an elbow to attach hose; joints are sealed by O-rings                             of three compression spring units (5) comprising five
                        1             2
                                                3
                                                          4
                                                                                  5
                       ABEf0342
                                                                                                                         7
                                                                           3-40
               1                                                      The outboard ends of the rods are bolted to a similar
                          2
                                                                      plate, which has a welded clevis outboard, through
                                                 3                    which is bolted the eyed terminal of the
                                                       4              counterbalancing spring cable. The cable (7) runs
                                                           5          through two sheaves and is then bolted through its
                                                                      terminal to the actuator arm of the barricade stanchion,
                                                                      below the point of attachment for the cylinder.
                                                                           When the stanchion is lowered by the cylinder, the
                                                                      sets of springs are uniformly compressed and resist the
                                                                      force of the descent, and cushions its fall against the
   ABEf0343
                                                                      deck. Raising the stanchion slackens the spring cable
                                                                      and decompresses the spring, but this release of
                                                                      compression has no appreciable effect on raising the
               1. END PLATE             4. BODY                       stanchion.
               2. SPRING                5. LATCH
               3. PIN                                                 STANCHION LATCH
              Figure 3-43.—Stanchion latch assembly.
                                                                           Stanchion latches are used to secure the stanchions
                                                                      to the deck in their DOWN position. Stanchion latches
                                                                      (fig. 3-43) are spring-loaded latches bolted to the
individual springs (4) each. It is designed to act as a               subdeck and provided with a slotted frame, designed to
single spring by means of rods (3) that pass through                  allow the latch (5) to be retracted against the force of a
each set of springs and end in eyed terminals (6). The                spring (2), and turned to lock the latch open. When the
inboard ends of the rods are bolted to clevises (2),                  stanchion is lowered, the latch may be engaged in a hole
which are welded to an equalizing plate (1). The plate                provided in the stanchion, and a spring will hold the
has a threaded adjustable rod that is secured to the ship's           latch in.
structure to hold the inboard ends of the spring unit.
                                                                                          STOWAGE
                                                                                          TANK
                                                                                                     CONTROL
                                                                                                     PANEL
ACCUMULATOR
                                                                                               SIGHT
                                                                                               GLASS
                                                                                                       PUMP/
                                                                                                       MOTOR
                                            CONTROLLER
ABEf0344
                                                               3-41
POWER PACKAGE                                                           The control panel assembly (fig. 3-45) is attached
                                                                   to the gravity tank by four bolts.
    The power package (fig. 3-44) provides and
                                                                        The panel consists of the panel frame (1), two
maintains the fluid pressure required by the hydraulic
                                                                   piping support brackets (9), accumulator pressure
cylinders to raise and lower the barricade stanchions. It
                                                                   gauge (6), pressure sensing switch (7), gauge valve (3),
consists of a base weldment, gravity tank assembly,
                                                                   air-charging valve (5), vent valve (2), air supply valve
control panel assembly, accumulator, motor controller,
                                                                   (4), caution plate (8), and operating instruction plate
pump, electric motor, electrical system, and piping
                                                                   (10). Necessary copper tubing and sil-braze fittings
system.
                                                                   connect the panel to the accumulator assembly, to a
     The gravity tank assembly has a capacity of                   ship's exhaust line, and to the ship's high-pressure air
approximately 125 gallons and is the fluid reservoir in            supply line. The accumulator pressure gauge (6) is used
the power package assembly. Displaced fluid from the               to indicate pressures ranging from 0 to 2,000 psi in the
cylinder assemblies is returned to the gravity tank, and           accumulator.
from there it is pumped back to the accumulator. The
                                                                       The pressure-sensing switch (7) is a piston type,
gravity tank is welded steel, closed at the top and
                                                                   contained in a splashproof housing. It is connected to
bottom by flat plates. The top cover plate has an access
                                                                   the pressure line from the accumulator with a threaded
hole, which is covered by a cap plate and gasket held in
                                                                   adapter and a coil of tubing between the adapter and tee
place by bolts. Tapped bosses welded to the cap plate
                                                                   in the pressure line. The function of the
are for breather vents. A liquid-level gauge is connected
                                                                   pressure-sensing switch is to maintain accumulator
to the side of the gravity tank. An indicator plate is
                                                                   pressure between 1,250 psi and 1,500 psi. It does this
attached to the tank at the level gauge to show the
                                                                   by opening or closing to stop or start the pump motor.
proper fluid level.
                                              6                    7               5                4
                        10
AIR SUPPLY
VENT VALVE
CAUTION
ABEf0345
1 8 2
                                                            3-42
The pressure switch operates only when the motor                  and open full at 1,750 psi. This line is equipped with a
controller switch is set at the AUTOMATIC position.               liquid sight indicator for visual checking of fluid flow,
The caution plate (8) is located next to the vent valve           which would indicate an open relief valve. The air
(2). It cautions all concerned to keep the vent valve             safety head, which ruptures at approximately 2,000 psi,
open at all times except when charging the                        is connected to the air line between the accumulator and
accumulator, and contains instructions for closing the            control panel. It acts as a safety to prevent charging the
vent valve when charging the accumulator.                         accumulator and related components above their design
                                                                  limits. Two breather vents at the top of the gravity tank
     A gauge valve (3) is furnished to maintain pressure
                                                                  provide for passage of air out of or into the tank as the
in the accumulator when it is necessary to remove the
                                                                  liquid level rises or lowers. A screen in the breather vent
pressure gauge (6). The air-charging valve (5) regulates
                                                                  removes any foreign matter from incoming air.
the charging flow. The air supply valve (4) controls the
flow intake of air to the control panel and accumulator.
                                                                  BARRICADE OPERATION
The operating instruction plate (10) contains basic
operating instructions and a piping schematic.                         During normal operations the system is put in the
    The motor controller regulates the starting and               READY condition. The power package, which is
stopping of the pump motor in conjunction with the                located below deck and includes an accumulator and
pressure-sensing switch. The controller, operating                gravity tank, is to be placed in a READY condition as
magnetically, provides a switch control for OFF,                  follows:
AUTOMATIC, or RUN positions. The OFF position is
                                                                      • Place accumulator pressure at 1,500 psi.
used when the power package is secured. The
AUTOMATIC position is used when the power                             • Fill accumulator and gravity tank liquid to
package is to be operated, and the RUN position is used                 operating level.
when it is necessary to bypass the pressure-sensing
switch. Protective features of the controller include                 • Open or close proper valves.
pilot circuit and motor overload protection and                       • Place motor controller switch on AUTOMATIC.
undervoltage release. A white light is mounted on the
controller to indicate when power is available. When                  • Check controls for proper operation.
the switch is in the OFF position, the circuits from the              • Inspect barricade-tensioning pendants for fray-
controller to the motor and the pressure-sensing switch                 ing.
remain open, or dead. In the AUTOMATIC position,
the motor starts when the contacts are closed in the                  As shown in figure 3-46, after the latch at the top of
pressure-sensing switch, and the motor stops when the             the stanchion is released, the deckedge control valve
contacts open. The RUN position is spring returned,               lever is placed in the Raise position (No. 1), and the
and the motor runs only as long as the switch is                  stanchions will raise simultaneously. Raising opera-
manually depressed.                                               tions may be stopped and stanchions held in any
                                                                  position by placing the deckedge control valve lever in
     In the piping system, manual valves are placed in            the Neutral position (No. 2).
the lines to provide for operating and standby
conditions and for maintenance. Each valve is tagged                  To lower the stanchions, place the deckedge control
with a nameplate giving its number and normal                     valve lever in the Lower position (No. 3). Stanchions
operating position (OPEN or CLOSED). Mis-                         will lower simultaneously. Lowering operations may be
cellaneous equipment includes a check valve, fluid                stopped and stanchions held in any position by placing
strainer, hydraulic pressure relief valve, and an air             the deckedge control valve lever in mid-position
safety head. The check valve between the accumulator              (No. 2).
and pump prevents fluid pressure from backing up to                   The deckedge control valve lever in mid-position
the pump. The fluid strainer in the line between the              (No. 2) is the standby position. It blocks all valve ports,
gravity tank and the pump removes foreign matter                  and any passage of fluid is stopped when the valve is in
before it enters the pump. The hydraulic relief valve             this position. This position should be used to stop
connected to the line between the check valve and                 stanchions during raising or lowering or to hold the
pump provides for pressure relief. The hydraulic relief           stanchions either up or down.
valve is adjusted to crack open at 1,600 psi (minimum)
                                                           3-43
                                                                                                                   DE
                                                                                                                CA
                                                                                                           R RI
                                                                                                                 P
                                                                                                         BA U
                                                                                                                    E
                                                                                                                 AD
                                                                                                             R IC AL
                                                                                                           R     R
                                                                                                         BA EUT
                                                                                                           N
                                                                                                                       E
                                                                                                                  AD
                                                                                                               IC
                                                                                                           A RR WN
                                                                                                          B DO
                                                                                                                       CONTROL
                                                                                                                        LEVER
ABEf0346
                                                         E
                                                    E  DG
           CONTROL VALVE                         CK
              (4-WAY)                          DE
                                                             3-44
    During the READY condition at 1-hour intervals,                effective life of equipment or to forewarn of impending
check the accumulator pressure, accumulator and                    troubles. Corrective maintenance includes procedures
gravity tank liquid levels, controller switch for                  designed to analyze and correct material defects and
AUTOMATIC setting, and make sure the pump is not                   troubles. The main objective of shipboard preventive
operating when accumulator pressure is 1,500 psi or                maintenance is the prevention of breakdown,
above.                                                             deterioration, and malfunction of equipment. If,
                                                                   however, this objective is not reached, the alternative
    During the SECURE condition, make a daily check
                                                                   objective of repairing or replacing failed
of the accumulator pressure, accumulator and gravity
                                                                   equipment—corrective         maintenance—must        be
tank liquid level, valves for position (open or closed),
                                                                   accomplished.
and controller switch for OFF setting.
                                                                        Maintenance by the arresting gear crew must go
    The system must be operated WEEKLY to raise
                                                                   beyond a wipedown and periodic lubrication. The
and lower the stanchions, to vent air from both ends of
                                                                   arresting gear personnel must be instructed to alert the
the hydraulic cylinders, and to check the operations of
                                                                   officer in charge to any signs of malfunction, wear,
the system. It is not necessary to attach the barricade
                                                                   looseness, leakage, damage, or any other irregular
webbing during this exercise.
                                                                   conditions in the arresting gear equipment. They should
                                                                   also learn the physical location of all operating parts,
               REVIEW QUESTIONS                                    cable runs, air supply lines, valves, electrical supply
 Q7.     List the four differences between a pendant               lines, switches, fuse boxes, tools, and spare parts.
         engine and a barricade engine.                                Engine inspection should be visual, mechanical,
 Q8.     What connects the upper and lower loads                   and operational. The following general notes apply to
         straps to the barricade stanchions?                       maintenance throughout the arresting gear equipment:
 Q9.     When are the counterbalancing springs                         • Mechanical inspection is performed while the
         compressed?                                                     engine is at rest. It consists of a security check,
                                                                         exercising the engine, and manipulating the
Q10.     What secures the barricade stanchions to the                    controls. This inspection is a check for
         deck?                                                           looseness, excessive play, improper operation of
Q11.     What is the barricade power package                             hidden parts, lack of lubrication, or any
         accumulator operating pressure?                                 abnormal resistance to motion.
Q12.     What are three positions of the motor                         • Operational inspection consists of running all
         controller switch?                                              operable systems through a full cycle of
                                                                         operation, checking for smoothness of
                                                                         operation, proper timing, and synchronization.
         MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Describe the                                  • All maintenance performed on recovery
    procedures for replacing purchase cables.                            equipment should be noted in the maintenance
    Describe the procedures for replacing                                log for that particular unit.
    packings.                                                          • Changes in critical measurements should be
     Arresting gear must be kept ready for instant use.                  logged so that they can be used to predict trends
There is only one way such a condition may be effected;                  and avoid possible troubles.
that is, by constant inspection, repair, and maintenance.              • Wipe down all arresting gear equipment daily to
Preoperational and postoperational inspection of all                     remove dirt and grime.
components is mandatory, as directed by the applicable
MRC. Every section, topside, below deck, engine areas,                 • Remove rust; paint when necessary.
and ready stowage must be prepared to function on                      • Do not paint threads or finished machined
command.                                                                 surfaces.
    Maintenance can be divided into two broad
                                                                       • Check for loose or damaged bolts, nuts, and
categories: preventive maintenance and corrective
                                                                         screws. Tighten or replace as required.
maintenance. Preventive maintenance consists of
routine shipboard procedures designed to increase the
                                                            3-45
       Replacement bolts should be of equal or greater               pulling a kink into the line. If the purchase cable is
       strength than the original.                                   severed below deck but still reeved, isolate the break
                                                                     and thread a 9/16-inch cable through the system and
    • All bolts should be tightened to the proper
                                                                     butt braze this to the longer length to provide a
      torque value.
                                                                     continuous line for pulling in the new cable.
    • Check for hydraulic and pneumatic leaks.                           The following procedures should be followed in
    • Be alert for any unusual sounds that may                       replacing purchase cables:
      indicate malfunctioning equipment. Report                          1. Initial reeving of an engine is facilitated by
      these conditions to the officer in charge.                            hand-threading the complete fairlead system
    • Check spares on hand against allowable spares                         and engine with a length of 9/16-inch cable.
      list. Replenish spare parts monthly.                                  After reeving the 9/16-inch cable, splice and
                                                                            braze the end to the purchase cable and pull the
    • Maintenance personnel must establish and                              larger into the system with the smaller. This
      carefully maintain the Recovery Wire Rope                             smaller-diameter cable is easier to push
      History Chart, recording all wire rope data.                          through the fairlead pipes and wrap around the
    • The replacement of any O-ring, V-ring, or other                       sheaves before pulling in the purchase cable.
      pressure seal necessitates a high-pressure test of                 2. To thread the cable through the deck and
      the equipment before resuming arresting                               fairlead sheaves, remove the sheave covers and
      operations. Before you can pressure test newly                        pull out the sheaves. Push the cable through the
      installed seals, it is necessary that the unit stand                  fairlead pipes from sheave housing to sheave
      for a period of 1 hour before the seals can be                        housing. Then slip the cable into the sheave
      accepted.                                                             groove as the sheave is replaced in the housing.
    Once each year (or as modified by appropriate                           When the cable is fully threaded, replace the
technical publications), drain the ethylene glycol from                     covers.
the system and replace with fresh fluid.                                 3. In reeving the engine, use only the original,
                                                                            approved reeving pattern. Study the reeving
REPLACING PURCHASE CABLES                                                   diagram in the applicable NAVAIR main-
                                                                            tenance manuals, and be careful to pass the
    During recovery operations, malfunctions may                            cable over the sheaves in the approved
develop in the engine and cable system, causing the                         sequence and through the appropriate fairleads
purchase cable to pull out of the sheave arrangement or                     and guides.
break below deck, close to or at the engine, resulting in
shutdown of the system. Also, conditions occur in                        4. After the cable is reeved, the next step is to
which initial reeving of the engine is necessary or old                     connect the anchor end of each length. Then
purchase cable is required to be replaced by new                            the cable must be stretched taut to determine
purchase cable. Any or all of these conditions can occur                    the correct location for the terminal of the
on single or endless reeved engines.                                        opposite end.
    If the old cable is still reeved, do not pull it out.                 New cables acquire a stretch over the course of the
When possible, the old cable should be used to pull in               first several engagements. This lengthening of cables
the new. Even if the old cable is only partially reeved, it          decreases the distance between crosshead and
will prove useful. Reeving is very much simplified if                crosshead stop in the BATTERY position, and this in
cable already reeved in the proper way can be used. A                turn increases the fluid capacity of the hydraulic system
decision must be made for each particular engine as to               and makes it necessary to add fluid to maintain the fluid
whether it is easier to feed the new cable from the                  level. If the distance from crosshead to crosshead stop
engine and pull from the flight deck level with a tractor,           in the BATTERY position becomes less than the
or feed from the flight deck and pull from the engine                minimum allowable clearance of 1 inch between the
with block and tackle. In either case, the cable should              crosshead and the crosshead stop, it becomes necessary
be pulled very slowly, and communication should be                   to crop the cable and repour a terminal to readjust the
maintained between engine and flight deck, so that the               clearance to 6 inches between the crosshead and the
pulling can be stopped quickly if there is danger of                 stop. The clearance between the crosshead and
                                                                     crosshead stop with newly installed purchase cables is
                                                              3-46
set at 7 inches. New purchase cables will stretch very              nected from both topside terminals to allow a more
rapidly during the first few arrestments. The initial               efficient detorque of the cable system.
7-inch dimension between the crosshead and the stop
allows for this structural stretch, which causes a                  Preparing Cable and Terminal for Pouring
progressive narrowing of the gap distance between the
crosshead and crosshead stop. After the purchase cable                  When working around an arresting gear engine,
has been stretched and reaches the minimum allowable                make sure the arresting engine retracting system is
clearance of 1 inch between the crosshead and                       depressurized before performing any of the following
crosshead stop, a 6-inch dimension is used thereafter.              steps involving the handling of the wire rope.
     When it becomes necessary to rereeve a                         Preparing Wire Rope
single-reeved engine, both purchase cables must be
replaced. Reeving only one purchase cable on a                          When it is necessary to cut the wire rope, place two
single-reeved engine result in unequal length of the two            seizings of approximately 15 or 20 turns of soft steel
cables, because of the initial stretch of the new cable.            seizing wire on the cable, approximately 1 inch apart.
An offcenter deck pendant is an indication of one cable             (See fig. 3-47, view A.) Cut the cable between the two
stretching more than the other. This condition could                seizings.
cause one of the purchase cable terminals to rest in the
deck sheave. To correct this condition, you will have to                Remove the seizing from the cut end of the cable
crop the longer cable and repour the terminal.                      and, with the use of a marlinespike, unlay three strands
                                                                    of the cable. Using a pocketknife, cut and remove the
    During arrestment operations, torque builds up in               hemp center a distance equal to the length of the
the purchase cables. Failure to remove this torque                  terminal plus 1 inch. (See view B of fig. 3-47.) Re-lay
results in accelerated wear and bird-caging of the                  the strands of the cable.
cables, with vastly increased susceptibility to failure.
Compliance to detorquing methods at specified                           Make a seizing a distance equal to the length of the
intervals is mandatory. Newly installed purchase cables             terminal plus 1 inch. The seizing should be made with
should be detorqued after the initial 50 landings (no               the use of a serving tool and be 15 or 20 turns of soft
more than 60) and every 200 landings thereafter.                    steel seizing wire. (See fig. 3-47, view C.) Place two
                                                                    wraps of seizing wire immediately above the large
                                                                    seizing, as shown in view D.
                      WARNING
                                                                         Loop and tighten one or two turns of
    Keep hands free of spinning parts when                          0.047-inch-diameter copper wire on the end of all
    releasing torque from cables.                                   strands, as shown in view D. Using a marlinespike and
     Purchase cable torque can be removed in the                    tubing, unlay and straighten the strands of the cable to
following ways. During flight operations, disconnect                the top of the seizing. Pull the strands in toward the
one side of the crossdeck pendant at the completion of              center to ensure a good distribution when the individual
an arrestment and partially retract the engine. This                wires of each strand are straightened. (See view D of
allows the cables to untwist. If time allows, blow the              fig. 3-47.) After all the strands are straightened, remove
engine down to 200 psi and pull the engine out to its full          the two turns of seizing previously placed at the top of
stroke; disconnect one side of the crossdeck pendant;               the large seizing. Do NOT remove the large seizing;
and retract the engine slowly to approximately 20 feet              this seizing remains in place until pouring procedures
out of battery.                                                     are completed.
    If torque buildup is greater than normal, it is                    Do NOT use pliers to straighten the wires; pliers
recommended that the crossdeck pendant be discon-                   may damage or weaken the wires.
                                                             3-47
                                    UNLAY 3 STRANDS
                                                                     TERMINAL
   CUT BETWEEN SEIZING                                                LENGTH
                                                                        PLUS
   1 INCH APPROXIMATE                                                  1 INCH
     15 TO 20 TURNS
     3/32 DIA. WIRE
HEMP CENTER
(A) (B)
                                                STRAND
                                             STRAIGHTENING
                                                 TUBE
TERMINAL LENGTH
  PLUS 1 INCH
     15 OR 20 TURNS
     3/32 DIA. WIRE
                                                                      2 TURNS
                                                                      3/32 DIA.
                                            1 OR 2 TURNS                WIRE
                                            0.047 DIA. WIRE
                                            ON ALL STRANDS
(C) (D)
ABEf0347
                                     3-48
     Make certain that the large seizing is tight; remove              make sure the area is properly ventilated. For
the copper wire seizing from one strand at a time, and                 complete safety procedures concerning zinc
straighten the individual wires, using the power                       terminal pouring and wire rope preparation,
straightening device, shown in figure 3-48.                            consult the current arresting gear NAVAIR
                                                                       operation, maintenance, and overhaul
   Repeat the straightening procedure on each strand,
                                                                       instructions.
working on one strand at a time, until all the wires are
completely broomed out as shown in figure 3-48.                         In a well-ventilated space, prepare the ultrasonic
                                                                   degreaser unit by filling it with GRISOLVE PEG-2, to
Cleaning Wire Rope and Terminal Pouring                            within 1 inch of the tank top. The ultrasonic degreaser
                                                                   must then be energized for 2 hours before degreasing
    The cleaning and preparation of wire rope and                  operations begin; this degasses and removes oxygen
terminals requires the use of chlorinated degreasing               from the solvent, which increases its cleaning ability.
solvents, grit blasting, and the heating and melting of            One hour before the degreasing operation is to start,
zinc.                                                              turn on the ultrasonic unit's heaters to heat the
                                                                   GRISOLVE PEG-2 to a temperature of 90 to 100°F. A
                      WARNING                                      stainless steel bucket (14-quart) will also be filled with
                                                                   3 gallons of GRISOLVE PEG-2; this is used to rinse the
    Personnel cleaning wire rope and pouring                       broomed cable end after it has been cleaned in the
    terminals must use chemical respirators and                    ultrasonic degreaser unit.
BENT TUBE
                                                                                                    DIRECTION
                                                                                                     OF DRILL
VISE
NOTE
                                                                                          IF DIFFICULTY IS ENCOUNTERED
                                                                                          IN STRAIGHTENING THE INDIVIDUAL
                                                                                          WIRES IT IS SUGGESTED THAT THE
                                                                                          LENGTH OF THE BEND IN THE BENT
                                                                                          TUBE BE SHORTENED TO 2 1/4" FROM 3"
ABEf0348
                                                            3-49
                           IMMERSE TO
                           THIS POINT
                           0NLY
1"
CLEANING SOLUTION
    To degrease, immerse the broomed end and                        repeat this cycle using clean rinse water each time until
approximately 1 inch of the seizing into the solvent in             the broom appear clean.
the ultrasonic degreaser unit tank (see fig. 3-49).
                                                                        After the broomed out wires have been thoroughly
    • The cleaning solution must be changed after 10                cleaned, wrap the end of the wire rope with two
      uses.                                                         longitudinal strips of pressure-sensitive tape for a
                                                                    distance of 2 feet, leaving the broomed out wires and
    • Replace the rinsing solution when it becomes                  1/2 inch of the seizing exposed (fig. 3-50).
      cloudy.
                                                                        The method used in preparing wire rope and
     After cleaning the broomed end, slowly lift it out of          terminals for zinc-poured terminals includes a grit blast
the solution, allowing it to drain over the tank. Now,              method for etching the cables and terminals prior to
rinse the broomed end in the bucket of clean                        pouring.
GRISOLVE PEG-2 then remove it and allow it to
air-dry for 5 minutes as shown in figure 3-49. After the            The following steps are used in the grit blast method:
broomed end has dried, inspect it to ensure that all dirt,              1. Fill the cabinet hopper with loose grit, 100
grease, and all other foreign matter have been removed.                    pounds minimum to 200 pounds maximum.
If necessary repeat the cleaning/degreasing operation.
Following degreasing, the cleaner residues must be                      2. Install the applicable inserts in the cabinet,
rinsed from the wire broom. Heat a 3-gallon bucket of                      depending on the size of the purchase cable
clean, potable water to a temperature of 160º to 200ºF.                    being cleaned.
Immerse the broom in the rinse bucket of hot water until
half of the seizing is immersed. Allow the broom to
rinse for 2 or 3 minutes, gently swirling the terminal to              ½ IN.                        2 FT
preservative remaining on the wires, especially where                                      2 STRIPS 3-INCH WIDE TAPE
wires touch. If preservative accumulations are still
apparent, reimmerse the broom into the degreaser,                      Figure 3-50.—Adhesive cloth tape applied to wire rope.
                                                             3-50
   3. Open the door of the grip blast cabinet by
      holding two thumbscrews and lifting. Place the
      prepared end of the wire rope into the grit blast
      cabinet to a convenient working location.
      Support the wire rope externally so that it
      enters horizontally. Secure the door with the
      wire rope in position. The wire rope should fit
      snugly. If the inserts used do not effect a snug
      fit, apply tape or cloth to that area of the wire
      rope.
          An 80-100 psi dry-air source must be
       connected to an air filter located in the grit blast
       cabinet. Turn on the air source when ready to                                                                  ABEf0352
ABEf0351
ABEf0353
                                                              3-51
                         WARNING-DANGEROUS AREA
                      PROVIDE ADEQUATE VENTILATION                                                         1-1/2"
                                                                                                                    3/4"
                   WHEN POURING TERMINALS, ONLY AUTHORIZED A. G. PERSONNEL,
                   FOLLOWING THE PROPER POURING INSTRUCTIONS OUTLINED IN A.G.
                   MANUALS AND LATEST BULLETINS, AND WEARING SPECIFIED PROTECTIVE
                   GEAR, ARE PERMITTED IN POURING ROOM/AREA.
                                                                                                                    AMEf0354
                                Figure 3-54.—Safety placard for terminal-pouring rooms.
    7. Shake the wire rope vigorously, broomed-out                     be used cold. If the cable is to be dried by
       end down, to remove any grit between the                        natural air, use the procedures listed in step 4.
       wires or in the hemp center. Only air from the
                                                                   4. Heat the clear flux solution until the
       cabinet supply is used to remove grit; do NOT
                                                                      temperature is between 160 and 210°F.
       use any other source, because other sources
                                                                      Immerse wires carefully so the flux solution
       may be contaminated with oil or water.
                                                                      does not enter the core of hemp-center-type
    8. Remove the grit-siphon tube from the grit                      wire rope.
       supply, and air blast the wire rope to remove
       the remaining grit.                                                           WARNING
NOTE: After grit blasting a total of 15 broomed-out                Do NOT flux wire rope terminals.
ends, drain off 10 pounds of used grit from the bottom
of the hopper and replace it with 10 pounds of new grit.           5. Immerse the grit-blasted wires in the solution
                                                                      to within 1 inch of the top of the seizing for 5
    9. Remove the tape from the wire rope.                            minutes.
  10. Prepare a solution and flux the wire rope.                   6. Remove the wire rope from the solution, shake,
                                                                      and turn the broomed end upright at once. Then
Fluxing
                                                                      allow it to dry for 5 minutes. Any evidence of
                                                                      rust on the wires after the flux-dry period will
    For solution preparation and fluxing, the following
                                                                      necessitate refluxing.
procedures are used:
    1. Heat the pre-mixed solution until the
       temperature is between 160 and 210°F, using
       the hotplate provided. Measure the
       temperature of the solution with the bimetallic
       thermometer. Allow the solution to remain at
       this temperature for 5 minutes, then remove it
       from the hotplate and allow it to cool to room                                                  CAMP BELOW
                                                                                                         SEIZING
       temperature.
    2. Remove any scum or foreign matter from the                                                          NOTE: USE LEAD OR
                                                                                                            WOOD BLOCKS TO
       surface of the cooled solution with clean                                                            PROTECT CABLE IN
                                                                                                            JAWS OF VISE.
       napkins or wiping towels. Do NOT agitate the
       solution during this operation.
                                                                                                        ABEf0355
    3. Carefully pour the clear, cooled solution into
       another stainless steel container. Avoid pouring                 INSTALLING TERMINAL ON BROOMED
       any foreign matter into this container. If the                             END OF WIRE
       hot-air drying method is used, the solution can                    Figure 3-55.—Installing the terminal.
                                                           3-52
Preparing the Terminals                                                    Attach wooden handles to each end of a length of
                                                                      soft steel wire that has been cleaned in the same way as
      Using a degreased length of seizing wire, suspend               the broomed-out cable and terminal. Loop this wire
the terminal from the top of the ultrasonic degreaser so              once around the broomed-out wires. Pull the wire to
it is submerged in the solution. Inspect the terminal and             tighten the loop, and compress the broomed-out wires
repeat the procedure if necessary. Rinse the terminal in              together. See figure 3-55. Do NOT touch broomed-out
a bucket of clean GRISOLVE PEG-2 for 30 seconds,                      wires with greasy rags or hands.
then let air-dry for 5 minutes.                                            Start the terminal on the compressed wires and
    Replace the solution in the ultrasonic degreaser                  slide it onto the wire rope until the bottom rests on the
after 10 terminals have been cleaned/degreased.                       seizing. See figure 3-55.
Replace the rinsing solution after 10 terminals have                       Reclamp the wire rope in the vise in a vertical
been rinsed or as soon as the solution becomes cloudy.                position. Make sure the terminal is not tilted in any way.
                                                                           Degrease and secure two turns of copper wire
     Lay the terminal in the grit blast cabinet. Plug the             around the broomed-out wire rope, 1/2 inch beyond the
cable entry hole with the rubber plug hanging from the                top of the terminal. Draw the broomed-out wires
cabinet. Secure the doors on the side. Grit blast the                 inward and away from contact with the terminal so that
internal surfaces of the terminal from both ends. Rotate              there is approximately 1/16-inch clearance between the
the terminal so that the entire internal surface is blasted.          wire and the inner wall or the terminal.
    Remove the terminal, invert it, and shake it                           Wet a roll of plaster of paris bandage in lukewarm
thoroughly to remove residual grit.                                   water and squeeze out the excess water. Wrap the
                                                                      plaster of paris bandage around the base of the terminal
    To keep arresting gear crews constantly aware of                  at a distance of about 4 inches. Press the bandage firmly
the health hazards associated with the present terminal               to the contour of the terminal and wire rope. (See fig.
pouring procedures, safety warning placards,                          3-56.) Dampen a textile cloth with water and wrap it
fabricated by ship's forces, will be posted in clearly
visible locations in the arresting gear terminal pouring
rooms/area. (See fig. 3-54.)
                                                                      APPROX.
Preparing and Pouring Zinc                                            3 INCHES
                                                                                                            SEIZING WIRE
                                                               3-53
around the plaster of paris and secure it with seizing
wire. The textile cloth may extend far enough to protect
the wire rope from the torch while the terminal is being
heated.
    Heat the terminal carefully and uniformly with the
torch, making certain the flame is not directed on the
exposed wire rope at the bottom of the asbestos cloth.
(See fig. 3-57.) Continue heating the terminal until it
begins to radiate heat waves. Remove the torch from the
terminal and leave the terminal undisturbed for 30
seconds. Make a mark on the thickest portion of the
                                                                                                           ABEf0358
terminal with a 550 and 600°F Tempilstik. Repeat this
at four areas, 90 degrees apart, to ensure an average                               Figure 3-58.—Pyrometer.
temperature.
    The zinc should be at the proper temperature at this
                                                                        Do not handle the portable pyrometer carelessly,
time so that the pouring can take place when the
                                                                   because the millivoltmeter on it is a sensitive, precision
terminal is heated to the correct temperature. Do NOT
                                                                   instrument. When the portable pyrometer is not in use,
attempt to measure terminal temperature with the
                                                                   keep it in the carrying case.
portable pyrometer.
                                                                       Measure the temperature of the molten zinc by
    If the 550°F Tempilstik leaves a wet mark and the
                                                                   holding the portable pyrometer in one hand and dipping
600°F Tempilstik leaves a chalk mark at the four areas,
                                                                   the iron tube of the portable pyrometer in the molten
pour the zinc immediately. If the four areas show a wet
                                                                   zinc, being sure to keep the thermocouple in the center
mark for both the 550 and 600°F Tempilstik, continue
                                                                   of the molten zinc and not touching the bottom of the
checking the four areas every 20 seconds until the
                                                                   pot. The temperature of the molten zinc will then be
600°F Tempilstik leaves a chalk mark and the 550°F
                                                                   indicated on the portable pyrometer dial. Pour zinc at a
Tempilstik leaves a wet mark; then pour the zinc
                                                                   temperature of 950 to 1,000°F.
immediately.
                                                                       Pour the zinc into the terminal. Fill it to within 1/2
    If the temperature has fallen below 550°F (550°F
                                                                   inch from the top of the textile cloth to provide a
Tempilstik leaves a chalk mark), reheat the terminal and
                                                                   sufficient "hot top."
proceed again as previously described.
                                                                       Tap the sides of the terminal lightly with wooden
    Skim the dross (impurities) from the top of the
                                                                   sticks during and after pouring of the zinc, until a
molten zinc before pouring. Use the portable pyrometer
                                                                   surface crust forms. See figure 3-59.
to measure the temperature of the molten zinc and to
determine, thereby, if the zinc has reached its proper
temperature for pouring. (See fig. 3-58.) The
temperature of the zinc must be accurately measured
with a portable pyrometer.
HEATING TORCH
WOOD STICKS
        HEAT TERMINAL
        TO 500 O F - 600 O F                                                                             TAP TERMINAL
                                                                                                         UNTIL SURFACE
                                                                                                        CRUST HARDENS
                                                                                             ABEf0359
                                                 ABEf0357
           Figure 3-57.—Heating the terminal.                          Figure 3-59.—Tapping the terminal during pouring.
                                                            3-54
     Using a short piece of seizing wire thoroughly                     Inspect the zinc face of the terminal for soundness
degreased, pierce the bubbles that rise to the surface of          of zinc and good wire distribution. The presence of any
the hot top. Do not poke the wire into the zinc more than          cavities in the face of the zinc indicates that the strength
1/2 inch. Skim the surface of the hot top with the end of          of the terminal is questionable. The criteria for
the seizing wire to allow the gas bubbles to rise and be           acceptance of cavities are as follows:
accessible for piercing.
                                                                       1. A maximum of five cavities up to 1/32-inch
    After the zinc has solidified, allow the poured                       wide and 1/32-inch deep scattered randomly
terminal to air-cool at room temperature for 30 minutes.                  over the zinc face. Figure 3-61, view A,
During this time the zinc will harden. After the cooling
period, proceed as follows:                                                        1/32 WIDE X 1/32 DEEP CAVITY
                                                                                            (MAX OF 5)
    1. Remove the textile cloth and plaster the
       terminal.
    2. Pour 4 gallons of preservative oil into a clean
       5-gallon metal container.
    3. With the preservative oil at room temperature,
       immerse the entire poured terminal for 30
       minutes. This will rapidly cool the terminal.
    4. Immediately after the 30-minute oil quench
       period, remove the terminal and allow the
       excess oil to drain into the container.
    5. Using the hot-top cutter assembly, cut off the
       hot top flush with the top of the terminal after
       the terminal has cooled (fig. 3-60).                        ACCEPTABLE                         UNACCEPTABLE
3/4 DIA
                                           P
                                    HOT TO
                                         ER
                                    CUTT
                                                                       ACCEPTABLE                          UNACCEPTABLE
                                                                                                                       ABEf0361
                                               ABEf0360
                                                                                      CONDITION B
            Figure 3-60.—Cutting the hot top.                                  Figure 3-61.—Inspection of zinc face.
                                                            3-55
           illustrates an acceptable face. Crop and repour              of a well-poured terminal. The wires of the strands of
           if six or more cavities are found.                           the wire rope below the terminal must not show any
                                                                        deformity due to having been held too tightly in the vise
      2. A cavity up to 1/8-inch wide and 1/8-inch deep
                                                                        during the pouring and finishing operations.
         caused by breaching of several wires must
         NOT be in the center of the zinc face within the
                                                                        Testing the Terminal
         area of 3/4-inch diameter. An acceptable face is
         shown in view B. A 1/8-inch cavity by 1/8-inch                      During an arrestment, the wire rope system must
         cavity caused by any other factor than                         take a very high impact load; therefore, all fittings of
         breaching wires is not acceptable. This                        the system must be carefully poured. It is imperative
         breaching is several wires coming together at                  that the fitting be strong and well made. To determine
         the surface, which does not permit the zinc to                 their condition and strength, the terminals must be
         fill the area. These allowable cavities are the                tested for soundness of the poured joint.
         result of pouring, and not that of a pull test.
                                                                            Terminals poured by a naval activity or by
    Inspect around the base of the terminal for a                       personnel aboard ship are tested for reliability. The
penetration of zinc. This penetration must be present to                cable terminal proof-loading machine is a self-
have an acceptable terminal. It is also a good indication
                                                                                           7
                                          15
16 8
                                                                               9      13
                                                                        10
                                                               11
                                                         12
                               3
             2
 14
                                                                                                     ABEf0362
 4
                            1.     Wedge set                             9. Connecting pin
                            2.     Safety lock pin                      10. Clevis socket
                            3.     Grip assembly lid                    11. Lock ring
                            4.     Retracting cables                    12. Cable terminal
                            5.     Tension gauge                        13. Tension rod
                            6.     Hand hydraulic pump                  14. Purchase cable
                            7.     Hose assembly                        15. Needle valve
                            8.     Ram (cylinder)                       16. External load release valve
                                    Figure 3-62.—Wedge-type proof-loading machine (single ram).
                                                               3-56
contained hand-operated unit designed specifically for                 2. Relieve all pressure in the hydraulic system by
proof loading poured terminals on both deck cables and                    cracking open the external load-release valve
purchase cables.                                                          (21) to slowly release the proof-load on the
                                                                          gauge. Slowly releasing the gauge load will
Cable Terminal Proof-loading Machine                                      prevent rapid snapback, with resultant possible
                                                                          breakage of the gauge pointer.
     The cable terminal proof-loading machine is
capable of providing a test load that substantially                    3. Manually move the crosshead away from rams
exceeds the test load required for testing the reliability                and install the crosshead terminal.
of terminals used by ABEs. The test load is read on the                4. Remove the safety lock pin and slide the lid
tension gauge, which is calibrated in pounds, and is                      toward the cylinders to open.
positioned in the line leading from the pump to the ram
                                                                       5. Install the wedge set, Lucker Manufacturing
(see figs. 3-62 and 3-63).
                                                                          Company Part No. 3130-143 (for testing 1
    The machine operating procedure is as follows                         7/16-inch-diameter purchase cable). Do not
(refer to fig. 3-63).                                                     lubricate the cable gripping surface or the lid
    1. Thoroughly clean the portion of cable (19) that                    sliding surface.
       will be in contact with the wedge set (1) during                6. Retract the wedges by pulling on the retracting
       the test. Do NOT use solvent for this cleaning                     cables. Lubricate the wedge sliding surfaces
       operation.                                                         with PRELUB-6 before each test.
20
                                                                                                              6
                                                                               8
                                                                                                         9
                                                                                                   14        10
                               3                                                                                  11
                                                                                                                             12
                     2
             1
      4
                                                                                                                  ABEf0363
                                                                                               7    13
                                                                                        15
                                                                                   16
      19             4               18                                   17
                                                             3-57
 7. Screw the clevis socket on the cable terminal.                REPLACING PACKINGS
 8. Place the cable between the wedges and
                                                                      The efficiency of any hydraulic equipment is
    connect the clevis socket to the crosshead
                                                                  directly dependent on the proper selection, preparation
    terminal with the pin.
                                                                  and installation of its packing. The replacement
 9. Manually move the crosshead into the rams,                    packing shall be only those that are called out in the
    making certain that the adapter attached to                   assembly parts list. No substitutes or deviation in size
    each end of the ram engages its respective                    or number shall be made. Prior to installation, the age of
    guide hole in the face of the crosshead.                      natural or synthetic rubber packing shall be checked to
                                                                  determine whether these parts are acceptable for use. A
10. Release the wedges, close the lid, and insert the
                                                                  positive identification indicating the source, cure date,
    safety lock pin.
                                                                  and expiration date shall be made. This information
11. Using chalk, masking tape, or some other                      shall be available for all packing used.
    means, mark the cable a measured distance
                                                                      The age control of all natural or synthetic packing
    from the wedge set. This procedure provides a
                                                                  shall be based upon the “cure date” stamped on the
    means for checking cable slippage while the
                                                                  manufacturer’s unit package, intermediate package,
    system is being pressurized.
                                                                  and shipping container. The cure date means the date of
12. Visually inspect the socket tester to make                    manufacture and is designated by the quarter of the year
    certain that all components are securely                      and year of manufacture. The cure date forms the basis
    attached. Do not open the choker valve during                 for determining the age of the V-ring, O-ring packing,
    operation of the hand pump, as this will result               therefore, it becomes important that the cure date be
    in excessive pressurization of the socket tester              noted on all packages. Packing manufactured during
    after the desired proof-load has been reached.                any given quarter will be considered one quarter old at
13. Open the choker valve (20) on the hand pump,                  the end of the succeeding quarter. For the purposes of
    and close the external load-release valve.                    explaining the coding used by manufacturers to
    Never apply proof-loading with the lid open,                  designate the cure date, each year is divided into
    and keep hands clear of pin and crosshead area.               quarters as follows:
14. Using the hand pump, pressurize the system to                     • First quarter: January, February, March
    increase the test load to 120,000 pounds. Hold                    • Second quarter: April, May, June
    the test pressure for 2 minutes.
                                                                      • Third quarter: July, August, September
15. As the pressure is gradually increased, observe
    the cable for evidence of slippage. If the cable                  • Fourth quarter: October, November, December
    begins to slip, proceed as follows:                           The shelf-life control of all packing shall be governed
     a. Relieve the pressure as in step 2.                        by the “expiration date” stamped beside the
                                                                  manufacturer’s cure date on each package. The
     b. Remove the safety lock pin and open the
                                                                  expiration date is the date after which packing
        lid. It may be necessary to first strike the lid
                                                                  CANNOT BE USED IN-SERVICE. Synthetic and
        with a soft mallet before it can be slid
                                                                  natural rubber packing and V-rings shall have a
        forward to open.
                                                                  shelf-life limit of three years (12 quarters). Synthetic
     c. Retract the wedges.                                       and natural rubber O-rings shall have a shelf-life limit
                                                                  of five years (20 quarters). Fluorocarbon O-rings,
     d. Remove the cable and clean it thoroughly.
                                                                  M83248/1-, have a shelf-life of twenty years (80
     e. Clean and inspect the wedge gripping                      quarters). Thus, packing and V-rings shall be scrapped
        surfaces. Replace the wedges if necessary.                if not put into service within three years after the cure
     f.   Lubricate the wedge sliding surfaces.                   date, and O-rings shall be scrapped five years (twenty
                                                                  years for fluorocarbon O-rings) after the cure date. All
     g. Repeat proof-loading procedures                           packing shall be scrapped if not put into use before the
     h. Remove the cable from the socket tester                   time of the expiration date.
        and examine the poured terminal.
                                                           3-58
Removing Old Packings                                              rings as they are being inserted, collapse a short section
                                                                   of the ring by placing a thin rod of brass or other soft
     If practical, remove the shaft, ram, or other sealed          metal between the lips and the stuffing box wall. The
members from the installation, since this permits                  male adapter, if used, must then be properly seated.
inspection and correction of any defects in the shaft or
                                                                        Extreme care must be exercised on installation to
packing assembly. Although it is preferable to remove
                                                                   insure that the rings are not forced over sharp edges. A
the sealed member, limitations of time, design of the
                                                                   light coating of petrolatum conforming to the proper
installation, or problems of reassembly often make the
                                                                   specification may be used if necessary, but excessive
removal impractical. After the gland or flange is
                                                                   use must be avoided. Care is also taken that the rings or
removed, the chief problem usually encountered is
                                                                   stuffing box wall is not damaged in any way.
removing the female adapter. If this ring is provided
with holes, insert a suitable hoop of bent and flattened
                                                                   Gland Installation
wire, or a threaded rod if the holes are tapped, and pull
the ring back along the shaft. The packing can be                       Some of the packings of the engine may be
removed using a U-shaped pick made of copper or brass              spring-loaded. No gland adjustment is necessary on this
wire. The pick should be small enough to enter the                 type, since the springs normally allow sufficient float of
stuffing box, and the ends should be bent and flattened.           the packing. If the gland is other than spring-tensioned,
The pick should be inserted behind the ring, and the               insert the gland and apply easy hand pressure until the
ring removed. It is usually not necessary to remove the            gland touches the packing. Do not force it. If there is
male adapter. If the adapters are not provided with holes          clearance between the flange of the gland and the body
or if removal is difficult, they may be removed by                 surface, withdraw the gland and insert one or more
alternate methods, such as inserting a wire or piece of            gaskets with a total thickness of from 1/64 to 3/64 inch
flat stock behind the adapter and pulling it out (if               greater than the distance between the gland flange and
sufficient space exists), or by bumping the shaft or               body surface. If there is metal-to-metal contact between
stuffing box to dislodge the adapter. All traces of the            gland flange and body upon application of hand
packing must be removed and the stuffing box cleaned               pressure, the gland must be removed and the depth of
and inspected for scratches, burrs, or sharp edges.                the stuffing box must be measured. The length of the
Rough spots or sharp edges must be honed down with a               gland from the inner face of the flange to the surface
fine Carborundum stone. It is usually not necessary to             that contacts the packing must be measured. This length
replace the metal support rings or adapters when                   must be subtracted from the depth of the stuffing box; if
packings are replaced unless inspection shows failure,             the difference exceeds 3/64 inch, a shim of the
defects, or excessive wear.                                        thickness of the excess must be removed or the gland
                                                                   flange must be machined to take up the excess. If the
Installing New Packings
                                                                   gland is the screw-in type, the procedure is the same
                                                                   except that the gland must be screwed in until contact
     A V-ring packing housing generally consists of
                                                                   with the packing is made and then backed off
male adapters and female adapters. Either or both of the
                                                                   sufficiently to give a minimum of 1/64-inch and a
adapters may be designed as part of the gland or
                                                                   maximum of 3/64-inch clearance between the gland
stuffing box. The adapters position and support the
                                                                   and the packing. The amount of backup may be
V-rings and form an efficient seal only when pressure
                                                                   determined by counting the number of gland nut
spreads the lips of the rings firmly against the shaft,
                                                                   threads to the inch. For instance, if there are 10 threads
ram, or piston and against the walls of the stuffing box.
                                                                   to the inch, one revolution of the gland will give
To function properly, the female (open) side of the rings
                                                                   1/10-inch clearance. If possible, the gland nuts should
must face the pressure.
                                                                   be lock-wired to prevent rotation.
     In double-acting installations, two opposing sets of
packings are used with the open sides of each set facing           General Precautions Regarding V-Ring Packing
away from each other. The female adapter must be
inserted into the stuffing box first and seated properly.              If leakage appears at the V-ring packing joint,
Each packing ring must then be inserted individually.              check the gland flange for metal-to-metal contact with
Each ring must be seated carefully before the next ring            the body. Rework or replace parts as necessary, and if
is inserted. The rings must be seated with the aid of a            leakage continues, remove and examine the packing for
flat tool or stick. To eliminate air trapped between the           damage or wear. A small leakage or "weeping"
                                                            3-59
generally appears when a V-ring packing has been                   trained and indoctrinated in the operations. Disregard
replaced, but it usually ceases after operation. If                for the fundamentals of caution and safety creates
leakage persists after operation, the packing may have             hazards far in excess of the previously mentioned
unseated itself and the gland should be readjusted. If             inherent danger factors.
leakage persists after a reasonable adjustment,
                                                                        All operating personnel must understand the
disassemble and check the stuffing box walls and the
                                                                   importance of accurate commands, attention to
pistons for scoring, and check the packing for damage.
                                                                   commands, and proper care of communications
Leaking packing must be replaced when adjustment
                                                                   systems. The system may be phones, synchro signals,
does not stop the leakage. Excessive gland pressure
                                                                   or lights, and must be operational at the time of use.
must not be applied. V-ring packing under pressure
                                                                   Accuracy in making proper settings of gears, indicator
from the gland not only functions improperly or wears
                                                                   systems, tension, and pressure tests must be
out faster but also applies uncalculated forces on the
                                                                   emphatically impressed on all personnel.
ram, shaft, or piston, which may cause improper
operation of the machinery. A clearance of 1/64 to 3/64                The following general safety observations are
inch must be maintained to allow the packing freedom               arranged according to location, and copies should be
of movement. When there is clearance between the                   supplied to all applicable stations.
body and the gland flange, check the clearance at four
points, 90° apart, to ensure that the packing or gland is          TOPSIDE AND DECKEDGE AREAS
not cocked before installing the gasket.
                                                                       During arrestment, all topside and deckedge
                                                                   personnel should be aware of all movement on and
               REVIEW QUESTIONS                                    about the deck, with strict attention paid to the landing
Q13.     What is the minimum allowable clearance                   aircraft. Deckedge control operators should duck below
         between the crosshead and the crosshead                   deck level during pendant arrestment in the event of
         stop?                                                     pendant breakage or failure that would cause cable
                                                                   whip or the aircraft to go over the deck edge.
Q14.     What is the age of all packing based on?
Q15.     What is the shelf life of V-ring packing?                 Hook Runners
Q16.     When installing V-ring packing, what side                      Hook runners should approach aircraft from the
         faces the pressure?                                       front and side. This will place them away from danger
                                                                   of jet blast or broken cable backlash.
             SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
                                                                   Overcrowding
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: List the safety
    precautions associated with topside and                            Catwalk personnel should be held to a minimum so
    deckedge areas. List the safety precautions                    they can exit quickly should they be placed in jeopardy.
    associated with the arresting engine below
    decks. List the safety precautions associated                  Barricade Readiness
    with maintenance of aircraft recovery
    equipment.                                                         Rapid fuel consumption by jet aircraft requires
     Safety is not an accident. Safety is the result of            highly trained, responsible crews for rigging the
trained personnel knowing their jobs and doing those               barricades. Regular drills in rigging should be held to
jobs to the utmost of their ability. Attention to every            reduce rigging time to a minimum.
detail, concern over every function, and awareness of
malfunction will nullify the possibility of accident from          Walkback
improper operational procedures. Mechanical failure
cannot be completely neutralized, but trained personnel                 Air in the main engine cylinder or the CRO valve
can make such a failure a rarity.                                  does not seat properly are the major causes of
                                                                   walkback. This is an extremely dangerous occurrence,
    Recovering aircraft involves various inherent                  as the pilots have no control over the aircraft in addition
dangers, due to the complex coordination of personnel              to being unable to see where they are going, thus the
and machinery. Personnel engaged in the operation of               aircraft may go overboard, endanger deckedge
the arresting gear equipment must be thoroughly
                                                            3-60
personnel, or cause injury to personnel on deck not                particularly necessary. Daily inspection, inspection
paying attention to what is happening around them.                 after each arrestment, and depending on the unit
                                                                   involved, inspection and maintenance at regular
Pendant Retraction                                                 intervals nullify many of the conditions that might arise
                                                                   to endanger operating and flight personnel. Always
     The retracting cycle of the deck pendant is                   keep hands and body clear when engine is operating or
normally executed at full speed. The operator, prior to            in a condition to become operable.
pulling the retracting lever, must ascertain that no
personnel or equipment are in a position to be struck              Weight Selector Settings
during retraction. If for any reason a sudden
interruption of the retracting cycle occurs, the same                   The safe arrestment of incoming aircraft can be
precaution must be taken prior to the resumption of the            directly attributed to proper setting of the aircraft
retraction cycle.                                                  weight selector. Aircraft weight selector settings should
                                                                   always be made according to current aircraft recovery
Wire Supports                                                      bulletins. Maximum efficiency is obtained from the
                                                                   arresting engine through proper weight settings. There
    Broken or deformed wire supports should be                     is one distinct error in arrestment that can be directly
replaced as soon as practical.                                     attributed to improper weight settings or error in the
                                                                   gross weight estimate. This error results in
Stanchions                                                         TWO-BLOCKING the engine.
    Personnel should stay clear of areas where                         TWO-BLOCKING is a condition in which the
stanchions are being raised or lowered, and particularly           weight selector is set too light for the incoming aircraft.
when barricades are being raised or lowered. When                  This condition causes the ram to ride forward into the
stanchion repair is to be effected, the stanchions safety          cylinder until the crosshead bangs into the mouth of the
brace must be installed.                                           cylinder. A wooden block assembly, called a ram block,
                                                                   is positioned at the crosshead end of the ram to act as a
Terminals, Fittings, and Cables                                    shock absorber by preventing metal-to-metal contact
                                                                   between the crosshead and the mouth of the cylinder.
     Frequent inspection of all cables, terminals, and                 BOUNCEBACK is the movement of an arrested
fittings should be maintained. Any indication (no                  aircraft backward and is caused by the stretch inherent
matter how slight) of failure should be corrected                  in the purchase cables. Bounceback is desirable
immediately. Particular attention should be given to               because the hook is disengaged, allowing rapid deck
terminals jamming sheaves. Any condition where this                clearance for future landings. Pilots are instructed to
is evident is extremely critical. The unit involved                allow for bounceback before braking.
should not be operated until correction of the condition
is made.                                                           Control Valve Failure
Sheaves and Winches                                                    Prime failure, with resultant disastrous
                                                                   consequences, could be failure of the drive system that
    Generally all sheaves should be free running, have             would result in improper opening or closing of the CRO
no indication of turning of the lips, or indication of             valve. Cam alignment is equally important, as improper
jamming by terminals. No slippage of the sheave on                 alignment would result in fluid flow through the CRO
races should be evident, and any fault of this nature              valve at a ratio different from that indicated on the
should be corrected. Winches should be checked for                 aircraft weight selector indicator. Thus, while the
running and positioning. Both sheaves and winches                  operator would have an indication of a proper setting,
should be kept clean of debris or foreign matter, and be           actual flow control would be different.
regularly lubricated.
                                                                   Drive System Hazards
BELOW DECKS—THE ARRESTING ENGINE
                                                                       Much of the cable system is contained behind
    The greatest safety factor in the operation of the             U-channels to protect personnel during operation. This
arresting engine is constant attention to inspection,              cable, with connections, is subject to wear and fatigue
maintenance, and overhaul. Preventive maintenance is
                                                            3-61
and should be checked against failure. Failure of the              result of carelessness with work materials could result
drive system could cause serious injury to operating               in injury and/or loss of life. Lubrication tables for all
and aircraft personnel.                                            equipment must be strictly adhered to. Venting the
                                                                   various lines to remove entrapped air, foam, or waste
Excessive Pressures                                                fluids is a preoperational and operational requirement.
                                                                   Safe operations depend upon strict adherence to these
    The accumulator is built to take a 400-psi initial             and all other pertinent safety instructions.
charge and such additional pressure as is developed
during arrestment. This capacity provides for an                   Molten Metal and Heating Methods
overloading factor. However, it is most important that
the accumulator blow-down valve on the charging                        A detailed description of heating and using molten
panel be kept open. Should leakage occur from                      metal for pouring sockets is contained earlier in this
high-pressure piping as the result of inadequate                   chapter. Particular attention should be given to the
valving, this, with the additional compression loading             warning notes and instructions regarding personnel
during arrestment, could cause an extremely dangerous              safety. All personnel involved in terminal pouring
accumulator pressure. One operating indication of                  operations or in any operations where molten metals
excessive accumulator pressure is retraction that                  are involved should wear goggles, gloves, aprons, and
exceeds normal speed. Initial accumulator pressure                 such other protective clothing as is necessary. Ample
must be held at 400 psi. A safety diaphragm is installed           ventilation must be provided against fumes given off by
on the air side of the accumulator to eliminate the                molten metals.
possibility of an accumulator explosion.
                                                                   Cables, Pendants, and Taut Lines
Fluid Level Indicator Safety
                                                                       In running pendants, cables, or taut lines, personnel
    When the engine is in BATTERY position, the fluid              should be familiar with procedures so that equipment is
level indicator must read BATTERY. Should any other                placed without kinking, twisting, or unnatural
reading be indicated, the engine must not be operated              positioning. Improper handling of cables will cause
until a battery indication is effected.                            strand breakage and subsequent weakening and failure.
                                                                   Whenever deck tractors are used for pulling out
Malfunctions and Safety                                            pendants, all personnel must be on guard for cable lash.
                                                            3-62
   • Lubricate deck pendants and barricade cables                Q18.     What can cause walkback?
     properly and frequently.                                    Q19.     Before making repairs to the barricade
   • Replace broken wire supports.                                        stanchions, what must be installed?
   • Raise the barricade webbing to the proper                   Q20.     What is the condition that can cause
     height.                                                              two-blocking?
   • Replace loose or damaged cable fittings and                 Q21.     What is an indication of excessive arresting
     couplings.                                                           engine accumulator pressure?
                                                          3-63
                                                  CHAPTER 4
STEAM-POWERED CATAPULTS
    Steam is the principal source of energy and is                the steam system major components will provide a
supplied to the catapults by the ship's boilers. The              better understanding of catapult operations. Figure 4-2
steam is drawn from the ship's boilers to the catapult            is a simplified schematic of a typical catapult steam
wet steam accumulator, where it is stored at the desired          piping arrangement. The schematic only shows the
pressure. From the wet accumulator, it is directed to the         piping and valves associated with a single catapult
launch valve, and provides the energy to launch aircraft.         when lined up with the steam plant that normally
The most significant differences between the various              supplies that catapult. Valves and piping that allow
types of steam catapults are the length and capacity. See         cross connecting of catapults with all steam plants are
table 4-1 for the differences.                                    not shown. Cross connecting provides the capability of
                                                                  operating any catapult from any power plant.
Each steam catapult consists of eight major systems:
    • Steam System                                                WET ACCUMULATOR WARM-UP
    • Launching Engine System                                          The accumulator warm-up procedure allows valves
    • Lubrication System                                          and piping between the steam plant and the catapult to
                                                                  initially slowly warm up to bring the metal
    • Bridle Tensioning System                                    temperatures to operating level. Hot feed water is
    • Hydraulic System                                            admitted into the steam accumulator to approximate the
                                                                  low operating level. The launch valve is opened to
    • Retraction Engine System                                    purge air from the accumulator and steam is slowly
                                                                  admitted into the accumulator feed water to raise the
    • Drive System
                                                                  water temperature. When the water temperature
    • Catapult Control System                                     reaches approximately 225 degrees, the launch valve is
                                                                  closed and accumulator heating continues. Steam
                                                                  pressure is increased in increments allowing enough
                  STEAM SYSTEM
                                                                  time at each increment for the water temperature to
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Describe the                             increase to a predetermined temperature. This slow
    components of the steam system. Describe the                  increase in temperature and pressure will ensure a
    function of the steam system.                                 thermally stable accumulator when operating
    The catapult steam system (fig. 4-1) consists of the          parameters are reached.
steam wet accumulator, accumulator fill and blowdown
                                                                  TROUGH WARM -UP
valves, trough warm-up system, steam smothering
system and the associated valves and piping. The seam
                                                                      The trough warm-up procedure allows valves and
system is under the technical cognizance of
                                                                  piping between the steam plant and the catapult to
NAVSEASYSCOM and is operated and maintained by
                                                                  slowly warm -up to bring the metal temperatures to
engineering department personnel. An explanation of
                                                                  operating level. When steam is directed to a catapult for
                                            Table 4-1.—Steam Catapult Data
                                                            4-1
                      THRUST-EXHAUST
                           UNIT
     LAUNCHING VALVE
        ASSEMBLY
                                                                                           STEAM CUTOFF
                                                                                         PRESSURE SWITCHES
                                               PRESSURE-BREAKING
                                                 ORIFICE ELBOW
                                                                                NAVSHIPSSYSCOM STEAM
                                                                                 WET-RECIEVER SYSTEM
                                                                  WATER-CHARGING VALVE
                           WATER SUPPLY
                                                                                              ABEf0402
                                     Figure 4-1.—Steam system.
DEAERATING
 FEED TANK
                                                                 STEAM FROM ENGINEERING PLANT
                                                                               (STEAM)
                                                                                                  CROSS CONNECT
                                                                                                   LINE TO OTHER
                     RELIEF
                                                                                                   STEAM PLANTS
                     VALVE        STEAM SMOTHERING LINE
                                   TO CATAPULT TROUGH
                                         FINNED
                                         TUBING IN                        SUPPLY
                                         CATAPULT                          VALVE
                                         TROUGH
                                         FOR
                                         EXTERNAL
                                         PREHEATING
                              (STEAM) TO CATAPULT
                                      LAUNCH VALVE
                                                                                             MANUAL
                                                                                             SHUTOFF
                                                                                              VALVE
                                                 ACCUMULATOR FILL VALVES
                   CATAPULT
                     WET
                 ACCUMULATOR
  FEED WATER
BLOWDOWN VALVE
                                 STEAM
             FEED WATER        BLOWDOWN
              FILL VALVE         VALVE
                                                                                                    ABEf0403
                                                4-2
accumulator warm-up, steam is available through a                     Trough steam smothering is accomplished by
branch line and valves to the trough warm-up system               admitting main steam into a pipe located between the
(fig. 4-3). The launching engine cylinders are heated to          launching engine cylinders, holes in the pipe direct
operating temperature by a pair of trough heaters                 seam to all of the trough area. Trough steam smothering
located below each row of launching engine cylinders.             can be actuated pneumatically by a valve at deckedge or
The rough heaters are installed in two sections referred          manually by a bypass valve located near the
to as the forward and aft legs. Each trough heater                pneumatically operated steam supply valve.
consists of a pipe within a larger pipe that is capped at
the forward end. Steam is admitted into the inner pipe,           WET ACCUMULATOR OPERATION
them flows through the inner pipe into the outer pipe,
heating the outer pipe. Fins installed on the outer pipe               The steam accumulator provides a volume of steam
provide even radiation of heat to the launching engine            under pressure to the launch valve assembly. At
cylinders, condensation from each outlet pipe is                  operating temperatures, when the launch valve opens
removed by drains lines which are equipped with fixed             and steam is released to the launch engine cylinders,
orifices. The orifices are sized so that water is removed         steam pressure within the accumulator drops, when the
at a rate that will maintain enough steam flow to heat            pressure drop in the accumulator occurs, the steam fill
and maintain the launching engine cylinders at                    valve open and admit steam into the accumulator by
operating temperature, bypass valves are provided                 means of a perforated manifold submerged in the water,
around each orifice to remove excess water if required.           this will rapidly heat the water back to the operating
                                                                  temperature. Water level will return its pre-established
STEAM SMOTHERING SYSTEM                                           level.
    The steam smothering system (see fig. 4-3)                             LAUNCHING ENGINE SYSTEM
provides a rapid means of extinguishing a fire in the
catapult trough or in the launch valve compartment.                   LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Describe the
The launch valve steam smothering is accomplished by                  components of the launching engine system.
admitting steam into a pair of lines encircling the                   Describe the function of the launching engine
launch valve area, holes in these lines direct steam to               system.
cover the area.
                                                       ORIFICE
                                                                                               STEAM SMOTHERING
 CAT                                                                                                      PIPING
 STEAM
 SUPPLY
                                                                                                      THROUGH HEAT
                                                                                                        FINNED PIPES
                                                                                                           (AFT LEGS)
                                      CAT DK
                                      EDGE STA                                                                TO FWD
                                                                                                                LEGS
                    COMPT
                    STEAM                                                                      RESERVOIR
                   SMOTHER                                                                     NOT ON ALL
                                                                                             INSTALLATIONS
  CONSTANT STEAM
  HEATING SUPPLY
                                                                                                              FROM FWD
                                                                                                                  LEGS
                                                            4-3
    The launching engine system (fig. 4-4) consists of              • Sealing Strip Anchor and Guide
most of the major components that are used in applying
steam to the launching engine pistons during launch                 • Launching Engine Pistons
operation and stopping the launch engine pistons at the             • Shuttle Assembly
completion of a launch. The major components that
comprise the launching engine system are as follows:                • Water Break Installation
                                                                                                 SEALING-STRIP
                       SEALING STRIP                                                 SHUTTLE      TENSIONER
                                                                                      TRACK
        SEALING-STRIP
          ANCHOR
                                                                                                  WATER
                                                                                                  BREAK
                                                                                PISTON
                                                                               ASSEMBLY
                                                          LAUNCHING-ENGINE
                                                              CYLINDER
                                   THRUST-EXHAUST
 LAUNCHING VALVE                      UNIT (REF)                                     ABEf0405
    ASSEMBLY
                               EXHAUST VALVE
                         PRESSURE-BREAKING
                           ORIFICE ELBOW
                                                          4-4
       STEAM VALVE
LV-STROKE-TIMER
STOP TIMING LIMIT
     SWITCH
  (CLOCK NO. 2)
         HYDRAULIC
          CYLINDER
COLUMN
                                                                                   LV-STROKE-
                                                                                   TIMER STOP
                                                                                   TIMING LIMIT
                                                                                     SWITCH
                CLOSED                                                            (CLOCK NO. 1)
    OPEN         PLATE
    PLATE                                                                 OPERATION
                                                                          CONTROLS
                                                                          ASSEMBLY
                                        LV-STROKE-TIMER
                                     START TIMING PRESSURE
            INCREMENT                        SWITCH                    ABEf0406
               PLATE
                                            4-5
STEAM VALVE                                                          shaft. Each lift nut is connected to the crosshead by a
                                                                     lifter lever and a lifter link. Movement of the crosshead,
    The steam valve (fig. 4-6) admits and shuts off the              which is connected to the hydraulic cylinder piston rod,
flow of steam to the launching engine cylinders during               causes the lift nuts to rotate and the plugs to move
catapult operations. With the valve in the CLOSED                    toward or away from the steam valve body seats.
position, two plugs in the valve are in full contact with            Movement of the crosshead also obtains rotational
the valve body seats, providing a tight seal. When the               movement of the plugs. Each plug shaft is connected to
valve is opened, the plugs are moved away from the                   the crosshead by a rotator lever and a rotator link. With
valve body seats and rotated 90 degrees. In the OPEN                 the steam valve in the CLOSED position, the plugs are
position, the circular openings in the plugs are in line             fully seated. When the crosshead starts to move to the
with the valve body passages.                                        OPEN position, the lift nuts move the plugs downward,
                                                                     and the links and levers begin to rotate. Due to the
OPERATION CONTROLS ASSEMBLY                                          geometrical arrangement of the levers, the plugs are
                                                                     moved away from the body seats before rotation begins.
    The operation controls assembly (fig. 4-7) is                    As the crosshead stroke approaches the FULL OPEN
attached to the bottom of the steam valve assembly. The              position, the plugs move toward the valve body seats.
assembly provides vertical movement needed for                       When the valve is fully opened, the plugs are not in
seating and unseating the steam valve plugs and                      contact with the body seats, because of the unequal
rotational movement needed for opening and closing                   lengths of the links, and the plugs and body parts are in
the steam valve. Vertical movement of the plugs is                   perfect alignment. As the crosshead moves to the
obtained by the action of the lift nuts. Each lift nut has a         CLOSED position, the links and levers rotate the plugs
steep angle thread that mates on each steam valve plug               upward to seat the plugs against the seats.
                                                                                  LUBRICATION
                                                                                     PORT
                                                                                      STEAM-VALVE
                    BUSHING                                                              BODY
                                                                                            OUTLET
                                                                                            FLANGE
                                                                                            STEAM-VALVE
                                                                                               PLUG
                        INLET
                       FLANGE                                                         LUBRICATION
                                                                                         PORT
                          STEAM-VALVE
                             HEAD
                                                                                 ABEf0407
                                  PLUG SEAT
BUSHING
                                                               4-6
               FRAME
CROSSHEAD
                                                                                             ROTATOR
                                                                                               LINK
                                                                                             ROTATOR
                                                                                              LEVER
             LIFTER
              LINK                                                                           HEAD-COVER
                                                                                                PLATE
                 LIFTER LEVER
                                  LIFT NUT
                                                                      ADJUSTING NUT
                                     THRUST RING
                                                                                     ABEf0408
                                 Figure 4-7.—Launch valve operation control assembly.
HYDRAULIC CYLINDER ASSEMBLY                                    hydraulic fluid to open and close the steam valve
                                                               assembly. When pressurized fluid is applied to port E,
   The hydraulic cylinder assembly (fig. 4-8) is               the piston moves to the opposite end of the cylinder to
connected to the operation control assembly. The               open the steam valve. The rate of movement of the
hydraulic cylinder assembly is actuated by pressurized         piston is faster at the beginning of the stroke, because of
                                                                                    FLANGE
                                    CYLINDER
     ORIFICE                   PISTON
    SNUBBER
FLANGE
PISTON ROD
                                                                                         PORT E
                                                                                     (OPENING PORT)
          PORT A
      (CLOSING PORT)
                                     Figure 4-8.—Launch valve hydraulic cylinder.
                                                         4-7
the effect of the metering rod. At the beginning of the            clocks which measure and displays time in seconds and
opening stroke, fluid flows out of port A and port B.              hundredths of seconds. When the valve opens 3 1/2
When the piston has moved approximately 1 inch into                inches, a limit switch on the crosshead opens and clock
the cylinder, the metering rod shuts off the flow of fluid         number one stops and display time elapsed. At the
from within the cylinder to port B. At the end of the              9-inch stroke, a second switch opens, stopping and
opening stroke, the orifice snubber controls the escape            displaying elapsed time.
of fluid from the cylinder, this prevents the moving
                                                                       The timer clocks are located on the main control
parts from slamming to a stop and possibly being
                                                                   console for CV-64, CVN-65, and CV-67 and the central
damaged.
                                                                   charging panel for CVN-68 through CVN 76.
     When pressurized fluid is applied to port A, the              Variations in the launching valve stroke rates may
piston moves toward the opposite end of the cylinder to            seriously affect catapult performance. The launching
close the steam valve. At the end of the closing stroke,           valve stroke timers provide a means of detecting
the tapered end of the piston rod enters the flange. This          differences in the launching valve stroke. Deviations in
prevents the moving parts from slamming to a stop and              the launching valve stroke can be detected by
possibly being damaged.                                            comparing current timer readings with previously
                                                                   established timer readings.
LAUNCH VALVE STROKE TIMER
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM                                                  THRUST EXHAUST UNIT
     The launch valve stroke timer electrical system (see               The thrust/exhaust units (fig. 4-9) absorbs the
fig. 4-5) provides a means of measuring the launch                 thrust of the launch engine pistons and shuttle
valve performance by timing the stroke from fully                  assembly, connects the launch valve to the power
closed position to the point at which the crosshead has            cylinders and to the exhaust valve, anchors the aft end
moved 9 inches. When the catapult is fired, fluid                  of the launching, engine and prevents aft expansion of
pressure from the hydraulic cylinder opening port E                the launching engine cylinders.
actuates the start timing pressure switch. This starts two
                                                                                                            OM
                                                                                                    A N D FR E
                                                                                               M TO      NGIN
                                                                                           STEA CHING-E S
                                                                                            LAUN YLINDER
                                                                                                C
                  OM
        T E A M FR ALVE
      S          GV
       U N CHIN BLY
    LA          M
         ASSE
ABEf0410
                                             STEAM TO
                                           EXHAUST VALVE
                                             Figure 4-9.—Thrust exhaust unit.
                                                             4-8
     In ships preceding CV-67, a thrust unit anchors the         LAUNCH-VALVE CONTROL VALVE
aft end of the launching engine and connects the steam
accumulator to the launch valve. An exhaust tee                       The launching-valve control valve (fig. 4-11)
mounted between the launch valve and the aft power               directs pressurized hydraulic fluid to the launch valve
cylinders also provides connection to the exhaust valve.         hydraulic cylinder to open or close the launch valve.
                                                                 The control valve consists of a valve body enclosed on
CAPACITY SELECTOR VALVE (CSV)                                    both ends by glands. A piston within the valve divides
                                                                 the control valve into seven chambers. Piping connects
    The CSV (fig. 4-10) provides the means of varying            each chamber of the control valve to other components.
the energy output of the catapult by controlling the             As the launching valves go through their opening and
opening rate of the launch valve for aircraft of various         closing cycles, fluid is being directed to the operating
types and weights. An electric motor unit assembly is            chambers by the action of the sliding piston, lining up
used to position the CSV spindle, which meters the               the ports and allowing pressurized fluid to enter one
flow of fluid from the operating cylinder when the               chamber while venting the other chamber to gravity. A
launch valve is opening, changing the valve setting for          tailrod is attached to each end of the piston. The tailrods
different capacity launchings. A handwheel is provided           extend through the gland and provide a visual
to change the valve setting should the automatic control         indication of the position of the control valve.
become inoperative. For complete information                     Pressurized fluid used to shift the control valve is
concerning the CSV assembly, refer to technical                  supplied through the launch valve solenoid-operated
manual NAVAIR 51-15ABE-1.                                        hydraulic lock valve.
                                                       REVOLUTION
                                                       COUNTER
                                                                                       INLET (PORT L)
                                                        ENCODER
DECLUTCH LEVER
MOTOR UNIT
                                                                                               ABEf0411
    HANDWHEEL
            LUBRICATION
              FITTING       LOCKPIN
                                      Figure 4-10.—Capacity selector valve assembly.
                                                           4-9
                                                                               FROM LAUNCHING-VALVE
         FROM OPERATING CYLINDER              TO OPERATING CYLINDER            HYDRAULIC-LOCK VALVE
            CLOSING CHAMBER                     OPENING CHAMBER                      (PORT C)
                (PORT D)                             (PORT A)
                                                 PISTON
     FROM LAUNCHING-VALVE
     HYDRAULIC-LOCK VALVE
           (PORT B)
ABEf0412
BUTTERFLY EXHAUST VALVE                                            launching engine pistons when the launch valve is
                                                                   closed. The pressure breaking orifice elbow is attached
     The butterfly exhaust valve (fig. 4-12) provide the           to a flange on the thrust/exhaust unit or exhaust tee
means to direct spent steam from the launching engine              above the exhaust valve assembly and contains an
cylinders overboard after the launch valve closes at the           orifice that is large enough to allow the escape of launch
completion of a launch. The exhaust valve is attached to           valve steam leakage but small enough to have no
the bottom flange of the thrust/exhaust unit or exhaust            detrimental effect on catapult performance. Any steam,
tee; it consists primarily of a valve body, a disc, and a          which may leak through the closed launch valve when
hydraulic actuator. Prior to launch, hydraulic pressure            the exhaust valve is closed, is permitted to escape
is directed from the exhaust valve hydraulic lock valve            through the pressure-breaking orifice. This prevents a
to the closing port of the hydraulic actuator causing the          build -up of pressure that could cause premature release
piston to move downward and the disk within the valve              of an aircraft from its holdback bar restraint.
body to move onto its seat. A switch is then actuated
that energizes a portion of the electrical circuitry that          KEEPER VALVE
allows the launch sequence to continue. After a launch,
when the launch valve closes, hydraulic pressure is                    The keeper valve (fig. 4-14) prevents the exhaust
directed from the exhaust valve hydraulic lock valve to            valve from opening while the launch valve is open. The
the opening port of the hydraulic actuator causing the             keeper valve is located in the piping between the launch
piston to move upward and the disk within the valve                and exhaust valve lock valves and the closing chamber
body to move off its seat and release the spent steam              of the exhaust valve actuator. The valve consists of a
overboard. The limit switch is released and allows for a           block with an internal cylinder containing a movable
portion of the electrical circuitry necessary to allow             piston. The keeper valve is actuated by hydraulic fluid
retraction of the launching engine pistons.                        from the launch-valve hydraulic lock valve. When the
                                                                   launch valve opens, the piston of the keeper valve shifts
PRESSURE-BREAKING ORIFICE ELBOW                                    and blocks the flow of hydraulic fluid to the exhaust
                                                                   valve hydraulic actuator. This prevents the exhaust
    The pressure-breaking orifice elbow (fig. 4-13)                valve from opening until the launch valve is closed and
prevents a buildup of steam pressure behind the                    the keeper valve piston is shifted.
                                                            4-10
                                                                                                     CRANK
CAM
                                                                                                    EXHAUST-VALVE
                                                                                                     LIMIT SWITCH
DISK
CLOSING PORT
            CLOSING
            CHAMBER
PISTON
ABEf0413
PISTON
ORIFICE
                                     ABEf0414
                                                                                                           VALVE BODY
                                                                                        ABEf0415
                                                        4-11
HYDRAULIC-LOCK-VALVE PANELS                                       circuit is energized, the fire air-solenoid valve directs
                                                                  air pressure to shift the lock valve to the fired position.
    There are two hydraulic-lock-valve panels, one for            This causes pressurized fluid to be directed from port A
the launch valve (fig. 4-15) and one for the exhaust              through port B to the launching-valve control valve, the
valve (fig. 4-16). The launch-valve hydraulic-                    keeper valve, and port D via the launch-valve
lock-valve panel consists of two air-solenoid valves, a           emergency cutout valve. Fluid pressure in port D
hydraulic lock valve with lock positioner, the launch             hydraulically locks the valve in the fired position.
pilot latch solenoid, and piping connections. The                 When the catapult LAUNCH COMPLETE circuit is
launch-valve hydraulic lock valve (fig. 4-17) provides a          energized, the close launch valve air-solenoid directs
hydraulic lock to hold the launch-valve control valve in          air pressure to again shift the lock valve, venting port D
the FIRED position until launch is completed or until             to gravity and directing pressurized fluid from port A
the launch-valve emergency cutout valve is placed in              through port C to the launch-valve control valve and
the EMERGENCY position, by controlling the flow of                closing the launch valves. (During a HANGFIRE
fluid to the launch-valve control valve.                          condition, port D is vented and port C is pressurized
    The launch pilot latch solenoid controls a plunger            when the launch-valve emergency cutout valve is
that prevents the lock valve from being shifted to the            placed in its EMERGENCY position, ensuring that the
FIRED position unless the catapult control system is in           launch valves remain closed.)
the FINAL READY phase of operation. (A manual lock                     The exhaust-valve hydraulic-lock-valve panel (see
screw [fig. 4-17] is provided to secure the valve during          fig. 4-16) consists of the exhaust-valve hydraulic lock
nonoperational periods.) When the catapult FIRE                   valve, two air-solenoid valves, and piping connections.
MANUAL LOCK
                                                                                                 LOCK POSITIONER
                                                                                                LAUNCHING-VALVE
                                                                                              HYDRAULIC-LOCK-VALVE
                                                                                                 HYDRAULIC-LOCK-VALVE
                                                                                                  SOLENOID (LAUNCH-
                                                                                                   PILOT-LATCH LPL)
    SOLENOID VALVE
(CLOSE-LAUNCHING-VALVE                                                                        INDICATOR FLAG
     SOLENOID CL)
                                                                                              CAUTION PLATE
ABEf0416
                                                           4-12
                                                               SOLENOID VALVE (OPEN-
                                                             EXHAUST-VALVE SOLENOID OE)
                                                                                        EXHAUST-VALVE
                                                                                         HYDRAULIC-
                                                                                         LOCK-VALVE
ABEf0417
                                                                                LOCK POSITIONER
                                                                              (SHOWN IN UNLOCKED
                                                                                   POSITION)
                                                         MANUAL LOCK
            PORT C
                                                  PISTON
PORT E
                                                                                          FROM CLOSING
                                                                                          SOLENOID (CL)
                                                             PORT A
                                                                                     ABEf0418
PORT D PORT B
                                                    4-13
                                             PORT C
PORT E
PISTON
                                                                                                                                   FROM CLOSING
                                                                                                                                   SOLENOID (CE)
                                                                                                         PORT A
FROM OPENING (FIRE)
   SOLENOID (OE)
                                                              PORT D                                               PORT B
                                                                                   ABEf0419
                                        7              SEALING STRIP
                           6
                     5
                                                         8
           4                                                                                  27
           3
                                                                                                                                   9
               2
                                   26
                              25
23 24
                          22                                                 13
                    21                                                               12
                         20                                                   14                             11       10
                     19
                                                                                              ABEf0420
                                                                            15
                         18                                     16
                                         17
1.   Thick spacer                                     10.    Flange                                          19.   Pad (NAVSHIP)
2.   Shim                                             11.    Aligning ring                                   20.   Baseplate
3.   Cylinder outer block                             12.    Cable support plate                             21.   Bolt
4.   Thin spacer                                      13.    Cable support spacer                            22.   Bearing pad
5.   Cylinder outer-block spacer                      14.    Cable support shim                              23.   Cylinder base
6.   Cover support bracket                            15.    Guide                                           24.   Screw
7.   Shim                                             16.    Clamp                                           25.   Launching engine cylinder
8.   Cylinder cover                                   17.    Shim (NAVSHIP)                                  26.   Track supporting bar
9.   Dowel pin                                        18.    Lubrication fitting                             27.   Cylinder slot
                                                      Figure 4-19.—Typical Cylinder Section.
                                                                         4-14
The exhaust-valve hydraulic lock valve (fig. 4-18)                    stud bolts are designed to minimize bolt failure due to
opens and closes the exhaust valve by controlling the                 uneven thermal stress within the cylinders during pre-
flow of hydraulic fluid to the exhaust-valve actuator.                heating and operation. Each cylinder is identified by a
When the exhaust-valve open solenoid is energized, air                serial number stamped on the outer surface of its flange.
pressure is directed to the opening side of the lock
                                                                           Base pads are welded in the bottom of the catapult
valve, causing it to shift. This allows fluid to flow from
                                                                      trough at specified intervals to match the bearing pads
port A, out port B, through the keeper valve, and into
                                                                      fastened to the cylinder bases. Shims are then used to
the opening chamber of the actuator. Fluid also flows
                                                                      properly align each cylinder section, and then the
from port D to lock the valve in the OPEN position.
                                                                      cylinder sections are secured to the trough base pads by
When the exhaust-valve closed solenoid is energized,
                                                                      bolts and clamps, which prevent the lateral movement
air pressure shifts the lock valve to the closed position,
                                                                      of the cylinders while allowing smooth elongation of
allowing fluid to flow from port A, out port C, and into
                                                                      the cylinders due to thermal expansion. Lubricator
the closing chamber of the exhaust-valve actuator. The
                                                                      fittings are provided for lubrication of the sliding
valve is locked in this position by pressure from port A
                                                                      surfaces.
acting on the larger working area of the lock valve
piston.                                                               CYLINDER COVERS
LAUNCHING ENGINE CYLINDERS                                                The cylinder cover (fig. 4-20) acts as clamps
                                                                      holding the slotted portion of the cylinder in position to
     Each catapult has two rows of launching engine
                                                                      prevent radial spreading when steam pressure is
cylinders (see fig. 4-4) mounted parallel to each other in
                                                                      applied. Space is provided in the cylinder covers for the
the catapult trough. Each row of cylinders is made up of
                                                                      sealing strip. Lubrication oil is supplied to the
sections that are slotted on the top and flanged at each
                                                                      launching engine cylinders through lubrication ports
end, with the number of sections determined by the
                                                                      and lubricators in each cover. Cylinder cover support
overall length of the catapult. The cylinder sections are
                                                                      brackets, screwed to the cylinder, hold the cylinder
bolted together at their flanges (fig. 4-19) by means of
                                                                      cover in place. Cover seals are used to seal and maintain
long stud bolts, spacers, and nuts. The spacers and long
                                                                      alignment of each cylinder cover section.
TIE BOLT
                                                 COVER SUPPORT
                                                 BRACKET                  PLUGGED PORT
                                   LUBRICATOR
        REAR COVER
PLUGGED PORT
                                    SCREW
           CYLINDER
                                                                                              12-FOOT
           COVER SEAL
                                                                                              INTERMEDIATE
                                                                                              COVER
LUBRICATOR
PLUGGED PORT
                     LUBRICATOR
                                                                                         FORWARD
                                                                                         COVER
                                                67-INCH
                                                INTERMEDIATE
                                                COVER                                                        ABEf0421
                                                               4-15
                               CYLINDER
                                COVER                             SHUTTLE          SEALING STRIP
            PISTON
           ASSEMBLY
                                                                                                    RIGHT-HANDED
         LEFT-HANDED                                                                                  CYLINDER
           CYLINDER
TROUGH
                                                                                     ABEf0422
                            Figure 4-21.—Cross section of launching engine cylinders (typical).
CYLINDER SEALING STRIPS                                          piston connectors lift the sealing strips and the sealing
                                                                 strip guides reseat them. Action of the sealing strip is
    The sealing strip (fig. 4-21) prevents the loss of           shown in figure 4-22. View A shows the strip position
steam from the cylinders by sealing the space between            forward of the piston assembly. View B shows the
the cylinder lip and the cylinder cover. As the steam            connector lifting the strip to permit the piston-shuttle
piston assemblies move through the cylinders, the                connector to pass under it. View C shows the guide
CYLINDER SHUTTLE
ABEf0423
                        E                  D                       C                       B                 A
                                            Figure 4-22.—Sealing strip action.
                                                          4-16
                                                                            ROLLER                GUIDE
                                     SPRING
ABEf0424
GUIDE LINK
                                                                                         SEALING - STRIP
                                                                                        CONNECTING LINK
re-laying the strip into its sealing position. View D               by a compressed spring. This force is transmitted to the
shows the final step in seating. View E shows the strip             sealing strip through the tensioner guide, which is free
fully seated with steam pressure keeping it seated.                 to slide back and forth on rollers.
                                                    SLEEVE
                                         CAP
                                                                                                         SEALING
                COVER          JAW                                                                      STRIP (REF)
ABEf0425
                                                             4-17
set of jaws wedged into a hollow sleeve and held in                 the power stroke. The connector and the strip guide are
place by a threaded cap                                             bolted to the top of the barrel. The connector lifts the
                                                                    sealing strip off its seat to permit passage of the shuttle
STEAM PISTON ASSEMBLY                                               assembly along the cylinder. The strip guide returns the
                                                                    sealing strip to its seat after the connector passes under
     The launching engine piston assembly (see fig.                 it, minimizing loss of steam pressure as the piston
4-25) consists of left and right hand launching pistons             assembly advances through the power stroke. In
and attaching parts. The launching engine pistons are               addition, the connector has interlocking "dogs," which
installed side by side in the launching engine cylinders            couple with matching "dogs" on the shuttle assembly to
the shuttle assembly provides the connection for one                effect the connection between the connectors and the
launching piston to the other along with the connection             shuttle assembly.
to the aircraft. The pressurized steam in the launching
engine cylinders drives the launching engine steam                      The tapered spear and bronze piston guide are
piston assemblies. They, in turn, drive the shuttle.                bolted to the forward end of the barrel. The piston guide
Component parts of each piston assembly are the steam               acts as a bearing surface for the piston assembly and
piston, the barrel, the connector, the strip guide, the             keeps it centered with respect to the cylinder walls. The
piston guide, and the tapered spear                                 tapered spear works in conjunction with the
                                                                    water-brake cylinder assemblies to stop the piston
     The barrel serves as the chassis for the other                 assemblies and shuttle at the end of the power stroke.
components of the assembly. The piston is bolted to the
aft end of the barrel; the piston rings installed on the            SHUTTLE ASSEMBLY
piston seal the space between the piston and the
cylinder wall. The cylinder cover segmented seal                        The shuttle assembly (see fig. 4-26) carries the
assembly acts as an extension of the piston into and                forward motion of the pistons to the aircraft by means
through the cylinder slot. This seal assembly consists of           of a launch bar attached to the aircraft nose gear and
a housing, three upper seal segments, and six lower seal            connected to the nose gear launch shuttle spreader. The
segments. The upper seal segments press against the                 meshing of interlocking “dogs” of the piston assembly
cylinder covers, and the lower seal segments press                  connectors and the shuttle frame connect the shuttle
against the sides of the cylinder slot to prevent the loss          and the piston assemblies.
of steam pressure from behind the steam pistons as the
                                                                         The shuttle is essentially a frame mounted on
piston assemblies move through the cylinders during
                                                                    rollers. Two pairs of rollers fitted with roller bearings
                                                                       RUBBING
                                   NUT
          COTTER PIN                                                    STRIP
                                    BOLT                                                    CONNECTOR
                                                                                          DEFLECTOR
                                                                                             RING
         CYLINDER
        COVER SEAL
            SEALING-
             STRIP                                                                                               SPEAR
             GUIDE
                                                                                                   SUPPORT
                                                                                                    GUIDE
BOLT
                                                                                      PISTON
                                                                                      GUIDE
                                                                              STUD
BARREL
                                PISTON
                    PISTON                                                                        ABEf0426
                    RINGS
                                                             4-18
                                                       BRIDLE SPREADER
RAMP GUIDES
ROLLER
                                                                                                      RETAINER
                                                                                                        NUT
        REAR SWEEPER
       PLATE AND CLEVIS                                                   DOGS
                             PIN
                                       FRAME
                                                                                                            ABEf0427
                                               Figure 4-26.—Shuttle assembly.
are installed on hubs mounted at each end of the shuttle          frame and is the only part that protrudes above the
frame. The shuttle is installed in a track between and            shuttle track. The nose gear launch spreader is attached
above the launching engine cylinders. The trough                  to the shuttle blade.
covers form the shuttle track, which supports and
guides the shuttle.                                               WATER-BRAKE CYLINDERS
     The bearings of the rollers are lubricated through                The water-brake cylinders (fig. 4-27) are installed
fittings, which are accessible through the slot in the            at the forward end of the launching engine cylinders.
shuttle track. The shuttle blade is part of the shuttle
                   LAUNCHING                                                                  FWD
                 ENGINE CYLINDER
                                                                                                    END PLUG
                          CHOKE RING
           JET RING
                                                                                                          CHOKE
ABEf0428
VANE
                                                         ANNULUS RING
                       WATER
                       SUPPLY                   STRIKER RING
                                     Figure 4-27.—Water-brake cylinder installation.
                                                           4-19
The water brakes stop the forward motion of the shuttle              which is maintained by the continued vortex action at
and pistons at the end of the catapult power stroke. The             the mouth of the cylinder.
after end of each water-brake cylinder is supported and
                                                                          Braking action occurs at the end of the power run
aligned by the most forward section of each launching
                                                                     when the tapered spear on the piston assembly enters
engine cylinder, which telescopes over the after end of
                                                                     the water brake. Water in the brake is displaced by the
the water-brake cylinder. The forward end of each
                                                                     spear and forced out the after end of the cylinder
cylinder is anchored in place by an upper bracket and
                                                                     between the choke ring and the spear (fig. 4-28). Since
lower support saddle and chock.
                                                                     the spear is tapered, the space between the choke ring
    The open end of each cylinder holds four rings.                  and the spear is gradually decreased as the spear moves
They are the choke ring, the annulus ring, the jet ring,             into the brake cylinder. This arrangement provides a
and the striker ring.                                                controlled deceleration and energy absorption, which
                                                                     stops the piston assembly within a distance of about 5
     The choke ring is the innermost ring and is threaded
                                                                     feet without damage to the ship's structure.
into the water-brake cylinder. The annulus ring has
angled holes machined in it to direct pressurized water
                                                                     WATER-BRAKE TANK
into the cylinder and forms a vortex (whirlpool) at the
open end of the cylinder. The jet ring is bolted to the end               The water-brake tank is installed below the
of the cylinder and holds the annulus ring in place. The             water-brake cylinders to supply water to and reclaim
striker ring, the outermost of the four rings, are                   water spillage from the water brakes during operation.
designed to absorb the impact of any metal-to- contact               It has a minimum capacity of 3,000 gallons of fresh
between the launching engine piston assemblies and                   water. Overflow and oil-skimming funnels and bottom
the aft end of the water brakes.                                     drains are provided in the tank to maintain proper water
                                                                     level and to remove excess oil used in the lubrication of
                      WARNING                                        the launching engine cylinders.
    To prevent damage to the water brakes and
                                                                     WATER-BRAKE PUMPS
    piston assembly components, a water-brake
    pump must be running any time the shuttle and                        Water is supplied to the water-brake cylinders by
    piston assemblies are not fully bottomed in the                  two electric-motor-driven, rotary-vane-type pumps
    water brakes.                                                    installed in the immediate vicinity of the water-brake
    A vane is keyed to the end plug (see fig. 4-27). Its             tank. They are capable of producing 650 gallons of
purpose is to break up the vortex caused by the annulus              water per minute at 80 psi. The pumps are electrically
ring and to create a solid head of water in the cylinder,            interlocked so that if the running pump breaks down,
ABEf0429
                                                              4-20
the alternate pump automatically starts running. A                             single line, which later splits into two lines.
gauge board within the pump room contains gauges for                           High-pressure, flexible hoses lead to and connect to the
pump suction and discharge pressure and for measuring                          brake cylinder water supply connectors, which are
the water pressure at the connectors (elbow pressure).                         attached to the water-brake cylinders. A drain valve for
                                                                               the water-brake tank leads to an overboard discharge.
WATER-BRAKE WATER SUPPLY PIPING                                                Fresh water from the ship's system is added to the tank
                                                                               via fill and shutoff valves in the water-brake pump
     The suction inlets of the pumps (fig. 4-29) are                           room.
submerged in the water-brake tanks. The pump
discharges each with appropriate valves and a                                  WATER-BRAKE PRESSURE-SENSING
flow-limiting orifice plate, are tied together and                             SWITCHES
connected via flexible hoses to strainer flanges at the
bottom of the water supply pipes. Hoses and rigid                                  Two pressure switches are connected to the piping
piping connect the pressure switches to the supply                             leading from the pumps to the brake cylinders (see fig.
pipes. A pump suction gauge and a pump discharge                               4-29). They usually are installed on the bulkhead
gauge are located on the gauge panel for each pump.                            adjacent to the tank. The switches are electrically tied
These are in addition to the gauges for the pressure                           in with the main control console/ICCS/CCP to prevent
sensing switches. The suction side of the pump consists                        operation in case the pressure falls below normal. Water
of an inlet with a gate type shutoff valve, a gauge valve,                     pressure keeps the switch contacts closed, thus
and a Macomb strainer immediately ahead of the pump                            completing a circuit. Should the pressure fall below
inlet. A petcock for venting is mounted at the top of the                      normal, either one or both of the switches will drop
strainer. The discharge side of each pump includes a                           open, breaking the circuit. There are also two pressure
flow limiting orifice plate, a check valve, and a gate                         gauges in the lines to give a visual indication of the
type shutoff valve. Two discharge lines merge into a                           pressure, commonly referred to as "elbow pressure."
FLIGHT DECK
     BAFFLES                                                                                    GAUGE
                                                                     PRESSURE                   PANEL                                   GATE
                                                                     SWITCHES                           GATE                            VALVE
   STRAINERS                                                                                            VALVE
  PLATFORM
             FLEX HOSES
                                        TO CHARGE PANEL
                                                                   FILL FUNNEL
                          WATER LEVEL                                                                           CHECK VALVES
                                                                  GATE VALVE   MACOMB
     OVERFLOW FUNNEL
                                                                               STRAINER
                                                                                                           ORIFICE FLANGES
SKIMMING FUNNEL
                                                                          GATE VALVE
                                                                                            PUMP                   PUMP
                                                               DRAIN COCKS                  NO. 1                  NO. 2
                                                                                 MACOMB
                                                                                 STRAINER
THERMOMETER
                                                                                                                                        ABEf0430
   OVERBOARD DRAIN
                                                                     4-21
STEAM CUTOFF PRESSURE-SWITCH                                       launch complete phase of operation and the subsequent
INSTALLATION                                                       closing of the launch valve. The pressure switches are
                                                                   preset to close at an increasing pressure of
    The steam cutoff switch installation (fig. 4-30)               approximately 20 psi and open at decreasing pressure
consists of two pressure switches and associated piping            of approximately 10 psi.
mounted in an intrusion-proof enclosure. The steam
cutoff pressure-switch installation is located at a point          CATAPULT TROUGH INSTALLATION
in the catapult power stroke determined during the
catapult certification program. Flexible tubing connects               The catapult trough installation (fig. 4-31) provides
the steam cutoff pressure switch assembly to a port in             a means of covering the catapult trough and providing a
one of the launching engine cylinders. After the                   track within which the shuttle and grab rollers ride. In
catapult is fired, when the launching engine piston                addition, it covers the launching engine components
passes the port that is connected to the cutoff switches,          and seals the launch valve area from fluid spills and
steam pressure actuates each switch. This initiates the            debris.
              ADAPTER
               FLANGE
SWITCH
                                                                                            INTRUSION-PROOF
                                                                                            ENCLOSURE (REF)
                                                            4-22
Aft Portable Trough Cover                                        Shroud and Periphery Drain
    The aft portable cover or Flush Deck Nose Gear                   On most ships, a shroud and periphery drain
Launch (FDNGL) cover, covers the launch valve area               assembly is installed directly below the FDNGL cover
and houses the bridle tensioner cylinder and NGL unit.           and on top of the launch valve to further protect the
Access covers are provided for the bridle tensioner              launch valve and its associated piping from corrosion
hydraulic lines.
               RETAINER
                 BAR
              FILLER                                                    INTERMEDIATE
               BAR                                                     TROUGH COVER
                                                                                          UPPER SUPPORT
                                                                                               BAR
                                              CATAPULT TROUGH
                                                 CENTERLINE
                                           CL                        CL
                                       CYLINDER                  CYLINDER               STEAM SMOTHERING
                                                                                             PIPING
                                                                                         TROUGH STEAM
                                                                                         PREHEAT PIPING
                   FOOTSTOOLS
                                                          4-23
resulting from water or other fluids leaking past the             Track Slot ButtonS
FDNGL cover.
                                                                      Track slot buttons (fig. 4-32) are provided to
Intermediate Tough Covers                                         prevent the arresting gear purchase cables from falling
                                                                  into catapult number three’s trough cover slot during
    The intermediate trough covers bridge the catapult            recovery operations. Track slot buttons must be
trough to provide a smooth continuous flight deck and             removed prior to any catapult operations
are manufactured with a track section (channel) which
supports and guides the shuttle and grab during catapult          Track Slot Button Installation
operations. All trough covers are designed to withstand
a vertical rolling load of 264,000 pounds total (132,000              1. Removed the button from the designated ready
pounds to each cover) in upward directional force and                    storage area and install 12 buttons at 12 feet
100,000 pounds wheel-load in downward directional                        intervals beginning with the first button 12 feet
force. The standard trough covers are made in various                    forward of catapult position.
lengths.                                                              2. Insert speed wrench in each button latch
                                                                         capscrew and turn one full turn counter-
Forward Trough Covers
                                                                         clockwise. This will align the latches with the
                                                                         button.
    The forward trough covers are nothing more than
intermediate covers, machined to receive a splash bar to              3. Place the button in the track slot and turn each
prevent water from splashing up out of the water brake                   latch capscrew clockwise until it is fully
tank when the spears enters the water brakes                             tightened. Insure each latch turns to a position
                                                                         perpendicular to the track slot.
Forward Portable Trough Covers
Retainer Bars
                                                                               5                         4
Slots Seals
                                                                           2
    The slots seals are “T” shaped rubber seals that are
installed in the trough cover slots during all
non-operation periods. The slot seals aid in maintaining                                                                 ABEf0433
                                                           4-24
Track Button Removal                                             Cylinder Expansion Indicator
   1. Turn the latch capscrew of each button                         The cylinder expansion indicators (fig. 4-33)
      counterclockwise until the latches are aligned             provide a flight deck visual indication of cylinder
      with the buttons. The button can then be lifted            thermal expansion. There are two expansion indicators,
      out of the slot with the speed wrench.                     each connected to the forward end of each launching
                                                                 engine cylinder. The indicator support is fastened to the
   2. Perform a count of the buttons to ensure they
                                                                 cylinder cover inner male guide, and supports the
      have all been removed.
                                                                 pointer assembly. The pointers normally extend
   3. Return the buttons to their storage cart and               through slots in the deck, but are spring loaded to
      return the cart to their designated storage area.          prevent damage during deck access cover removal.
   4. Any missing or damaged button shall be                     Recessed in the deck beside each deck slot is a scale
      reported to the catapult officer.                          with 0.10-inch graduations. The expansion indicators
                                                                 move with the cylinders, and expansion can be
   5. After the catapult slot has been cleared of                measured directly by reading the scale beside the
      buttons, stow the shuttle forward.                         pointer.
                                                                                                                  4
                               2
ABEf0434
                               7
                                                                            6
                                                          4-25
                     MAGNETIC SENSORS
                                                                      SHUTTLE MAGNET
                                                                         ASSEMBLY
DESI CONSOLE
               THERMAL
               PRINTER
                                     DESI REMOTE
                                      READOUT
CHANNEL 1 ENCODER                                                 INTERFACE
  JUNCTION BOX                                                  JUNCTION BOX
                                                                       2                  ABEf0435
                    Figure 4-34.—Digital endspeed indicator system.
                                         4-26
Digital Endspeed Indicator System                                      The lubrication system (fig. 4-35) provides a means
                                                                  of lubricating the launching engine cylinder and sealing
     The Digital Endspeed Indicator System (DESI)                 strip prior to firing the catapult, by injecting lubricating
(fig. 4-34) provides a means for measuring the                    oil through the cylinder covers with a spray pattern that
endspeed of the steam catapult shuttle during operation.          ensures even lubrication of the cylinder walls before
The endspeed is measured when a shuttle-mounted                   passage of the launching engine pistons. The major
magnet passes three magnetic sensors mounted in the               components of the lubrication system consists of the
catapult track near the water break end. The endspeed is          following:
digitally displayed for visual readout on a console
assembly. In addition, on CVN-68 through CVN-76, a                LUBE PUMP MOTOR SET
remote readout is provided in the catapult officer
console. A thermal printer permanently records this                   The lube pump motor set delivers lube oil from the
along with other information such as Capacity Selector            lube tank to the lube side of the metering pumps/
Valve (CSV) setting, date, time, and shot count. For              injectors. The pump motor is left running continuously
more detailed information on the DESI installation,               during operations.
refer to technical manual NAVAIR 51-15ABE-2.
                                                                  LUBE STORAGE TANK
             LUBRICATION SYSTEM                                        The lube storage tank stores lubricating oil for used
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Describe the                             during operations. The lube oil tank holds
    components of the lubrication system.                         approximately 220 gallons and is located in close
    Describe the function of the lubrication                      proximity to the lube pump. The lube oil tank is piped
    system.                                                       to the ship’s lube oil stowage tank, which enables easy
                                                                  and convenient lube oil replenishment.
                                                                                               TO OTHER
                                                                                            METERING PUMPS
                                                                                           LP AIR
                                  METERING                                TO OTHER
                                  PUMP                                    METERING
                                                                           PUMPS
                                 CHECK
                                 VALVE                RELIEF                            FROM
                                                      VALVE                             HYD
                                                                                        ACCUM-
                                                                                        ULATOR
                                                                                                         TO
                                                                                                         GRAVITY
                                                                  LUBE AIR
                                                                                                         TANK
                                                                  SOLENOID
                             LUBE OIL
             TO              SUPPLY
             OPPOSITE
             METERING                                                        TO OTHER
                                                                                                      LUBE
             PUMP                                                         METERING PUMPS
                                                                                                    CONTROL
                  TO OTHER                                                                           VALVE
                  METERING                                     GAUGE LINE
                   PUMPS
                                                                                                    LUBE
                                                                     RELIEF                      PUMP/MOTOR
                                                                     VALVE
                                                           4-27
AIR-OPERATED LUBE CONTROL VALVE                                 AIR-SOLENOID VALVE
    The lube control valve when actuated, directs                   The air-solenoid valve, when energized, directs low
accumulator pressure to the high pressure or actuating          pressure air to an air cylinder on the lube control valve.
side of the metering pumps.
                                                                     LUBRICATION OIL
                                                                     FROM
                                                                     LUBRICATION PUMP
                                                                             LUBRICATION OIL TO
                                                                             LUBRICATOR HOUSING
                                                                             AND PISTON
BLEED VALVE
                                            RELIEF VALVE
                                                                                CHECK VALVE
                                      O-RING
PISTON
                                                           BACKUP
                                                           RINGS
                           HOUSING
                                                                                    ABEf0437
                                                         4-28
METERING PUMPS                                                          When the lube air solenoid is energized, it directs
                                                                   low pressure air to the air chamber of the lube control
    The metering pumps distribute lubricating oil to the           valve, overcoming the unbalanced control valve piston.
lubricator housing located on the cylinder covers. Each            Low pressure air shifts the control valve allowing
metering pump contains a piston that separates the                 accumulator hydraulic pressure to be directed to the
metering pump into two chambers, a high-pressure                   high-pressure hydraulic side of all the metering pumps
hydraulic chamber and a lube oil chamber.                          (see fig. 4-36). The lube oil in the metering pumps is
                                                                   forced out through a relief valve and to the two injectors
LUBE OIL SYSTEM OPERATIONS                                         in each of the cylinder covers. One lube injector directs
                                                                   lube oil through the open cylinder slot and the other
     With the lube air solenoid deenergized, ac-                   injector is angled to direct lube oil onto the sealing
cumulator pressure supplied to the lube control valve,             strip.
acting on the differential area on the control valve
piston will keep the control valve shifted to the air
chamber side of the control valve. This allows the                             BRIDLE TENSIONING SYSTEM
high-pressure hydraulic side of the metering pumps                      LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Describe the
(fig. 4-36) to be vented through the control valve to the               components of the bridle tensioning system.
gravity tank. With the lube pump running, the metering                  Describe the function of the bridle tensioning
pumps will fill with lube oil. When all metering pumps                  system.
are full, the lube oil pump discharge pressure will
                                                                       The bridle tensioning system (fig. 4-37) provides a
increase to the pump relief valve setting (150-165).
                                                                   means of tightly connecting the aircraft to the shuttle
Pump discharge will now recirculate to the stowage
                                                                   prior to firing the catapult. The bridle tensioning system
tank while maintaining relief valve setting pressure
                                                                   is comprised of components that directly apply a
throughout the lube oil side of the system.
                                                                   forward force to the shuttle (external tension) and other
                                                                                 BRIDLE TENSIONER FULLY-
                                                                                  EXTENDED LIMIT SWITCH
                                                            4-29
components that cause the retraction engine motor to                end of the tensioner cylinder during the bridle tension
slowly rotate (internal tension). The components of the             phase. At other times the control valve provides a vent
external tensioning system is comprised of a bridle                 to the gravity tank for the aft end of the tensioner
tensioner pilot valve, a pressure regulator, a tensioner            cylinder.
control valve, a tensioner cylinder, a relief valve, and a
full aft limit switch.                                              BRIDLE TENSIONER CYLINDER
    The pressure regulator is used to reduce ac-                        The external tensioning relief valve is set to relieve
cumulator pressure to the pressure required for the                 at 150 psi over the normally required pressure.
proper application (4000 plus or minus 250-ft lbs.)
through the grab to the shuttle. Reduced pressure from              BRIDLE TENSIONER FULL AFT LIMIT
the regulator is directed to the bridle tensioner control           SWITCH
valve and to the forward end of the bridle tensioner
cylinder.                                                               The full aft limit switch in the bridle tensioning
                                                                    system is located in the aftermost trough cover, and are
BRIDLE TENSIONER CONTROL VALVE                                      actuated by a cam on the bridle tensioner piston rod
                                                                    crosshead. The fully aft limit switch, when actuated,
   The tensioner control valve directs reduced                      allows completion of the RETRACT PERMISSIVE
hydraulic pressure from the pressure regulator to the aft           circuit. This prevents retraction of the grab and shuttle
ABEf0439
                                                             4-30
into an extended bridle tensioner piston rod. This limit             bridle tensioner pilot valve, reduced pressure hydraulic
switch is also part of the MANEUVER AFT circuit.                     fluid flows through the inlet valve to the hydraulic
This circuit ensures that the tensioner piston rod is fully          motor and orifice bypass piping. Hydraulic fluid from
aft, allowing the grab latch to remain locked to the                 the motor and bypass piping is routed to the gravity
shuttle in an aircraft-launch-abort situation.                       tank through the outlet valve. This enables the
                                                                     hydraulic motor to rotate the drum slowly so that static
Internal Tensioning Components                                       friction in the retraction engine and drive system is
                                                                     overcome.
    The internal tensioning is comprised of com-
ponents that cause the retraction engine motor to slowly             Internal Tension Relief Valve
rotate and consists of a pressure regulator, and a inlet
and outlet valve.                                                       The relief valve is set to relieve at 225 psi over the
                                                                     normal internal tension pressure.
Pressure Regulator
                                                                                   HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
     The pressure regulator is used to reduce ac-
cumulator pressure to the pressure required to move the                  LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Describe the
grab and shuttle forward (creep rate) a distance of six                  components of the hydraulic system. Describe
feet in 30-50 seconds.                                                   the function of the hydraulic system.
                                                                         The hydraulic system (fig. 4-39) supplies
Internal Tensioning Inlet and Outlet Valve
                                                                     pressurized fluid to the hydraulic components of the
    The internal tensioning inlet and outlet valve                   catapult. The system consists of a main hydraulic
controls the flow of reduced pressure hydraulic fluid to             accumulator, an air flask, three main hydraulic pumps,
and from the hydraulic motor and orifice bypass piping               a booster pump and filter unit, a gravity tank, a 90
during the tensioning phase. When actuated by the                    gallon auxiliary tank, and a circulating pump.
TO MAIN HYDRAULIC
  ACCUMULATOR
                                   MAIN HYDRAULIC PUMP
   (NOT SHOWN)
           TO FLUID COOLER/
             GRAVITY TANK
GRAVITY TANK
DELIVERY
CONTROL
  UNIT
            SUCTION LINE
             STRAINER
                                                                                                                     AUXILIARY
                                                                                                                       TANK
                                         BOOSTER PUMP
                                            FILTER
                                                                                                                     FLUID
                                                                                                                     FILTER
                                                     BOOSTER PUMP
                                                                                           CIRCULATING
                                                                                              PUMP
ABEf0440
                                                              4-31
HYDRAULIC FLUID                                                      The accumulator provides hydraulic fluid under
                                                                     controlled pressure to all hydraulically operated
     The hydraulic fluid, MIL-H-22072, is 50 percent                 catapult components. The bottom chamber of the
water, which provides its fire resistance. The remaining             accumulator connects by piping to the air flask and the
50 percent is composed of a water-soluble polymer,                   top chamber is connected by piping to the hydraulic
which increases the viscosity of the water, the freezing             system. A stroke control actuator provides the means of
point depressant, and selected additives that impart                 controlling main hydraulic pump delivery as required.
lubricant and corrosion protection. The red dye additive             A volume normal actuator mounted to the top flange
provides good visibility for leak detection. With use,               provides protection from operating the catapult if the
the fluid loses water and volatile inhibitors. Water loss            fluid volume is low.
is indicated by an increase in the fluid viscosity. Loss of
inhibitors is indicated by a change in the pH number of              STROKE-CONTROL ACTUATOR
the fluid. (External contamination will also cause a
change in pH number.) Normal values for the viscosity                    The stroke-control actuator is mounted near the
and pH number of the unused fluid are as follows:                    bottom of the main hydraulic accumulator cylinder.
                                                                     The actuator is a lever-operated cam that operates two
    • Viscosity (fluid temp. 100°F): 185 to 210 SSU                  limit switches. The bottom limit switch controls the
    • pH number: 8.8 to 9.8                                          operation of the primary pump, and the top limit switch
                                                                     controls the operation of the remaining two pumps.
MAIN HYDRAULIC ACCUMULATOR                                           With the accumulator full of fluid, both on stroke cams
                                                                     are in the released position, deenergizing all pump
    The main hydraulic accumulator (fig. 4-40)                       delivery control solenoids. As fluid is used, air pressure
consists of a vertical cylinder and a floating piston. The           raises the accumulator piston and the actuator rod move
piston separates the accumulator into two chambers, a                upward. The on stroke cam for the primary pump
fluid chamber on top and an air chamber on the bottom.               actuates first and that pump will deliver fluid to the
                                                                                                 VOLUME-NORMAL
                                      FLUID SIDE OF                                            ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
                                      ACCUMULATOR
                                                                                                                  HYDRAULIC-
                                                                                                                ACCUMULATOR
                                                                                                                    VOLUME
                                                                                                              LIMIT SWITCH (S130)
                                       PISTON ASSEMBLY
                                                                                                                         CAM
 OFF-STROKE
    CAM               ACTUATOR
                        ROD
                                     ON-STROKE
                                        CAM
                                                                                                                         ARM
                                                                                            AIR SIDE OF
                                                                                           ACCUMULATOR
CYLINDER
         STROKE CONTROL
           LIMIT SWITCH   STROKE CONTROL
            (S855) FOR      LIMIT SWITCH
           SECONDARY         (S857) FOR
              PUMPS        PRIMARY PUMP
                                     STROKE CONTROL
                                    ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
                                                                                                                   ABEf0441
                                           Figure 4-40.—Main hydraulic accumulator.
                                                              4-32
accumulator. If the system fluid use is in excess of the            MAIN HYDRAULIC PUMPS
primary pump output, the accumulator piston will
continue to rise causing actuation of the onstroke cam                   The main hydraulic pumps (see fig. 4-39) deliver
for the other two pumps. The delivery control solenoid              hydraulic fluid to the main hydraulic accumulator. The
of those pumps energizes and all pumps then deliver                 hydraulic pumps are connected in parallel. The intake
fluid to the accumulator. As the accumulator fills, the             line to each pump is provided with a strainer. Each
piston move downward reversing the movement of the                  pump discharge line is fitted with a delivery control
actuating arm and sequentially opening the circuits to              unit, which has a built-in relief valve. When the hydrau-
the delivery control solenoids of the three pumps.                  lic fluid leaves the pumps, the delivery control unit
                                                                    directs it either through a fluid cooler to the gravity tank
VOLUME-NORMAL ACTUATOR                                              (pump offstroke), or through the pressure line to the
                                                                    main accumulator. This pressure line is equipped with
    The volume-normal actuator is located in the top of             one-way check valves to prevent the backing up of fluid
the cylinder (see fig. 4-39). During launching                      from the accumulator when the pumps are offstroke.
operations, if hydraulic fluid volume in the
accumulator becomes dangerously low, the concave top                BOOSTER PUMP AND FILTER UNIT
surface on the accumulator piston will come in contact
with the arm on the actuator. The arm will rotate and                    The booster pump and filter unit (fig. 4-42) consists
cause the cam to release the limit switch. The limit                of a pump and motor assembly and a filter unit installed
switch contacts shift, lighting a malfunction light and             between the gravity tank and the main hydraulic
breaking the circuit to the cat/first ready phase of                pumps. The booster pump is operated anytime that a
operation.                                                          main hydraulic pump is running. During operation the
                                                                    booster pump maintains a positive head of hydraulic
AIR FLASK                                                           pressure at the inlet to the main hydraulic pumps. The
                                                                    filter unit ensures that a clean supply of hydraulic fluid
    The air flask (fig. 4-41) is a 70 cubic foot container          is always available. A means is provided to drain the
of compressed air, which is used to maintain nearly                 filter housing to facilitate changing of filter elements. A
constant hydraulic-fluid pressure in the accumulator.               bypass line, containing a check valve, is installed to
As the fluid in the accumulator is used, the air pressure           permit the main hydraulic pumps to take suction
forces the piston upward, displacing the fluid. Because             directly from the gravity tank in the event of a clogged
of the large volume of air in the air flask, the pressure           filter unit of booster pump failure.
change in the accumulator is relatively small.
TO MAIN HYDRAULIC
                                                                    GRAVITY TANK
ACCUMULATOR AND
MEDIUM-PRESSURE                                                         The gravity tank is the storage reservoir for catapult
 AIR SUPPLY VALVE
AT CHARGING PANEL                    TO PRESSURE GAUGE              hydraulic fluid. The tank is made up of internal baffles
                                     ON CHARGING PANEL              to minimize fluid surging and foaming. The tank is
                                                                    vented at the top and all low-pressure fluid return lines
                                                                    lead into the top portion of the tank. The tank capacities
                                                                    may vary slightly but the minimum operating tank level
                                                                    with a full hydraulic system and piping is 800 gallons.
AUXILIARY TANK
                                                             4-33
                                       TO MAIN PUMPS
                                                                                   FROM
                                                                                GRAVITY TANK
FILTER UNIT
                                                                                          BOOSTER
                                                                       HANDWHEEL           PUMP
                                                                               VENT VALVE
                                                                                 SAMPLE
                                                                                PETCOCK
DUPLEX GAUGE
                   TO MAIN
                    PUMPS
                     SAMPLE
                    PETCOCK
                                                       FILTER UNIT
                 FLEXIBLE                                                     DRAIN
                   HOSE                                                        LINE
                   QUICK
                DISCONNECT
                            SHUTOFF VALVE
                                                                                                            ABEf0443
CIRCULATING PUMP                                                            the discharge side of the circulating pump and the
                                                                            gravity tank. This ensures that all new or recycled
    The circulating pump (see fig. 4-39) is utilized to                     hydraulic fluid is filtered prior to entering the gravity
return hydraulic fluid from the auxiliary tank to the                       tank.
gravity tank. The fluid passes through a filter between
                                                                     4-34
     RETRACTION ENGINE AND DRIVE                                            The retraction engine and drive system (fig. 4-43)
              SYSTEMS                                                   consists of the components that are used to return the
                                                                        launching engine pistons and shuttle to the battery
   LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Describe the
                                                                        position after each launch or to maneuver the grab,
   components of the retraction engine and drive
                                                                        whenever necessary
   systems. Describe the function of the retraction
   engine and drive systems
  VENT VALVE
  PANEL (REF)
 VENT
VALVES
                                                                                            TENSIONER          DRUM
 PIPING TO                                   PORT-TO-ADVANCE                               ACCUMULATOR
 RETRACT             MANIFOLD                DIRECTIONAL VALVE
DUMP VALVE           ASSEMBLY
GRAB ASSEMBLY
                                                                                  LEAD SHEAVE
                                                                                   ASSEMBLY
ADVANCE CABLE
                             RETRACT CABLE
                                                   AD ET
                                                    R
                                                     VA RA
                                                       NC CT
                                                          E
                                                                 HYDRAULIC
                                                                  MOTOR
ABEf0444
                                                                 4-35
HYDRAULIC MOTOR                                                   SCREW AND TRAVERSE CARRIAGE
                                                                  INSTALLATION
    The hydraulic motor (see fig. 4-43) is rotated by
pressurized fluid from the main hydraulic accumulator.                 The screw and traverse carriage installation (fig.
Various directional valves located on the retraction              4-44) is mounted on the retraction engine frame above
engine manifold control speed and direction of rotation.          the drum and is driven by a gear arrangement connected
The hydraulic motor is coupled directly to the drum               to the drum. Rotation of the drum causes the traverse
assembly, causing the drum to rotate in the same                  carriage to slide along tracks mounted on the engine
direction and speed as the motor.                                 frame. A sheave and adapter assembly, bolted to the
                                                                  carriage body, acts as a guide for the advance and
DRUM ASSEMBLY                                                     retract cables as they wind and unwind on and off the
                                                                  drum preventing the cables from becoming tangled. As
    The drum is a grooved, cylindrical shaped as-                 the carriage assembly moves along the length of the
sembly which winds and unwinds the drive system                   retraction engine, cams mounted on top of the carriage
cables to either advance or retract the grab, based on            body come in contact with valves and switches
directional rotation of the hydraulic motor. The drum is          mounted within the retraction engine frame. The cams
directly coupled to the hydraulic motor and is geared to          actuate the advance and retract dump valves, advance
the screw and traverse carriage installation.                     and retract cutoff limit switches, grab fully aft limit
CAMS SCREW
GEARING
DRUM
ABEf0445
                                                           4-36
switch, and grab fully advanced limit switch. The cam               directional valve. When the retract solenoid (SR) is
positions are adjusted for individual installations.                energized, the pilot shifts, directing hydraulic fluid
                                                                    flow through the pilot valve, through the retract dump
RETRACTION ENGINE MANIFOLD                                          valve to shift the retract directional valve
                                                                               INTERNAL-TENSIONING
                        INTERNAL-TENSIONING                                         INLET VALVE
                            OUTLET VALVE
                                                                                                      TENSIONER
                                                                                                      PILOT VALVE
                                                                                             ADVANCE DIRECTIONAL
                                                                                                   VALVE
                                                                                  RETRACT DIRECTIONAL
                                                                                        VALVE
                                                             4-37
ADVANCE DIRECTIONAL VALVE                                         forward solenoid (EF) and the maneuver aft solenoid
                                                                  (EA). The maneuvering valve is energized
    The advance directional valve (see fig. 4-45)                 automatically during the latter part of the advance and
controls the hydraulic motor during advance. When                 retract stroke to control the speed of the grab after
actuated by fluid flow from the pilot valve, the advance          braking has been completed. Orifices control hydraulic
directional valve piston shifts, directing fluid flow             fluid flowing through the valve to and from the
through the directional valve to the hydraulic motor.             hydraulic motor. At times other than during normal
The fluid returns from the motor and flows through the            operations, the valve can be energized to slowly
directional valve to the gravity tank. When the advance           maneuver the grab, shuttle, and pistons forward or aft
directional valve is not actuated, no fluid flow is               for testing or maintenance. A manual override button
allowed through the valve. As the traverse carriage               on the valve can be pushed to maneuver the grab aft in
nears the end of an advance stroke, a cam mounted on              case of power failure and permit disengagement of the
the carriage actuates the advance dump valve. This                aircraft from the shuttle.
drains the pressure in the advance directional valve
actuating chamber back to the gravity tank through the            DUMP VALVES
dump valve. The advance directional valve piston then
closes, causing a gradual cutoff of hydraulic fluid from               The two dump valves (fig. 4-46) are mounted on
the hydraulic motor, initiating retraction engine                 the retraction engine frame. The valves are actuated by
braking.                                                          cams mounted on the traverse carriage. When the
                                                                  retraction engine nears the end of the advance stroke,
MANEUVERING VALVE                                                 the advance dump valve is actuated. The dump valve
                                                                  closes allowing the pilot-actuating fluid from the
   The maneuvering valve (see fig. 4-45) is mounted               advance directional valve to return to the gravity tank,
on the manifold and is operated by the maneuver                   initiating the advance braking stroke. When the
                                                                         TO RETRACT
                                                                      DIRECTIONAL VALVE
     TO ADVANCE
  DIRECTIONAL VALVE
                                                                   FROM ADVANCE AND
                                                                  RETRACT PILOT VALVE
 FROM ADVANCE AND
RETRACT PILOT VALVE
                                                                        TO GRAVITY TANK
                                                                                          CABLE TENSIONER
                                                                                           ASSEMBLY (REF)
                                                                                                               ABEf0447
                                                           4-38
retraction engine nears the end of the retract stroke, the           CABLE TENSIONER ASSEMBLY
retract dump valve is actuated. The dump valve closes
allowing the pilot-actuating fluid from the retract                       The cable tensioner assembly (fig. 4-47) consists of
directional valve to return to the gravity tank, initiating          the four cable tensioners required to keep the retraction
the retract braking stroke.                                          engine drive system taut. Each cable tensioners consists
                                                                     of a hydraulic cylinder containing a piston with a
VENT VALVE PANEL                                                     threaded rod extending from one end and a rod
                                                                     attaching a clevis/sheave from the other end. Fluid
     The vent valve panel is located on top of the                   under pressure from the cable tensioner accumulator
retraction engine manifold assembly. Vent valves are                 forces the tensioner sheaves toward the cylinders
mounted on the panel and are connected to various                    applying tension to the drive system cables. The
points in the retraction engine hydraulic system. These              threaded rods with adjusting nut on the other end of
valves are used to bleed (vent) air and air saturated                each tensioner provide a stop for sheave stroke when
hydraulic fluid from various retraction engine                       the pressure in the tensioner cylinders is overcome by
components. A hydraulic fluid reservoir is located at                the braking action which occurs during dump valve
the bottom of the vent valve panel. The reservoir is used            actuation.
to collect vented fluid and provide the outlet to return
vented fluid to the hydraulic system.
                                                                                                     SHEAVE ASSEMBLY
                                                                              CLEVIS ASSEMBLY
                                                                     PISTON ROD
                        RETRACT CYLINDER ASSEMBLY
STOP NUT
LOCKING NUT
ABEf0448
                                                              4-39
SHEAVES                                                           CABLES
     The sheave assembly (fig. 4-48) is a type of pulley               The drive system cables are 9/16-inch wire rope
used to guide and change direction of the drive system            with a swage type fitting on one end for attachment to
cables. Sheaves are located on the traverse carriage to           the grab. Two advance cables and two retract cables
feed the cable on and off the drum when the retraction            attach to the forward and aft end of the grab. The cables
engine is in motion. Fixed sheaves on the retraction              are then fairleaded to the retraction engine, around the
engine guide the cables to the fairlead sheaves. The              traverse carriage sheaves and then a predetermined
fairlead sheaves are those sheaves that lead the drive            length is wound onto the drum. The drum ends of the
system from the retraction engine to the forward and aft          cables are held in place by bolted clamps. During
ends of the catapult trough.                                      retraction engine operation, as the drum rotates, one
                                         CABLE-TENSIONER
                                         SHEAVE ASSEMBLY
                                         (OUTBOARD SIDE)                                    LEAD SHEAVE
                                                                                             ASSEMBLY
                                                              CABLE-TENSIONER
                                                              SHEAVE ASSEMBLY
                                                               (INBOARD SIDE)
     CABLE-TENSIONER
     CLEVIS ASSEMBLY
                        TRAVERSE-CARRIAGE
                            SHEAVE AND
                        ADAPTER ASSEMBLY
ABEf0449
Figure 4-48.—Sheaves.
                                                           4-40
pair of cables winds onto the drum while towing the                      cam follower, trapping the latch and locking the grab to
grab. The other pair of cables is unwound from the                       the shuttle clevis pin, as shown in diagram B. The grab
drum by movement of the grab. The traverse carriage                      will not release the shuttle until both have been returned
moves in proportion with the drum rotation and feed the                  to the BATTERY position and the grab unlocking
cables on and off the drum.                                              mechanism is actuated by the bridle tensioner. When
                                                                         the bridle-tensioner piston rod moves forward, the
GRAB                                                                     bridle-tensioner buffer cap (11) pushes the grab
                                                                         pushrod (1) inward until the buffer cap contacts the
     The grab (fig. 4-49) is a spring-loaded latch,                      grab block (2). When the pushrod is pushed inward, the
mounted on a wheel frame and installed within the                        lock block (9) is pulled from under the latch cam
shuttle track behind the shuttle. The two retract cables                 follower and the latch is free to rotate and release the
are fastened to the aft end of the grab, and the two                     shuttle, as shown in diagram C. When the shuttle and
advance cables to the forward end. After a launch, the                   bridle tensioner move away from the grab, the grab
grab is pulled forward the length of the shuttle track by                remains in the UNLOCKED position, as shown in
the drive system, and automatically latches to the                       diagram A. During no-load tests, the grab and shuttle
shuttle with a positive-locking device. Diagram A of                     must be unlatched. The grab is manually released from
figure 4-50 shows the grab in the UNLOCKED                               the shuttle, as shown in diagram D. A manual-release
position, approaching the shuttle. When the grab latch                   disengaging lever (12) is placed over the
(5) comes in contact with the shuttle clevis pin (6), the                manual-release arm (3), which is accessible through the
latch rotates and the latch cam follower (8) moves out                   track slot, lifted up and pushed forward. This motion
of the cam detent (7) in the lock block (9) and continues                pulls the lock block from under the latch cam follower
upward until it reaches the top surface of the lock block.               and frees the latch so that the grab and shuttle can be
The spring-loaded lock block then moves under the                        separated.
                                                                                    11   12    13
                                                                               10
                                                                  9
                     4                   5              7     8
                                                 6
                 3
             2
1
                                                                                                           14
15
20
19 16
                                                                                                                    ABEf0450
                             18
                               17
                                                                  4-41
      1         2             3                               4   5                  1       2          3                            4           5
                                  DECK LINE                                                                         DECK LINE
                        10                    9    8          7       6                           10                         9   8   7       6
                                  DIAGRAM A                                                                       DIAGRAM B
           UNLOCKED POSITION - APPROACHING SHUTTLE                                                 LATCHED & LOCKED TO SHUTTLE
                                                                                                              3                          4           5
           1        2   3                                         4       5                12
                                  DECK LINE                                                                         DECK LINE
               11            10                   9 8     7           6                            10                       9                6
                                  DIAGRAM C                                                                       DIAGRAM D
           UNLOCKED - SHUTTLE FREE TO MOVE FORWARD                                                          MANUALLY UNLOCKED
                                                                                                                                      ABEf0451
                                                                              4-42
                                CORE
                                                   PLUNGER
                                                     SPRING
                                                                           N     S N            S
Figure 4-51.—Solenoid.
action of the spring. When voltage is applied, the                  contact C1, which completes the circuit from the
current through the coil produces a magnetic field,                 common terminal to C1. At the same time, it has
which draws the plunger within the coil, thereby                    opened the circuit to contact C2.
resulting in mechanical motion. When the coil is
                                                                        The relay is one of the most dependable
de-energized, the plunger returns to its normal position
                                                                    electromechanical devices in use; but like any other
by the spring action.
                                                                    mechanical or electrical equipment, relays occasionally
     Solenoids are used in steam catapult systems for               wear out or become inoperative for one reason or
electrically operating bridle tensioning valves,                    another. Should inspection determine that a relay has
lubrication valves, engine retraction valves, and relays,           exceeded its safe life, the relay should be removed
and for various other mechanisms where only small                   immediately and replaced with one of the same type.
movements are required. One of the distinct advantages
in the use of solenoids is that a mechanical movement               Fuses And Circuit Breakers
can be accomplished at a considerable distance from
the control station. The only link necessary between the                The electrical control system is protected from
control and the solenoid is the electrical wiring for the           overloading by fuses and circuit breakers.
coil current.                                                                  COMMON TERMINAL
Relays
                                                             4-43
    The fuse is the simplest protective device. A fuse is          examples. The push button used in a holding circuit
merely a short length of wire or metal ribbon within a             stays energized once it is depressed until that particular
suitable container. This wire or metal ribbon is usually           circuit is de-energized by the normal sequence of
made of an alloy that has a low melting point and is               operations or one of the suspend switches is actuated.
designed to carry a given amount of current                        All the push buttons associated with the normal
indefinitely. A larger current causes the metal to heat            operation of the catapult are incorporated into holding
and melt, opening the circuit to be protected. In                  circuits.
replacing a burned-out fuse, you should be sure that the
new fuse is the same size (capacity in amperes) as the             CATAPULT CONTROL SYSTEM FOR CVN-68
original.                                                          THROUGH CVN-76 (INTEGRATED
                                                                   CATAPULT CONTROL STATION
    The circuit breaker serves the same purpose as the
                                                                   (ICCS))
fuse, but it is designed to open the circuit under
overload conditions without injury to itself. Thus, the                The controls for the ICCS are mainly divided
circuit breaker can be used again and again after the              between the ICCS at the flight deck level and the
overload condition has been corrected.                             Central Charging Panel (CCP) below deck. The ICCS is
                                                                   an enclosure that may be retracted into the deck when
Limit Switches
                                                                   not in use. It contains the catapult-officer control
                                                                   console and the monitor control console, and controls
    Limit switches are used as remote indicators of the
                                                                   the operation of two adjacent catapults. Sound-powered
position of various components throughout the system.
                                                                   phones and a system of indicator lights link the ICCS to
They are actuated mechanically by the movement of the
                                                                   the remote panels for individual catapults. In an
component. Electrical contacts within the switch
                                                                   emergency, the functions of the ICCS can be
change the mechanical action to an electrical signal
                                                                   transferred to the emergency deckedge control panel or
indicated by lights on the various operating panels.
                                                                   the central charging panel, and the catapult officer can
Microswitches                                                      direct operations on the flight deck.
                                                            4-44
                                                                                                INTERMEDIATE SLOPE
                                                                                                   WEDGE PANEL
                                       LEFT WEDGE
                                     OPERATING PANEL                                                                LOWER END
      LOWER END                                                        AMBIENT TEMPERATURE                       OPERATING PANEL
   OPERATING PANEL                                                        READOUT PANEL                          (REFER TO VIEW B)
   (REFER TO VIEW B)                              INTERMEDIATE SLOPE
                                                     WEDGE PANEL
                       OPERATING PANEL
                      (REFER TO VIEW A)                                                                               OPERATING PANEL
                                                            DESI REMOTE                                              (REFER TO VIEW A)
                                                             READOUTS
STEAM PRESSURE
        OFF
  N           B/
  G
  L           /A                                                                                  CATAPULT
                                                                                                                                  MILITARY
                                                                                                  SUSPEND
                                                                                                                                  POWER
                                                                                 CAT. SUSPEND      LOCAL
                                                                                MONITORING STA.
                                                                                                              CAT        BRIDLE              FINAL
                                                                                 CAT. SUSPEND
                                                                                                             READY      TENSION                        FIRE
                                                                                    PRE-FLT                                                  READY
                                                                                 CAT. SUSPEND
                                                                                 WATER BRAKE       MAN                            COMBAT
                                                                                                   GRAB                           POWER
                                                                                                    AFT
COMMAND
       CSV MATCH
                             AUTO
                              P.B.
                                        JOG
                                        P.B.                                                                           VIEW B
                                                     CSV
      CSV M3 MATCH                                  CONF
                              DEFEAT   HAND
                             INTERLK   WHEEL
VIEW A ABEf0454
                                                                   4-45
                                            MONITOR WEDGE PANEL
                                                            LOWER MONITOR PANEL
                                                                                                 ABEf0455
                                           Figure 4-54.—Monitor control console.
  MILITARY
POWER LIGHT
        COMBAT
      POWER LIGHT
ABEf0456
ABEf0457
Figure 4-55.—Military and combat power lights (typical). Figure 4-56.—Deckedge control panel.
                                                            4-46
Monitor Control Console                                           the pilot when an aircraft is in launch position. The
                                                                  lights are used to signal the pilot when to apply full
     The monitor control console (fig. 4-54) is used in           military power or combat power (afterburner) to
conjunction with the catapult-officer control console             aircraft engines during launching operations. These
and central charging panel during catapult operations.            lights are used when operating in the normal (ICCS)
The control console is of wraparound design and is                mode.
located facing forward in the ICCS. The console
consists of a monitor panel and a lower monitor panel             Deckedge Control Panel
for each of the two adjacent catapults. The center
section consists of a wedge panel containing a 24-hour                The deckedge control panel (fig. 4-56) is located on
clock. The switches and lights on the monitor panel and           the bulkhead in the catwalk outboard of the associated
lower monitor panel enable the monitor control console            catapult. The panel is located such that a clear and
operator to keep the launching officer advised of any             unimpeded view of the launching officer and hook up
malfunction occurring on that pair of catapults. During           crew is assured. The deckedge control panel is used
normal operation the green status lights are on. If a             when launching operation are conducted in the
malfunction occurs, the green lights go out and the red           deckedge mode with the launching officer directing
lights come on. The malfunction lights will indicate red          operations from the center deck station.
only when a malfunction occurs. A gauge on the
monitor panel also indicates steam pressure. In addition          Deckedge Signal Box
to monitoring catapult status, the monitor operator
retracts both shuttles and operates the NGL buffer                     The deckedge signal box (fig. 4-57) is located at
during aircraft abort procedures.                                 flight deck level adjacent to the deckedge control panel.
                                                                  Its function is to indicate the readiness of the catapult to
Military Power Lights and Combat Power Lights                     the launching officer during operations. The deckedge
                                                                  signal box is only used when operating in the deckedge
    Military-power and combat-power lights (fig.                  or central charging panel mode.
4-55) are located on the deck where they are visible to
                                                                                FIRE
                                                                  FINAL
                                                  MIL             READY
                                                 POWER
                                    CAT
                                   READY                                                         ABEf0458
                                                           4-47
Deck Catapult-Suspend Light                                        intensity of the deck signal lights. The panel enclosure
                                                                   also contains pressure switches, gauge shutoff valves,
    The deck catapult-suspend light (fig. 4-58) is                 and other piping components.
located on the edge of the flight deck outboard of its
                                                                        LEFT-FRONT PANEL.—The left-front panel
associated catapult and in clear view of all topside
                                                                   contains the switches and pressure gauges for the
catapult crew members. The light flashes red during a
                                                                   operation and monitoring of the catapult hydraulic
suspend situation to indicate to personnel on the flight
                                                                   system. The panel contains pressure gauges and
deck that a catapult-suspend situation exists.
                                                                   OFF-ON switches for the main hydraulic pumps, the
Water Brake Control Panel                                          booster pump, the circulating pump, and the lubrication
                                                                   pump. Also included are a gravity-tank fluid
     The water brake control panel (fig. 4-59) is located          temperature gauge, three main hydraulic accumulator
in the water brake pump room. In the event of an                   hydraulic-pressure gauges, an off-on pump delivery
emergency or malfunction of the water brakes, a switch             control switch, a primary pump selector switch, a
on the panel is used to suspend catapult operations and            retraction-engine suspend switch, a blowdown valve
it further protection for personnel when access to the             for the retraction-engine hydraulic fluid, and delivery
launching engine cylinders or water brake cylinder is              control fuses.
required.                                                               LEFT-INTERMEDIATE-FRONT PANEL.—
                                                                   The left-intermediate-front-panel contains the valves
Central Charging Panel                                             and pressure gauges for charging or blowing down
                                                                   catapult components that require air pressure for their
     The central charging panel (CCP) (fig. 4-60)                  operation. Gauges on the panel indicate the air pressure
provides a single, centralized station from which                  in the air side of the main hydraulic accumulator, the air
virtually all below decks catapult functions are                   flask, the air side of the cable-tensioner accumulator,
accomplished. The CCP consists of left-front panel,                the low-pressure-air supply, medium-pressure-air
left-intermediate-front panel, right-intermediate-front            supply, and the air side of the tensioner surge
panel, right-front panel, transfer-switch enclosure, and           accumulator. A dual gauge indicates the air pressure at
launch-valve-emergency-cutout-valve, which are
described in the following paragraphs. The deck-
                                                                                                              BOX
signal-light panel is located inside the central charging
panel, below the left-intermediate front panel. Controls
on the deck-signal-light panel are used to adjust the
LIGHT
                                                                                                       ULT
                                                                                                    TAP ON
                                                                                                 CA ENSI KE
                                                                                                  S P RA
                                                                                                SU ERB
                                                                                                  T
                                                                                                WA
SWITCH
                                    ABEf0459
                                                                                                                    ABEf0460
                                                            4-48
                    LEFT-INTERMEDIATE-FRONT PANEL
RIGHT-FRONT PANEL
                                                                                           TRANSFER SWITCH
                                                                                            ENCLOSURE-BOX
ABEf0461
the dome of the tensioner regulator and the pressure in            catapult and wet steam accumulator components. The
the hydraulic fluid side of the tensioner surge                    lowest row of lights and switches provide emergency
accumulator. Valves on the panel are used for charging             operational capability at the charging panel.
and blowing down the air flask, the air side of the main
hydraulic accumulator, the air side of the                         Transfer Switch Enclosure
cable-tensioner accumulator, the dome of the tensioner
regulator, and the air side of the tensioner surge                     The transfer switch enclosure is located on the
accumulator. There is also a valve to shut off the                 lower right end of the central charging panel. The
low-pressure-air supply. A bank of red and green                   switch enclosure contains switches that provides a
indicator lights on the panel indicates go and no-go               means of transferring catapult control functions for
indication for various catapult functions.                         operating in either the deckedge or central charging
                                                                   panel emergency mode. The other switches provide a
    RIGHT-INTERMEDIATE-FRONT PANEL.—                               means of transferring pri-fly, deck signal lights, central
The top portion of the right-intermediate-front panel              control station, and the catapult interlock switch out of
contains the pressure gauges and valves monitoring,                the catapult control circuit.
charging, and blowing down the nose gear launch
accumulators. The lower portion of the panel contains a            Launch Valve Emergency Cutout Valve
24-hour clock and the CSV setting controls.
    RIGHT-FRONT PANEL.—The right-front panel                           The launch valve emergency cutout valve is located
top portion contains the launch valve timer readout,               on the lower left end of the central charging panel. The
water brake elbow pressure gauges, the wet                         emergency cutout valve provides the central charging
accumulator pressure gauge, the main power (RC)                    panel operator with a positive control to prevent the
on/off switch and a panel with the steam fill/blowdown             launch valve from opening during a HANGFIRE
valve selectors. The lower portion of this panel contains          condition. When placed in the emergency position, the
lights and switches for operating and monitoring                   cutout valve electrically and hydraulically shifts the
                                                                   launch valve control system to the closed position.
                                                            4-49
Central Junction Box                                               throughout the various operational phases. The
                                                                   following is a description of the control system
    The central junction box (fig. 4-61) provides a                components.
single location for the catapult control system wiring
and relays. The terminal board and all wires are clearly           Deckedge Control Panel
marked for easy identification. Relay status lights and a
relay tester aid in troubleshooting electrical                         The deckedge control panel (figs. 4-62 and 4-63) is
malfunctions.                                                      located on the bulkhead in the catwalk outboard of the
                                                                   associated catapult. The panel is located such that a
CATAPULT CONTROL SYSTEM FOR CV-63,                                 clear and unimpeded view of the launching officer and
CVN-65, and CV-67                                                  hook up crew is assured. The deckedge control panel
                                                                   contains lights and switches used for catapult control
   The control system consists of those panels, lights,            during launching, retraction, and bridle tensioning
and switches that are used to operate a catapult                   phases.
 FUSE LIGHT
    UNIT
RELAY LIGHTS
         RELAY
        TESTER
RELAY
     TERMINAL
      BOARD
ABEf0462
                                                            4-50
                                         CAT INTERLOCK
                                            RELEASE                                     RETRACTION PERMISSIVE
                                                                                        RETRACTION COMPLETE
    NIGHT LIGHTING
                                                                                                          FIRE
FINAL READY
CAT SUSPEND
    DECK                                                                                               STANDBY
CAT SUSPEND
WATER BRAKE                                                                                            BRIDLE TENSION
CAT SUSPEND
   PRI-FLY                                                                                          FIRST READY
                                                                                                 CAT'S INTERLOCKED
   CAT SUSPEND
     CONSOLE
                                                                                          MANEUVER
                                           MANEUVER                                      SHUTTLE AFT
                                          SHUTTLE FWD
  RET ENG SUSPEND
                             RETRACT
                                                                                                         ABEf0463
              Figure 4-62.—Deckedge control panel (CVN-65 and CV-67).
                                                                                              TION
                                                                                      RETRAC E
                                                                                   LT   ENGIN ON
                                                                            CATAPU ON       ENSI
                                                                     LT        EN SI  SU SP
                                                              CATAPU ON    SUSP OLE
                                                                    SI      CONS
                                                    LT
                                            CATAPU ON        SUSPEN
                                     LT            SI           DECK
                              CATAPU ON    SUSPENLY
                                    SI
                             SUSPEN AKE      PRI-F
                                   BR
                             WATER
                                                                                                     G
                                                                                               ON EN
                                                                                         RACTI
                                                                                    N RET SPENSION
                                                                              ACTIO     SU
                                                                          RETR ETE
                                                                  ULT      COMPL
                                                            CATAP SION
                                                 ULTS      SUSP
                                                                EN
                                            CATAP CKED
                                                LO
                                  ULT     INTER
                             CATAP CK
                                 LO
                            INTER SE
                             RELEA                                                               VER
                                                                                          MANEU FWD
                                                                                               E
                                                                               ACTIO
                                                                                     N   ENGIN
                                                                           RETR SIVE
                                                                   FIRE         IS
                                                                           PERM
                                                         FINAL
                                               BY        READY
                                         STAND
                                 FIRST
                                 READY
                                                                                                  ER
                                                                                              EUV
                                                                                          MAN LE AFT
                                                                                             TT
                                                                                         SHU
                                                                               AC   T
                                                                          RETR
                                                                 FIRE
                                                   DBY
                                            STAN
                                   LE
                               BRID N
                                   IO
                              TENS
ABEf0464
                                              4-51
Main Control Console (CVN-65 and CV-67)                                    STEAM CHARGING PANEL.—The steam
                                                                      charging panel contains steam pressure and tem-
    The main control console (fig. 4-64) is used in                   perature gauges, status lights, and setting controls. The
conjunction with the deckedge control panel during                    setting controls provide a means of operating the fill
catapult operation. The control console consists of a                 valves automatically or by a manually set air signal. In
monitor panel, operating panel, steam panel, the launch               normal operations, the fill valves are operated in
valve cutout valve, and the transfer switch enclosure.                automatic charge. With automatic charge and charge
     MONITOR PANEL.—The monitor panel con-                            valve selected, the air signal to the fill valves is preset to
sists of a series of status lights on the top right side for          closely control the opening rates of the fill valves. The
various catapult system pressures. These lights will                  manually loading air regulator is used to control the air
indicate green for pressure within safe operating limits              signal to the blowdown valve and to the fill valves when
or red for out-of-limit pressures. Malfunction lights are             in manual charge.
located down the right side of the panel. These lights
                                                                      Transfer Switch Enclosure
will indicate red in the event of a malfunction. The
switches that energize these lights will also interrupt
                                                                          The transfer switch enclosure is located on the
the launching sequence. The monitor panel also
                                                                      lower right side of the main control console. The
contains the launch vale stroke timers, and the digital
                                                                      transfer switch enclosure provides a means of isolating
endspeed indicator.
                                                                      remote panels and switching control to the control
    OPERATING PANEL.—The operating panel is                           console. The transfer switches are rotated from
used in conjunction with the deckedge panel during                    NORMAL to EMERGENCY, as required, to isolate a
launching operations. It contains the lights,                         remote panel that has malfunctioned.
push buttons, and switches that are used for catapult
control during launching, retraction, and bridle                      Launch Valve Emergency Cutout Valve
tensioning phases. The operating panel also contains
the CSV setting controls.                                                 The launch valve emergency cutout valve is located
                                                                      on the lower left side of the main control console. The
                                                               4-52
emergency cutout valve provides the console operator a                Main Control Console (CV-63)
positive control to prevent the launch valve from
opening during a HANGFIRE condition. When placed                          The main control console (fig. 4-66) is used in
in the emergency position, the cutout valve electrically              conjunction with the deckedge control panel during
and hydraulically shifts the launch valve control system              catapult operation. The control console consists of an
to the closed position.                                               operating panel, an emergency panel, a malfunction
                                                                      panel, two gauge panels, a launch valve cutout valve,
Central Junction Box                                                  and the transfer switch enclosure.
                                                                          OPERATING PANEL.—The operating panel is
     The central junction provides a single location for
                                                                      used in conjunction with the deckedge panel during
the catapult control system wiring and relays. The
                                                                      launching operations. It contains the lights,
terminal board and all wires are clearly marked for easy
                                                                      push buttons, and switches that are used for catapult
identification. Relay status lights and a relay tester aid
                                                                      control during the launching sequence.
in troubleshooting electrical malfunctions.
                                                                          EMERGENCY PANEL.—The emergency panel
Deckedge Signal Box                                                   contains all the lights, push buttons, and switches are
                                                                      required to provide complete control during the
     The deckedge signal box (fig. 4-65) is located at                launching, retraction, and bridle tensioning phases.
flight deck level adjacent to the deckedge control panel.
Its function is to indicate the readiness of the catapult to              STEAM GAUGE PANEL.—The steam gauge
the launching officer during operations.                              panel contains a steam pressure gauge, CSV setting
                                                                      controls, digital endspeed indicator and launch valve
Water Brake Control Panel                                             timer displays.
                                                                          GAUGE PANEL.—The gauge panel provides a
    The water brake control panel (see fig. 4-59) is                  means of monitoring steam and hydraulic temperature
located in the water brake pump room. In the event of                 and pressures.
an emergency or malfunction of the water brakes, a
switch on the panel is used to suspend catapult                           MALFUNCTION PANEL.—The malfunction
operations and it is further protection for personnel                 panel contains lights that indicate the status of certain
when access to the launching engine cylinders or water                catapult components or systems. The hydraulic
brake cylinder is required.                                           pressure and the valve position malfunction lights are
                                                                                               E
                                                                                            FIR
                                                                                   AL
                                                                                FIN Y
                                                                                    D
                                                                                REA
                                                                      ND
                                                                  STA
                                                       ST           BY
                                                    FIR Y
                                                        D
                                              R     REA
                                         INTEK
                                         LOC
                                           ON
ABEf0466
                                                               4-53
                                                                                               CVS SETTING
                                                                                           CONTROLS AND DIGITAL
                                                                                           END SPEED INDICATOR
                                                                                                          LAUNCH VALVE
                                                                                                          STROKE TIMER
     STEAM GAUGE                                                                                          INSTALLATION
        PANEL
                                                                                                         GAUGE PANEL
  OPERATING PANEL                                                                                          (VIEW C)
     ( VIEW A)
                                                                                                            MALFUNCTION
                                                                                                               PANEL
  EMERGENCY                                                                                                   (VIEW D)
    PANEL
   (VIEW B)
                                                                                                               TRANSFER
                                                                                                                SWITCH
LAUNCH VALVE
                                                                                                              ENCLOSURE
CUTOUT VALVE
ABEf0467
red and will illuminate in the event of a malfunction.             NORMAL to EMERGENCY, as required, to isolate a
The blow through no-load light is amber and will                   remote panel that has malfunctioned.
illuminate when the blow through circuit is energized.
All other lights on this panel are green and will fail to          Launch Valve Emergency Cutout Valve
illuminate in the event of a malfunction.
                                                                        The launch valve emergency cutout valve is located
Transfer Switch Enclosure                                          on the lower left side of the main control console. The
                                                                   emergency cutout valve provides the console operator a
    The transfer switch enclosure is located on the                positive control to prevent the launch valve from
lower right side of the main control console. The                  opening during a HANGFIRE condition. When placed
transfer switch enclosure provides a means of isolating            in the emergency position, the cutout valve electrically
remote panels and switching control to the control                 and hydraulically shifts the launch valve control system
console. The transfer switches are rotated from                    to the closed position.
                                                            4-54
Central Charging Panel                                              accumulator. A dual gauge indicates the air pressure at
                                                                    the dome of the tensioner regulator and the pressure in
    The central charging panel (fig. 4-67) provides a               the hydraulic fluid side of the tensioner surge
single centralized station from which pneumatic and                 accumulator. Valves on the panel are used for charging
hydraulic systems are controlled and monitored.                     and blowing down the air flask, the air side of the main
     LEFT-FRONT PANEL.—The left-front panel                         hydraulic accumulator, the air side of the
contains the switches and pressure gauges for the                   cable-tensioner accumulator, the dome of the tensioner
operation and monitoring of the catapult hydraulic                  regulator, and the air side of the tensioner surge
system. The panel contains pressure gauges and                      accumulator. There is also a valve to shut off the
OFF-ON switches for the main hydraulic pumps, the                   low-pressure-air supply. A bank of red and green
booster pump, the circulating pump, and the lubrication             indicator lights on the panel indicates go and no-go
pump. Also included are a gravity-tank fluid                        indication for various catapult functions.
temperature gauge, three main hydraulic accumulator                     RIGHT-INTERMEDIATE-FRONT PANEL.—
hydraulic-pressure gauges, an off-on pump delivery                  The top portion of the right-intermediate-front panel
control switch, a primary pump selector switch, a                   contains the pressure gauges and valves monitoring,
retraction-engine suspend switch, a blowdown valve                  charging, and blowing down the nose gear launch
for the retraction-engine hydraulic fluid, and delivery             accumulators. The right-intermediate-front panel is
control fuses.                                                      installed on CVN-65 only.
     LEFT-INTERMEDIATE-FRONT PANEL.—
The left-intermediate-front-panel contains the valves                             REVIEW QUESTIONS
and pressure gauges for charging or blowing down
                                                                     Q1.     How are the launching engine cylinders
catapult components that require air pressure for their
                                                                             heated?
operation. Gauges on the panel indicate the air pressure
in the air side of the main hydraulic accumulator, the air           Q2.     How is the catapult trough steam smothering
flask, the air side of the cable-tensioner accumulator,                      actuated?
the low-pressure-air supply, medium-pressure-air                     Q3.     What is the purpose of the launch valve steam
supply, and the air side of the tensioner surge                              valve?
ABEf0468
                                                             4-55
 Q4.      What provides a means of measuring launch                                       SHUTTLE            SHUTTLE TRACK
          valve performance?
                                                                                                                        A
 Q5.      What is the purpose of the keeper valve?
                                                                     GRAB            PISTON
 Q6.      What component transfers the forward                                     AIRCRAFT PREPARED FOR LAUNCH
          motion of the pistons to the aircraft?                       1. SHUTTLE IN BATTERY POSITION
                                                                       2. AIRCRAFT ATTACHED TO SHUTTLE AND HOLDBACK UNIT
 Q7.      What system provides a means of lubricating                  3. TENSIONER AND GRAB EXERT FORWARD PRESSURE ON
          the launching engine cylinders?                                 SHUTTLE FOR TENSIONING. GRAB AND SHUTTLE UNLOCK
                    OPERATIONS                                                                                           D
    LEARNING OBJECTIVE: Describe the
    operation of a steam catapult.
                                                                               GRAB ADVANCES AND LATCHES TO SHUTTLE
     A steam fill-valve system controls the amount of
steam from the ship's boilers to the wet-steam
accumulator. Steam from the steam accumulator is then                                                                    E
released into the launching engine cylinders through                                                                 ABEf0401
the launch valve (the amount of steam used is varied by
a capacity selector valve [CSV] assembly that controls                        GRAB RETRACTS SHUTTLE TO BATTERY POSITION
the launch valve opening rate).
                                                                                 Figure 4-68.—Catapult operation.
    This surge of steam acts on a set of steam pistons
inside the launching engine cylinders. These pistons are             assembly to the battery position in preparation for the
connected to a shuttle that is attached to an aircraft. The          next aircraft launch.
force of the steam being released from the steam                         A integrated catapult control station (ICCS),
accumulator pushes the pistons forward, towing the                   central charging panel (CCP), main control console,
shuttle and aircraft at an increasing speed until aircraft           deckedge     control     panel,   retraction    engine
take-off is accomplished.                                            control/charging panel, and water brake panel are used
    The shuttle and steam pistons are stopped at the end             in conjunction to direct and integrate the catapult
of their "power stroke" as a tapered spear (fig. 4-68)               electrical and hydraulic systems functions and to
enters a set of water-filled cylinders, forcing the water            control the sequence of operations through a normal
to be "metered" out of the cylinders as the tapered spear            catapult launching cycle.
moves into them.                                                         Preliminary functional tests are performed by all
    After the shuttle and pistons have been stopped, a               operating personnel. These tests consist of at least two
grab is advanced forward along the catapult trough                   no-load launchings, during which the control system is
covers by means of the retraction engine, and attaches               operated through its complete cycle. The functioning of
to the shuttle assembly. The retraction engine is then               as many component parts of the catapult as possible
reversed and returns the grab, shuttle, and piston                   should be observed by personnel at the various stations
                                                              4-56
during the preliminary functional tests. All                              mechanical counter all match. If in
malfunctions must be reported to the maintenance                          disagreement with the command setting, the
officer, catapult officer, or catapult captain.                           charging panel operator shall not depress the
                                                                          set pushbutton until the setting discrepancy is
INTEGRATED CATAPULT CONTROL                                               resolved.
STATION (ICCS) NO-LOAD LAUNCHING
                                                                      7. The launching officer notifies pri-fly to make a
PROCEDURES
                                                                         5MC warning announcement of the impending
    No-load launches are conducted during the                            no load launches.
accomplishment of the preoperational MRCs. No-load                    8. The launching officer depresses the bridle
launches may also be required for post maintenance                       tensioning pushbutton, military power, and
catapult checkout.                                                       final ready pushbuttons.
                                                                      9. The safety observer shall ensure that the
                     WARNING                                             catapult track is clear and all safety personnel
    NO-load tests shall be conducted under the                           are indicating thumbs up and signal the
    supervision of a qualified launching officer. To                     launching officer to fire the catapult.
    prevent injury to personnel, safety lines shall                 10. The launching officer shall check for a clear
    be rigged along the deck inboard of the catapult                    launching area and depress the fire pushbutton.
    and safety personnel shall be stationed in the
    catwalk to keep unauthorized personnel clear                    11. Repeat the above procedures if necessary for
    of the catapult area.                                               subsequent no loads.
Perform the following steps for no-load test launchings:          INTEGRATED CATAPULT CONTROL
    1. With the catapult track clear, the safety                  STATION (ICCS) LAUNCHING PROCEDURES
       observer signals the monitor operator to
                                                                      Where the ICCS is the primary mode of controlling
       retract.
                                                                  fixed-wing-aircraft launching operations, the following
    2. With the grab and shuttle in battery position,             procedures apply:
       the safety observer signals the monitor to
                                                                       As the ship approaches the launch course, the air
       maneuver forward a sufficient distance to
                                                                  officer monitors the wind repeater and keeps the
       allow grab/shuttle separation (one to two feet is
                                                                  launching officer(s) advised of the relative wind
       adequate).
                                                                  velocity. When permission to launch aircraft is received
    3. With a crewmember manually releasing the                   from the bridge, a final check must be made to ensure
       grab latch, the safety observer signals the                relative wind is within the limits prescribed in the
       monitor operator to maneuver the grab to the               applicable launching bulletin. This is accomplished
       fully aft position.                                        before changing the rotating beacon(s) from red to
    4. The charging panel operator closes the fluid               green, which lights the pri-fly "go light" on the catapult
       supply valve to the bridle tensioner pressure              officers ICCS console, thereby clearing the launching
       regulator and blows off the air pressure in the            officer(s) to begin launching.
       dome of the bridle tensioner regulator, surge                  The following steps must be completed before the
       accumulator, and from the dome of the internal             launching officer assumes control of the aircraft.
       tensioning pressure regulator.
                                                                      1. Before aircraft tension, the topside safety petty
    5. The launching officer shall set the CSV                           officer performs the following:
       command setting to the required value and
                                                                          1) Ensures that appropriate            jet   blast
       ensure that the CSV is confirmed and that the
                                                                             deflectors are raised.
       CSV match lights come on.
                                                                          2) Supervises the attachment of the holdback
    6. The charging panel operator shall ensure that
                                                                             to aircraft.
       the CSV command setting is in the no-load
       range, and if in agreement with the command                        3) Checks the catapult area forward.
       setting, depresses the set pushbutton, and
                                                                          4) Gives the tension signal to the director.
       ensures that command, position, and
                                                           4-57
2. The catapult director performs the following:              catapult safety observer then signals “suspend”
                                                              to the launching officer in the ICCS.
    1) Checks the catapult area forward.
                                                              5. The catapult safety observer performs the
    2) Ensures that the appropriate jet blast
                                                                 following:
       deflectors are raised and that all personnel
       are clear of the jet blast and prop wash.                  1) Visually checks for proper aircraft hookup
                                                                     and alignment.
    3) Signals the launching officer in the ICCS
       to take tension, while signaling the pilot to              2) Ensures that the appropriate jet blast
       release brakes; the pilot in turn applies                     deflectors are raised and that all personnel
       power as specified in the NATOPS Manual                       are clear of the aircraft, jet blast, and prop
       for that type of aircraft.                                    wash.
    4) After the aircraft is tensioned on the                 6. The launching officer signals for final turnups
       catapult, signals the pilot, if required, to              by lighting the military power (green) light and
       raise the aircraft launch bar.                            the combat power (amber) light, if applicable,
                                                                 in that order. The pilot shall apply full power
    5) Turns the aircraft over to the ICCS deck
                                                                 and afterburner, if applicable, as these lights
       signal lights.
                                                                 are illuminated. When the pilot is ready for
3. After tension is taken, the top side safety petty             launch, he or she signifies by saluting the
   officer performs the following:                               catapult safety observer or, at night, by turning
    1) Inspects for proper aircraft hookup and                   the navigation lights on steady. The pilot
       alignment.                                                ensures that no exterior lights are on before the
                                                                 military power/combat power (afterburner
    2) Ensures that all personnel are clear of the               launch) lights are illuminated.
       aircraft on the catapult.
                                                              7. The catapult safety observer, after observing
    3) Inspects the launch bar to ensure proper                  the pilot's ready to launch signal performs the
       engagement with the catapult shuttle after                following:
       full power application and catapult
       tensioning are completed.                                  1) Makes a final scan of the aircraft.
    4) Signals "thumbs up" to the catapult safety                 2) Checks for a "thumbs up" signal from the
       observer with a hand or wand signal if all                    catapult topside safety petty officer and the
       conditions are satisfactory for launch.                       squadron's aircraft inspector.
4. The squadron aircraft inspector performs the                   3) Signals "thumbs up" to the launching
   following:                                                        officer in the ICCS with a hand or green
                                                                     wand signal if all conditions are
    1) Makes a final inspection of the aircraft for                  satisfactory for the launch.
       proper configuration; flaps; trim settings;
       leaks; and loose panels, doors, or hatches.            8. Upon receiving the catapult safety observer's
                                                                 "thumbs up" signal and before firing the
    2) Signals "thumbs up" to the catapult safety                catapult, the launching officer performs the
       observer with a hand or wand signal if all                following:
       conditions are satisfactory for launch.
                                                                  1) Checks for a pri-fly go light on his or her
                                                                     console.
                 CAUTION
                                                                  2) Scans the normal area of visibility.
If there is any doubt in the mind of the topside
safety petty officer, director, or squadron                       3) Checks the catapult officer console for
aircraft inspector as to satisfactory hookup or                      satisfactory catapult launch condition.
aircraft configuration, he or she must so                         4) Checks deck and traffic forward.
indicate to the catapult safety observer by
initiating a crossed arm suspend signal (day) or                  5) Checks deck pitch.
a horizontal wand movement (night). The                           6) Ensures the catapult safety observer is
                                                                     giving the "thumbs up" signal.
                                                       4-58
   9. After ensuring that all conditions are                                          WARNING
      satisfactory, the launching officer depresses the
                                                                     The main control console operator shall not
      fire button. If, after coming to full power on the
                                                                     place the catapult in first ready until the CSV
      catapult, the pilot desires to stop the launch, he
                                                                     setting has been made, verified and the catapult
      or she does so by shaking the head negatively,
                                                                     is ready for no load launches.
      rather than by giving the "thumbs down"
      signal. At the same time, the pilot transmits                  6. The console operator shall ensure that the CSV
      "suspend, suspend." At night, the visual signal                   command setting is in the no-load range and
      also consists of not turning on the navigation                    depress the set pushbutton. The console
      lights. The catapult safety observer signals                      operator then ensures that command, position,
      suspend to the launching officer in the ICCS,                     and mechanical counter all matches and places
      using standard hand or wand signals.                              the catapult in first ready. If in disagreement
                                                                        with the command setting, the console operator
NON-INTEGRATED CATAPULT CONTROL                                         shall not depress the set pushbutton and shall
STATION (ICCS) NO-LOAD LAUNCHING                                        leave the catapult in safe until the setting
PROCEDURES                                                              discrepancy is resolved.
                                                                     7. The launching officer shall ensure that the CSV
    No-load launches are conducted during the
                                                                        has been properly set by ensuring a green CSV
accomplishment of the preoperational MRCs. No-
                                                                        status light.
Loads launches may also be required for post
maintenance catapult checkout.                                       8. The launching officer notifies pri-fly to make a
                                                                        5MC warning announcement of the impending
                    WARNING                                             no load launches.
   NO-Loads tests shall be conducted under the                       9. The launching officer checks that safety lines
   supervision of a qualified launching officer. To                     are properly rigged and safety personnel are on
   prevent injury to personnel, safety lines shall                      station. The launching officer then signals the
   be rigged along the deck inboard of the catapult                     deckedge operator to place the catapult in final
   and safety personnel shall be stationed in the                       ready.
   catwalk to keep unauthorized personnel clear                     10. The deckedge operator presses the bridle
   of the catapult area.                                                tensioning and standby pushbuttons.
    Perform the following steps for no-load test                    11. The console operator observes the standby
launchings:                                                             light come on, ensures that all conditions are
   1. With the catapult track clear, the launching                      satisfactory and depresses the final ready
      officer signals the deckedge operator to retract.                 pushbutton.
   2. With the grab and shuttle in battery position,                12. The deckedge operator observes the final ready
      the topside safety petty officer signals the                      light come on and gives the final ready signal.
      deckedge operator to maneuver forward a                       13. The launching officer shall check for a clear
      sufficient distance to allow grab/shuttle                         launching area and give the fire signal.
      separation (one to two feet is adequate).
                                                                    14. The deckedge operator first looks forward and
   3. With a crewmember manually releasing the                          aft to ensure a clear launch area and then
      grab latch, the topside petty officer signals the                 presses the fire pushbutton.
      deck edge operator to maneuver the grab to the
                                                                    15. Repeat the above procedures if necessary for
      fully aft position.
                                                                        subsequent no loads.
   4. The retraction engine operator closes the fluid
      supply valves to the bridle tensioner pressure              NON-INTEGRATED CATAPULT CONTROL
      regulator and the internal tensioning pressure              STATION (ICCS) LAUNCHING PROCEDURES
      regulator.
                                                                      The following steps must be completed before the
   5. The launching officer shall set the CSV
                                                                  launching officer assumes control of the aircraft.
      command setting to the no load value.
                                                           4-59
1. Before aircraft tension, the topside safety petty               hand rapidly for full engine turnup of the
   officer performs the following:                                 aircraft.
    1) Ensures that appropriate          jet   blast           6. When the catapult officer starts giving the full
       deflectors are raised.                                     power turnup (two-finger) signal, the
    2) Checks the catapult area forward.                          launching operation proceeds.
    3) Supervises the attachment of the holdback               7. The deckedge operator, observing the catapult
       to aircraft.                                               officer's full power turnup signal, immediately
                                                                  presses the standby button. As soon as the
    4) Gives the tension signal to the director.
                                                                  standby (green) light comes on at the deckedge
2. The catapult director performs the following:                  panel, he or she holds two fingers overhead.
    1) Checks the catapult area forward.                          The console operator, observing that the
                                                                  standby (green) light is on at his or her console,
    2) Ensures that the appropriate jet blast
                                                                  immediately checks all gauges and lights. If
       deflectors are raised and that all personnel
                                                                  everything is ok, he or she puts the catapult into
       are clear of the jet blast and prop wash.
                                                                  final ready condition.
    3) Signals the deckedge operator to take
       tension, while signaling the pilot to                   8. When the final ready condition is reached, all
       RELEASE BRAKES; the pilot in turn                          final ready (red) lights come on, and the
       applies power as specified in the NATOPS                   launching operation continues. As soon as the
       Manual for that type of aircraft.                          final ready (red) light comes on at the deckedge
                                                                  panel, the deckedge operator immediately
3. When the catapult director gives the hand                      holds both hands open above his or her head.
   signal that tension is to be taken, the deckedge
   operator immediately presses the BRIDLE                     9. With the aircraft at full power, the pilot checks
   TENSION button and verbally relays the                         all instruments and gauges. If everything is ok,
   message to the console operator via the                        he or she gets set and indicates ready by turning
   sound-powered phone by saying the words                        his or her head slightly toward the catapult
   TAKING TENSION. Under normal conditions                        officer, executes a right- or left-hand salute,
   this is the last word spoken until the launch is               and then positions his or her head against the
   complete. This is to prevent misunderstanding;                 cockpit headrest. The pilot may refuse to be
   for example, misfire, hangfire, fire.                          launched by shaking his or her head negatively,
                                                                  in which case the catapult officer gives the
4. Only after correct bridle tension has been                     suspension signal.)
   applied is control of the aircraft passed, as
   follows: The director, upon completing bridle              10. The launch signal is given only after the
   tension, immediately passes control of the                     catapult has reached final ready and the pilot of
   aircraft by pointing both hands toward the                     the aircraft indicates he or she is ready. The
   catapult officer.                                              catapult officer ensures that the pilot's head is
                                                                  back against the headrest, checks that the deck
                                                                  is clear forward, and then executes the fire
                    NOTE                                          signal. Upon receiving the fire signal, the
Aircraft to be launched receive a preliminary                     deckedge operator makes a final check of the
engine check before being spotted on the                          flight deck and catwalks. If they are clear, he or
catapult; therefore, normal operational                           she depresses the fire push button.
procedure is for the catapult officer to go
directly into the full power turnup signal after                                 CAUTION
the aircraft has been tensioned.
                                                               The deckedge operator must not anticipate the
5. The catapult officer verifies steam pressure                fire signal; if any discrepancy in aircraft
   readings on the gauges at the center deck panel.            hookup is noted or if the deck and catwalks are
   The catapult officer observes the first ready               not clear, he or she must NOT fire but must
   signal from the deckedge operator, and                      suspend and notify the catapult officer of the
   acknowledges the signal by holding two                      discrepancy.
   fingers overhead, hesitates, and then rotates the
                                                       4-60
INTEGRATED CATAPULT CONTROL                                                   2) The launching officer depresses the bridle
STATION (ICCS) SUSPEND                                                           tension pushbutton to position the shuttle
PROCEDURES                                                                       forward of the launch bar. When the shuttle
                                                                                 has moved forward of the launch bar, the
     A catapult launch can be halted at any time up until                        launching officer shall momentarily press
the fire pushbutton has been depressed by actuating a                            the maneuver aft pushbutton.
catapult suspend switch. Suspend switches are located                         3) The safety observer shall step in front of
at pri-fly, launching officer’s console, monitor console,                        the aircraft and in view of the pilot, give the
central charging panel, and at the water brake station.                          throttle back signal.
                                                                          7. For aircraft with manual launch bar (E-2 and
                          NOTE                                               C-2):
    If the suspend switch at the water brake station                          1) After the shuttle has moved aft, the safety
    is actuated during catapult operations,                                      observer shall ensure that the catapult is in
    breaking tension by energizing maneuver aft                                  the suspend condition, step in front of the
    cannot occur. If this switch initiated a suspend                             aircraft and in full view of the pilot, give
    action, the charging panel operator shall                                    the throttle back signal.
    actuate suspend and direct the water brake                                2) With the aircraft at idle power the safety
    station to release the water brake suspend.                                  observer directs the topside safety petty
     Actuation of any catapult suspend switch lights a                           officer to approach the aircraft and
red flashing light mounted at the edge of the flight deck                        manually hold the launch bar high enough
near the battery position for the associated catapult. The                       to permit shuttle clearance.
operator initiating the suspend must immediately                              3) With the launch bar held clear, the safety
inform the launching officer of the reason for the                               observer gives the bridle tension signal to
suspend. The launching officer shall determine the                               the launching officer.
action to be taken for resolution. If the suspend action                      4) The launching officer depresses the bridle
occurs prior to aircraft hookup, the aircraft shall be held                      tension pushbutton to position the shuttle
short of the hookup position until the problem has been                          forward of the launch bar. When the shuttle
rectified or the catapult is placed in the down status. If a                     has moved forward of the launch bar, the
suspend occurs after an aircraft has been tensioned, the                         launching officer shall momentarily
following apply:                                                                 depress the maneuver aft pushbutton.
    1. The safety observer signals suspend to the pilot                   8. At this time, if the condition that initiated the
       and other members of the aircraft launching                           suspend action has been corrected and the
       team.                                                                 aircraft and catapult are both up, the shuttle
                                                                             may be maneuvered aft, launch bar lowered
    2. The launching officer shall immediately                               and the aircraft hooked up to the catapult.
       depress the suspend pushbutton.
    3. The safety observer shall ensure that the deck                 NON-INTEGRATED CATAPULT CONTROL
       suspend light is on and signal the launching                   STATION (ICCS) SUSPEND PROCEDURES
       officer to maneuver aft.
                                                                          A catapult launch can be halted at any time up until
    4. The launching officer depresses and holds the                  the fire pushbutton has been depressed by actuating a
       maneuver aft pushbutton until the grab and                     catapult suspend switch. Suspend switches are located
       shuttle are moved fully aft.                                   at pri-fly, deckedge, main control console, and the
    5. After the shuttle has moved aft, the safety                    water brake station.
       observer signals the pilot to raise launch bar.
    6. For aircraft with NGL selector switch (F/A 18                                          NOTE
       and S-3):                                                          If the suspend switch at the water brake station
        1) With the launch bar raised, the safety                         is actuated during catapult operations,
           observer gives the bridle tension signal to                    breaking tension by energizing maneuver aft
           the launching officer.                                         cannot occur. If this switch initiated a suspend
                                                                          action, the main control console operator shall
                                                               4-61
    actuate suspend and direct the water brake                              3) With the launch bar held clear, the
    station to release the water brake suspend.                                launching officer gives the bridle tension
                                                                               signal to the deckedge operator.
     The operator initiating the suspend must
immediately inform the launching officer of the reason                      4) The deckedge operator depresses the
for the suspend. The launching officer shall determine                         bridle tension pushbutton to position the
the action to be taken for resolution. If the suspend                          shuttle forward of the launch bar. When the
action occurs prior to aircraft hookup, the aircraft shall                     shuttle has moved forward of the launch
be held short of the hookup position until the problem                         bar, the deckedge operator shall
has been rectified or the catapult is placed in the down                       momentarily depress the maneuver aft
status. If a suspend occurs after an aircraft has been                         pushbutton.
tensioned, the following apply:
                                                                        7. At this time, if the condition that initiated the
    1. The launching officer signals suspend to the                        suspend action has been corrected and the
       pilot and other members of the aircraft                             aircraft and catapult are both up, the shuttle
       launching team.                                                     may be maneuvered aft, launch bar lowered
                                                                           and the aircraft hooked up to the catapult.
    2. The deckedge operator shall immediately
       actuate the suspend switch and give the
                                                                    INTEGRATED CATAPULT CONTROL
       suspend signal.
                                                                    STATION (ICCS) HANGFIRE
    3. The launching officer signals the deckedge                   PROCEDURES
       operator to maneuver aft.
                                                                        In the event the catapult does not fire within 10
    4. After the shuttle has moved aft, the launching
                                                                    seconds after the fire pushbutton is depressed, a
       officer signals the pilot to raise launch bar.
                                                                    hangfire exists. At this time, the launch sequence must
    5. For aircraft with NGL selector switch (F/A 18                be safety stopped and the aircraft removed from the
       and S-3):                                                    catapult. The actions to be taken and the order in which
                                                                    they are accomplished are paramount to the success of
        1) With the launch bar raised, the launching
                                                                    the procedure.
           officer gives the bridle tension signal to the
           deckedge operator.
                                                                                         WARNING
        2) The deckedge operator depresses the
           bridle tension pushbutton to position the                    If a hangfire occurs, the execution of the
           shuttle forward of the launch bar. When the                  hangfire procedure must be accomplished.
           shuttle has moved forward of the launch                      Even if the cause of the hangfire is quickly
           bar, the deckedge operator shall momen-                      determined and can be easily resolved, the
           tarily press the maneuver aft pushbutton.                    actions of all topside crew members and pilot
                                                                        are not known and interrupted firing of the
        3) The launching officer shall step in front of
                                                                        catapult could have catastrophic consequences.
           the aircraft and in view of the pilot, give the
                                                                        The only corrective action authorized is the
           throttle back signal.
                                                                        performance of the hangfire procedure.
    6. For aircraft with manual launch bar (E-2 and
                                                                        1. The launching officer depresses the suspend
       C-2):
                                                                           switch and transmits to the charging panel
        1) After the shuttle has moved aft, the                            operator via the monitor operator, “rotate the
           launching officer shall ensure that the                         emergency cutout valve, rotate the emergency
           catapult is in the suspend condition, step in                   cutout valve.” The launching officer shall then
           front of the aircraft and in full view of the                   inform the safety observer of the hangfire
           pilot, give the throttle back signal.                           condition verbally and by hand signals in
                                                                           daytime or the red wand hangfire signal at
        2) With the aircraft at idle power the
                                                                           night.
           launching officer directs the topside safety
           petty officer to approach the aircraft and                   2. The safety observer shall remain in the
           manually hold the launch bar high enough                        crouched position and shall not take any action
           to permit shuttle clearance.                                    toward the removal of the aircraft until the
                                                             4-62
       shuttle has moved aft and assurance is received            hangfire exists. At this time, the launch sequence must
       that the catapult is safe.                                 be stopped and the aircraft removed from the catapult.
                                                                  The actions to be taken and the order in which they are
   3. The charging panel operator shall perform the
                                                                  accomplished are paramount to the success of the
      following actions in exact order:
                                                                  procedure.
       1) Depress the suspend pushbutton.
       2) Remove the cotter pin and unscrew the pin
                                                                                        WARNING
          from the emergency cutout valve.
       3) Rotate the emergency cutout valve to the                    If a hangfire occurs, the execution of the
          emergency position.                                         hangfire procedure must be accomplished.
       4) Depress and hold the maneuver aft                           Even if the cause of the hangfire is quickly
          pushbutton for 15 seconds.                                  determined and can be easily resolved, the
       5) Report to the launching officer via the                     actions of all topside crew members and pilot
          monitor operator that the catapult is safe.                 are not known and interrupted firing of the
                                                                      catapult could have catastrophic consequences.
   4. The launching officer transmits verbally that
                                                                      The only corrective action authorized is the
      the catapult is safe and signals the safety
                                                                      performance of the hangfire procedure.
      observer a thumbs up in daytime or a red wand
      signal at night.                                                1. The launching officer shall remain in the
                                                                         crouched position and signals in exact order:
   5. If the shuttle did not move aft during the
      preceding steps, the launching officer shall                        1) Suspend
      direct the charging panel/retraction engine                         2) Hangfire
      operator, via the monitor operator, to depress
      and hold the manual override on the maneuver                        3) Maneuver aft
      aft valve for 15 seconds.                                       2. The launching officer shall remain in the
   6. After receiving assurance that the catapult is                     crouched position and shall not take any action
      safe and observing that the shuttle is aft, the                    toward the removal of the aircraft until the
      safety observer steps in front of the aircraft and                 shuttle has moved aft and assurance is received
      in view of the pilot, gives the throttle back                      that the catapult is safe.
      signal. The normal suspend/abort are                            3. The deckedge operator depresses the suspend
      accomplished for aircraft removal from the                         switch and transmits to the main control
      catapult.                                                          console operator, “rotate the emergency cutout
   7. After aircraft removal from the catapult has                       valve, rotate the emergency cutout valve.”
      been accomplished, the launching officer shall                  4. The main control console operator shall
      set the CSV command to a no-load setting and                       perform the following actions in exact order:
      ensure that CSV confirmed and match lights
      come on.                                                            1) Depress the suspend pushbutton.
   8. The emergency cutout valve shall remain in the                      2) Remove the cotter pin and unscrew the pin
      emergency position until the maintenance                               from the emergency cutout valve.
      officer authorizes rotation of the valve to the                     3) Rotate the emergency cutout valve to the
      normal position.                                                       emergency position.
   9. The catapult is placed in a down status until the                   4) Depress and hold the maneuver aft
      cause of the hangfire is determined, corrected,                        pushbutton for 15 seconds.
      and two satisfactory no-load launches
      accomplished.                                                       5) Report verbally to the deckedge operator
                                                                             that the catapult is safe.
NON-INTEGRATED CATAPULT CONTROL                                       5. The deckedge operator upon receiving the
STATION (ICCS) HANGFIRE PROCEDURES                                       assurance from the main control console
                                                                         operator, signals to the launching officer, the
    In the event the catapult does not fire within 10                    hangfire signal followed by thumbs up in
seconds after the fire pushbutton is depressed, a                        daytime or a red wand signal at night.
                                                           4-63
    6. If the shuttle did not move aft during the                        Precaution should be taken by the pilot not to taxi
       preceding steps, the deckedge operator shall                  hard against the holdback unit. This may result in a
       direct the retraction engine operator to depress              premature release.
       and hold the manual override on the maneuver
                                                                         At no time are personnel to walk in front of a
       aft valve for 15 seconds.
                                                                     tensioned aircraft.
    7. After receiving assurance that the catapult is
                                                                         If operation of the catapult is suspended for any
       safe and observing that the shuttle is aft, the
                                                                     reason, bridle tension should be released and the
       launching officer steps in front of the aircraft
                                                                     aircraft released from the shuttle.
       and in view of the pilot, gives the throttle back
       signal. The normal suspend/abort are                               The shuttle and grab must not be moved along the
       accomplished for aircraft removal from the                    catapult track until the track slot has been inspected and
       catapult.                                                     found to be clear of obstructions and all adjacent areas
                                                                     are clear of loose gear. Using the maneuver forward and
    8. After aircraft removal from the catapult has
                                                                     aft push buttons, slowly move pistons forward and aft
       been accomplished, the launching officer shall
                                                                     while all sheaves are visually checked to ensure the
       set the CSV command to a no-load setting.
                                                                     cables are not sliding over any locked sheaves.
    9. The main control console operator shall
                                                                         All personnel must be kept out of areas forward of
       depress the set pushbutton.
                                                                     an aircraft positioned on the catapult, and clear of the
  10. The emergency cutout valve shall remain in the                 shuttle track area during a no-load firing. All personnel
      emergency position until the maintenance                       must be kept clear of the area immediately behind the
      officer authorizes rotation of the valve to the                jet blast deflectors during aircraft turnups and
      normal position.                                               launching.
  11. The catapult is placed in a down status until the                  During night operations, do not attempt to speed up
      cause of the hangfire is determined, corrected,                the prelaunch check of catapult components or take
      and two satisfactory no-load launches                          unnecessary chances in an effort to maintain rapid
      accomplished.                                                  aircraft launching intervals. Sufficient time should be
                                                                     taken to double-check each step to prevent accidents
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS                                                   due to faulty hookups, misinterpreted signals, and other
                                                                     causes.
     There are certain safety precautions that must be
observed by catapult-operating personnel, maintenance                ICCS, CCP, Deckedge and/or Main Control
personnel, deck personnel, pilots, and other personnel               Console
stationed in the catapult area.
                                                                         Retraction must not be undertaken unless the water
Flight Deck                                                          brakes are operating properly and the grab and shuttle
                                                                     are latched. During preheating and throughout
     Bridle (deck) tensioner pressure, as determined by              launching operations, the difference in elongation
calibration, must be precisely adjusted and maintained               between the two launching engine cylinders must NOT
at all times. Pressures in excess of those specified may             exceed 1 inch. The catapult must NOT be fired with the
cause premature holdback.                                            shuttle out of BATTERY.
    In the event of a malfunction, suspend, or hangfire,                 The shuttle must NOT be retracted with steam in
the signal for throttle back must NOT be given to the                accumulators unless the water brakes are functioning.
pilot until bridle tension has been released and the
launch bar is raised.                                                    Do not advance the grab with spears out of the
                                                                     water brakes because possible grab latch damage may
     When attaching the aircraft to the shuttle, extreme             result, due to impact. Therefore, use the maneuver
care must be taken so that the launch bar properly                   forward push button to advance the grab until it engages
engages the shuttle. The catapult officer must ensure                the shuttle.
that the aircraft is properly tensioned prior to launching.
                                                              4-64
Water Brakes                                                           The catapult must NOT be operated with any
                                                                   known broken lockwires, loose or cracked components,
    If the water-brake cylinder elbow pressure drops               major hydraulic leakage, defective reeving, or electrical
below minimum value the water brakes should be                     control malfunction.
suspended and the CCP/main control console operator
                                                                        During any type of launching, live steam escapes
notified immediately. The malfunctioning water-brake
                                                                   from the track and brake areas. As this steam can cause
pump should be secured and the standby pump started.
                                                                   severe scalding of exposed areas of the body, personnel
     Do not allow excessive oil to accumulate on top of            in the area must avoid contact with it. When the catapult
the water in the water-brake reservoir. Skim off the oil,          is in operating status, exposed metallic parts, such as
or remove it by adding fresh water and allowing the oil            track covers, launching and exhaust valves, and steam
to flow out the overflow drain.                                    supply piping, may be hot enough to burn exposed
                                                                   areas of the body on contact. Therefore, operating
                        NOTE                                       personnel with duties in these areas should be equipped
                                                                   with appropriate protective clothing.
        During in-port periods, do not skim the
    water-brake tanks or allow the water level to                       Aircraft launchings must NOT be made if the
    reach the overflow pipe. Maintain the water                    required minimum cylinder elongation has not been
    level by use of bottom tank drains. This is to                 attained. An exception to this rule may be made under
    prevent oil from being dumped into harbors.                    emergency       conditions    when     wind-over-deck
                                                                   requirements have been increased as specified in
Retraction Engine                                                  applicable Aircraft Launching Bulletins.
                                                                       Aircraft must not be launched at weights and wind
     All loose gear and tools must be kept clear of the            requirements other than those specified in applicable
retraction engine and cable system. Maintain all                   Aircraft Launching Bulletins. Maximum loading of
pressures at predetermined settings.                               aircraft as specified in the NATOPS Manual for each
    If any malfunction is observed during the advance              type of aircraft, must be adhered to at all times.
of the grab or the retraction of the shuttle and grab,                 Inspect all pumps and their limit switches and
immediately SUSPEND the retract engine and notify                  safety valves. Failure of safety devices can result in
the CCP/main console operator. All sheaves must be                 dangerous overpressures if the pump continues to
inspected for freedom of motion before beginning a                 operate. This condition may result in rupture of
series of launchings.                                              hydraulic pneumatic lines and danger to personnel.
General                                                            SECURING THE CATAPULT
    Operating personnel should wear appropriate                        At the completion of aircraft launching operations,
protective clothing to prevent burns from steam or from            the catapult officer shall decide what state of catapult
contact with hot metallic surfaces. Earplugs should be             readiness will be maintained. Depending on
worn in areas of high noise level.                                 operational requirements, one of the following
    The entire hydraulic system must be vented                     readiness conditions will be established:
thoroughly and frequently, particularly after extended
periods of idleness. Air in the fluid system may cause             Ready
unpredictable variations in catapult performance and
delays in actuation of operating components.                            The order to maintain the catapult in a READY
                                                                   condition should be given when launching operations
    Combustible and volatile fluids and materials must             are intermittent or when certain conditions make it
be kept away from heated catapult parts to reduce the              necessary to keep the catapult in a state of preparedness
hazard of fire and explosion. Adequate ventilation must            for launching within seconds after an order is given.
be provided below flight deck level to prevent the
accumulation of explosive vapors.                                      In the READY condition, the catapult is kept in a
                                                                   fully operational status, as between launching cycles.
    If a hangfire occurs, personnel must not pass
forward of the aircraft until all danger of a delayed
launching has passed.
                                                            4-65
Standby                                                                  3. Reduce steam pressure in the                steam
                                                                            accumulator to atmospheric pressure.
    If the order for the STANDBY condition of
                                                                         4. Open the retraction-engine           accumulator
securing is given, it usually comes after the day's
                                                                            blowdown valve.
launching operations are completed and there is no
possibility of additional launching within 12 hours.                     5. Station a safety person at the ICCS, CCP, main
                                                                            control console and deckedge control manning
    The post-launch duties and inspection must be
                                                                            sound-powered telephones to prevent
performed according to the MRCs.
                                                                            tampering with catapult controls.
Shutdown                                                                 6. Station a safety person at the retraction engine
                                                                            and the water-brake tank, manning
    The order for SHUTDOWN condition of securing                            sound-powered telephones.
the catapult is given when the catapult is placed out of
service for maintenance or when the ship is in port.                     7. Tag the steam-smothering valve "out of
                                                                            service."
Cold Iron
                                                                         8. Station a safety person on the flight deck (in the
    When the catapult will not be required for                              shuttle area) to prevent accidental movement of
launching operations for an extended period of time, or                     the shuttle while personnel are in the
the steam system and preheat system must be secured                         water-brake tank.
and the components allowed to cool down.
                                                                          The preceding safety instructions must be strictly
INSPECTIONS AND MALFUNCTIONS                                         followed. Under any conditions when inspection of the
                                                                     water brakes area is undertaken, it is imperative that the
     The entire catapult should be kept as clean as                  control system remain in a SAFE position (exhaust
possible. It should be wiped down daily to remove                    valve open, grab aft).
excess grease, oil, and dirt. All catapult personnel
should be constantly alert for any unusual sound or                  Malfunctions
action of the machinery. Report any unusual condition
to the catapult officer for immediate investigation.                      This section provides operating personnel with a
                                                                     guide to assist in isolating and correcting causes of
Periodic Inspections                                                 malfunctions. During aircraft launch operations,
                                                                     malfunctions may occur that can be rapidly corrected if
     Prior to the first launching of each day's operations,          the cause is correctly determined. In other cases,
execute the PMS preoperational inspection according                  corrective action may require extensive repairs, and it is
to the MRCs.                                                         important that operating personnel rapidly isolate the
                                                                     cause of the malfunction in order to inform the catapult
    After each day's operation, perform the PMS                      officer if the catapult must be placed out of service.
postoperational inspection according to the MRCs.                         When a malfunction occurs, the catapult must be
    Other inspections must be conducted in addition to               put in a SAFE condition before corrective action is
preoperational and postoperational. These inspections                attempted, to prevent accidental launching of aircraft or
are also accomplished through the use of MRCs.                       injury to personnel.
                                                                          To property correct any malfunction(s) all primary
    Prior to conducting an inspection or maintenance                 causes should be checked first to quickly isolate the
on catapult equipment where an injury could occur                    malfunction to a specific system. The secondary causes
from careless operation, make sure the following safety              can then be checked to determine which component(s)
precautions have been accomplished in the order                      within the system caused the malfunction.
indicated:                                                                All preoperational and post operational inspection
    1. Disconnect the grab from the shuttle and move                 procedures that apply to a specific system or station of
       it fully aft.                                                 the catapult are to be conducted and completed by the
                                                                     person or persons assigned the duty. For detailed
    2. Close the main steam supply to the steam
                                                                     inspection procedures, the ABE must consult the
       accumulator.
                                                                     applicable MRCs or technical manuals.
                                                              4-66
            REVIEW QUESTIONS                                                       SUMMARY
                                                                   We have described functions and operations of the
                                                               major catapult systems, descriptions of ICCS, central
Q13.   When are no loads conducted?
                                                               charging panels, main control consoles, and general
                                                               maintenance procedures. For a more detailed study of
Q14.   A hangfire exists when the catapult does not            the catapult systems and components, see the
       fire within what amount of time after the fire          applicable NAVAIR technical manuals with the latest
       pushbutton has been pressed?                            revisions.
                                                        4-67
                                                 CHAPTER 5
     The associated launching equipment discussed in                 The jet blast deflector (JBD) installation consists of
this chapter is used in conjunction with catapults and           water-cooled panels that are mounted flush with the
arresting gear. This equipment includes the jet blast            flight deck. The panels are raised and lowered by
deflectors and nose gear launch equipment.                       hydraulic cylinders connected to mechanical operating
                                                                 gear. When raised, the JBDs serve to protect personnel,
           JET BLAST DEFLECTORS                                  equipment and other aircraft from the hot jet exhaust
                                                                 created by an aircraft spotted on the catapult. Seawater,
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Identify the                            supplied from the ship’s firemain, is continuously
    components of the jet blast deflectors.                      circulated through the modules of each panel assembly
    Describe the operation of the jet blast                      to prevent overheating. Figure 5-1 shows the basic
    deflectors. Describe the emergency operations                operation of JBDs.
    of the jet blast deflectors.
WATER IN
WATER RETURN
ABEF0501
                                                           5-1
Jet Blast Deflector Assembly                                     the Mk 7 Mod 1 JBD assembly has four panel
                                                                 assemblies and two sets of operating gear. The Mk 7
   The JBD assembly (fig. 5-2) consists of a series of           Mod 2 JBD contain two additional sideplate cooling
water-cooled panels and operating gear assemblies.               panels. The sideplate cooling panels provide additional
The Mk 7 Mod 0/2 JBD assembly is comprised of six                cooling which helps to prevent warping of the JBD
panel assemblies with three sets of operating gear while         panels.
(MK 7 MOD 1)
                                                           5-2
    Regardless of the JBD installation, the operation is           shaft. This method of attachment permits raising and
the same. A pair of JBD panels is connected to a set of            lowering the JBD panels in pairs. The trunnion shaft is
operating gear. The panel assemblies can be raised                 mounted and supported by the three bearing block
independently or simultaneously with others in the                 assemblies. The two hydraulic cylinders are connected
same installation. By connecting a pair of panels to a set         to the to the trunnion shaft by means of the crank
of operating gear, one cylinder can raise or lower a pair          assemblies.
of JBD panels in the event of a failure to the other
                                                                        Movement of the hydraulic cylinder piston rods
cylinder.
                                                                   rotates the shaft. Rotation of the trunnion shaft extends
                                                                   or retracts the linkage to raise or lower the JBD panels.
Operating Gear Assembly
                                                                   Magnets, attached to the linkage arm and eye
    The operating gear assembly (fig. 5-3) provides the            assemblies, actuate limit switches mounted to brackets
means of physically raising and lowering the JBD                   on the side of the operating gear deck cutouts to
panels. A set of operating gear consists of two hydraulic          indicate position of the panel assemblies. Removable
cylinders, three bearing blocks, one trunnion shaft, two           panel supports can be attached to the operating gear and
crank assemblies and four linkage assemblies. Each                 flight deck to lock panels in the raised position for
linkage assembly consists of an arm, strut and eye. The            maintenance, or if access to the area beneath the panels
linkage for two JBD panels is connected to a single                is required.
                                                                                HYDRAULIC
                                                                                 CYLINDER
                                                       LUBRICATION
                                                       FITTINGS
                  LINKAGE
     (ARM, STRUT, AND EYE
                                                                                                          FLIGHT DECK
                                                                                                                 (REF)
    BEARING
    BLOCK
              LUBRICATION
              FITTING
                     CRANK
                                                                                                           HYDRAULIC
                         SHAFT                                                                             CYLINDER
ABEf0503
                                                             5-3
Water-Cooled Panel Assembly                                     The module assemblies are fastened to the panel base
                                                                by screws, thereby permitting easy removal in the event
    A water-cooled panel assembly (fig. 5-4) is a               of module failure. Each module contains water
reinforced ribb-based aluminum alloy structure                  passages connected to inlet and outlet water manifolds
containing water inlet and outlet piping. Each panel            by tube assemblies. Seawater, supplied from the ship’s
assembly contains 14 tube assemblies and 7 removable            firemain is continuously circulated through the
module assemblies and attached hinge and lift fittings.         individual module assemblies to dissipate heat
LIFT FITTING
                                         COOLING
                                          WATER
                                        DISCHARGE
       ORIFICE
      LOCATION
        NO. 7
       HOSE                                                      MODULE
   (PREFORMED)                                                  ASSEMBLY
                                                                                             COOLING
         RETURN PIPE                                                                          WATER
                                                                                               INLET
                                                                                           (SEE DETAIL A)
             PANEL BASE
            (STRUCTURE)
INLET PIPE
                  VACUUM-BREAKER
                  VALVE LOCATIONS
                                      SWIVEL
          LUBRICATION                  JOINT
            FITTING                  ASSEMBLY
                                     SALT WATER
                                        HOSE
                        A
                                                          5-4
generated by jet exhaust. An orifice located in the                flange is not used and cooling water flow at that
return line connection of each module controls the flow            location is line sized. The outlet flange assembly orifice
rate of cooling water within the module assemblies. A              is sized to provide a flow rate of approximately 1,200
removable hinge protector plate located below the                  gallons per minute.
bottom module of each panel assembly, permits easy
                                                                        A temperature switch, located near the water
access to the hinge bearing and fitting for maintenance.
                                                                   discharge of one of the center JBD panels, will close if
                                                                   the cooling water reaches 210°F and alert the JBD
Cooling Water Piping Installation
                                                                   operator by lighting a red temperature light on the
     The cooling water piping installation (fig. 5-5)              control panel. A pressure switch, located in the line
consists of a strainer, swivel joint assemblies, orifice           leading to the overboard discharge, will close if the
flange assemblies, temperature switch, pressure switch,            water pressure drops below the setting that determined
pressure gauges and associated piping and connections.             adequate flow rate and alert the JBD operator by
Seawater, supplied by the ship’s firemain, is                      lighting a red pressure light on the control panel.
continuously circulated through each module assembly               Pressure gauges, located on the control panel, provide
and then discharged overboard. The strainer removes                an indication of cooling water pressure being supplied
particles, which could clog water passages in the                  by the ship’s firemain. The cooling water pressure must
modules. The swivel joint assemblies provide a means               be maintained at a minimum of 90 psi. An additional
of connecting the water manifolds, via hoses, to the               pressure gauge, located upstream of the discharge
seawater supply piping. The swivel joint also permits              orifice, is provided. A drop in pressure at this gauge
rotational movement of the piping as the JBD is raised             indicates blockage within the cooling water system or
or lowered. Two orifices flange assemblies are provided            inadequate firemain pressure. During JBD
to regulate the cooling water flow rate. The inlet orifice         certification, the normal discharge pressure and
                                                                   pressure switch setting is determined.
                                                                   TEMPERATURE
                                                                   SWITCH                           INLET FLANGE ASSEMBLY
                                                                                                        WITH ORIFICE PLATE
STRAINER (REF)
                                                                           VALVE
                                                                                                 PRESSURE
                     LUBRICATION                                                               GAUGE PIPING
                     FITTING
                                                PRESSURE
                                                GAUGE                                                    DECKEDGE CONTROL
                      SWIVEL                                                                             PANEL (IF USED)
                      JOINT
 SALT                 ASSEMBLY                                        PRESSURE
 WATER                                                    VALVE         SWITCH
 HOSE                                                                                       AUXILIARY
                                                                                             CONTROL
                                                                                           PANEL (REF)
                                          SALT WATER                 OUTLET FLANGE ASSEMBLY               ABEf0505
         VIEW A                           DISCHARGE                       WITH ORIFICE PLATE
                                          OVERBOARD
                                                             5-5
Hydraulic Control Piping Assembly                                 cylinder and to the gravity tank return lines. The bypass
                                                                  lines permit routing of fluid around the stack valve and
    The hydraulic control piping assembly (fig. 5-6)              are only used during an emergency situation to lower
consists of the control valves (stack valves), hose               the JBD panels.
connections, and associated piping and fittings.
                                                                       An orifice assembly is provided in the line to the
Hydraulic fluid is provided to the JBDs by an inlet line
                                                                  raising side of the hydraulic cylinders which maintains
and shutoff valve connected to the main catapult
                                                                  control of fluid flow for both the raising and lowering
hydraulic system. The inlet branches off into three lines
                                                                  sequence. Shutoff valves are located in each line of the
(Mk 7 Mod 0/2) or two lines (Mk 7 Mod 1) with each
                                                                  hydraulic cylinders for emergency and maintenance
line connecting to a stack valve. The stack valve
                                                                  purposes. Hose assemblies provide a flexible con-
controls the flow of hydraulic fluid to and from the
                                                                  nection between the hydraulic cylinders and piping to
hydraulic cylinders. Emergency-lowering bypass lines
                                                                  compensate for movement of the cylinders during
and valves are connected to the raising side of each
                                                                  raising and lowering operations.
PORT B
                                                                         PORT A
REFER TO
 VIEW B                                                                    REFER TO VIEW D
   REFER TO VIEW C
                           TO ATMOSPHERE     TO ATMOSPHERE           TO ATMOSPHERE
                                                                                           EMERGENCY LOWERING
                                                   REFER TO               AUXILIARY
                                                                                               BYPASS LINE
                                                    VIEW A                CONTROL PRESSURE
                                                                                    GAUGE
                                                                           PANEL    PIPING
                                                                                                  DECKEDGE
                                                                                     SYSTEM     CONTROL PANEL
     FOUR-WAY CONTROL                                                                SHUTOFF       (IF USED)
     VALVE (STACK VALVE)                                    TO GRAVITY TANK           VALVE
                                                                       FROM CATAPULT HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
ABEF0506
                                                            5-6
Four-way Control Valve (Stack Valve)                                    valve side. The slide shifts and directs fluid to
                                                                        port A of both hydraulic cylinders. The
    A four-way control valve (stack valve) (fig. 5-7)                   hydraulic cylinder pistons extend, pushing the
controls the flow of hydraulic fluid to and from a pair of              crank assembly of the operating gear aft and
hydraulic cylinders. The stack valve is a solenoid                      rotating the shaft. Rotation of the shaft extends
controlled, pilot-operated valve assembly. The stack                    the operating gear linkage and raises the
valve consists of a solenoid-operated valve, a                          associated panel assemblies. During the raise
pilot-operated main valve, and a sequence valve. All                    cycle, fluid in the cylinder lower port B vents to
three valves are secured together to conserve space and                 the gravity tank through the main valve. If the
simplify connection to a subplate or manifold. One                      raise switch is released during the raise cycle,
stack valve controls fluid flow for a pair of panel                     solenoid B deenergizes, a spring returns the
assemblies. Three stack valves are required for Mk 7                    solenoid spool to the centered position, and
Mod 0/2 and two stack valves for Mk 7 Mod 1 JBDs.                       panel movement will stop. Fluid flow will be as
Hydraulic fluid at 2,500 psi from the associated                        described above in step a.
catapult is supplied to the stack valve with all fluid
                                                                   3. When a lower switch is actuated, solenoid A in
return lines going to that catapult gravity tank. The
                                                                      the pilot valve energizes, shifting the spool and
operation of a stack valve is described as follows:
                                                                      directing pressure to a pilot port at the main
    1. With hydraulic fluid at normal operating                       valve slide. The slide shifts in the opposite
       pressure and neither solenoid B (raise) nor                    (from raising) direction and directs fluid to port
       solenoid A (lower) energized, fluid flows                      B of both hydraulic cylinders. The pistons
       through the sequence valve and pilot valve to                  retract, pulling the crank assembly of the
       both sides of the slide in the main valve. This                operating gear forward and rotating the shaft.
       pressure to both sides of the slide keeps it                   The rotation of the shaft retracts the operating
       centered and blocks fluid flow into and out of                 gear linkage and lowers the panels. During the
       both ends of the hydraulic cylinders.                          lower cycle, fluid in the raise port A vents to
    2. When a raise switch is actuated, solenoid B in                 the gravity tank through the main valve. . If the
       the pilot valve energizes, shifting the spool and              lower switch is released during the lower cycle,
       directing pressure to a pilot port at the main                 solenoid A deenergizes, a spring returns the
                                                                                     SOLENOID A
          SOLENOID-OPERATED
          PILOT VALVE
SOLENOID B
                                                                                                 THREADED FITTING
                                                                                                     FOR CONDUIT
                                                                                                     CONNECTION
     MANUAL PUSH PIN
     (BOTH ENDS)
                                                                                                   PILOT-OPERATED
                                                                                                        MAIN VALVE
                                                                                      SEQUENCE
                                                                                          VALVE
                                                 ABEf0507
                                                             5-7
                                                              BLEED
                                                              VALVE
                                  BLEED
                                  VALVE
                                                     VENT
                                                    PIPING
                                                                                       HOSE
                                                                                     ASSEMBLY
                                                     ABEF0508
                                                                                              CAP
                                                                                            ASSEMBLY
CHESTPACK
                                          AUXILIARY CONTROL
                                          PANEL
  28VDC
  ON/OFF      CUTOUT
  SWITCH      SWITCH
                                                                                                          RELAY
                                                                                                       TERMINAL
MACHINERY ROOM                                                                                              BOX
ENCLOSURE PANEL
           LIMIT SWITCH
           (REF)
                                                                                                     SALTWATER
                                                                                                          VALVE
                                                                                                   JUNCTION BOX
                                 FOUR WAY CONTROL VALVES
                                 (STACK VALVES)
                                                                TRANSFER
                                                                 SWITCH
                                 COOLING WATER
                                 PRESSURE SALTWATER (REF)          TO SALTWATER
                                                                  SHUTOFF VALVES                             ABEf0509
       COOLING WATER TEMPERATURE SALTWATER (REF)
                                                          5-8
        solenoid spool to the centered position and              Chestpack Portable Control Assembly
        panel movement will stop. Fluid flow will be as
        described earlier in step a.                                  The chestpack (fig. 5-11) contains three individual
                                                                 raise and lower toggle switches, an “all” raise and lower
Cylinder Vent Piping Installation                                toggle switch, a defeat interlock toggle switch, an
                                                                 emergency cooling water toggle switch, and a yellow
    The cylinder vent piping installation (fig. 5-8)             water indicator light. Electrical power is provided by an
consists of bleed valves, flexible hose assemblies,              umbilical cable connected to a receptacle on the rear of
piping, and associated fittings. Each JBD hydraulic              the chestpack and another receptacle located in the
cylinder is vented through flexible hoses connected to           deck. The defeat interlock switch permits raising and
vent ports directly above the cylinder raising and               lowering the JBDs during emergencies, such as low
lowering ports. The hoses also connect the piping to a           cooling water pressure or high cooling water
nearby vent station and bleed valves.                            temperature. The emergency cooling water switch,
                                                                 when actuated, closes a motor operated shutoff valve in
ELECTRICAL CONTROL ASSEMBLY                                      the saltwater line leading to the applicable JBD
                                                                 assembly. The yellow cooling water indicator light,
    The electrical assembly consists of the deckedge,            when lit, indicates a malfunction within the cooling
auxiliary and portable (chestpack) control panels, a             water system. The three individual raise and lower
transfer switch, relay terminal box, cutout switch, and          switches allow the operator to raise individual pairs of
associated wiring and connectors. All JBD assemblies             panels while the “all” raise switch permits raising and
are electrically controlled by means of the individual           lowering of all panels simultaneously. The red (port)
control panels. Each control panel and chestpack has its         and green (stbd) indicator lights show the operator to
own electrical installation and each is operated                 which JBD the chestpack is connected. All JBD
independently of the other. An auxiliary control panel           installations currently use the deckedge control for JBD
and transfer switch, located below deck, is provided for         number four. Handles are provided on each chestpack
emergency operating purposes. The auxiliary control              to attach a harness worn by the JBD operator.
panel is identical to the deckedge panel.
                                                                 Transfer Switch (Chestpack Portable Control
Deckedge and Auxiliary Control Panels                            System)
    The deckedge and auxiliary control panels (fig.                  The transfer switch (fig. 5-12) for the chestpack
5-10) are identical in design. The Mk 7 Mod 0/2 control          portable control is a rotary type with a rotary dial. The
panels contain nine light switches while the Mk 7 Mod            dial face is identified with two “portable” and two
1 panels contain seven light switches. Each panel also           “aux” positions. The transfer switch is located near the
contains four fuse lights, a power on light switch,              applicable auxiliary control panel. When the transfer
double indicator light, a cooling water and hydraulic            switch is in the portable position, the chestpack is
fluid shutoff valve, and a cooling water and hydraulic           operable. Moving the dial to the aux position shifts
pressure gauge. Six switches (Mk 7 Mod 0/2) or four              electrical power from the chestpack to the auxiliary
switches (Mk 7 Mod 1) are used to raise and lower the            panel.
JBD panels. Two switches are push-to-test and the last
switch is an emergency cooling water shut off valve              Transfer Switch (Deckedge Control System)
light switch (water-emer-off). The water-emer-off
switch, when actuated, closes a remote-controlled                    The transfer switch is a rotary type switch with a
shutoff valve in the saltwater line leading to the               rotary dial. The dial face is identified with two
applicable JBD assembly. The fuse light will provide an          “deckedge” and two “aux” positions. The transfer
indication of a blown fuse and possible trouble in the           switch is located near the applicable auxiliary control
applicable circuitry. The double indicator lights will           panel. When the transfer switch is in the deckedge
provide an indication of low cooling water pressure or           position, the deckedge control panel is operable.
high cooling water temperature. A plastic guard,                 Moving the dial to the aux position shifts electrical
mounted over the up and down switches, prevents                  power from the deckedge panel to the auxiliary panel.
accidental operation of the panels.                              The only difference between the chestpack and the
                                                                 deckedge transfer switch is the dial face.
                                                           5-9
                                   COOLING-WATER
                                     PRESSURE
                                                            HYDRAULIC
                                                            PRESSURE
                                                                            FUSE
COOLING-WATER                                                               LIGHT
  PRESSURE
 CONNECTION                                                                 EMERGENCY
                                                                            COOLING-WATER
                                                                            SHUTOFF SWITCH
                                                                           SW PRESSURE
                                                                           SW TEMPERATURE
    SWITCH
    GUARD                                                                     POWER-ON
                                                                              SWITCH
                                                                                    PUSH-TO-TEST
                                                                                    LIGHT SWITCHES
                                  COOLING-WATER
                                    PRESSURE
                                           HYDRAULIC
                                           PRESSURE
 COOLING-WATER                                                                FUSE
   PRESSURE                                                                   LIGHT
  CONNECTION
                                                                              EMERGENCY
                                                                              COOLING-WATER
                                                                              SHUTOFF SWITCH
                                                                           SW PRESSURE
     SWITCH                                                                SW TEMPERATURE
     GUARD
                                                                              POWER-ON
                                                                              SWITCH
                                                                                      PUSH-TO-TEST
                                                                                      LIGHT SWITCH
                                          SWITCH                  SWITCH
                  SWITCH LEFT                                      RIGHT       ABEf0511
                                          CENTER
                  Figure 5-11.—Chestpack portable control assembly.
                                                5-10
                                                                    PANEL SUPPORT INSTALLATION AND
                                                                    EMERGENCY LOWERING DEVICE
                                                                    INSTALLATION
                                        PANEL
                                        SUPPORT
INSTALL
QUICK-RELEASE PIN
THRU BRACKET
AND THRU PANEL
SUPPORT AS SHOWN
    EYE ON LINKAGE
                     VIEW B
SEE VIEW B
JBD PIT
                                                              EMERGENCY
                                                              LOWERING
                                                              BAR
FLIGHT DECK
                                                             5-11
being conducted under JBD panels. The panel supports                     • Below decks phone talker/Valve operator
attache to the JBD operating linkage arm assembly,
with a quick release pin and fit into an indentation in the              • Two personnel to install emergency lowering
depressed deck area (JBD pit) at the forward end. The                      device
panel supports are used to lock panels in the raised                     • Two safety observers (stationed at the port and
position for maintenance purposes or emergencies. A                        starboard sides of the JBD panels)
panel support is provided for each set of operating gear,
three supports for Mk 7 Mod 0/2 and two for Mk7 Mod                      • Tractor driver
1 JBDs.
                                                                     Electrical Control Failure
    The emergency lowering device connects to a tow
tractor on one end and fits against the operating linkage                 Should the chestpack, deckedge, and auxiliary
arm assembly at the other end. This allows the tractor to            control panels become affected by an electrical power
push the operating linkage “over-center”. With the                   failure and the hydraulic system is functional, proceed
emergency bypass valves open, the weight of the panels               as follows:
will then force fluid from the raise end of the hydraulic
cylinders through the emergency bypass valve                             1. Station a crewperson to act as a valve operator
permitting the panels to slowly lower.                                      at the stack valves. The valve operator shall be
                                                                            equipped with a sound-powered phone set. The
Preparation for Use                                                         chestpack or JBD deckedge operator shall
                                                                            remain at his or her station and relay
    When the JBDs are put in operation for the first                        instructions to the valve operator. The JBD
time or after being idle, use the following procedures:                     deckedge or auxiliary panel operator shall also
                                                                            monitor the pressure gauges.
    1. Perform the preoperational inspection accord-
       ing to the applicable maintenance requirement                     2. The valve operator, when instructed by the
       card (MRC).                                                          chestpack or JBD deckedge operator, shall
                                                                            raise or lower the JBD panels by the manual
    2. Ensure that personnel, aircraft, and flight deck                     push pins of the A and B solenoids of the stack
       equipment are clear of the panel area before                         valves. The B solenoid controls the raising of
       attempting to raise the JBDs.                                        the panels, and the A solenoid controls the
                                                                            lowering.
                       CAUTION
                                                                     Hydraulic Control Failure
        Damage by excessive heat can result from
    jet engine exhaust if cooling water is not                           Should the JBD hydraulic system fail with the
    flowing at the correct pressure.                                 JBDs in the FULL-UP position, the following
    3. Check to ensure salt water supplied from the                  procedures must be used to lower the panels:
       ship's fire main is flowing through the                           1. Establish sound-powered phone communica-
       water-cooled panels.                                                 tion between the valve operator and the
    4. Functionally test the JBD hydraulic and                              chestpack or deckedge operator.
       electrical system for proper operation and
       leaks.                                                                               WARNING
                                                              5-12
       arm and attach the ring end to a tractor tow                    control panel is completely checked out and
       hook. Push with the tractor until the operating                 restored to proper operating condition.
       gear linkage unlocks.
                                                                                    WARNING
                    WARNING
                                                                       Prior to returning control back to deck
        Once the emergency lowering device is                      operation, verify with the flight deck safety
   installed, all hands shall stand back at a safe                 observer that the area around the JBD is clear
   distance from the JBD and around tractor. As                    of aircraft, support equipment, and personnel.
   the JBD begins to lower, the emergency
                                                                   4. Return control of the JBD to the chestpack or
   lowering device will be dragged out of the JBD
                                                                      deckedge operator.
   pit by the tractor utilizing reverse gear.
   5. Adjust the panel lowering speed by                        MAINTENANCE
      opening/closing the emergency bypass valve.
                                                                    This section contains preventive and corrective
   6. Once the strut is over-center, the JBD panels             maintenance information and procedures, some of
      will fall under its own weight until it is flush          which are general and apply to various items of the
      with the deck.                                            system and others which are specific and apply to a
                                                                particular part of the equipment.
Inoperative Deckedge Control Panel or Portable
Electrical System Control Box                                   Planned Maintenance
    In the event of an emergency where the chestpack                The planned maintenance system furnishes all
or the deckedge control panel cannot be used, the               vessels and stations with MRCs containing specific
auxiliary control panel becomes operational.                    maintenance instructions. These cards are used at
   1. Station a crewperson at the flight deck or                required frequencies to maintain JBD equipment in
      deckedge to man the phone and relay                       operating condition and to prevent breakdown and
      instructions to the auxiliary-control-panel               subsequent shutdown of operations. The planned
      operator.                                                 maintenance system and the maintenance data
                                                                collection system are described in OPNAVINST
                                                                4790.4.
                    WARNING
                                                                    Current MRCs include the following inspection
       The crewperson, acting as a safety
                                                                and cleaning procedures:
   observer, should ensure that the area around the
   JBD is clear of aircraft, support equipment, and                1. Preoperational inspections
   personnel.
                                                                   2. Postoperational inspections
   2. With the transfer switch in the AUX position,
                                                                   3. Cleaning and inspecting hydraulic piping
      the auxiliary-control-panel operator shall
                                                                      orifice plate(s)
      operate the panel by the instructions relayed to
      him or her from the flight deck or deck edge
      personnel.                                                                    WARNING
                                                                       Before performing any maintenance
                    CAUTION                                        procedures behind a JBD panel in the raised
                                                                   position, install the panel supports to prevent
       Repair and checkout of the faulty panel or
                                                                   the panel from lowering. Failure to do this
   control box operation shall be accomplished at
                                                                   could result in serious injury to personnel.
   times when the raising or lowering of the JBD
   would not be prohibited by aircraft movement                     To ensure dependable operation of the JBD
   on the flight deck.                                          equipment, proper lubrication of the mechanical
                                                                linkage is essential. Lubrication is part of the
   3. Continue operation of the auxiliary control
                                                                preoperational checks given in the MRC. Extension
      panel until the faulty chestpack or deckedge
                                                                tubes are provided on trunnion bearings and hydraulic
                                                         5-13
cylinder bracket assemblies so that all lube fittings can               Information that allows operating and maintenance
be reached from the deck.                                          personnel to locate the source of problems or
                                                                   equipment failure is found in the JBD technical manual,
    PROTECTING OPEN EQUIPMENT.—When
                                                                   in the section covering trouble shooting.
removing a component from the hydraulic system, cap
or plug all openings to prevent entry of foreign matter.
Use tape to protect pipe threads.                                               SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
    CLEANING.—Hydraulic system components                              The energy required to operate the JBD is supplied
must be disassembled, cleaned, repaired, and                       by fluid under pressure; therefore, when operating with
reassembled as specified in the operation, maintenance,            fluid under pressure, observe standard safety
and overhaul instructions manual for the specific type             precautions that apply.
of JBD installation on your ship.                                      All moving parts and equipment should be checked
                                                                   for rags, tools, or other foreign material before
                      WARNING                                      operating any of the machinery. Only qualified
                                                                   operators shall be allowed to operate the JBDs.
         Before repairing or removing any
    components connected to hydraulic or water                         The parking of aircraft on the deflector panel
    lines, make sure the lines are depressurized.                  should be avoided. The panels are designed to
    Also, before repairing or removing any elec-                   withstand only the temporary weight of the aircraft
    trical component, de-energize the electrical                   taxiing over them.
    circuit and attach an out-of-service tag.                         When you perform maintenance on the JBD,
    HOSES, SEALS, AND O-RINGS.—Hoses,                              comply with the safety precautions listed on the MRC.
seals, and O-rings are selected on the basis of their                  Personnel and equipment shall be clear of the JBD
compatibility with the hydraulic fluid. Therefore,                 machinery enclosure and depressed deck when the
replacement parts should be of the same material as                panels are being raised or lowered. This includes the
original parts. O-rings must be removed and replaced               times when the panels are being operated during
with care to avoid damage to the O-ring and O-ring                 preoperational inspections and maintenance or
sealing surfaces of the various parts. O-rings must be             overhaul tests and inspections.
free of cuts and not deformed. New O-rings must be
installed at every reassembly of components. Before
assembly, all O-rings must be lightly lubricated with                            REVIEW QUESTIONS
the system hydraulic fluid. Hoses are subject to wear               Q1.     What provides the means of physically raising
and require periodic replacement. When installing                           and lowering the JBD panels?
hoses, take care to avoid unnecessary bends and
overstressing.                                                      Q2.     Each Mk 7 Mod 0 JBD panel assembly
                                                                            consists of how many tube assemblies?
    To restore the JBD system to operating condition
after a down period that required draining fluid,                   Q3.     What permits rotational movement of the
perform preoperational inspection procedures given in                       piping as the JBD is raised and lowered?
the applicable MRC.                                                 Q4.     What is the maximum temperature of the
    For most repairs to the hydraulic system, only                          cooling water?
portions of the system need be drained. Isolation valves            Q5.     What controls the hydraulic fluid to and from
in each of the hydraulic cylinder lines and a shutoff                       the hydraulic cylinders?
valve between the stack valve and the catapult pumps
permit isolation of portions of the JBD hydraulic                   Q6.     What type of valve is the stack valve?
system.                                                             Q7.     What is the differences between the deckedge
                                                                            and the auxiliary control panel?
Troubleshooting
                                                                    Q8.     The double indicator light will provide what
    Most problems that occur on JBDs can be                                 indication?
recognized as a failure of one of three                             Q9.     What is the function of the “all” raise switch
systems—namely, hydraulic, electrical, or water.                            on the chestpack portable control?
                                                            5-14
Q10.     What is the function of the panel support?              actuator reset assembly, shuttle spreader, and buffer
                                                                 cylinder assembly. These components and their
Q11.     List the personnel required to perform a JBD
                                                                 operation are discussed in the following paragraphs.
         emergency lowering?
                                                                 NOSE-GEAR-LAUNCH GUIDE TRACKS
       MK 2 NOSE-GEAR-LAUNCH (NGL)
                 SYSTEM                                              The guide tracks (fig. 5-14), which guides the
                                                                 aircraft launch bar into engagement with the catapult
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Describe the
                                                                 shuttle spreader assembly consists of an approach
    components of the Mk 2 nose gear launch
                                                                 track, buffer-cylinder track, aft slide-access track,
    system. Describe the operations of the Mk 2
                                                                 forward slide-access track, and a forward track. The
    nose gear launch system.
                                                                 approach track contains a V-shaped mouth, which
    The nose-gear-launch (NGL) equipment is                      guides the aircraft launch bar into the guide track.
designed to assist in the launching of aircraft by               Grooves constructed in the individual tracks and top
providing a positive and automatic means of attaching            surface of the buffer cylinder guide the launch bar as the
the aircraft launch bar to the catapult shuttle and              aircraft moves forward. Inserts installed in the forward
spreader. This method of launching permits a positive,           slide-access tracks provide a camming surface, which
automatic engagement of aircraft to catapult.                    ensures that the launch bar makes positive contact the
Automatic engagement of the aircraft launch bar to the           buffer hook actuator roller. Inserts installed in the
catapult reduces the number of personnel required to be          forward track guide the launch bar up and over the
in close proximity to the aircraft during catapult               spreader assembly for proper launch bar to shuttle
hookup.                                                          hookup.
    The major components of the Mk 2 NGL system                      Wheel guides bars are provided to guide the aircraft
include the flush-deck guide track, slide assembly,              nose wheel along the guide track. The inner wheel
                                                                                 STATION 1
                                                                             TROUGH COVER                  INSERTS
                                                                                     (REF)
                                                                 FWD TRACK
                                                          FWD
                                                          SLIDE-ACCESS
                                                          TRACK
                                               INSERTS
                                                                                                           STATION 0
                                   AFT                                                                         (REF)
                                   SLIDE-ACCESS
  REMOVABLE INNER                  TRACK                                                             NOSEWHEEL TIRE
  WHEEL GUIDE BARS                                                                                  OUTER GUIDE BARS
                                                                                                                (REF)
                                                                                                 END OF INNER
                                                                                                  GUIDE BARS
    APPROACH TRACK
                                                                                       AFT PORTABLE
                                                                                      TROUGH COVER
                                                                                               (REF)
                                              BUFFER CYLINDER
                                              TRACK
                                    NOSEWHEEL TIRE
                                    INNER GUIDE BARS
                ABEf0514
                                                          5-15
guide bars keep the nosewheel straight during forward            Slide Assembly
movement. The outer wheel guide bars prevent the nose
wheel from sliding side to side once the nosewheel                   The slide assembly (fig. 5-15) consists of a body
clears the inner guide bars and aid in proper alignment          containing rollers, which reduce friction during
of launch bar to spreader assembly.                              forward and aft movement of the assembly; the buffer
                                                                 hook, which engages the aircraft hold-back bar; and the
NOSE-GEAR-LAUNCH (NGL) ASSEMBLY                                  buffer-hook actuator assembly, which raises the buffer
                                                                 hooks to flight deck level. The slide assembly is
    The NGL assembly consists of the slide assembly,             mechanically connected to the buffer-cylinder piston
reset assembly, forward and aft slide-access tracks,             rods by three links.
buffer cylinder assembly, tensioner cylinder assembly,
housing, drain pan assembly, and a shock absorber.
LAUNCH BAR
BUFFER HOOK
                                                                         BUFFER HOOK
                                  BUFFER HOOK                         ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
ROLLER
ABEf0515
                                                          5-16
     During operation, (see view A, fig. 5-15) as the              surface that reduces wear due to contact with the buffer
aircraft moves forward, the launch bar, sliding in the             hook actuator lever. Grooves machined in the top of the
track-guide grooves, contacts the buffer- hook-                    slider provide a path for the flow of lubricant between
actuator-assembly roller, forcing it to rotate forward             the slider and the inner walls of the housing. The
and down. When the buffer hook actuator is forced                  housing is chrome-plated to prevent corrosion. The
down, its forces against the underside of the buffer hook          actuating spring is housed in a hole in the bottom of the
and raises the hook into position to engage the aircraft           slider. The slider and spring are secured in the housing
holdback bar. As the aircraft continues forward, the               by means of the retainer.
holdback bar engages the buffer hook and pulls the
                                                                        During operation when the slide assembly is
slide assembly forward. The slide assembly, connected
                                                                   forward, the reset-assembly slider is not restrained by
to the buffer cylinder piston rods, pulls the three rods
                                                                   the actuator assembly but is held above the surface of
from the buffer cylinder assembly. Hydraulic resistance
                                                                   the housing by the slider actuating spring. After launch,
within the buffer cylinder assembly decelerates the
                                                                   as the slide assembly retracts, the buffer hook actuator
aircraft. When the aircraft stops, it is in position for
                                                                   contacts the extended reset slider, causing the actuator
catapult shuttle hookup.
                                                                   assembly to rotate downward. This action permit the
    After launch, the piston rods are retracted into the           buffer hook to drop below the deck through the track
buffer cylinder assembly automatically. As the slide               opening into the deck housing cavity (see view B, fig.
assembly moves aft, the buffer hook assembly contacts              5-15). When the buffer hook is below deck, the actuator
the reset assembly slider (see view B, fig. 5-15),                 assembly lever holds the reset-assembly slider down in
causing the actuator lever to rotate down. This action             the reset assembly housing.
permits the buffer hook to drop below deck level
through an opening in the track into the deck housing.             Forward and Aft Slide-Access Tracks
The slide assembly is now ready for the next aircraft
hookup.                                                                The slide-access tracks retain the slide assembly in
                                                                   the housing. They also serve to guide the aircraft launch
Reset Assembly                                                     bar to ensure proper engagement with the catapult
                                                                   shuttle spreader. Inner and outer guide wheel bars are
    The reset assembly (fig. 5-16), which resets the               attached to the aft and forward slide-access track to
buffer hook, causing it to drop below deck at the end of           keep the aircraft nosewheel straight during forward
the buffer-cylinder-assembly retract stroke, is located            movement of the aircraft. Inserts installed in the
below the slide assembly in the deck housing. The reset            forward slide-access tracks provide a camming surface,
assembly consists of a housing, slider, slider actuating           which ensure that the launch bar contacts the buffer
spring, and retainer. The slider contains a stellite               hook actuator roller.
                                                                                 LUBE FITTING
               SLIDER
                                                     LUBE
                                                    FITTING
                                                                                           HOUSING
                                                                                           SLIDER
                                                  HOUSING
                                                                                          ACTUATING
                                                                                           SPRING
                                                                                            RETAINER
               RETAINER
                                                                                      VIEW A
                                                                                                  ABEF0516
                                                            5-17
Buffer Cylinder Assembly                                            tubes is progressively reduced, causing an increasing
                                                                    resistance to forward motion of the slide assembly, thus
    The NGL buffer cylinder (fig. 5-17) is located in               decelerating and bringing the aircraft to a smooth stop
the deck housing between the approach track and the aft             at the end of the buffing stroke.
slide-access track. The buffer-cylinder body has
                                                                        During the buffing stroke, fluid in front of the
integral guide tracks on its top surface and contains
                                                                    center-cylinder piston is forced through a port in the
three hydraulic cylinders. The two outer cylinders
                                                                    cylinder and through the hydraulic line into the NGL
contain hollow piston rods; the center cylinder piston
                                                                    valve-manifold accumulator, which acts as a cushion
rod is solid. The forward end of each piston rod is
                                                                    and fluid reservoir. After launch, the fluid pressure
attached to the slide assembly. Within each outer piston
                                                                    established by the valve-manifold reducing valve
rod is an orifice tube, which meters fluid flow through
                                                                    acting on the forward side of the center cylinder forces
the outer cylinders to absorb the forward energy of the
                                                                    the center piston aft, thus retracting the three rods into
aircraft during the buffering stroke.
                                                                    the cylinders.
     Prior to aircraft holdback bar/buffer hook
engagement, the buffer cylinder assembly is in the                  Buffer Accumulator Assembly
standby cycle (fig. 5-18) with the three piston rods fully
retracted into the buffer cylinders. While in the standby                The buffer accumulator assembly (fig. 5-19) is
cycle, hydraulic fluid is constantly circulated between             located below deck in line with and aft of the buffer
the hydraulic system and the buffer cylinder assembly               cylinder assembly. The buffer accumulator consists of a
through two metering orifice screws at a rate of                    hydraulic accumulator mounted in a support with a tee
approximately 8.5 gpm. This metered flow, which is                  fitting and associated hardware.
nonadjustable, is to maintain the hydraulic fluid in the                 During operation, as the buffer cylinder piston rods
system at the proper temperature.                                   are pulled forward, hydraulic fluid flows from the
    When the aircraft holdback bar engages the buffer               accumulator, through the tee fitting and associated
hook, the slide assembly moves forward, pulling the                 piping into the aft end of the buffer cylinder assembly
three piston rods from the cylinders. As the piston rods            filling the void created as the piston rods move forward.
move forward, fluid in front of each outer-cylinder                     After the launch, the buffer piston rods retract into
piston is forced through the holes around the periphery             the buffer cylinder forcing fluid from the buffer
of each outer-cylinder piston and through the metering              cylinder back to the accumulator. Fluid continues to
holes in the two orifice tubes. As the pistons continue             flow into the accumulator until the pressure buildup
forward, the number of metering holes in the orifice                exceeds the spring-load of the check valve located
PISTON RODS
BLEEDER PLUG
METER SCREW
                            ABEf0517
                                          Figure 5-17.—Buffer cylinder assembly.
                                                             5-18
                                                                                           HLP RETURN
                                                                                          HMP SUPPLY
                                                                HYD
                                                                                             NORMAL SYS PRESSURE
DRAIN
PILOT PRESSURE
                                                                HYD
                SOL A                    SOL B
HYD HYD
ABEf0518
down stream from the accumulator. Opening of the               Drain Pan Assembly
check valve permits excess fluid from the buffer
cylinder to be returned to the catapult gravity tank.              The drain pan assembly (fig. 5-20) is located on the
                                                               underside of the NGL assembly directly below the
                                                               tensioner cylinder. The drain pan supports and protects
                                                               the two quick disconnect, self sealing hydraulic
SUPPORT
PIPE FITTING
                              ACCUMULATOR
                                                                                             DRAIN PAN ASSEMBLY
                  AIR FILTER
                                             ABEf0519                          ABEf0520
                                                        5-19
                                                                     Shock Absorber (Soft-Stop) Assembly
                           PORT R
                     REDUCED PRESSURE
                         TO BUFFER
                          CYLINDER
            CHECK VALVE                                         PORT P
                                                               HYDRAULIC
                PORT T                                          SUPPLY
               RETURN                                  REDUCING
              TO GRAVITY                                 VALVE
                 TANK
                          PORT S
                       FROM BUFFER
                       ACCUMULATOR                                                              FLOW
                                                                                               CONTROL
                                                                                                VALVE
              CHECK
              VALVE
                                                                                                         DRAIN
                                                                                              SOLENOID B
              FLOW                                                                               ACCUMULATOR
             CONTROL
              VALVE
                                                                                    SOLENOID CONTROL
                                                                                         VALVE
                                                                     SOLENOID A
                  SUPPORT
                                                                                              ABEf0522
                                                              5-20
NOSE-GEAR-LAUNCH CONTROL SYSTEM
                                                             5-21
                                                                             HLP RETURN
HMP SUPPLY
                                                   HYD
                                                                              NORMAL SYS PRESSURE
DRAIN
PILOT PRESSURE
                                                   HYD
        SOL A                 SOL B
HYD HYD
ABEf0525
HLP RETURN
                                                                             HMP SUPPLY
                                                     HYD
DRAIN
                                                                                 PILOT PRESSURE
                                                     HYD
SOL A SOL B
HYD HYD
ABEf0526
                                            5-22
assembly. Fluid pressure is applied to the forward side           Q16.     The orifice tube is located in which cylinder
of the buffer pistons; and the pistons, piston rods, and                   of the buffer cylinder assembly?
slide assembly move aft. As the pistons move aft, fluid
                                                                  Q17.     The void created as the piston rods move
is forced out of the aft end of the buffer cylinder
                                                                           forward is filled with hydraulic fluid from
assembly, through a check valve and the other flow
                                                                           what assembly?
control valve, to the gravity tank.
                                                                  Q18.     On ICCS ships, the buffer fwd and buffer aft
                                                                           pushbuttons are installed on what control
              REVIEW QUESTIONS
                                                                           panels?
Q12.     List the NGL guide tracks.
Q13.     The slide is mechanically connected to what                                   SUMMARY
         component?
                                                                      In this chapter we have discussed the functions and
Q14.     What component resets the buffer hooks?                  operating procedures for the JBDs and Mk 2 NGL
                                                                  equipment. For additional, in-depth descriptions of this
Q15.     What ensures the launch bar makes contacts
                                                                  equipment, see the applicable NAVAIR technical man-
         with the buffer hook actuator roller?
                                                                  uals.
                                                           5-23
                                                    CHAPTER 6
    As an ABE, you will find that most of your duties               maintenance tasks must be accomplished, you must
will be performing preventive maintenance, or the                   refer to the appropriate technical manual. Maintenance
supervision of maintenance, on catapults, arresting                 tasks are assigned according to the complexity, scope,
gear, visual landing aid (VLA) and their associated                 and range of the work to be performed. This allows
equipment. At times you may also be assigned to one of              maintenance to be performed at the lowest practical
the support branches of V-2 division, such as                       level in order to maintain required readiness and
maintenance control, maintenance support, or material               material condition. The three levels of maintenance are
control. Regardless of your assignment and specific                 explained in the following paragraphs.
duties, you will need a working knowledge of the
Aircraft Launch and Recovery Equipment Main-                        Organizational Maintenance
tenance Program (ALREMP).
                                                                        Organizational or O-level maintenance is the
    The primary objective of the ALREMP is to                       maintenance that is normally done by the catapult and
achieve and sustain maximum operational readiness of                arresting gear crews. In some cases organizational
aircraft launch and recovery equipment in support of                maintenance may be done by intermediate or depot
carrier flight operations and to achieve and maintain a             activities. O-level maintenance tasks are grouped under
zero maintenance error rate through the use of                      the following categories:
standardized procedures, a dynamic quality assurance
program, and analytical review of maintenance                           • Inspection, operation, and servicing as defined
documentation and records.                                                and required by PMS
                                                                        • Corrective and preventive maintenance, in-
          MAINTENANCE, LEVELS,                                            cluding on-equipment repair and removal/
        RESPONSIBILITIES, AND TYPES                                       replacement of defective parts
    LEARNING          OBJECTIVES:           Identify                    • Incorporation of technical directives (TDs)
    organizational, intermediate, and depot level                         within prescribed limitations
    maintenance. Identify the maintenance
    concepts peculiar to each of the three levels of                    • Record keeping and report writing
    maintenance. Recognize upkeep and overhaul
    maintenance.                                                    Intermediate Maintenance
    The term maintenance has a very general meaning.                    Intermediate or I-level maintenance is done by
It could mean maintenance that can be performed in                  designated maintenance activities in support of fleet
minutes at the work center, or organizational level, or it          units. The aircraft intermediate maintenance depart-
could mean maintenance that requires months of                      ment (AIMD) on aircraft carriers is an example of such
overhaul in an industrial-type facility at the depot level.         activities. I-level maintenance includes the following
We need more than the word maintenance to indicate                  functions and services:
that a specific type of maintenance must be ac-
complished.                                                             • Repair, test, inspection, and modification of
                                                                          ALRE components and related equipment
MAINTENANCE LEVELS                                                      • Manufacture of selected and nonavailable parts
    All aircraft launch and recovery equipment                          • Incorporation of technical directives within
(ALRE) maintenance functions are divided into one of                      prescribed limitations
three distinct maintenance levels: organizational,
                                                                        • Calibration of designated equipment
intermediate, or depot. To determine at which level
                                                              6-1
Depot Maintenance                                                                REVIEW QUESTIONS
                                                                   Q1.      List the three levels of maintenance.
    Depot or D-level maintenance is maintenance that
requires skills and facilities beyond the O- and I-levels          Q2.      What is the concept of each level of main-
of maintenance. It is performed by naval shipyards,                         tenance?
commercial shipyards, Naval Ship Repair Facilities,
                                                                   Q3.      What are the general types of maintenance?
contractor repair, the Naval Air Warfare Center
(NAWC), and by voyage repair teams (VRTs) from
specified naval aviation depots. D-level maintenance                     V-2 MAINTENANCE ORGANIZATION
supports the lower I- and O-levels of maintenance by                     STRUCTURE AND RESPONSIBILITY
providing engineering assistance and performing                       LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Describe the
maintenance beyond the capability of lower level                      duties of maintenance control, quality
maintenance activities. D-level maintenance functions                 assurance, and maintenance support branches
are grouped as follows:                                               of V-2 division. Describe the procedures used
    • Major overhaul and repair to ALRE                               to complete the ALRE maintenance action
                                                                      form (MAF). Describe the operation of the
    • Modernization, modification, or conversion of                   visual information display system (VIDS)
      system components                                               board.
    • Calibration (type III) by Navy Calibration                      Aircraft launch and recovery equipment (ALRE)
      Laboratories                                                includes catapults, arresting gear and visual landing
    • Incorporation of TDs and service changes                    aids (VLA). Since ALRE is utilized by high
                                                                  performance aircraft, safety must always be paramount
    • Manufacture of parts and/or accessory items                 to the personnel who operate and maintain the
                                                                  equipment. A properly implemented maintenance
    • Technical and engineering assistance
                                                                  program will improve safety, maintenance integrity,
                                                                  performance, training of personnel, management, and
MAINTENANCE TYPES
                                                                  evaluation of maintenance performed. The aircraft
    There are two general types of ALRE maintenance               launch and recovery maintenance program (ALREMP)
performed without distinction as to levels of main-               is designed to maximize the effective utilization of
tenance. They are upkeep and overhaul.                            manpower and material to accomplish this goal.
                                                                       The ALREMP provides standard maintenance
Upkeep Maintenance                                                organization and procedures to be used by all V-2
                                                                  divisions. This standardization relies heavily on the
    Upkeep maintenance is preventive, corrective, or              maintenance control (MC), quality assurance (QA),
additive maintenance performed by catapult and                    and maintenance support (MS) branches of the division
arresting gear crewmembers. It includes servicing,                to establish good management practices and prevention
periodic inspection, functional and bench testing,                of maintenance defects. Figure 6-1 depicts the ALRE
replacement, preservation, and repair of catapult and             maintenance organizations for aircraft carriers. You
arresting gear equipment.                                         will notice that in each of the divisions illustrated, three
                                                                  distinct types of organization are identified. They are
Overhaul Maintenance                                              (1) the operational organization, which depicts the lines
                                                                  of authority delegated in the daily functions of a V-2
    Overhaul maintenance is the process of                        division; (2) the maintenance group, which includes the
disassembly sufficient to inspect all the operating               lines of authority to be observed by all personnel
components. It includes the repair, replacement, or               involved in the actual performance of any maintenance
servicing as necessary followed by reassembly and                 action; and (3) the maintenance organization.
functional testing. Upon completion of the overhaul
process the equipment will be capable of performing its               The maintenance organization has the res-
intended service. Much of this work is normally done at           ponsibility of managing the maintenance effort. This
naval overhaul and depot facilities, contractor plants,           includes the planning and performance of maintenance,
and other industrial facilities.                                  compliance with all maintenance policies and technical
                                                                  directives, continued training of all maintenance
                                                            6-2
                                                CATAPULT & ARRESTING
                                                     GEAR OFFICER
                                                 V-2 DIVISION OFFICER
                                                       ALRE                                            MATERIAL
                                                   MAINTENANCE                                         CONTROL
                                                     OFFICER                                           OFFICER
                                                                                                                                       FLIGHT
    NO 1       NO 2         NO 3     NO 4            NO 1        NO 2        NO 3           NO 4  BARRICADE      LENS        ILARTS     DECK
  CATAPULT   CATAPULT     CATAPULT CATAPULT        ENGINE      ENGINE      ENGINE         ENGINE    ENGINE       PETTY       PETTY    LIGHTING
   CAPTAIN    CAPTAIN      CAPTAIN  CAPTAIN         PETTY       PETTY       PETTY          PETTY    PETTY       OFFICER     OFFICER     PETTY
                                                   OFFICER     OFFICER     OFFICER        OFFICER  OFFICER                            OFFICER
VB-01 VB-02 VB-03 VB-04 VB-05 VB-06 VB-07 VB-08 VB-09 VB-10 VB-11 VB-12
personnel,      maintenance     administration,                  and                The maintenance officer, with the assistance of the
verification of actual maintenance performance.                                maintenance control chief, is specifically responsible
                                                                               for the following:
MAINTENANCE CONTROL (MC)
                                                                                       • Upkeep maintenance performed on a day-to-day
     Maintenance control is the nerve center of V-2                                      basis, including scheduled and unscheduled
division's maintenance effort. It is the center of all                                   maintenance, on-equipment repair, and the
maintenance activity, directing and receiving                                            removal/replacement of defective parts and
up-to-date information in order to properly assess                                       components
courses of action to be taken when any maintenance                                     • Incorporation of TDs, service changes (SCs),
action is performed. In every situation the maintenance                                  interim rapid action changes (IRACs), rapid
officer, assisted by the maintenance control chief, will                                 action changes (RACs), service bulletins, and
be the controlling agent, acting as the event manager in                                 repair procedures
all maintenance actions. Only the ALRE maintenance
officer or the maintenance control chief has the                                       • Documentation of all maintenance actions
authority to certify that maintenance actions have been                                • Administration of the Maintenance Data System
completed and that equipment can be returned to an                                       (MDS)
operational status.
                                                                         6-3
    • Maintenance of an active QA program to include                 • Being knowledgeable of procedures for ordering
      the inspection of all critical areas of each                     repair parts, from initial identification through
      maintenance action performed, the availability                   material receipt.
      of qualified quality assurance inspectors (QAIs),
                                                                     • Being knowledgeable of operating space item
      work center collateral duty inspectors (CDIs),
                                                                       (OSI) operations and listings. (Stocking of OSIs
      and when necessary, collateral duty quality
                                                                       is a Supply Department function, but inputs for
      assurance inspectors (CDQAIs), and the
                                                                       stocking originate with the work center.)
      operation and maintenance of an ALRE
      technical publications library (TPL) to support                • Maintaining strict tool control accountability
      all equipment and maintenance in the division                    within the work center.
    • Ensuring liaison and coordination with and                     • Recommending qualified and responsible
      documentation of maintenance from shore                          personnel to be CDIs for the work center.
      intermediate maintenance activities (SIMAs),
      VRTs, naval shipyards (NSYs), and local                        • Ensuring that QAIs/CDQAIs or CDIs are
      maintenance support activities                                   available for all tasks requiring QA inspection.
    • Planning and submitting budget requests for the                • Assisting the QA Branch in implementing and
      funding of tools, spare parts, and materials                     maintaining support for the division safety
      necessary for the proper operation and main-                     program by conducting safety training in the
      tenance of ALRE                                                  work center, using and promoting practices to
                                                                       enhance safety, and reporting all accidents and
    • Maintaining OPTAR expenditure logs and                           unsafe practices, procedures, or conditions.
      records
                                                                     • Assisting work center branch officers in
    • Requisitioning parts and materials to support                    maintaining the training program by ensuring
      ALRE operations and maintenance                                  optimum use of personnel through job
                                                                       assignments based on prior training and
    • Establishing and maintaining an effective tool
                                                                       experience, that formal in-service training is
      control program
                                                                       conducted, that on-the-job training (OJT) is
    All personnel in the maintenance organization are                  conducted under the supervision of qualified
subordinate and responsible to the maintenance officer.                work center personnel, and that Personnel
As work center group supervisors and work center                       Qualification Standards are administered
supervisors, they are responsible for the maintenance of               according to established procedures.
all systems and equipment assigned to their work
centers. Both the group and the work center supervisors              • Maintaining required reading files and ensuring
direct and manage the maintenance program in their                     that all assigned work center personnel read and
work centers, supervise the day-to-day ALRE                            initial the information contained in them on a
operations, ensure proper documentation of preventive                  monthly basis.
and corrective maintenance, and maintain effective                   • Ensuring that all work center required
communications between the work centers and MC to                      publications are available and maintained with
ensure an up-to-date maintenance profile of the                        current changes.
division. They also direct assigned work center
personnel in the performance of their duties and the             VISUAL INFORMATION DISPLAY SYSTEM
daily operation of ALRE. Group and work center                   (VIDS)
supervisors are also responsible for the following:
                                                                     The division overall maintenance status is provided
    • Keeping MC informed of all problems and
                                                                 by a visual display of current maintenance information,
      equipment status in the work center.
                                                                 located in maintenance control and maintained by the
    • Updating and validating information on the                 maintenance control chief, through the use of the visual
      Visual Information Display System (VIDS)                   information display system (VIDS) and the
      board with MC daily.                                       maintenance requirement (MR) status boards. These
                                                                 are important management tools in the maintenance
    • Ensuring that all maintenance documentation is
      complete and correct.
                                                           6-4
program because they provide a graphic display of vital         maintenance officer, maintenance control chief, and
up-to-date information.                                         group and work center supervisors to carry out their
                                                                duties more effectively and efficiently.
    The VIDS board displays all maintenance status
information—particularly system problems or failures                The maintenance control VIDS board (fig. 6-2)
and supply status—providing the ability to review the           displays maintenance information from all work
overall maintenance situation quickly. This allows the          centers in the division. It and the work center VIDS
           ALL WORK CENTER
           VIDS BOARDS VERIFIED WITH M/C
                                                                                    VERIFIED:
                                         MAINTENANCE CONTROL
                    W/C                 IN WORK                       AWM                       AWP
            CATAPULTS
                          VB-01
                    A                        B                         C                        D
                          VB-02
                                                                     JOBS
                          VB-03        JOBS IN WORK             AWAITING MAINT.
                                                                                             JOBS
                          VB-04                                                          AWAITING PARTS
             ARR GEAR
                          VB-05
                                    WORK CENTER
                                    DESIGNATIONS
                          VB-06
VB-07
                                                                                                       ABEf602
                                    Figure 6-2.—Maintenance control VIDS board.
                                                          6-5
boards (fig. 6-3) are divided into sections representing            designation, as already mentioned; (2) the In-Work
each work center. Each work center section is identified            column, which is used to display in-progress
by a standard work center designation, identification of            maintenance actions; (3) the AWM or Awaiting
the work center systems within the work center                      Maintenance column, to display maintenance actions
maintenance areas are optional on the maintenance                   that have been deferred; and (4), the AWP or Awaiting
control VIDS board. Four columns are mandatory on                   Parts column, to display maintenance actions that
the maintenance control and all work center boards.                 cannot be completed because of a lack of parts or
They are (1) the column displaying the work center                  material.
W/C VB - 01
                 SYSTEM
                EQUIPMENT                     IN WORK                    AWM                    AWP
                   DRIVE
                                          MAF                                               MAF
                  SYSTEM
                                         CARD                                              CARD
                ELECTRICAL
                  SYSTEM
                 LAUNCH
                 ENGINE
                                                                                                       ABEf603
                                              Figure 6-3.—Work center VIDS board.
                                                              6-6
Aircraft Launch and Recovery Equipment                              Black is used when a maintenance action has been
(ALRE) Maintenance Action Form (MAF) Cards                      completed and inspected at the proper level and only a
                                                                functional check remains to return the equipment to
     ALRE MAF cards (fig. 6-4) are used on the VIDS             service; a black line is drawn across all four blocks of
boards to track all outstanding work center                     the PRIORITY section.
maintenance actions, both on the work center and
                                                                     Similarly, the MS and QA blocks are provided on
maintenance control VIDS boards. Before any
                                                                the MAF card to indicate requirements for maintenance
maintenance action is started, the responsible work
                                                                support augmentation of the work center and/or
center must notify maintenance control. At this time,
                                                                QAI/CDQAI (not CDI) level inspection of the job. Jobs
work center and maintenance control MAF cards are
                                                                requiring QAI/CDQAI (not CDI) inspection will be
initiated, each card will reflect identical information
                                                                reflected with a MAF card on the quality assurance
consisting of a job control number (JCN) and a brief
                                                                (QA) VIDS board and job requiring maintenance
description of the maintenance action to be performed;
                                                                support (MS) participation will be reflected on the MS
the work center also initiates a MAF at this time. The
                                                                VIDS board.
PRIORITY section of the card will also be color coded,
as required, to indicate the system and maintenance                 The MAF card is then placed in the appropriate
status concerning equipment operational capability.             columns of the maintenance control, quality assurance,
These color codes are standardized as follows:                  maintenance support, and work center VIDS boards, to
                                                                indicate the maintenance action's current status:
    Blue is used in the LIM block to indicate limited
                                                                in-work, awaiting maintenance, or awaiting parts.
capability.
                                                                Upon completion of the maintenance action, the MAF
    Red is used in the DN block to indicate that the
                                                                card is inverted to indicate that maintenance control is
equipment is out of commission.
                                                                now awaiting a completed MAF from the responsible
    No Color is used or required if maintenance is
                                                                work center.
routine and does not affect equipment operability.
                                        JULIAN
                            JCN                     DISCREPANCY/PMS             PRIORITY
                                         DATE
W/C JSN
MRG QA MS DN LIM
                The MAF Card is locally produced and is used to monitor and manage the workload.
                Outstanding maintenance actions will be indicated by a MAF Card on both the M/C
                and w/c VIDS boards, as well as in QA and MS, when applicable. When the job is
                completed and reported to M/C, the MAF Card is simply reversed on the board to
                indicate "AWAITING MAF" until the 2-part MAF is completed, delivered to M/C, and
                signed off by the maintenance officer/maintenance control supervisor. M/C then
                discards the MAF Card and the w/c discards it upon receipt of the copy 2 MAF from
                M/C. QA will discard its MAF Card upon receipt of MAF copy 1. MS discards its MAF
                Card upon job completion and transfer of manhours to summary sheet.
                NOTE: The large, unused central portion of the front of the MAF Card may be
                modified locally to help track supply data, manhours, work start/stop, etc, If desired.
                                                                                               ABEf604
                                             Figure 6-4.—ALRE MAF card.
                                                          6-7
Aircraft Launch and Recovery Equipment                                                                         Maintenance Action Form, used in support of the
(ALRE) Maintenance Action Form (MAF)                                                                           Current Ships' Maintenance Project (CSMP). All
                                                                                                               equipment inspections and maintenance actions
    The ALRE MAF (fig. 6-5) is the major divisional                                                            (scheduled/unscheduled and corrective maintenance)
record of all maintenance performed and provides                                                               are documented on the ALRE MAF.
historical data for future references. The ALRE MAF                                                                The ALRE MAF (see fig. 6-5) is divided into seven
also supplements the OPNAV 4790/2K, Ship's                                                                     areas as follows:
      AIRCRAFT LAUNCH AND RECOVERY EQUIPMENT (ALRE)
      MAINTENANCE ACTION FORM (FOR SNAP I OMMS)
      SECTION I INFORMATION
      1. SHIPS UIC             2. W/C      3. JSN              4. APL/AEL          5. EQUIPMENT NOUN NAME                            6. WND          7. STAT       8. CAS           9. DFR        10.
      11.         12.           13. IDENT/EQUIPMENT SERIAL NUMBER                       14. EIC            15. SAFETY            16. LOCATION                                     17. WND DATE
                                                                                                                HAZARD
18. ALTERATIONS (SERVICE CHANGE - SHIPALT) 19. "/" 20. INSURV NUMBER 21. SUFFIX 22. U 23. S 24. P/F
                                                                    25. S/F MHRS EXP.                     26. DEFER DATE                   27. S/F MHRS REM                 28. DEADLINE DATE
      SECTION II DEFERRAL ACTION
29. ACTION TKN 30. S/F MHRS 31. COMPLETION DATE 32. ACT MAINT TIME 33. TI 34. METER READING
START
STOP
      SECTION IV REMARKS/DESCRIPTION
      35. REMARKS/DESCRIPTION
38. FIRST CONTACT/MAINT MAN (PRINT/SIGN) 39. RATE 40. SECOND CONTACT/SUPERVISOR (PRINT/SIGN) 41. PRI 42. T/A 43. INTEGR. PRI 44. IUC 45. TYCOM
YES NO WND EXT DAMAGE TYPE MALF TYPE ACT. TKN. SAFETY TAGS REQUIRED?
                                                                                                                              YES    NO        IF YES,
                                                                                                                                               HOW MANY?
                        1ST QA INSP. BY (PRINT/SIGN)                   2ND QA INSP. BY (PRINT/SIGN)                     FINAL QA INSP. BY (PRINT/SIGN)                V-2 MAINT. OFFICER (PRINT/SIGN)
       Q
       A
YES NO
YES NO
PAGE OF
ABEf605
Figure 6-5.—Aircraft Launch and Recovery Equipment (ALRE) Maintenance Action Form (MAF).
                                                                                                         6-8
    1. Information: contains the job control number,              arresting gear, and VLA equipment. These re-
       consisting of the work center designation and              quirements are based on calendar periods (daily,
       the job sequence number (JSN), equipment                   weekly, monthly, and so on) and the total number of
       configuration data, and discrepancy descrip-               catapult shots or arresting gear arrestments (hits)
       tion codes.                                                accumulated. Documentation of shots and hits is
                                                                  therefore mandatory to ensure that prescribed
    2. Deferral Action: contains deferral dates and
                                                                  maintenance and inspection requirements are per-
       manhours expended information (total
                                                                  formed on time.
       manhours expended by personnel involved in
       the maintenance action up to the time of                       Maintenance requirement status boards (figs. 6-6
       deferral), manhours remaining (estimated                   and 6-7) are locally produced or procured. As a
       number of manhours remaining to complete                   minimum these boards will contain information on
       the maintenance action).                                   each shot- or hit-related maintenance task specified in
                                                                  the PMS system. The minimum information elements
    3. Completed Action: contains action taken,
                                                                  required are the following:
       completion date and total manhours expended.
    4. Remarks/Description: contains a narrative                      • Maintenance requirement periodicity code
       description of the discrepancy and the work                      (M-1R, Q-1R, 24M-2R, and so forth)
       done to correct it.                                            • Description of the task and the frequency of
    5. Additional ALREMP Information: contains                          requirement
       ALRE specific codes, safety tag data,                          • Shot or hit number that the maintenance require-
       shot/hit/VLA data, PMS data and QA/ALRE                          ment is due to be performed on
       MO signatures.
                                                                      • Total number of shots or hits to date
    6. Material Control: contains quantity, nomen-
       clature, part number and contract number for                    As with the maintenance control VIDS board, the
       requisitioned items also contains two blocks               maintenance control MR status board will reflect the
       for AIMD-assistance VIDS MAF JCNs.                         required maintenance tasks of each work center in the
                                                                  division. The maintenance control MR status board is
    7. ALRE Tool Control: contains lines for the                  maintained and updated only by the maintenance
       work center and central tool room Petty                    officer, the maintenance control chief, or a person
       Officers signature.                                        specifically designated by the maintenance officer.
    When a maintenance action is completed, the                       Each work center will also have a MR status board
appropriate work center will complete a MAF, this will            that reflects the exact information contained on the
provide a comprehensive record of the maintenance                 maintenance control board. The work center supervisor
action performed and establish historical data for future         or his designated assistant will maintain and update the
reference. Therefore MAFs will be retained as follows:            work center's MR status board.
    • Corrective maintenance action MAFs will be                      A continuous audit and daily validations of the MR
      retained for a period of 1 year. The QA branch              status boards between maintenance control and the
      will retain copy 1. Copy 2 of the MAF will be               work centers are required to ensure accuracy and
      retained by the maintenance responsible work                continuity of shot/hit numbers and inspection
      center.                                                     requirements.
    • Preventive maintenance action MAFs must be
      retained by QA and the work center for the most                           REVIEW QUESTIONS
      recent PMS action performed only.
                                                                   Q4.     What is the nerve center of V-2 division
MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENT STATUS                                             maintenance effort?
BOARDS                                                             Q5.     What are the difference types of distinct
                                                                           organizations within V-2 division?
    Maintenance requirement (MR) status boards are
tools used to track critical scheduled/situational                 Q6.     What are the mandatory columns required on
maintenance and inspections required on catapults,                         the VIDS board?
                                                            6-9
 WORK                PMS                            PMS                          PMS                            PMS
CENTER     MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENT        MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENT      MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENT        MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENT
                     R-2                            R-3                          R-5                            R-6
                                           REQUEST CYLINDER SLOT     INSPECT SHUTTLE, CONNECTOR     INSPECT AND LUBRICATE WATER-
             REPLACE DRIVE SYSTEM         MEASUREMENTS FROM TYPE        GUIDES, WATERBRAKE AND        BRAKE AND LAUNCH PISTON
                                                                       LAUNCH PISTON ASSEMBLIES
  V      CABLE BETWEEN 3000/3500 SHOTS
             OR 24 MONTHS SERVICE
                                                 COMMANDER
                                          NOTE: ACCOMPLISH THIS MR    FOR ALIGNMENT AFTER EVERY
                                                                                                    ASSEMBLIES. NOTE: ACCOMPLISH
                                                                                                     BETWEEN 1300-1400, 2500-2800,
                                                                      2600 AND BEFORE 2800 SHOTS,
  B                                       WHEN DICTATED BY TABLE 1
                                                   OF MRC            REPLACE CYLINDER GAP SEALS
                                                                                                        AND EVERY 500 SHOTS
                                                                                                            THEREAFTER.
  0      24 MONTHS CABLE REPLACEMENT
  B       DATE OF
          LAST MR
                       REPLACEMENT       DATE OF       REPLACEMENT   DATE OF        REPLACEMENT      DATE OF
                                                                                                     LAST MR
                                                                                                                    REPLACEMENT
                       DATE MR           LAST MR                     LAST MR        DATE MR                         DATE MR
  0      SHOT NO.                        SHOT NO.
                                                       DATE MR
                                                                     SHOT NO.                        SHOT NO.
  3      LAST MR                         LAST MR                     LAST MR                         LAST MR
         SHOT NO.                        SHOT NO.                    SHOT NO.                        SHOT NO.
         DUE MR                          DUE MR                      DUE MR                          DUE MR
         TOTAL SHOTS                     TOTAL SHOTS                 TOTAL SHOTS                     TOTAL SHOTS
         TO DATE                         TO DATE                     TO DATE                         TO DATE
         TOTAL SHOTS                     TOTAL SHOTS                  TOTAL SHOTS                    TOTAL SHOTS
         LEFT TO MR                      LEFT TO MR                   LEFT TO MR                     LEFT TO MR
ABEf606
                                                              6-10
                    PMS                             PMS                                      PMS                              PMS
          MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENT         MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENT                  MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENT          MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENT
                    R-2                             R-3                                      R-5                              R-6
                                           REQUEST CYLINDER SLOT                 INSPECT SHUTTLE, CONNECTOR       INSPECT AND LUBRICATE WATER-
           REPLACE DRIVE SYSTEM           MEASUREMENTS FROM TYPE                    GUIDES, WATERBRAKE AND           BRAKE AND LAUNCH PISTON
          CABLE BETWEEN 3000/3500                COMMANDER                         LAUNCH PISTON ASSEMBLIES                 ASSEMBLIES.
        SHOTS OR 24 MONTHS SERVICE        NOTE: ACCOMPLISH THIS MR                FOR ALIGNMENT AFTER EVERY         NOTE: ACCOMPLISH BETWEEN
                                          WHEN DICTATED BY TABLE 1                2600 AND BEFORE 2800 SHOTS,     1300-1400, 2500-2800, AND EVERY
                                                   OF MRC                        REPLACE CYLINDER GAP SEALS           500 SHOTS THEREAFTER.
                                                              6-12
    • Reduced man-hours required to complete each                         A properly functioning QA program points out
      maintenance task                                               problem areas to maintenance managers so that
                                                                     appropriate action can be taken to accomplish the
    • Assurance that the proper tools are available to               following:
      perform specific maintenance tasks
                                                                         • Improve the quality, uniformity, and reliability
    Detailed information concerning the ALRE TCP
                                                                           of the total maintenance effort
can be found in NAEC Miscellaneous Report 51/OR
732, the ALRE Tool Control Manual.                                       • Improve the work environment and the tools and
                                                                           equipment used in the performance of
               REVIEW QUESTIONS                                            maintenance
Q13.      List benefits of the tool control program?                     • Eliminate unnecessary man-hour and dollar
                                                                           expenses
           QUALITY ASSURANCE (QA)                                        • Improve the training, work habits, and pro-
                                                                           cedures of maintenance personnel
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Describe the
    quality assurance branch organization.                               • Increase the accuracy and value of reports and
    Describe the quality assurance branch                                  correspondence originated by the division
    responsibilities. Describe quality assurance
                                                                         • Distribute required technical information more
    audits.
                                                                           effectively
     QA is the planned and systematic pattern of actions
necessary to prevent defects from occurring from the                     • Establish realistic material and equipment
start of a maintenance operation to its finish. QA is the                  requirements in support of the maintenance
responsibility of all personnel involved in the                            effort
operation, upkeep, and maintenance of ALRE.                              • Support safety and FOD prevention and report-
   The achievement of QA depends on prevention,                            ing programs
knowledge, and special skills as they are described.
                                                                     QUALITY ASSURANCE BRANCH
    • Prevention is the power to regulate events rather              ORGANIZATION
      than being regulated by them. This extends to
      the safety of personnel, the maintenance of                         The QA branch is comprised of a small group of
      equipment, the training of personnel, and all                  skilled personnel who are permanently assigned to the
      aspects of the total maintenance effort.                       branch. The personnel assigned to the QA branch are
                                                                     known as quality assurance inspectors (QAIs). They are
    • Knowledge is derived from factual information.                 responsible for conducting QAI-level inspections and
      Knowledge is acquired through data collection                  the management and monitoring of QA programs in the
      and analysis as a means of identifying, tracking,              division. Additionally, personnel assigned to other
      and preventing defects.                                        branches and work centers will be designated to
    • Special skills are those skills possessed by the               perform certain inspection functions NOT requiring
      personnel trained in the technique of data                     QAI-level involvement. These personnel are collateral
      analysis and supervision of the QA program.                    duty inspectors (CDIs), who are assigned to inspect
                                                                     specific steps of a maintenance procedure performed by
     The QA program provides an efficient method of                  their respective work center. They are responsible to the
gathering and maintaining information on the quality,                QA branch supervisor while performing QA functions.
characteristics of repair parts, maintenance procedures,             CDIs are NOT permitted to inspect their own work
training, and on the source and nature of defects and                under any circumstance.
their impact. The QA program permits maintenance
and operational decisions to be made based on facts                       It may also be necessary to augment the QA branch
rather than intuition or memory, by providing                        with collateral duty quality assurance inspectors
comparative data that is useful long after the details of a          (CDQAIs) to temporarily alleviate given skill or
particular event has been forgotten.                                 manpower shortages. CDQAIs must meet the same
                                                                     criteria as QAIs, including designation in writing by the
                                                                     commanding officer, and will have the same authority
                                                              6-13
as QAIs but remain part of their respective work                   general and specific safety rules, and the analysis of
centers. Should it become necessary to assign an                   maintenance deficiencies, while minimizing man-hour
individual below the paygrade of E-6 as a CDQAI, a                 and material expenditures.
letter must be submitted informing the cognizant type
                                                                       To carry out these responsibilities, personnel
commander (TYCOM) of this decision and the
                                                                   assigned to the QA branch perform the following
assignment must not exceed a period of 90 days without
                                                                   duties:
the approval of the cognizant TYCOM. In no case an
individual below the paygrade of E-5 be appointed as a                 • Maintain the central TPL for the division.
CDQAI.                                                                   Review incoming technical publications and
                                                                         directives to determine their application to
RESPONSIBILITY FOR QUALITY OF                                            individual maintenance branches, and monitor
MAINTENANCE                                                              the management of the dispersed TPLs in the
                                                                         maintenance branches.
     To establish a successful QA program, everyone in
the maintenance organization must fully support it. It is              • Ensure that all work guides, equipment guide
not the training, maintenance instructions, or other                     lists, and maintenance requirement cards, and
facilities that determine the success or failure of a QA                 other information used to define or control
program, it is the frame of mind of all assigned                         maintenance are complete and current before
personnel.                                                               issuing to work centers.
     Each person must know that quality work is vital to               • Prepare or assist in the preparation of main-
the effective operation of the maintenance organization.                 tenance instructions (MIs) to ensure that QA
Each must know the specifications required to achieve                    objectives and requirements are defined.
quality work, as well as the purpose of those                          • Provide a continuous training program in the
specifications.                                                          techniques and procedures used to conduct
    The person most directly concerned with and                          inspections. Participate as members of task
responsible for quality workmanship is the work center                   forces to study trouble areas and submit
supervisor. This stems from his responsibility for the                   recommendations for corrective action.
proper professional performance of assigned
                                                                       • Establish requirements and qualifications for
personnel. It is the direct responsibility of the work
                                                                         QAI/CDQAIs and CDIs; review the
center supervisor to ensure that the proper level of QA
                                                                         qualifications of personnel nominated for these
inspection is assigned to the job when the job is
                                                                         positions; and develop and administer written
assigned to maintenance personnel. This procedure
                                                                         examinations to test the knowledge of personnel
allows the inspector to make a progressive inspection as
                                                                         nominated for QA positions.
required. This also ensures that an inspector is not
confronted with a job that has been completed before he                • Provide technical assistance to CDIs and
could inspect it.                                                        periodically accompany CDIs on assigned
                                                                         inspections and evaluate their performance.
     Direct communication between the QA branch and
the maintenance branch is a necessity and must be                      • Monitor and review all requests for departures
energetically exercised. Although the maintenance                        from specifications, requests for engineering
officer is responsible for the overall quality of the                    information (REIs), hazardous material reports
maintenance in the division, branch officers, branch                     (HMRs), fast-action discrepancy reports
supervisors, and work center supervisors are                             (FADRs), feedback reports (FBRs), technical
responsible for ensuring that required inspections are                   publications deficiency reports (TPDRs),
conducted and that quality workmanship is attained.                      quality deficiency reports (QDRs), and technical
                                                                         manual        deficiency/evaluation      reports
QUALITY ASSURANCE BRANCH                                                 (TMDERs) to ensure that they are clear, concise,
RESPONSIBILITIES AND FUNCTIONS                                           and comprehensive prior to submission.
    The QA branch is responsible for the                               • Monitor the use of precision measuring
implementation, management, and monitoring of                            equipment (PME) to ensure compliance with
specific programs designed to improve the quality of                     calibration intervals and safety instructions.
maintenance, the training of personnel, adherence to
                                                            6-14
   • Inspect all maintenance equipment and facilities               QAI/CDQAIs are designated in writing by the
     to ensure compliance with fire and safety                  commanding officer after recommendation by the V-2
     regulations and existence of satisfactory                  maintenance officer, the V-2 division officer, and the air
     environmental conditions.                                  department officer on the ALRE Quality Assurance
                                                                Inspector Recommendation/Designation form (fig.
   • Monitor training, qualification, and licensing of          6-8).
     equipment operators and drivers.
                                                                CDIs
   • Maintain a Trend Analysis Program, either
     through the periodic review of inspection                      As stated earlier in this chapter, CDIs are assigned
     records, noting any recurring discrepancies                to the work centers and are to inspect all work and
     requiring special attention, or at the request of          comply with all QA objectives and requirements during
     the work center supervisor for a particular                all maintenance actions performed by their respective
     problem area on a one-time or continuing basis.            work centers. They will also be familiar with the
                                                                provisions of the various QA and maintenance
   • Develop checklists for auditing work centers               management programs managed and monitored by the
     and specific maintenance programs.                         QA branch.
    Billet descriptions are to be prepared for QA                   QA will establish minimum qualifications for
personnel to ensure that all QA functions and                   personnel recommended for CDI. All CDIs must be
responsibilities are assigned to individual QAIs                PQS qualified on the particular type of equipment that
assigned to the QA branch.                                      they are assigned to inspect during maintenance. In
                                                                addition, while CDIs are performing QA duties, they
QUALITY ASSURANCE INSPECTOR                                     are responsible to the QA branch supervisor, ensuring
QUALIFICATIONS                                                  that all maintenance, safety, and QA requirements are
                                                                met by the work center by performing spot checks of all
    All personnel being considered for selection as a           in-progress maintenance and work.
QAI or CDQAI, should meet the following
qualifications:                                                      CDIs are designated in writing by the air
                                                                department officer after recommendation by the V-2
QAI/CDQAIs                                                      maintenance officer and the V-2 division officer (see
   1. Be senior in grade and experience. This is                fig. 6-8).
      defined to mean a first class petty officer or                 All QA inspectors (QAI/CDQAIs and CDIs) will
      above with a well-rounded maintenance                     be required to demonstrate their knowledge and ability
      background. It is recognized though, that                 by passing a written test administered by the QA
      unusual circumstances may temporarily                     branch. Personnel assigned to perform QA functions
      require the use of other than E-6 or above                (QAI/CDQAIs and CDIs) will receive continuous
      personnel. Under these circumstances, the                 training in inspecting, testing, and quality control
      most experienced personnel available, as                  methods specifically applicable to their area of
      determined by the maintenance officer, may be             responsibility. They will also receive cross training in
      temporarily designated as a QAI or CDQAI as               the performance of duties outside their area of
      required.                                                 responsibility. This training will include local training
   2. Have fully developed skills and experience                courses, OJT, rotation of assignments, and required
      related to the technical fields under their               formal equipment and QA training schools.
      cognizance.
                                                                QUALITY ASSURANCE AUDITS
   3. Be able to research, read, and interpret
      drawings, technical manuals, and directives.                  QA audits are essential elements of an effective QA
   4. Be able to write with clarity and technical               program. They provide an evaluation of performance
      accuracy.                                                 and program compliance throughout the division by
                                                                serving in an orderly method of identifying,
   5. Be stable and excellent in performance.                   investigating, and correcting program deficiencies on a
   6. Be observant, alert, and inquisitive.                     regular basis. Audits are used to evaluate specific
                                                         6-15
OPNAVINST 4790.15B
1 FEBRUARY 1995
"When performing inspections, I am considered to be the direct representative of the Commanding Officer for ensuring
operational safety of the item concerned. I will not permit factors, such as operational desires, maintenance
consideration, personal relations or the approach of liberty to modify my judgement. By signing an inspection report, I
am certifying upon my own individual responsibility that the work involved has been personally inspected by me; that it
has been properly completed and is in accordance with current instructions and directives; that it is satisfactory; that any
related parts or components which may have been removed by the work are properly replaced and all parts are secure;
and that the work has been performed in such a manner that the item is completely safe for use."
                                                            6-16
maintenance programs assigned to the QA branch for               specifically assigned to the QA branch for monitoring.
either management or monitoring.                                 Special audits are conducted at the direction of the
                                                                 maintenance officer or QA supervisor on an as required
    Audits fall into three categories:
                                                                 basis.
     1. Work center audit—These audits are con-
                                                                     Audit forms, with appropriate checklists, for each
ducted quarterly to evaluate the overall quality
                                                                 work center is developed by QA. Upon completion of
performance of each work center. As a minimum the
                                                                 an audit, the findings are reviewed with the branch and
following areas and items will be evaluated:
                                                                 work center supervisors; and a report of the findings,
    • Personnel and skills                                       with recommendations when required, is submitted to
                                                                 the maintenance officer. Records of audits are
    • Technical publications
                                                                 maintained for 2 years.
    • Maintenance instructions                                       Adequate follow-up procedures must also be
    • Adherence to directives, procedures, and                   established to ensure that discrepancies found during a
      inspections                                                QA audit are resolved. Attention from all levels within
                                                                 the V-2 division organization is essential.
    • Adequacy and availability of process, test, and
      inspection procedures                                          3. Annual type commander audit—The cognizant
                                                                 type commander maintenance management team
    • Availability and calibration status of PME                 conducts an annual audit of each carrier's ALRE QA
    • Proper use of PME                                          program.
                                                                     The Aircraft Launch and Recovery Equipment
    • Certification of personnel performing special
                                                                 Maintenance Program (ALREMP), OPNAVINST
      processes such as welding and operating yellow
                                                                 4790.15, establishes the maintenance policies, pro-
      gear
                                                                 cedures, and responsibilities required to provide an
    • Handling, packaging, protecting, and storing of            integrated system for performing maintenance and
      material and parts                                         supporting related functions on ship's installed aircraft
                                                                 launch and recovery systems and associated support
    • Cleanliness and condition of spaces                        systems and equipment.
    • Compliance with fire and safety regulations                    To obtain the full benefits of the QA program,
    • Configuration of components and equipment,                 teamwork must first be achieved. Blending QA
      and accuracy of associated logs and records                functions with the interests of the entire division creates
                                                                 a more effective program. Every maintenance person
    • Equipment logs and records                                 and supervisor must be permitted to use an optimum
    • Material condition of equipment                            degree of judgment in the course of daily operations
                                                                 and the performance of daily work assignments. A
    • FOD prevention program compliance                          person's judgment plays an important part in the quality
                                                                 of the work he performs. QA techniques supply each
    • TCP compliance
                                                                 person with information on actual quality, which
    • Corrosion control program compliance                       provides a challenge to improve the quality of his work.
                                                                 The resulting knowledge encourages the best efforts of
    • Tag-out program compliance                                 all maintenance personnel.
    • General and        electrical   safety   programs
      compliance                                                                REVIEW QUESTIONS
    2. Special audits—These are conducted to                     Q14.      True or False: CDIs are permanently
evaluate specific maintenance tasks, processes,                            assigned to the QA branch?
procedures, or programs. They provide a systematic,
coordinated method of investigating known                        Q15.      Who is responsible to ensure that the proper
deficiencies, evaluating the quality of workmanship,                       level of QA inspection is assigned to a
and determining the adequacy of and adherence to                           maintenance action?
applicable technical publications/instructions. Special          Q16.      Who designates QAIs and CDQAIs?
audits are also used by QA to monitor those programs
                                                          6-17
Q17.      What are the categories of QA audits?                         You should know that V-2 divisions support naval
                                                                    operations through the upkeep and operation of
                     SUMMARY                                        catapult and arresting gear equipment and that the
                                                                    Aircraft   Launch     and    Recovery    Equipment
    You should now know that overhaul maintenance is                Maintenance Program (ALREMP) makes this type of
restorative or additive work on catapults, arresting gear,          support possible.
VLA, and their associated equipment that is usually
performed at a naval overhaul and depot facility,                        You should also know that the ALREMP program
contractor plant, or industrial facility.                           depends heavily on the quality assurance concept and
    You should know that maintenance tasks are                      that quality assurance in maintenance is a responsibility
assigned according to the complexity, scope, and range              of all hands.
of the work to be performed. You have read about the                    Should you not fully understand this chapter, you
duties of the maintenance control, quality assurance,               should thoroughly study it again. You, as an ABE, will
and maintenance support branches of V-2 division. You               be responsible for supporting ALREMP through your
should now know the purposes of the maintenance                     knowledge and experience.
action forms and the procedures for their completion.
                                                             6-18
                                                   CHAPTER 7
    As the workcenter or branch supervisor, you are                according to schedule, they will allow equipment
directly responsible for the maintenance effort of your            operators and maintenance personnel to identify
workcenter. The planning, scheduling, control and                  possible problems before equipment failure. Properly
parts ordering are essential to its accomplishment.                performed PMS actions will help prevent failures that
                                                                   could result in repeated corrective maintenance actions.
    The factors that you must consider in maintenance
planning are equipment status, operational                              PMS procedures are developed by the activities and
requirements, the workload, and the personnel assets               offices of the systems commands responsible for the
available to perform the job.                                      development and procurement of the systems and
                                                                   equipment they control. PMS maintenance index pages
      PLANNED MAINTENANCE SYSTEM                                   (MIPs) and MRCs are developed as part of the
                                                                   Integrated Logistics Support effort for all new
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: State who has                             procurements, alterations, and modifications of
    the responsibility for managing PMS programs                   systems and equipment.
    for equipment aboard ship. Identify three
    considerations used to determine PMS                              Management tools provided by PMS for each ship,
    procedures.                                                    department, and supervisor include the following:
     The Planned Maintenance System (PMS) is a                         • Comprehensive procedures for planned main-
simplified, yet thorough means of accomplishing                          tenance of systems and equipment
preventive maintenance aboard ship. It identifies                      • Minimum requirements for planned main-
maintenance requirements, and schedules maintenance                      tenance
actions to make the best use of your resources. It
increases economy and simplifies records. It improves                  • Scheduling and control of maintenance
management,         workload     planning,     equipment               • Description of the methods, materials, tools, and
reliability, and on-the-job training of shipboard                        personnel needed to perform maintenance
personnel. As a system, however, it is neither
self-starting nor self-sustained, and careful supervision              • Prevention or detection of hidden failures or
at all levels is required.                                               malfunctions
     PMS procedures and how frequently the actions                     • Test procedures to determine material readiness
should be done are developed for each piece of
                                                                        PMS, though standard in concept and procedures,
equipment based on good engineering practices,
                                                                   is flexible enough to be adjusted by the ship to be
practical experience, and technical standards. These
                                                                   compatible with operational and other types of
step-by-step procedures are published on maintenance
                                                                   schedules.
requirement cards (MRCs). The cards contain detailed
information on each maintenance requirement, such as               DEPARTMENTAL MASTER PMS MANUAL
who (specific rate) should perform the maintenance,
and when, how, and with what resources. Some MRCs                       A Departmental Master PMS Manual is maintained
have equipment guide lists (EGLs) to identify the                  in each departmental office for use in planning,
locations of various pieces of the same type of                    scheduling, and supervising required maintenance. The
equipment, such as motors, controllers, valves, life               information contained in this manual pertains only to
rafts, deck fittings, and hatches that are serviced at the         equipment for which the department is responsible. The
same time.                                                         Departmental Master PMS Manual contains the
    Keep in mind that PMS actions, as preventive                   following:
maintenance actions, are the minimum maintenance                       1. Supplementary Information: Additional
actions required to maintain the equipment in a fully                     instructions, information, and data provided to
operable condition. If PMS actions are performed
                                                             7-1
   assist in implementation and accomplishment             department, divided by workcenters, and
   of PMS.                                                 contains the following information:
2. List of Effective Pages (LOEP): The                     a. Report date (date LOEP was produced).
   Departmental LOEP (fig. 7-1) provides a
                                                           b. FR (Force Revision).
   listing of the MIPs assigned to each
Unit: DDG 0053 UIC: R21313 Work Center: EA01 USS JOHN PAUL JONES
 Adds/
 Changes     MIP                      Nomenclature
                                                 7-2
c. Type Commander (TYCOM).                                                             h. Equipment status code.
d. Unit (ship's hull number, UIC, and name).                                     3. Maintenance Index Pages (MIP): MIPs are
   Shore activity (UIC number).                                                     prepared and issued for each installed system
                                                                                    or piece of equipment for which PMS support
e. Workcenter.
                                                                                    has been established. MIPs are basic PMS
f.     MIP number.                                                                  reference documents. Each MIP is an index of
g. Nomenclature (brief description of the                                           a complete set of MRCs applicable to a ship
   system/equipment).                                                               system, subsystem, and equipment. MIPs (fig.
                                                                                    7-2) contain the following information:
      SHIP SYSTEM, SYSTEM, SUBSYSTEM, OR EQUIPMENT                 REFERENCE PUBLICATIONS                      DATE
                                                                    NAVSEA S8225-GY-MMA-010                    May 2000
           Fire Extinguishing System, Fog, Foam, and AFFF
           5551                                                     NAVSEA S9555-AN-MMO-010
      T    O                                                                                 PERIO-                       RELATED
      E    T SYSCOM MRC                                                                                           MAN
      S    H CONTROL NO                MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENT DESCRIPTION                   DICITY   RATES                MAINT-
                                                                                                                 HOURS
      T    E                                                                                 CODE                         ENANCE
           R
                              A scheduling aid; Review maintenance requirements. Omit
                              MRC(s) which do not apply; no feedback report required.
                              # Mandatory scheduling required.
                46 6UMU N     1. Inspect high-capacity AFFF injection station.                D-1     HT2        0.2      None
                42 8UNR N     1. Inspect proportioner station FP-180.                         D-2     HT2        0.2      None
                42 8UNQ N     1. Turn AFFF proportioner shaft by hand.                        W-1     HT/DC3     0.4      None
                              2. Inspect oil level in AFFF proportioner.
       4        B4 6UMV N     1. Inspect high capacity AFFF injection station operation.      Q-1     HT3        2.0      None
                              2. Test AFFF concentrate for seawater contamination.                    FN         0.5
       4        80 6DAA N     1. Test operate, inspect, and clean 1000 gpm AFFF               Q-2     HT/DC3     2.0      None
                              proportioner station.                                                   FN         0.5
       4        16 6DAD N     1. Test AFFF concentrate for seawater contamination at          Q-3     HT3        2.0      None
                              FP-180 station.
                88 8DRU N     1. Clean and inspect hose reel stations.                        Q-4     HT/DC3     0.5      None
                44 6UMW N     1. Lubricate AFFF injection pump bearings.                      Q-5     HT3        0.3      Q-1
                                                                                                      EM3        0.3
       4        54 C1TH N     1. Test operate, inspect, and clean AFFF FP-180 station.        Q-6R    HT/DC3     2.0      None
                              2. Lubricate FP-180 proportioner.                                       FN         0.5
                              NOTE: Accomplish quarterly or after each use,
                                       whichever occurs first.
                97 8GMG N     1. Accomplish liquid foam quantitative analysis at FP-180       S-2     DCA                 D-2#
                              stations.                                                               HT1        0.7      Q-3#
                                                                                                      HG3        0.4      Q-4#
                                                                                                                          or
                                                                                                                          R-1#
                44 6UMY N     1. Change oil in AFFF injection station reducer.                S-3     HT3        0.4      None
                38 8HQR N     1. Inspect AFFF bilge sprinkling system nozzles.                S-4     HT/DC      1.0      None
                                                                                                      HTFN/      1.0
                                                                                                      DCFN
                39 6UMZ N     1. Accomplish AFFF concentration analysis                       A-1     HT/DC      0.7      D-1#
                                                                                                      HG/DC2     0.4      Q-1#
                                                                                                                          Q-4#
                                                                                                                          or
                                                                                                                          R-1#
                44 6UNA N     1. Lubricate high-capacity AFFF injection station flexible      A-2     HT3        0.8      None
                              couplings.
                10 8NPR N     1. Inspect and hydrostatically test AFFF station hose(s)..      A-3     HT/DC2     0.3      None
                                                                                                      2FN        0.6
      DISTRIBUTION STATEMENT D
      Distribution authorized to DOD components and DOD contractors only; critical technology; May 1994. Other requests for this
      document shall be referred to Naval Sea Systems Command (SEA 04TD). Destroy by any method that will prevent disclosure of
      contents or reconstruction of the document.
                                                                    7-3
  a. Ship system, subsystem, or equipment                     c. Date: Preparation date of the MIP by
     description of noun name.                                   month and year.
  b. Reference publications about the system,                 d. Test, Other, and SYSCOM MRC control
     subsystem, or equipment.                                    number columns.
                                                7-4
        e. Maintenance requirement: A brief                       maintenance action and state who is to perform the
           description of each maintenance require-               maintenance and what is to be done, and when, how,
           ment.                                                  and with what resources a specific requirement is to be
                                                                  accomplished. MRCs contain the following
        f.   Periodicity code: Shows how frequently
                                                                  information and instructions:
             the maintenance is to be performed.
                                                                      SHIP SYSTEM, SYSTEM, SUBSYSTEM,
        g. Rate (skill level): Identifies the
           recommended skill level of the person(s)               EQUIPMENT.—These            blocks    contains    the
           considered capable of performing the                   identification of the ship system (functional group),
           maintenance      requirement.    Qualified             system, subsystem, or equipment involved.
           personnel other than the rate/rating                       MRC CODE.—The MRC code consists of two
           specified may be assigned. When a Navy                 parts. The first part of the MRC code is the MIP series
           Enlisted Classification (NEC) is assigned,             code. MRCs applicable to more than one MIP series
           substitution of other personnel is not                 will have each MIP series entered in this block. If more
           allowed.                                               than four MIP series apply, reference will be made to a
        h. Man-hours (MH): Total time required to                 note in the Procedure block. The second part is the
           do the maintenance.                                    maintenance requirement periodicity code. The only
                                                                  authorized periodicities are listed in Table 7-1.
        i.   Related maintenance.
                                                                      The periodicity code also includes a number for
             (1) Mandatory                                        specific identification. When more than one MRC of
             (2) Convenience                                      the same periodicity exists in the same MRC set, the
                                                                  MRCs, in most cases, will be numbered consecutively;
             (3) None                                             for example, D-1, D-2, D-3, or M-1, M-2, M-3. An
        j.   Scheduling aids: Amplifying instructions,            existing MRC may be reapplied to a revised MIP even
             if needed, are located in the maintenance            though the periodicity code of the reapplied MRC may
             requirement description block.                       not fall within the normally sequential numeric
                                                                  periodicity codes. For example, W-1, W-2, W-3, and
        k. SYSCOM MIP control number.                             W-6 may appear on a MIP, since W-6 was an existing
        l.   Inactive equipment maintenance (IEM):                MRC that was reapplied to this equipment. Technically,
             Maintenance performed when specific                  valid MRCs will not be reprinted merely to change the
             equipment will remain inactive for 30 days           periodicity code number. Nonsequential numbers will
             or longer and is not scheduled for repair,           not affect scheduling or management control.
             maintenance, or overhaul by either the                    Dual periodicity codes are used when con-
             ship's force or an external repair activity.         figurations or utility differences of a permanent nature
    4. The Departmental Master PMS Manual also                    exist     between      installations   of   the    same
       includes a MIP to Workcenter File (fig. 7-3).              system/equipment. A dual periodicity may be assigned
                                                                  if no other aspect of the MRC requires modification to
WORKCENTER PMS MANUAL                                             fit both periodicities. For example, equipment installed
                                                                  in an SSN or in a surface unit may see daily use, while
    The Workcenter PMS Manual contains only the                   the same equipment installed in an SSBN may be idle
planned maintenance requirements applicable to a                  for long periods of time because of the nature of the
particular workcenter. It is designed to provide a ready          ship's mission. This long period of idleness may result
reference of planned maintenance requirements for the             in     less   frequently       performed    maintenance
workcenter supervisor and should be retained in the               requirements. In this case a dual periodicity, such as
working area, near the Weekly PMS Schedule, in the                M-1/Q-I or Q-1/S-2, may be assigned. When dual
holder provided.                                                  periodicities are assigned a note on the MIP and the
                                                                  MRC will specify the frequency of maintenance, for
Maintenance Requirement Cards (MRCs)                              example, "NOTE: SSBN, schedule quarterly; all others
                                                                  schedule monthly." The unrequired periodicity should
    Maintenance Requirement Cards (MRCs) (fig. 7-4)               be deleted by having a line drawn through it.
provide the detailed procedures used to perform a
                                                            7-5
 SHIP SYSTEM                          SUBSYSTEM                                    MRC CODE
 Miscellaneous Shipboard              Miscellaneous Shipboard Electrical Equip        3000        M-4/
 Electrical Equip and Installed       and Installed Receptacles 3000                              Q-2R
 Receptacles 3000
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
  1. Forces afloat comply with Navy Safety Precautions for Forces Afloat, OPNAVINST 5100 series.
  2. Ensure all tag-out procedures are in accordance with current shipboard instructions.
  3. Tool test set (SCAT 4547) can produce voltages dangerous to life. Wear rubber gloves.
                                                                                                                PAGE 1 OF 3
  4. [2277] Pad, writing paper
 NOTE: Numbers in brackets can be referenced to Standard PMS Materials Identification Guide (SPMIC) for stock
        number identification.
PROCEDURE
NOTE 1:     For equipment issued on permanent or semi-permanent loan to work centers,
            accomplish monthly, all other accomplish quarterly or before each issue. For repair
            locker equipment, accomplish quarterly or after each use, whichever occurs first.                   24
DISTRIBUTION STATEMENT D
                                                                                                                4ABG
Distribution authorized to DOD components and DOD contractors only; critical technology; February 1994.
Other requests for this document shall be referred to Naval Sea Systems Command (SEA 04TD). Destroy by any
method that will prevent disclosure of contents or reconstruction of the document.
LOCATION                                                                           DATE
                                                                                                                N
                                                           7-6
                                           Table 7-1.—Periodicity Codes
                                           PERIODICITY CODES
  D - Daily                                                    S - Semiannually
  2D - Every 2nd day                                           8M- - Every 8th month
  3D - Every 3rd day                                           A - Annually
  W - Weekly                                                   18M - Every 18 months
  2W - Every 2nd week                                          24M - Every 24 months
  3W - Every 3rd week                                          30M - Every 30 months
  M - Monthly                                                  36M - Every 36 months
  2M - Every 2d month                                          48M - Every 48 months
  Q - Quarterly                                                54M - Every 54 months
  4M - Every 4th month                                         60M - Every 60 months
                                     NON-CALENDAR PERIODICITY
    R - Situation requirement
    U - Unscheduled maintenance
                             INACTIVE EQUIPMENT MAINTENANCE (IEM)
    LU - Lay-up
    PM - Periodic maintenance
    SU - Start-up
    OT - Operational test
    Situation requirement codes may be used with a             schedule equipment lubrication weekly when at sea.
calendar periodicity code in certain circumstances.            That means that the R-IW is entered into a daily column
These situations fall within two general categories:           of the weekly schedule only when the ship is at sea.
                                                               During in-port times the R-IW will remain in the
    • When the situation governs the scheduling of the
                                                               Outstanding Repairs and PM Checks Due In Next 4
      requirement
                                                               Weeks column.
    • When the calendar periodicity governs the                     When the periodicity code is of the
      scheduling of the requirement                            calendar-situation combination, the calendar controls
    For example, consider the occasion of weekly               the scheduling and is only occasionally overtaken by
measurement of values when a certain system is in              the situation. The calendar periodicity is referred to first
operation. The measurement of these values will not be         in the code, for example, 18M-2R. In the example, the
required when the equipment is not being operated,             18M indicates that the longest time between
regardless of how prolonged the idle period may be.            accomplishment is every 18 months, and the 2R
There are cases in which requirements must be                  indicates that a situation could arise which would
scheduled with regard to the situation rather than the         require it to be done more often. An explanation of such
calendar timing. The periodicity code will state the R         situations will appear on the MRC. When the situation
for situation first, and after the hyphen and a unique         no longer exists, scheduling reverts to the 18-month
number, a letter will recognize the calendar                   period. Some examples of the combined calendar and
contingency. An example of a situation-calendar                situation requirements are as follows:
periodicity code is that an R-IW requires you to
                                                         7-7
   M-1R: Monthly or every 600 hours, whichever                           correctly, may lead to injury or death. Warnings
occurs first.                                                            are listed in the Safety Precautions block and are
                                                                         repeated preceding the procedure involved.
     W-3R: Weekly or after each use, whichever occurs
first.                                                                • Caution: Explains operating procedures,
   S-1R: Semiannually or during each upkeep period,                     practices, and so forth that, if not correctly
whichever occurs first.                                                 followed, may lead to damage to equipment.
                                                                        Cautions are not listed in the Safety Precautions
   Q1-1R: Quarterly or prior to getting underway,                       block; however, they do precede the instructions
whichever occurs first.                                                 for the procedure involved.
    When the periodicity code includes a situation                    TOOLS, PARTS, MATERIALS, TEST
requirement (such as R-1 or Q-1R), a note of                      EQUIPMENT.—This section lists the test equipment,
explanation is required in addition to the basic code.            materials, parts, tools, and miscellaneous requirements
This note is the first entry in the Procedure block.              necessary to perform the maintenance action. Each of
    MAINTENANCE               REQUIREMENT            DE-          the above categories may include both Standard PMS
SCRIPTION.—The              maintenance     requirement           Item Name (SPIN) and non-SPIN items. Entries in this
description is a brief definition of the PMS action to be         block can be cross-referenced to the Standard PMS
performed.                                                        Materials Identification Guide (SPMIG) for stock
                                                                  number identification.
     RATES.—The rate is the recommended skill level
of the person who should be qualified to do the work,             Equipment Guide List (EGL)
identified by rate or NEC (Navy Enlisted
Classification). Qualified personnel other than those                 The EGL (OPNAV Form 4790/81) (fig. 7-5) is a
specified may be assigned. When more than one person              5x8-inch card that is used with a controlling MRC
in the same rate is required, the appropriate number of           when the MRC applies to a number of identical items,
persons precedes the rate. When more than one person              such as motors, controllers, life rafts, valves, test
in the same rate is required and time requirements are            equipment, and small arms. Each ship prepares its own
not equal, each person is listed separately.                      EGLs.
     MAN-HOURS (M/H).—Man-hours is the                                The number of items included on an EGL is
average amount of time required of each rate listed in            directly related to the time to do the maintenance on
the Rates block to perform the maintenance, on each               each item. Each EGL normally contains no more than a
piece of identical equipment, listed in hours and tenths          single day's work. If more than 1 day is required,
of an hour. When more than one person in the same rate            separate EGL pages are prepared for each day and are
is required and time requirements are equal, man-hours            numbered consecutively.
listed are the sum of their requirements. When more
                                                                      In some instances it may be unnecessary or
than one person in the same rate is required and time
                                                                  impractical to list the equipment on EGLs. For
requirements are not equal, man-hours are listed for
                                                                  instance, if the equipment is listed on a
each person separately. Total man-hours are the sum of
                                                                  TYCOM-directed checklist or if an Automated
all entries in the M/H block. Make ready and put away
                                                                  Calibration Recall Program is in effect, a notation of the
time, including removal and/or replacement of
                                                                  applicable instruction in the Location block of the
anything that interferes with the maintenance (covers,
                                                                  MRC is all that is required.
other equipment, and so on) is not included.
     SAFETY PRECAUTIONS.—This section of the                      Tag Guide List (TGL)
MRC provides a listing of precautions and publications
that direct attention to possible hazards to personnel or             The TGL (OPNAV Form 4790/107) (fig. 7-6)
equipment during maintenance. The word “NOTE”                     contains the information necessary for equipment
will precede procedural advisories. Specific categories           tag-out required during PMS actions. The TGL
of direction are as follows:                                      contains the number of tags required, locations of the
                                                                  tags, position of each tagged item (open, shut, off, on,
    • Warning: Explains operating procedures,                     and so on) and permission or notification requirements.
      practices, and so forth, that, if not followed              Each ship prepares its own TGLs.
                                                            7-8
EQUIPMENT GUIDE LIST
OPNAV 4790/81 (2-76)                                             PAGE         OF
S/N 0107-LF-047-9405
MIIP NO. (Less last 2 characters)                                                  MRC PERIODICITY
                                                         SERIAL NO.
          EQUIPMENT NAME NOMENCLATURE                                        LOCATION            APPLICABLE DATA AS REQUIRED BY MRC
                                                          QUANTITY
                                                                                                                                 ABEf0705
                                                 Figure 7-5.—Equipment Guide List (EGL).
                                                                      7-9
Location of MRCs, EGLs, and TGLs                                     and TGLs are attached to related master MRCs. In
                                                                     addition, a complete working deck of applicable
    A master MRC deck is maintained at the                           MRCs, EGLs, and TGLs is located in MRC holders in
departmental level. Each departmental master deck                    each workcenter. Maintenance personnel use these to
contains only one copy of applicable MRCs filed by                   perform assigned planned maintenance.
SYSCOM control number. Applicable master EGLs
                                                                                                     REPORT SYMBOL OPNAV 4790-4
                                     SEE INSTRUCTIONS ON BACK OF GREEN PAGE
REMARKS
72 EZV9 N
12 EZV0 N
20 EZW5 N
                                                              7-10
PMS Feedback Report (FBR)                                           TYCOM, as applicable, of technical and nontechnical
                                                                    matters related to PMS. The FBR is a five-part form
    The PMS Feedback Report (FBR) (OPNAV                            composed of an original and four copies. Figures 7-7
4790/2B) is a form used by maintenance personnel to                 and 7-8 provide examples of FBRs. Instructions for
notify NAVSEACEN, NAVAIRENGCEN, and
                                                                                                    REPORT SYMBOL OPNAV 4790-4
                                    SEE INSTRUCTIONS ON BACK OF GREEN PAGE
REMARKS
                                                             7-11
preparation and submission of the form are printed on                                1. Category A—This category (fig. 7-7) is
the back of the last copy (fig. 7-9).                                                   nontechnical in nature and is intended to meet
                                                                                        PMS needs that do not require technical
PMS FBR Categories                                                                      review. Category A FBRs are submitted to
                                                                                        request classified or other PMS documentation
    There are two categories of FBRs-category A and                                     which cannot be obtained locally. With the
category B-defined as follows:                                                          ship’s master PMS requirements on compact
1. ORIGINATOR
a. Typewritten copies are preferred, however, handprinted copies are acceptable. Use ballpoint pen and ensure all copies are legible.
          b. EQUIPMENT IDENTIFICATION: Fill in titled blocks that apply. Give as much information that can be determined. Ensure that
             correct APL number is used for hull, mechanical or electrical equipment or electronic/weapons equipment which does not have
             any Army-Navy number or mark/mod designation.
Category A
               (1) MIP/MRC REPLACEMENT: Ensure that PMS documentation request is current in accordance with latest SFR. For missing
                   MIPs/MRCs, give SYSCOM control numbers when they can be determined. If SYSCOM control numbers cannot be
                   determined, provide as much nameplate data as can be obtained. When ordering a variety of missing/worn MIPs/MRCs, the
                   subject section shall be left blank.
Category B
(2) TECHNICAL:
(a) Identify specific discrepancy discovered in PMS by MRC control number, step number, etc.
                   (b) For publication discrepancies identify publication by number, volume, revision date/number, change number, page,
                       paragraph and or figure as appropriate.
               (3) TYCOM ASSISTANCE: Includes clarification of 3-M instructions and other matters related to PMS
                   administration.
               (4) OTHER: Identify in detail any problem not covered by (1) through (3) above. Shifts of maintenance
                   responsibility will be reported under this item. Ensure that all work centers involved in the change are
                   identified by work center code. Approval by the Executive Officer will be shown in the "Remarks".
          d. REMARKS: Provide brief, but complete, description of problem or requirement. Executive Officer indicate
             approval of maintenance responsibility shift by endorsement. Use additional forms if more space is required.
             Mark additional forms, "page 2 of 2", "page 2 of 3", etc. Staple additional forms behind basic form.
e. ORIGINATOR IDENTIFICATION: Sign and insert work center code in appropriate space.
2.. DIVISION OFFICER: Review for accuracy and completeness and sign in the space provided.
3. DEPARTMENT HEAD: Review for accuracy and completeness and sign in the space provided.
4. 3-M COORDINATOR:
          b. ROUTING INSTRUCTIONS: For Category "A" FBRs, forward the white and yellow copies to the appropriate
             NAVSEACEN and the pink copy to the TYCOM. For Category "B" FBRs, forward the white, yellow and pink
             copies to the TYCOM. Retain blue copy in suspense file. Return green copy to the originator.
                                                                         7-12
        disk, replacement copies will be generated                     PMS schedules are categorized               as   Cycle,
        with the print-on-demand capability.                        Quarterly, and Weekly Schedules.
    2. Category B—This category (fig. 7-8) is
                                                                    CYCLE PMS SCHEDULE
       technical in nature. These FBRs are submitted
       by the ship's 3-M coordinator to the applicable                   The Cycle PMS Schedule (fig. 7-10) displays the
       TYCOM and pertain to the following:                          planned maintenance requirements to be performed
        a. Technical discrepancies that inhibit PMS                 during the period between major overhauls of the ship;
           performance. These discrepancies can                     that is, from the first quarter after overhaul to the next
           exist in documentation, equipment design,                first quarter after a ship's overhaul. For ships in phased
           maintainability, reliability, or safety                  maintenance or similar incremental overhaul programs
           procedures as well as operational                        and other short industrial availability programs, the first
           deficiencies in PMS support (parts, tools,               quarter after overhaul is the quarter immediately
           and test equipment).                                     following completion of the docking availability. Cycle
                                                                    and multi-month requirements need to be scheduled
        b. Shift of maintenance responsibilities.
                                                                    during this time period. Any checks that have not been
           Individual ships sometimes desire or need
                                                                    accommodated in this cycle period are front loaded into
           to shift maintenance responsibility from
                                                                    the new cycle schedule period.
           one workcenter to another, combine two or
           more existing workcenters, or split an                   Content of the Cycle PMS Schedule
           existing workcenter. Such changes can
           only be made with the approval of the type                   The following information is found in the
           commander.        When       changes      in             block/column indicated in figure 3-10:
           maintenance responsibility are considered
           necessary, ship's personnel should submit a                  • Ship-The ship's name and hull number
           PMS FBR (category B) via the applicable                      • Workcenter-The applicable workcenter de-
           TYCOM, indicating from which work-                             signator
           center(s) equipment is to be deleted and to
           which workcenter(s) it is to be transferred.                 • Schedule Quarter After Overhaul As
           All such FBRs are signed by the executive                      Indicated-The annual, semiannual, multiple-
           officer.                                                       month (4M and greater) maintenance
                                                                          requirements, and any related maintenance
Preparation of the PMS FBR                                                checks to be completed during the quarter
                                                                          indicated
     The FBR is prepared and submitted according to
the instructions contained on its reverse side (fig. 7-9).              • Approval Signature/Date-The department
                                                                          head's signature and the date the Cycle Schedule
                                                                          was approved
               REVIEW QUESTIONS
                                                                        • Each Quarter-Maintenance that is performed
 Q1.      What is Inactive Equipment Maintenance                          every 2 weeks, monthly, every 2 months,
          (IEM)?                                                          quarterly maintenance requirements, and any
 Q2.      The workcenter PMS manual contains what                         related maintenance checks and situation
          requirements?                                                   requirements regardless of periodicity to be
                                                                          completed during each quarter are listed in this
 Q3.      What provide the detailed procedures used to
                                                                          column.
          perform a maintenance action?
                                                                    Preparation of the Cycle PMS Schedule
                 PMS SCHEDULES
                                                                        Cycle PMS Schedules are used to plan and
    LEARNING OBJECTIVE: Describe the                                schedule maintenance requirements to be conducted
    types of information displayed on each of the                   during each calendar quarter. Department heads devote
    following PMS schedules: Cycle, Quarterly,                      considerable attention to the preparation of the Cycle
    and Weekly. State the purpose of each                           Schedule since these efforts directly affect long range
    schedule.
                                                             7-13
     CYCLE PMS SCHEDULE (CONVENTIONAL)
     OPNAV FORM 4790/13 S/N 0107-LF-3220
        SHIP              WORK CENTER           SCHEDULE QUARTER AFTER OVERHAUL          AS INDICATED     APPROVAL SIGNATURE
 USS ROOSEVELT                  EA07        1          13 2         14 3                 15 4         16 B. A . O l s o n LCDR, U SN
     CVN-71                   (pg 1 of 1)   5          17 6         18 7                 19 8         20 DATE 30 JA N 94
        MIP               COMPONENT         9          21 10        22 11                23 12        24   EACH QUARTER
                     MACHINERY LUB OIL
       2000/001      NO. 1 AMR                                 18M-1 (6) (18)                18M-1 (12) (24)   2M-6, R-1
       5530/001
                     02N2 SYSTEM
                                                  S-1#                           S-1#            A-14#             BA 0
                                                                                                               M-1, M-2, Q-2#
                     FWD 1-30-6
                                                                                                                                     ABEf0710
                                                         Figure 7-10.—Cycle PMS Schedule.
PMS scheduling. The materials required and the                                           will be made in ink and initialed by the
procedures followed in schedule preparation are                                          department head.
detailed in the paragraphs that follow.
                                                                                  2. From the LOEP (Report PMS 5), list each item
   MATERIALS REQUIRED FOR PREPARA-                                                   of equipment in MIP sequence. It is not
TION.—The following materials are required:                                          necessary for the Cycle Schedule to match the
                                                                                     LOEP line for line.
    • Blank Cycle Schedules (OPNAV 4790/13 or
      approved automated form). Use of automated                                         a. Use the MIP column to list the MIP code
      forms generated from PMS scheduling                                                   without the date coding; for example,
      programs that have been approved by CNO and                                           E-1/55, EL-2/80, and 4411/1.
      the TYCOM are authorized for use in lieu of                                        b. Use the Component column to list the
      paper forms                                                                           name of each system, subsystem, or
    • Workcenter PMS Manuals (List Of Effective                                             equipment. Enter the item's serial number
      Pages) (LOEP)                                                                         or ship's numbering system number in the
                                                                                            Component column if more than one of the
    • Applicable MRCs (for general reference)                                               items is located within a workcenter. Also
     PROCEDURES.—The following are basic                                                    enter EGL in this column when an EGL is
instructions for filling out the cycle schedule (refer to                                   applicable. When multiple EGLs are used,
figure 7-10):                                                                               they can either be scheduled on separate
                                                                                            lines or be scheduled on the same line (or
    1. Neatly enter initial entries, either typed or in                                     group of lines) using the EGL number as
       black ink, on the Cycle Schedules. Changes                                           the prefix to the scheduling code; that is, a
                                                                                            quarterly check for MRC Q-1 would be
                                                                          7-14
         scheduled as 1-Q-1 on the same line with                        (1) List each semiannual (S) maintenance
         2-Q-1, 3-Q-1, and so on. These techniques                           requirement in one of the four col-
         permit the use of a reasonably compact                              umns, and then list it again 6 months
         schedule for MIPs with large quantities of                          later. For example, an S-1 requirement
         EGLs that are normally found on large                               scheduled to occur in the 1st, 5th, and
         ships, such as aircraft carriers.                                   9th quarters is also scheduled in the 3d,
                                                                             7th, and 11th quarters.
 3. From the applicable MIP, list the periodicity
    codes in the Schedule Quarter After Overhaul                         (2) List each annual (A) maintenance
    As Indicated and Each Quarter columns as                                 requirement in one of the four
    described in the sections that follow. From the                          columns.
    Related Maintenance column of the MIP
                                                                         (3) List each multiple month periodicity
    schedule all mandatory related maintenance
                                                                             MR (18M, 24M, 30M, 36M, and so
    requirements which are to be completed during
                                                                             on). The quarter after overhaul must be
    the quarter are indicated by the pound sign
                                                                             indicated in parentheses. (For
    symbol “#”. The pound sign placed next to a
                                                                             example, 18M-1(6) indicates an
    primary check, indicates that there is
                                                                             "every 18 months" periodicity MR
    mandatory related maintenance associated
                                                                             scheduled to be accomplished in the
    with that maintenance requirement (e.g. S-1#).
                                                                             sixth quarter after overhaul.) Table 7-2
     a. In the Schedule Quarter After Overhaul As                            serves as an example for determining
        Indicated column:                                                    the quarter after overhaul. To use the
                                                      7-15
               table, first determine in which quarter          requirements to be performed during a specific
               after overhaul the MR will be first              3-month period. This schedule, when updated weekly,
               scheduled. Go to this quarter in the             provides a ready reference to the current status of PMS
               first row of the table. Then schedule            for each workcenter. This schedule represents a
               the MR for the quarters in that column           departmental directive and, once completed, may be
               as applicable. For example, if an                changed only at the department head's discretion.
               18M-1 is scheduled for the 4th quarter           Responsibility for changes is sometimes delegated to
               after overhaul, it must also be                  division officers on carriers and cruisers.
               scheduled for the 10th, l6th, and 22d,
               as applicable.                                   Contents of the Quarterly PMS Schedule
                                                         7-16
QUARTERLY PMS SCHEDULE (CONVENTIONAL)
OPNAV FORM 4790/14 (REV 6-73)           S/N 0107-LF-3241
                      WORK CENTER               EA07         YEAR              QUARTER AFTER OVERHAUL               APPROVAL SIGNATURE                            DATE
                                                                     94                                   6                                M. M. Rodent30MAR94
           MIP                  MONTH           APRIL                                 MONTH      MAY                                   MONTH          JUNE                      RESCHEDULE
                                4          11           18          25         2           9      16           23          30          6         13          20    27
                                                                                           Q-2( M-1)
     5530/001-13                                M-1                                        S-1( R-1)                                       M-1
                                                                                    Q-3
                                                R1TM                               A-13R
                                                                                                                                                                                       ABEf0711
                                                                          Figure 7-11.—Quarterly PMS Schedule.
                  would include the months of October,                                                                7. Using both the LOEP and the Cycle PMS
                  November, and December as the first                                                                    Schedule, enter the MIP number including the
                  quarter.                                                                                               date code in the MIP column in a space on line
                                                                                                                         with the subject equipment on the Cycle
           b. Ships completing overhaul late in the
                                                                                                                         Schedule.
              quarter are not expected to do all planned
              maintenance scheduled during that quarter,                                                              8. From the Cycle PMS Schedule, select the
              but should do a certain amount based on                                                                    Schedule Quarter After Overhaul As Indicated
              the time remaining in the quarter. In this                                                                 column corresponding to the quarter being
              instance, the maintenance done and the                                                                     scheduled. Each of the maintenance re-
              effective dates are recorded on the back of                                                                quirements listed in this column and the Each
              the Quarterly PMS Schedule, and the                                                                        Quarter column will be transcribed to an
              schedule is marked to show that it is only a                                                               appropriate weekly column of the Quarterly
              partial quarterly PMS record.                                                                              PMS Schedule. If possible, do not schedule in
                                                                                                                         the last 2 weeks of the quarter. These 2 weeks
    5. Each column represents a week and is divided
                                                                                                                         may then be used for rescheduled maintenance
       into 7 days by the use of tick marks across the
                                                                                                                         requirements.
       top. The first tick marked space within a
       column represents Monday. Place Monday's                                                                       9. Refer to the MIPs and the departmental master
       date for each week in the quarter on the                                                                          deck of MRCs for a brief description of the
       pedestal between each column.                                                                                     maintenance actions represented by the
                                                                                                                         periodicity codes on the Cycle PMS Schedule
    6. Lightly shade in across the tick marks the days
                                                                                                                         to determine if the actions should be performed
       that the ship expects to be underway.
                                                                                                                         in port or at sea. Schedule the requirements on
                                                                                                     7-17
       the Quarterly PMS Schedule in the week most                  requirement. Fully accomplished MRs are
       appropriate for accomplishment. With the                     addressed and X'd off separately on the
       exception of related daily and weekly PMS                    Quarterly Schedule. Pay particular attention to
       requirements, ensure that all mandatory related              make sure situation requirements that were
       maintenance are scheduled within parentheses                 accomplished are added and X'd off separately.
       on the same line and during the same week as
                                                                    0 = Maintenance not completed. A circled
       the primary maintenance requirement.
                                                                    requirement indicates a requirement that was
  10. From the Cycle PMS Schedule column titled                     not accomplished according to the applicable
      Each Quarter, schedule monthly, quarterly, and                MRC.
      applicable situation requirements into the
                                                                    ¢ = Satisfied by higher authority test. This
      appropriate weeks of the Quarterly PMS
                                                                    symbol is used to mark scheduled equipment
      Schedule. All calendar situation requirements
                                                                    maintenance or lower level MRC requirements
      (24M-2R, A-2R, S-IR, Q-3R, M-IR) must be
                                                                    that have been satisfied by the completion of
      accomplished at least once during the
                                                                    the parent system test. A brief explanation of
      periodicity specified and also each additional
                                                                    the parent system test (including the MIP, who
      time the situation arises. Schedule 2M( )
                                                                    performed the maintenance, and when) is
      periodicity as indicated by a number in
                                                                    required on the reverse side of the Quarterly
      parentheses. For example, 2M(2) occur twice
                                                                    Schedule. An X marked over the higher level
      in the quarter (7 to 10 weeks apart).
                                                                    test symbol indicates that the lower level test
  11. From the Cycle PMS Schedule column, titled                    requirement annotated with the ¢ has been
      Schedule Quarter After Overhaul As Indicated,                 satisfied. (MRCs that are so satisfied are
      schedule the annual, semiannual, and multiple                 identified on the applicable system level test
      month requirements. Schedule the cycle                        MIP.)
      requirements for which the number in
                                                                2. The division officer is responsible for
      parentheses matches the quarter after overhaul
                                                                   rescheduling circled requirements still within
      being scheduled.
                                                                   periodicity and for determining the reason for
  12. Be sure that any PMS requirement listed in the               nonaccomplishment.
      Reschedule column of the previous Quarterly
                                                                3. From the Quarterly PMS Schedule, the
      PMS Schedule is brought forward to the
                                                                   workcenter    supervisor    schedules  the
      Quarterly PMS Schedule you are preparing.
                                                                   requirements for the following week on the
  13. The complete Quarterly PMS Schedule should                   Weekly PMS Schedule and updates the
      be reviewed and then signed and dated by the                 information in the Outstanding Repairs and
      department head in the appropriate block. If the             PMS Requirements Due In The Next 4 Weeks
      ship's     operating     schedule     changes                column.
      significantly, PMS requirements scheduled in
                                                                4. Any requirement that was not completed in
      the affected periods may need to be reviewed
                                                                   strict accordance with the applicable MRC
      and rescheduled as necessary to coincide with
                                                                   within its periodicity during the quarter must
      the new operating schedule.
                                                                   (in addition to being circled on the front of the
Use of the Quarterly PMS Schedule                                  Quarterly PMS Schedule) be identified on the
                                                                   back of the schedule by the complete MIP
     The Quarterly PMS Schedule serves as a directive              number and MRC code, followed by a brief
to workcenter supervisors for scheduling weekly                    reason for noncompletion. Example:
maintenance. Quarterly PMS Schedules are used as                C-2/1 - 11 M-1 Unable to accomplish step I.J.,
follows:                                                        "Test operate transmitter," due to antenna
   1. Each Monday, the division officer updates the             casualty. (This is an indication of a partial
      previous week's column of the Quarterly PMS               completion.) G-58/3-72 Q-1 Heavy seas
      Schedule, using the following symbols:                    preclude accomplishment as scheduled.
                                                         7-18
the Reschedule column for accomplishment in                     5. The completed Quarterly PMS Schedule is
the next quarter, if they are within their                         removed from the holder after the close of each
assigned periodicities. At the end of the quarter                  quarter and retained as a planned maintenance
the department head should indicate awareness                      record. The four previously completed
of the maintenance actions which were not                          quarterly schedules will be retained.
accomplished by reviewing, signing, and
                                                                6. The recopying of Quarterly Schedules to
dating the back of the schedule for the quarter
                                                                   facilitate legibility is discouraged, and should
just completed. The department head should
                                                                   only be done with the division officer's written
also take positive steps to ensure that priority is
                                                                   approval.
given to completing maintenance requirements
rescheduled from the previous quarter and                    WEEKLY PMS SCHEDULE
those not accomplished within their assigned
periodicities.                                                   The Weekly PMS Schedule (fig. 7-12) displays the
                                                             planned maintenance scheduled for accomplishment in
                                                      7-19
a given workcenter during a specific week. A Weekly                       Friday, and once in the SAT.-SUN. period.
PMS Schedule is posted in each workcenter and used                        Schedule 3D periodicity on Monday,
by the workcenter supervisor to assign and monitor the                    Thursday, and once in the SAT.-SUN.
accomplishment of required PMS tasks by workcenter                        period.
personnel.
                                                                      d. List all situation requirements in the Next
                                                                         Four Weeks column, and schedule them, as
Content of the Weekly PMS Schedule
                                                                         the situation requires. Also list the 2W
    The Weekly PMS Schedule contains the following                       periodicity requirements in the Next Four
information:                                                             Weeks column.
                                                         7-20
  2. When satisfied that the work has been properly            Q6.      How often is the quarterly schedule updated?
     completed, the workcenter supervisor crosses
     off, with an X, the maintenance requirement. If                 THE MAINTENANCE DATA SYSTEM
     the maintenance is not completed, the
     maintenance requirement is circled and                       LEARNING OBJECTIVES: State the
     rescheduled. However, if material deficiencies               purpose of the Maintenance Data System and
     or casualties that are unrelated to the                      describe the types of maintenance actions
     maintenance requirement are discovered, the                  reported on the following OPNAV forms:
     maintenance requirement can be X'd off, but                  4790/2K, 4790/CK, 4790/2P.
     the discrepancy must be reported to the                       The Maintenance Data System is used to record
     workcenter supervisor. PMS requirements                  information considered necessary for workload
     (other than daily checks) accomplished during            planning and coordination and to provide a data base
     the prescribed week but not on the day                   for evaluating and improving equipment installed in the
     specified are considered completed on                    fleet. Much of the data collected by MDS returns to the
     schedule and X'd off.                                    ship in the form of a material history known as the
  3. Each Monday morning, the division officer                Current Ship's Maintenance Project (CSMP).
     compares the preceding week's Weekly PMS                      Nearly all the reporting of maintenance actions
     Schedule with the Quarterly Schedule and                 other than normal PMS actions is done on a single
     ensures that the Quarterly Schedule is properly          multipurpose form, the Ship's Maintenance Action
     updated as follows:                                      Form, OPNAV 4790/2K. Personnel completing a
      a. Scheduled requirements         that   were           maintenance action fill out the appropriate sections of
         completed are X'd out.                               the form and send it via the ship's data collection center
                                                              to an ADP (automatic data processing) facility to be
      b. Scheduled requirements that were not                 processed. The 4790/2K contain information on the
         completed are circled.                               reporter's ship, workcenter, equipment worked on, and
      c. Situation requirements that occurred and             initial symptoms observed. In other sections, space is
         were completed are entered and X'd off.              provided to record completion information, deferral of
                                                              the work for various reasons, remarks, and special
      d. Requirements that were completed ahead
                                                              information for work requests. A space also exists for
         of schedule are circled, back scheduled and
                                                              recording time meter and counter readings where they
         X'd out.
                                                              are required.
  4. Each Monday morning, the division officer
                                                                  Normally, the following types of maintenance
     reviews the current week's Weekly PMS
                                                              actions will be reported on the 4790/2K: system or
     Schedule, ensures that it is properly made out
                                                              equipment repairs or improvements; maintenance
     according to the Quarterly Schedule, and signs
                                                              actions that require the use of parts or materials
     and dates the Weekly Schedule in the
                                                              specifically requisitioned for the job; actions that
     appropriate block.
                                                              cannot be completed in the usual amount of time due to
                                                              the ship's operations; requirements for outside
            REVIEW QUESTIONS                                  assistance, or unavailability of parts or material;
Q4.    What maintenance requirements do the cycle             assistance received from nonreporting activities, such
       schedules display?                                     as mobile technical training units (MOTUs) or
                                                              technical representatives; major work associated with
Q5.    All superseded cycle schedules are retained            corrosion control and preservation of the ship; and
       for how many months?                                   certain PMS actions listed in the 3-M Manual,
                                                              OPNAVINST 4790.4.
                                                       7-21
    To prevent the loss of significant data when it is              SHIP'S MAINTENANCE ACTION FORM
recorded on several forms, each maintenance action                  (OPNAV 4790/2K)
must be assigned a unique identifier. Under MDS, this
identifier is known as the job control number (JCN). It                 The ship's maintenance action form (OPNAV
consists of a five-character unit identification code               4790/2k) (fig. 7-14), printed on a single sheet of
(UIC), a four-character workcenter code, and a                      "no-carbon-required" paper, is the basic MDS
four-character serial number called the job sequence                document. If multiple copies are needed, the necessary
number (JSN). Figure 7-13 shows an example of a JCN                 number of forms may be fastened together and filled in
log used to record the JSNs. This system gives a                    at one time. The form may also be reproduced on
workcenter at least 9,999 JCNs. If additional JCNs are              electrostatic (Xerox-type) copying machines.
desired, letters can be substituted for the first numeral.               This form contains six sections that require entries
In any event, take care to make sure that two different             to describe the type of maintenance action being
jobs are not assigned the same JCN.                                 reported. Entries should be printed in capital letters. All
    There are many different situations that could be               entries must be legible and should be inserted within
covered by the MDS documents. This text will cover                  the tic marks. If an error is made, it should be lined out
only the basic actions.                                             using a single line, and the correct information entered.
                                                             7-22
Figure 7-14.—Ship's Maintenance Action Form (OPNAV 4790/2K).
                           7-23
     The OPNAV 4790/2K is used to report all deferred               Section VI-Repair Activity Planning Action
maintenance actions and the completion of
maintenance actions that do not result in configuration                 The repair activity may use this section for internal
changes. Partially completed maintenance actions that               planning and scheduling of the workload.
will result in configuration changes and complete or
partial accomplishment of alterations are reported on               Block G, Completed By
OPNAV 4790/CK. A description of the OPNAV
4790/2K information sections is presented in the                         This block contains the signature and rate/rank of
following paragraphs.                                               the senior person actively engaged on the job in the lead
                                                                    workcenter. For maintenance actions not requiring
Section I-Identification                                            assistance from an outside workcenter, the senior
                                                                    person working on the job signs this block and indicates
   This section identifies the equipment or system on               his or her rate.
which maintenance actions are being performed.
                                                                    Block H, Accepted By
Section II-Deferral Action
                                                                         This block contains the signature and rate/rank of
    This section filled in when reporting the deferral of           the individual authorized by the tended ship to verify
a maintenance action. Indicates ship's force man-hours              the acceptability of the work performed. Completion of
expended up to the time of deferral, the date of the                this block is mandatory when an OPNAV 4790/2K is
deferral, ship's force man-hours remaining, and if the              used to report completion of a previously deferred
work must be completed by a certain date.                           maintenance action. For maintenance actions not
                                                                    requiring assistance from an outside workcenter, the
Section III-Completed Action                                        workcenter supervisor will sign this block and indicate
                                                                    his or her rate/rank.
   This section is filled in to report the completion of a
                                                                        The commanding officer, or his/her authorized
maintenance action.
                                                                    representative, places his/her signature on all original
Section IV-Remarks/Description                                      deferrals in block E. Two copies are held in a deferral
                                                                    suspense file in the workcenter until the JCN appears on
    This section must be filled in when the deferral of a           the automated CSMP report, at which time the copies
maintenance action is reported. It is filled in when the            are transferred to the active suspense file held in the
completion of a maintenance action is reported, only                workcenter
when such remarks are considered important to the
maintenance action. This section must also be filled in             MAINTENANCE PLANNING AND
to report maintenance actions on selected equipment                 ESTIMATING FORM (OPNAV
requiring second level reporting, and to describe                   4790/2P)
situations that are safety related.
                                                                        The maintenance planning and estimating form
Section V-Supplementary Information                                 (OPNAV 4790/2P) (fig. 7-15) is used along with the
                                                                    OPNAV 4790/2K form for deferring maintenance to be
    This section contains helpful information about                 done by an intermediate maintenance activity (IMA).
deferred maintenance actions, such as what technical                Attached to the original 2K at the intermediate
manuals and blueprints are available and whether or not             maintenance activity, it is used by the IMA to screen
they are retained on board the requesting ship.                     and plan the job in detail.
                                                             7-24
Figure 7-15.—Maintenance Planning and Estimating Form (OPNAV 4790/2P).
                                7-25
SUPPLEMENTAL FORM (OPNAV 4790/2L)                               1. The ship's name and hull number are entered in
                                                                   blocks A and B.
     The supplemental form (OPNAV 4790/2L) (fig.
                                                                2. If the form is a continuation of a maintenance
7-16) is used by maintenance personnel to provide
                                                                   data form or another supplemental report form,
amplifying information (such as drawings and listings)
                                                                   the appropriate form is checked in block F and
related to a maintenance action reported on an OPNAV
                                                                   the JCN assigned to the basic form is entered in
4790/2K. The information on this form will never be
                                                                   blocks C, D, and E.
entered into the computer. The form is prepared in the
following manner:                                               3. Section II will contain comments, sketches, or
                                                                   other supplemental information.
                                                         7-26
   4. Section III (blocks H, I, J, and K) will contain          reporting cannot be overemphasized. Whenever any
      the names of the person and the supervisor                system, equipment, component, or unit within the ship
      submitting the report.                                    is installed, removed, modified, or relocated, the
                                                                change must be reported. This action will ensure proper
REPORTING CHANGES TO EQUIPMENT                                  accounting of configuration changes, and will improve
CONFIGURATION                                                   supply and maintenance support such as technical
                                                                manuals, PMS coverage, and COSAL to the fleet. The
    One of the major objectives of the MDS is to                Configuration Change Form (ONNAV 4790/CK) (fig.
provide the capability for reporting configuration              7-17) is used to provide this service.
changes. The importance of configuration change
                                                         7-27
    The OPNAV 4790/CK form is completed to the                        • Modification of any installed or in-use
maximum extent possible by the accomplishing                            equipment. A modification occurs when a
activity and provided to the ship or activity 3-M                       maintenance action alters the design or
coordinator.                                                            operating characteristics of the equipment or
    The 3-M coordinator then reviews the forms for                      when nonstandard replacement parts (not
legibility (all copies) and ompleteness and provides the                identified on the APL or in the technical manual)
forms to the applicable workcenter supervisor, who                      are used.
ensures that the proper documentation is completed and                • Relocation of any equipment to a new deck, new
processed when a configuration change is                                frame, or new compartment.
accomplished, including required signatures to indicate
verification of all reported configuration changes.                   • Accomplishment of any alteration directive,
                                                                        such as a field change or SHIPALT.
    The ship is also responsible for reporting and
monitoring all changes accomplished by ship's force               CAUTIONS ON ERRORS
during any type of availability, and for providing the
Configuration Change Form to the overhauling activity.                Since the data entered on the MDS forms is used by
The ship is not responsible for reporting configuration           data processing equipment to provide information to a
changes accomplished by an overhauling activity                   ship in the form of the CSMP report, it is essential that
during availabilities.                                            each form be filled in completely and accurately. A
     A configuration change is either (1) the                     computer cannot recognize anything that it is told does
accomplishment of any action prescribed by an                     not exist. It will reject incorrect and incomplete entries
alteration directive (SHIPALT or equipment alteration)            and the data will not be available for use. To prevent this
or (2) the installation, removal, or modification of any          from happening, it is important that the completed
system, equipment, component, or unit. The                        forms be reviewed at all levels. Some of the common
replacement of repair parts (such as nuts, bolts, wires,          errors that workcenter supervisors, division officers,
0-rings, gaskets, resistors, and capacitors) with like            department heads, and 3-M coordinators should be alert
parts, does not constitute a configuration change.                for are
    The OPNAV 4790/CK form is used to report a                        • omission of slash marks through zeros and Z's;
configuration change or to report the completion of a                 • incorrect EICs;
previous deferral that resulted in a configuration
change. Deferred maintenance actions and completed                    • use of improper codes for alterations and field
maintenance actions that do not result in configuration                 changes;
changes are reported on OPNAV 4790/2K. The                            • too many or not enough spaces between words
OPNAV 4790/2K form will never be used to report                         in the Remarks section;
accomplishment of any maintenance action that results
in configuration changes.                                             • incorrect dates; and
     A configuration change occurs whenever the                       • incorrect entries.
accomplishment of a maintenance action results in the
                                                                      These are only a few of the many errors detected
following:
                                                                  each day by a typical TYCOM 3-M staff section.
    • Addition or installation of any new equipment.
                                                                       Some areas on the 4790/2K require special
    • Deletion, removal, or turn-in of any installed              mention. Alterations and field changes are identified in
      equipment.                                                  block 18 by a two-letter code in the first two spaces,
                                                                  followed by the identification number of the change. A
    • Replacement or exchange of any equipment. A                 title code, such as A, D, F, or K may be shown in the
      replacement or exchange is reported as the                  authorizing directive of SHIPALTs. This title code, if
      removal of an installed item of equipment and               assigned, must be entered in the extreme right hand
      the installation of a new item of equipment.                position of the block.
                                                           7-28
    In block 18, the first two letters identify SHIPALT                  publications: FED LOG, ML–C, MCRL,
(SA), ORDALT (OA), field change (FC), or any other                       MRIL, ASG, and GSA.
appropriate instruction. Electronic equipment is always
                                                                         One of the duties of an ABE is to identify and
identified by serial number, and only one piece of
                                                                     requisition material. This section provides basic
equipment may be reported under a given JCN. If
                                                                     information to help you develop the knowledge you
several pieces of the same type of equipment are altered
                                                                     need to perform these duties. Proper material
by field changes, there must be one document for each
                                                                     identification is essential to the requisitioning and
piece of equipment. Example:
                                                                     receipt of the correct item. You must understand the
A ship has four C-13 Mod 1 catapults, and field change               terminology used in material identification.
17 is to be installed in all of them. Each catapult will be
changed, and the changes will be reported on separate                GENERAL INFORMATION
documents showing a specific JSN and equipment
serial number. This will enable the computers to                         Material is managed according to category
identify which items of equipment have been changed                  (Federal Supply Classification) and its intended use.
and which have not. It also will be reflected on the                 An inventory manager is assigned for each category of
readouts returned to the ship as part of its material                material, and has overall responsibility for all items
history.                                                             within the category. All items in the supply system have
                                                                     an assigned two-position cognizance symbol code.
    Another problem is the use of the noun name in                   This code identifies the inventory manager and the
block 5. For electronic equipment the "AN"                           stores account in which the material is carried. The
designation is the best entry for the noun name. If there            items assigned to bureau, office, or systems command
is no "AN" designation, the name from the nameplate                  for inventory management includes the following
should be used. Up to 16 characters of a name may be                 material:
entered.
                                                                         • Material in the research and development stage
     In block 35, a space follows each word, and words
that cannot be completed on a line are continued on the                  • Material that requires continuing logistics,
next line with no spaces or hyphens inserted. On                           engineering, or fiscal administration and control
deferred actions, the XXX's used to separate the trouble                   at the department level.
from the desired corrective action must not be
separated. If they cannot be fitted in on one line, extra                • Material recognized as a onetime installation
spaces will be left blank on that line and the XXX's will                  that was bought and issued for a specific use
be put in the first spaces of the next line.                             Naval Supply System Command (NAVSUP)
                                                                     Inventory Control point (ICP) items are those for which
               REVIEW QUESTIONS                                      bureau, office, or systems command management is not
                                                                     essential. The NAVSUP ICP provides stocks of these
 Q7.      Maintenance Data System is used to record                  items to its segment of the supply system. This group of
          what type of information?                                  items includes equipment, repair parts, and
 Q8.      Under the maintenance Data System, what is                 consumables. It also includes those items for which
          a Job Control Number?                                      stocking determination, quality control, funding, and
                                                                     issue control can be accomplished by the ICP if
 Q9.      What is the OPNAV 4790/2K used to report?                  required, the ICP ensure that these items are available
Q10.      The OPNAV 4790/2P provide what type of                     from commercial sources and other government
          information?                                               agencies. NAVSUP selects the items assigned to ICP
                                                                     for inventory management with the advice of the
                                                                     appropriate bureau, office, or systems command.
                        SUPPLY
                                                                         The Navy Retail Office items are items for which
    LEARNING OBJECTIVES: Recognize the                               joint military supply management responsibility is
    different types of stock and control numbers.                    vested to the Defense Logistics Agency (DLA). These
    Recall the purpose of cognizance symbols.                        items include components, repair parts, consumables,
    Recognize sources of identifying material                        and other material. The requirement determination and
    when a stock number is not available.                            procurement of these items can be accomplished by the
    Recognize the uses of the following supply
                                                              7-29
defense supply center on a combined basis for all                      Table 7-3.—Example List of Federal Supply Groups
military services.
                                                                       GROUP                    TITLE
         MATERIAL CATALOGING AND                                          17          Aircraft launching, land-
             CLASSIFICATION                                                           ing, and ground handling
                                                                                      equipment
    LEARNING OBJECTIVE: Recognize the
    different types of stock and control numbers.                         48          Valves
    Recall the purpose of cognizance symbols.
                                                                          53          Hardware and abrasives
    Recognize sources of identifying material
    when a stock number is not available.
    Recognize the uses of the following supply
    publications: MCRL, ML-C, MRIL, ASG, and                           The number of classes within each group varies.
    GSA.                                                           Each class covers a particular area of commodities
                                                                   according to physical or performance characteristics.
    This will help you understand the information used             The items in the class are usually requisitioned or
in material identification. There are ore than 4 million           issued together. This is used as a basis for including
supply items in the Department of Defense (DOD)                    items in the same area of commodities. Examples of
supply system. The Navy supply system alone stocks                 how classes are used to divide types of material within a
more than 1 million items. Each item must be identified            stock group are shown in figure 7-18. The stock group
to make buying, stocking, and issuing easier. To                   and class together make the Federal Supply
accomplish this, each item must be listed in different             Classification (FSC).
groups or categories.
    The Federal Supply Classification (FSC) System                     The Navy uses groups 01 through 09 for forms and
was designed to permit the classification of all items of          publications that are not included in the Federal
supply used by the Federal Government. Each item of                Catalog System. The forms and publications are
supply is classified in only one four-digit Federal                numbered according to the following system:
Supply Classification class. The first two digits denote               01 Navy Department forms
the group or major division of commodities within the
group. Currently, there are 76 groups assigned. Group                  02-08 Publications
numbers start from 10 and end at 99. Table 7-3 is an                   09 District and fleet forms
example list of federal supply groups and titles.
                                                            7-30
NATIONAL STOCK NUMBER (NSN)                                            In addition to the 13-digit NSN, the Navy uses
                                                                   other codes for material identification. These codes
     All items of supply that are centrally managed or             may be prefixes or suffixes to the NSN. The following
bought for system stock are required to have a National            paragraphs describe these codes.
Stock Number (NSN) assigned to them. National Stock
Numbers are used in all supply management functions                Cognizant (COG) Symbol
and publications that mention the items. The NSN is a
13-digit number assigned by Defense Logistics                          The cognizant (COG) symbol consists of a
Information Service (DLIS) to identify an item of                  two-character code that identifies the stores account
material in the supply distribution system. The                    and cognizant inventory manager of an item. The
following paragraph discusses the breakdown of an                  cognizant symbols are listed in table 7-4. To understand
NSN. Figure 7-19 is an example of an NSN.                          cognizant symbols, you must understand the following
                                                                   terms:
Federal Supply Classification (FSC)
                                                                       Stores Account: This is an account reflecting the
                                                                   value of material, supplies, and similar property on
    The Federal Supply Classification (FSC) is a
                                                                   hand. The accounts are the Appropriation Stores
four-digit number that occupies the first part of an
                                                                   Account (APA) and the Navy Stock Account (NSA).
NSN. The Defense Logistics Agency Cataloging
Handbook H2 (in book form) lists the groups and                        Appropriations Purchase Account (APA): This
classes in use today.                                              account is for all stock material paid for out of
                                                                   appropriations. This material is not charged to the
National Codification Bureau (NCB) Code                            user’s operating funds. If the material was ought for a
                                                                   purpose other than its original appropriation, the
    The National Codification Bureau (NCB) code is a               material is chargeable to the user’s fund.
two-digit code that occupies the fifth and sixth position
of a NATO stock number. These code identities the                      Navy Stock Account (NSA): The NSA consists of
NATO country that originally cataloged the item of                 all material paid from the Defense Business Operating
supply. The NCB codes currently assigned are listed in             Fund (DBOF). NSA material is always charged to the
Afloat Supply Procedures, NAVSUP P-485. The NSN                    user’s allotment, operating budget, or operating target
assigned by United States uses NCB codes “00” and                  funds.
“01.”                                                                  Inventory manager: This is an organizational unit
                                                                   or activity within the Department of Defense. The
National Item Identification Number (NIIN)                         inventory manager has the primary responsibility for
                                                                   controlling the functions of cataloging, identification,
    The National Item Identification Number (NIIN)                 determination     of    requirements,     procurement,
consists of a two digit National Codification Bureau               inspection, storage, and distribution of categories of
(NCB) code and seven digits which in conjunction with              material.
the NCB code, uniquely identify each NSN item in the
federal supply distribution system. In the example                     Technical responsibility: This is the systems
given in figure 3-2, the “00-1234567” is the NIIN.                 command or office that determines the technical
Although part of the NSN, NIINs are used                           characteristics of equipment. For example, the
independently for material identification. Except for              electronics equipment characteristics include items
identification list, most federal supply catalogs are              such as circuitry and the types and arrangement of
arranged in NIIN order.                                            components.
                 1710                                       00                                1234567
   Federal Supply Classification         National Codification Bureau              National Item Identification
   Code Number                           Code                                      Number
                                                            7-31
    Expense type item: This term identifies stock items              Consumable: Consumable material is material that
that are financed by the Defense Business Operating              is consumed in normal use. Some of the examples of
Fund, and is the same as NSA items.                              these materials are paints, cleaning supplies, office
                                                                 supplies, and common tools.
                                       Table 7-4.—Cognizance (COG) Symbols
                                                          7-32
     Cognizance       symbols      are   two-character,           requirements. Table 7-5 contains a list of MCCs
alphanumeric codes prefixed to national stock                     commonly encountered.
numbers. Cognizance symbols are listed in Table 7-4.
The first character of the cognizance symbol identifies           NAVY ITEM CONTROL NUMBER (NICN)
the stores account. The following information refers to
the first character of the cognizance symbol:                          As we have discussed in a previous paragraph,
                                                                  NSNs are required for all items centrally managed or
    • Cognizance symbols 0 (zero), 2A and 8A is not               bought for supply system stock. With changes of
      carried in the stores account and is issued                 equipment and products, the Navy buys new items from
      without charge to the requisitioner.                        the suppliers. New items entering the Navy supply
    • Even numbers 2, 4, 6, and 8 are carried in the              system are identified in time to permit assignment of
      Appropriation Stores Account (APA).                         NSNs before shipment. In numerous instances, the
                                                                  Navy Item Control Number (NICN) is used to identify
    • Odd numbers 1, 3, 5, and 7 are carried in the               the items before an NSN can be assigned. Some items
      Navy Stock Account (NSA).                                   are permanently identified by the NICN because of the
    • Number 9 is Navy-owned material carried in                  nature of the items. The NICN designation includes the
      NSA and managed-by the Naval Inventory                      following:
      Control Point Mechanicsburg.                                    • Inventory Control Point ICP control numbers
    The second position of the cognizance symbol                      • Kit numbers
identifies the item manager. The item manager
exercises supply management over specified categories                 • Publications and forms ordering numbers
of material.                                                          • Local Navy Activity Control (NAC) numbers
Material Control Codes                                                • Other locally assigned numbers
                                                                      The NICN is a 13-digit number that identifies an
     A Material Control Code (MCC) is a single
                                                                  item of supply. It is composed of the following parts:
alphabetic character assigned by the inventory
manager. It is used to segregate items into manageable                • Federal Supply Classification (FSC) code
groupings (fast, medium, or slow movers) or to relate to                (numbers that occupy the first four digits of the
field activities special reporting and control                          NICN)
                   CODE                                      DEFINITION
                      D          Field level repairable.
                      E          (1) Depot-level repairables.
                                 (2) Material (expendable ordnance) requiring lot and serial
                                     number control, but is reported by serial number only.
                      H          Depot-level repairables.
                      L          Items of local stock or items pending NSN assignment.
                      M          Medium demand velocity items (consumables).
                      S          Slow demand velocity items.
                      T          Terminal items.
                      W          Ground support equipment.
                      X          Special program repairables.
                      Z          Special program consumables.
                                                           7-33
                                          Table 7-6.—Navy Item Control Codes
    • Navy Item Control Number (NICN) code                         by using the DD 1348-6 format (part number
      (letters that occupy the 5th and 6th position)               requisition).
    • Serial number (alphanumeric and occupies the                 Temporary LL Coded NICNs
      7th through the 13th position)
    The NIC numbers that you must be familiar with                     The NICNs with “LL” in the 5th and 6th positions
are listed in Table 7-6. These codes differentiate the             and any letter except “C” in the 7th position are
types of NICN.                                                     assigned by ICPs or other Navy inventory managers for
                                                                   temporary identification. These NICNs enables the
Permanent LL Coded NICNs                                           item manager to establish and maintain automated file
                                                                   records, to ease procurement action, and to maximize
     The NICNs with “LL” in the 5th and 6th positions              automated processing of requisitions. The cognizant
and a “C” in the 7th position mean that the ICPs or other          item managers review the temporary NICNs
Navy item managers (including field activities)                    periodically to convert them to NSN or to delete the
assigned them. Its purpose is to identify and monitor              ones that are no longer required. When a requisition
nonstocked items that are not expected to have enough              identifies an item by a temporary NICN that has been
demand to qualify for NSN assignment. The NICNs are                converted to an NSN the status card will include the
assigned to permit the maintenance of a complete and               new NSN. A NICN to NIIN cross-reference list is
uniform inventory control point weapons system file. It            published monthly by the Defense Logistics
is also used to ensure that selected items are considered          Information Service (DLIS) on the FED LOG
for inclusion in future allowance lists. Stock points              CD-ROM.
must purchase items identified by this type of NICN.
Stock points currently do not have the capability to               LOCAL ITEM CONTROL NUMBER (LICN)
translate permanent LL coded NICNs to applicable
CAGES and part numbers. The items are requisitioned                    The LICN (fig. 7-20) is an identification number
                                                                   assigned by an activity for its own use. However,
                 1710                                   LL                                  0000123
  Appropriate Federal Supply Designation for locally assigned                     Serially assigned
  Classification Code Number identification number                                identification number
                                                            7-34
LICNs are not authorized in supply transaction                    FEDERAL LOGISTICS (FED LOG)
documents. LICNs are for local use only and may be
assigned to shipboard stocked consumable items that                   The FED LOG on Compact Disc Read-Only
are not identified by and NSN or another type of NICN.            Memory (CD-ROM) (fig.7-21) is the access to DOD
A LICN consists of 13 characters. The first four will be          logistics data. The FED LOG includes the basic
numbers corresponding to the federal supply                       management data necessary for preparing requisitions
classification (FSC) of a similar NSN items, the fifth            and it includes an integrated historical record of deleted
and sixth will be LL and the remaining seven alpha                and superseded NIINs with appropriate codes to
numeric.                                                          indicate disposition action.
    This chapter presents different sources of                        The part number, also called reference number, is
information that is needed in performing technical                an identification number assigned to an item by the
research. Material identification does not end with the           manufacture. It is made up of letters, numbers, or
assignment of the NSN. Some means of identifying                  combinations of both. When used with the Commercial
other particular needs by the stock number must be                And Government Entity (CAGE) code, it identifies the
provided to the customers. This includes the means of             item. It is used with other technical data (for example,
determining the correct quantities of these items to              model, series, and end-use application) to requisition
carry in stock. Identification of needs maybe                     an item when an NSN is not assigned. Part number to
determined by using the lists described in the following          NSN cross-reference is provided in FED-LOG.
paragraphs.
                                                           7-35
COMMERCIAL AND GOVERNMENT ENTITY                                  MASTER CROSS-REFERENCE LIST
CODE                                                              (MCRL)
     The Commercial And Government Entity (CAGE)                      The Master Cross-Reference List (MCRL) (fig.
(fig. 7-22) Code is a five-digit, numeric identification          7-23) Part I, provides a cross-reference from a
code assigned to manufacturers which have previously              reference number (manufacturer’s part number,
or are currently producing items used by the Federal              drawing number, design control number, etc.) to its
Government. The CAGE is used in conjunction with                  assigned National Stock Numbers (NSN). The MCRL,
part number, item number, symbol, or trade name                   Part II, provides a cross-reference from an NSN to a
assigned by the manufacturer to his product. The                  reference number. The MCRL is published on the FED
CAGE catalog handbook is published the Defense                    LOG CD-ROM.
Logistics Information Service (DLIS) on the FED LOG
CD-ROM.                                                           MASTER REPAIRABLE ITEM LIST
                                                                  (MRIL)
MANAGEMENT LIST-CONSOLIDATED (ML-C)
                                                                       The Master Repairable Item List (MRIL) (fig. 7-24
    The Management-List Consolidated (ML-C) is a                  and 7-25) is a catalog of selected Navy-managed items
consolidated, cumulative listing of National Stock                which, when are unserviceable and not locally
Numbers for all branches of the armed services. Each              repairable, are required to be turned in to a Designated
NSN is listed one time only. The integrated material              Overhaul Point (DOP) for repair and return to system
manager and service or agency is listed separately. The           stock. The MRIL is part of the FED LOG that is
ML-C is a tool used for determining management data               distributed in compact disc format. The MRIL is
applicable to items used or managed by other military             published on the FED LOG CD-ROM and is made up
activities.                                                       of two parts as shown in figures 7-24 and 7-25.
                                                           7-36
  Figure 7-23.—MCRL from FED LOG.
                7-37
                                       Figure 7-25.—MRIL Part II from FED LOG.
AFLOAT SHOPPING GUIDE                                              referred to for supply management data. The GSA
                                                                   supply catalog series consists of the following:
     The Afloat Shopping Guide (ASG) (fig. 7-26) is
                                                                       The GSA Supply Catalog Guide contains
designed to assist the fleet personnel in identifying the
                                                                   consolidated alphabetical and NSN indexes to all stock
NSNs for items that are frequently requested by ships.
                                                                   items. These are items listed in the four commodity
It includes a detailed description of each item, and
                                                                   catalogs and other items available through the FSS
(when applicable) the stock number for substitute
                                                                   program. It provides detailed information concerning
items. The ASG is distributed in CD-ROM format and
                                                                   the program and requisitioning procedures.
in printed form.
                                                                       The GSA Supply Catalog (Tools) contains listings
GENERAL SERVICES ADMINISTRATION                                    of common and special use tools. It includes
FEDERAL SUPPLY CATALOG                                             alphabetical and numerical indexes and a price list.
     The General Services Administration (GSA)                         The GSA Supply Catalog (Office Products) lists a
Federal Supply Catalog lists approximately 20,000 line             wide variety of items for office use, including paper
items that are stocked in GSA supply distribution                  supplies, standard and optional forms, and many items
facilities. The items listed in this catalog are assigned          of equipment. It includes alphabetical and numerical
cognizance 9Q. The GSA supply catalog series serves                indexes and a price list.
as the major merchandising instrument of the Federal                   The GSA Supply Catalog (Industrial Products)
Supply Service (FSS) Stock Program. Since they are                 contains descriptive listings of a broad range of items,
prepared for civilian agencies, the FED LOG must be                such as hardware, paints, adhesives, and cleaning
                                                            7-38
Figure 7-26.—Page from Afloat Shopping Guide.
                    7-39
equipment and supplies. It includes alphabetical and                 sequence by index number to make it easier to use. The
numerical indexes and a price list.                                  information in the parts list include index number, part
                                                                     number, description, units per assembly, Usable On
    The GSA Supply Catalog (Furniture) provides a
                                                                     code, and the Source, Maintenance, and Recoverability
single source of information for all furniture items
                                                                     (SM&R) code. Each major assembly in the parts list is
stocked by the FSS.
                                                                     followed immediately by its component parts or
NAVY STOCK LIST OF PUBLICATIONS,                                     subassemblies. Component parts listed in the
FORMS, AND DIRECTIVES                                                description column may be prefixed with a dot or
                                                                     indented to show their relationship. You should use this
    The Navy Stock List of Publications, Forms, and                  information to identify and obtain the required material
Directives, NAVSUP P-2002, contains requisitioning                   in accordance with the SM&R code. The numerical
procedures and sources of supply to assist in the                    index of the IPB lists all parts in reference/part number
determination of how and where material may be                       sequence.      Each      reference/part     number     is
obtained.                                                            cross-referenced to the figure and index number or the
                                                                     work package where the item is listed in the text.
HAZARDOUS MATERIAL INFORMATION
SYSTEM                                                               SOURCE, MAINTENANCE, AND
                                                                     RECOVERABILITY CODES
    The DOD Hazardous Material Information System
(HMIS) provides information concerning the use,                          The SM&R code consists of two-position source
procurement, receipt, storage, and expenditure of                    code, two single-position maintenance codes,
hazardous material. The NAVSUPSYSCOM maintains                       single-position recoverability code, and if applicable, a
and distributes the HMIS hazardous item list. This list              single-position service option code. Table 7-7 breaks
includes     information    concerning     hazardous                 down the SM&R code by position and defines the
ingredients, use of hazardous material, protective                   source, maintenance level, and reparability level of the
clothing, and emergency treatment.                                   component.
                                                                         Source Code: The source code is a two-character
ILLUSTRATED PARTS BREAKDOWN                                          code that occupies the first two positions of the SM&R
                                                                     code format. This code shows the manner of getting the
     An illustrated Parts Breakdown (IPB) is prepared                material needed for maintenance, repair, or rework of
by the manufacturer for each model aircraft, engine,                 items.
accessory, electronic equipment, support equipment, or
other equipment considered advisable by NAVAIR.                          Maintenance Code: The maintenance codes are
The IPB is printed and issued by the authority of                    indicated in the third and fourth positions of the SM&R
NAVAIR. It is used as reference for identifying and                  code. Levels of maintenance authorized to replace and
ordering replacement items. Each item of equipment is                repair an assembly or part are given. The code shown in
listed in assembly breakdown order, with the                         the third position provides the lowest level of
illustration placed as close as possible to its appropriate          maintenance authorized to remove or replace the
listing. Some IPBs have a different format from others               assembly or part. The fourth position indicates if the
                                                                     item is to e repaired and identifies the lowest
    The TABLE OF CONTENTS shows the                                  maintenance level authorized to perform the repair.
breakdown of publication into sections. It also
furnishes an alphabetical listing of the various                         Recoverability Code: The Recoverability Code is
assemblies and lists the page, work package, or figures              indicated in the fifth position, this code defines the
where they are illustrated.                                          approved disposition of unserviceable items.
                                                              7-40
                                               Table 7-7.—SM&R Code Format
information. The CASREP system contains four types                    Cancellation Casualty Report (CANCEL)
of reports: Initial, Update, Correct, and Cancel. These
reports are described in general in the following                         A cancel casrep is submitted when equipment that
paragraphs.                                                           has been the subject of casualty reporting is scheduled
                                                                      to be repaired during an overhaul or some other
Initial Casualty Report (INITIAL)                                     availability. Outstanding casualties that will not be
                                                                      repaired during such availability will not be canceled
     An initial casrep identifies the status of the casualty          and will be subject to normal follow-up casualty
and any parts or assistance needed. Operational and                   reporting procedures as specified.
staff authorities use this information to set priorities for
the use of resources.
                                                                                    REVIEW QUESTIONS
Update Casualty Report (UPDATE)                                       Q11.     National Stock Numbers are made up of how
                                                                               many digits?
    An update casrep is used to submit changes to
                                                                      Q12.     What occupies the first part of a National
previously submitted information.
                                                                               Stock Number?
Correction Casualty Report (CORRECT)                                  Q13.     What does the Cognizant Symbol identify?
    A correct casrep is submitted when equipment that                 Q14.     The Afloat Shopping Guide is designed for
has been the subject of casualty reporting is repaired                         what purpose?
and is back in operational condition.                                 Q15.     List the different types of casualty reports.
                                                               7-41
                ADMINISTRATION                                   CATAPULT WORK CENTER MAINTENANCE
                                                                 LOG
    LEARNING OBJECTIVE: Describe the use
    and maintenance of various logs and reports
                                                                     The work center maintenance log (fig. 7-27) is the
    used to record details of catapult and arresting
                                                                 most important record kept on the catapult systems.
    gear operations and maintenance
                                                                 Each catapult workcenter supervisor shall maintain a
    Record keeping in relation to launch and recovery            separate maintenance log for each catapult. Sufficient
equipment is as important as the operation of the                pages in the front of the log should be reserved for
machinery or maintenance procedures. Because of the              entering data of a historical or permanent nature, which
many 3-M maintenance requirements that must be                   will provide a read reference when required. Daily
adhered to and periodic reports that must be made, the           entries should be made listing all maintenance
important of accurate logs, reports, and records should          performed during a 24-hour period. This will provide a
be emphasized.                                                   continuous record of maintenance actions performed
                                                          7-42
on each catapult. When a logbook is filled, the                   system. The arresting gear supervisor shall maintain a
historical or permanent data shall be transferred into a          separate maintenance log for each arresting engine.
new maintenance log and the completed log retained                Sufficient pages in the front of the log should be
for a minimum of two years.                                       reserved for entering data of a historical or permanent
                                                                  nature. Daily entries should be made listing all
STEAM CATAPULT LOG                                                maintenance performed during a 24-hour period. When
                                                                  a log is filled, the historical or permanent data shall be
     The steam catapult log (fig. 7-28) is maintained             transferred into a new maintenance log and the
during all catapult operations by a catapult recorder             completed log retained for a minimum of two years.
stationed at the central charging panel (CCP) or main
control console (MCC).                                            RECOVERY LOG
ARRESTING GEAR WORK CENTER                                             The Recovery Log (fig. 7-30) is maintained during
MAINTENANCE LOG                                                   all aircraft recovery operations by the Pri-fly control
                                                                  pane operator to provide a uniform system of recording
   The work center maintenance log (fig. 7-29) is the             pertinent arresting gear data.
most important record kept on the arresting gear
                                                           7-43
  Figure 7-29.—Arresting gear maintenance log entries.
                         7-44
WIRE ROPE HISTORY REPORT                                            Report on computer disc. These discs would then be
                                                                    sent to NAWC Lakehurst vice the paper forms.
    The wire rope history chart (fig. 7-31) provides a
uniform system for recording arresting gear wire rope
                                                                                   REVIEW QUESTIONS
data. Engine operators shall maintain this for each
specific engine, with the last recovery number being                Q16.      The work center maintenance logs are
obtained from pri-fly. A new sheet shall be used at the                       retained for what minimum period of time?
beginning of each month.
                                                                                         SUMMARY
FLIGHT DECK OPERATIONS (NAVAIR FORM
13810/1 AND 138/1A)                                                      In this chapter, you learned that the Planned
                                                                    Maintenance System is a means for accomplishing
    The flight operation report (fig. 7-32) and (fig. -33)          preventive maintenance aboard ship. You also learned
is a two part form and is compiled from information                 that PMS procedures for a specific piece of equipment
contained in the catapult shot logs and the arresting               are based on good engineering practices, practical
gear recovery logs.                                                 experience, and technical standards. You studied the
                                                                    role the Maintenance Data System has in planning
ALRE AUTO SHOT RECOVERY LOG                                         workloads and providing a database for evaluating and
PROGRAM                                                             improving equipment installed in the fleet. The supply
                                                                    information in this chapter is not intended to make you
    The Auto shot and recovery log program provides a               an expert in supply matters. Rather, this section was
computerized program for the collection and                         developed to give you a basic understanding and
dissemination of launch and recovery log data. The                  provide you with some of the information needed for
automated program has been developed to record the                  ordering supplies. You also studied the maintenance
Shot Log, Recovery Log, and the Wire Rope History                   logs and reports for recording the details of catapult and
                                                                    arresting gear operations and maintenance.
                                                             7-45
Figure 7-32.—Flight Deck Operations (Part I) (NAVAIR Form 13810/1).
                               7-46
Figure 7-33.—Flight Deck Operations (Part II) (NAVAIR Form 13810/1A).
                                7-47
                                               APPENDIX I
GLOSSARY
ABE—Aviation Boatswain's Mate (Launching and                    BRAZE—To join two metals by intense heat and the
  Recovery Equipment).                                            application of a hard solder containing brass.
ABRASION—Wearing away of a surface by friction,                 BRINELLING—A displacement or flow of metal
  either by motion while in contact with another part              rather than a loss of metal due to wear.
  or by mechanical cleaning or resurfacing with
                                                                BULB SIDE—The side of the launching-engine
  abrasive cloth or compound.
                                                                  cylinders that mates directly with the cylinder
ac—Alternating current.                                           covers and is opposite the sealing-strip side.
ACHO—Aircraft Handling Officer.                                 BUR—A sharp projection of metal from an edge,
                                                                  usually the result of drilling, boring, counter-
ACNO—Assistant Chief of Naval Operations.
                                                                  sinking, and so forth, but may also be caused by
ACTIVATE—To put into action mechanically.                         excessive wear of one or both surfaces adjacent to
                                                                  the burred edge.
ACTUATE—To put into action electrically.
                                                                CAFSU—Carrier and field service unit.
ADP—Automated Data Processing.
                                                                CALIBRATION—To check, fix, or correct the
AEL—Allowance Equipage List.
                                                                  graduation of a measuring instrument.
AIMD—Aircraft Intermediate Maintenance Depart-
                                                                CALIPERS—An instrument composed of two curved
   ment.
                                                                  hinged legs, used for measuring internal and
ALINEMENT—Parts in correct related positions as                   external dimensions.
   specified on manufacturing drawings.
                                                                CASREP—Casualty Report.
ALRE—Aircraft Launch and Recovery Equipment.
                                                                CAUTION—An emphatic notice requiring correct
ALREMP—Aircraft     Launch     and          Recovery              operating or maintenance procedures to prevent
  Equipment Maintenance Program.                                  damage to equipment.
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE—The surrounding                             CDI—Collateral Duty Inspector.
  temperature.
                                                                CDP—Cross Deck Pendant.
APL—Allowance Parts List.
                                                                CDQAI—Collateral Duty Quality Assurance In-
ASG—Afloat Shopping Guide.                                        spector.
ATMOSPHERIC PRESSURE—The normal pres-                           CHAMFER—To bevel to a sharp external edge.
  sure of the air at sea level (14.7 psi).
                                                                CHARGE—To pressurize a hydraulic or pneumatic
AWM—Awaiting Maintenance.                                         system with fluid or air.
AWP—Awaiting Parts.                                             CHATTER—Vibration caused by uneven motion of a
                                                                  machine, possibly resulting in damage to parts.
AWR—Automated Work Request.
                                                                CIRCUMFERENCE—A line around a closed figure
BACK OUT—To remove a screw or other threaded
                                                                   of area.
  part from its fully torqued or set position.
                                                                CNO—Chief of Naval Operations.
BINDING—The stopping or the slowing down of
   motion between two surfaces because of foreign               COGNIZANT—Pertaining to the responsible upper
   matter, poor alinement of ports, unequal expansion,            authority who can make a final decision on a
   or unequal wear between surfaces.                              specific matter.
                                                         AI-1
COH—Complex Overhaul.                                            DEAD LOAD—A wheeled vehicle used instead of an
                                                                   aircraft during catapult testing.
COMCARGRU—Commander Carrier Group.
                                                                 DEENERGIZE—To remove from operation elec-
COME-ALONG—Ratchet hoist.
                                                                   trically.
COMFAIRMED—Commander Fleet Air, Mediter-
                                                                 DEFORMATION—A change in the shape or
  ranean.
                                                                   dimensions of a body, due to overstressing or
COMFAIRWESTPAC—Commander                  Fleet    Air,            repeated usage.
  Western Pacific.
                                                                 DEPRESSURIZE—To remove air or hydraulic fluid
COMNAVAIRLANT—Commander Naval Air Force,                           from a system.
  U.S. Atlantic Fleet.
                                                                 DIAMETER—The width or thickness of a part.
COMNAVAIRPAC—Commander Naval Air Force,
                                                                 DIAMETRAL CLEARANCE—The difference
  U.S. Pacific Fleet.
                                                                    between the inside diameter (ID) of one part and
COMNAVAIRSYSCOM—Commander Naval Air                                 the outside diameter (OD) of another part when
  Systems Command.                                                  both parts have the same axis.
COMNAVSEASYSCOM—Commander Naval Sea                              DOD—Department of Defense.
  Systems Command.
                                                                 DON—Department of the Navy.
COMNAVSURFLANT—Commander Naval Surface
                                                                 DSCC—Defense Supply Center Columbus.
  Force, U.S. Atlantic Fleet.
                                                                 DSCP—Defense Supply Center Philadelphia.
COMNAVSURFPAC—Commander Naval Surface
  Force, U.S. Pacific Fleet.                                     DYNAMOMETER—A device used to measure force.
COMPONENT—A part of an assembly or sub-                          EI—Engineering Investigation.
  assembly.
                                                                 EIC—Equipment Identification Code.
CONCENTRICITY—Having a common axis or
                                                                 ELONGATION—An increase in the length of a
  center. Usually refers to the closeness of tolerances
                                                                   material due to heating, stretching, hammering,
  between the common center of two or more circles
                                                                   and so forth.
  (bore and outside diameter, bore and bolt circle
  diameters, and so forth).                                      EM—Electrician's Mate.
CONDENSATE—The liquid that forms when a gas or                   ENERGIZE—To put into operation electrically.
  vapor, such as steam, is cooled.
                                                                 EROSION—Pitting or eating away of metal due to the
CONTINUITY—The completeness of an electrical                       action of steam, chemicals, water, or atmosphere.
  circuit.
                                                                 ERRATIC—Operating in an unusual manner that may
CORROSION—Deterioration of a metal surface,                        result in possible breakdown or failure.
  usually caused by moist, salty air.
                                                                 FATIGUE—A major breakdown of the surface metal
COSAL—Coordinated Shipboard Allowance List.                         over a large area, resulting in the surface metal's
                                                                    becoming loose and detached from the base
CROV—Constant Run Out Valve.
                                                                    material.
CSMP—Current Ship's Maintenance Project.
                                                                 FBR—Feedback Report.
CSV—Capacity Selector Valve.
                                                                 FED LOG—Federal Logistic.
CV—Multi-purpose aircraft carrier.
                                                                 FLOLS—Fresnel Lens Optical Landing System.
CVN—Nuclear-powered multi-purpose aircraft car-
                                                                 FMSO—Fleet Material Support Office.
  rier.
                                                                 FOD—Foreign Object Damage.
DLA—Defense Logistics Agency.
                                                                 FREEZING—Stopping of motion between two
D-LEVEL—Depot level.
                                                                   contacting surfaces because of lack of lubrication.
                                                          AI-2
GALLING—Tearing away of a metal surface by                      magnetized and then sprinkled with iron powder to
  friction.                                                     locate discontinuities, such as hairline cracks.
HERTZ—Cycles per second.                                    MALFUNCTION—Any failure of a system or
                                                              component that prevents normal operation of the
HMR—Hazardous Material Report.
                                                              catapult.
HONE—To grind with an abrasive stone to remove
                                                            MCRL—Master Cross Reference List.
  surface imperfections.
                                                            MDS—Maintenance Data System.
HUD—Heads-Up Display.
                                                            MEGGER—An instrument used for checking the
HYDRAULIC—That which is operated or moved by
                                                              insulation of electrical cables.
  the use of pressurized fluid.
                                                            MEGOHM—A unit of electrical resistance equal to a
HYDROSTATIC TEST—A test to determine whether
                                                              million ohms.
  a part can withstand certain hydraulic pressures
  without deforming or leaking.                             METCAL—Meteorology and Calibration (program).
I-LEVEL—Intermediate level.                                 MICROINCH—A unit of measurement equal to a
                                                              millionth of an inch.
IC—Interior Communications.
                                                            MIOCROMETER—A device used for measuring
ICCS—Integrated Catapult Control Station.
                                                              minute distances.
ICP—Inventory Control Point.
                                                            MILSTRIP—Military Standard Requisition and Issue
IEM—Inactive Equipment Maintenance.                           Procedures.
ILARTS—Integrated Launch and Recovery Television            MIP—Maintenance Index Page.
   Surveillance System.
                                                            MISALINEMENT—The condition of not being
IMA—Intermediate Maintenance Activity.                         along a fixed straight line; cocked to one side with
                                                               respect to other parts.
INSURV—Inspection and survey.
                                                            MOVLAS—Manually Operated Visual Landing Aid
IPB—Illustrated Parts Breakdown.
                                                              System.
IRAC—Interim Rapid Action Change.
                                                            MR—Maintenance Requirement.
JBD—Jet Blast Deflector.
                                                            MRC—Maintenance Requirement Card.
JCN—Job Control Number.
                                                            MRIL—Master Repairable Item List.
JSN—Job Sequence Number.
                                                            MS—Maintenance Support.
LAGGING—The material used to insulate steam
                                                            NATTC—Naval Air Technical Training Center.
  pipes or boilers to prevent the loss of heat by
  radiation.                                                NATO—North Atlantic Treaty Organization.
LANG LAY—The lay in the strands and the lay in the          NAVAIRWARCEN—Naval Air Warfare Center.
  rope are in the same direction.
                                                            NAVSHIPYD—Naval Shipyard.
LAY—That length of rope in which one strand makes
                                                            NAVSUP—Naval Supply System Command.
  one complete revolution about the core.
                                                            NDI—Non-destructive inspection.
LOEP—List of Effective Pages.
                                                            NECKING-DOWN—A reduction in diameter, as in a
MC—Maintenance Control.
                                                              bolt or stud, caused by wear from vibration of
MAF—Maintenance Action Form.                                  another part.
MAGNETIC       PARTICLE       INSPECTION—A                  NGL—Nose Gear Launch.
  nondestructive method of inspecting areas on or
                                                            NPC—Naval Personnel Command.
  near the surface of iron or steel. The part is
                                                     AI-3
NSN—National Stock Number.                                     REEVE—To pass a cable or rope through a sheave,
                                                                 hole, ring, or similar object.
NTP—Navy Training Plan.
                                                               REMOVAL TORQUE—The minimum torque re-
O-LEVEL—Organizational Level.
                                                                 quired to remove an installed screw, measured with
OHM—A measurement of electrical resistance.                      no axial load in the screw and while the screw is in
                                                                 motion.
OJT—On-the-job training.
                                                               SATURATED STEAM—Steam that contains mois-
OPNAV—Office of the Chief of Naval Operations.
                                                                  ture.
OPTAR—Operations (or Operating) Target (funding).
                                                               SAYBOLT SECONDS UNIVERSAL—A unit of
OSI—Operating space item.                                         measurement of fluid viscosity as determined by a
                                                                  Saybolt viscometer. (The higher the SSU number,
PARALLEL—Being arranged so that two or more
                                                                  the more viscous the fluid.)
   lines, such as centerlines or lines along outside
   edges, can all be at right angles to one common             SCORING—Deep grooves in a surface caused by
   line.                                                         rubbing when fine, hard particles are forced
                                                                 between moving surfaces (as in a bearing and
PEB—Pre-Expended Bin.
                                                                 journal), or when a moving part is not supplied with
PEEN—To change the shape of a metal part by striking             lubricant.
   with a hammer.
                                                               SE—Support Equipment.
pH NUMBER—A number used to measure the acidity
                                                               SECDEF—Secretary of Defense.
   or alkalinity of a solution; pH values run from 0
   through 14. A value of 7 indicates neutrality;              SECNAV—Secretary of the Navy.
   numbers less than 7 indicate acidity, and numbers
                                                               SECURE—Tighten joints or fasteners.
   greater than 7 indicate alkalinity.
                                                               SEIZING—A wrapping, consisting of several turns of
PICKLE—To clean castings or forgings in a hot weak-
                                                                  light line or wire, placed around the cut end of a
   sulfuric-acid bath.
                                                                  wire rope to prevent the strands of the rope from
PITTING—Small deep cavities with sharp edges.                     unraveling.
   May be caused in metal surfaces by high impacts or
                                                               SEIZING—The stopping of motion between two
   by oxidation.
                                                                  contacting surfaces because of lack of lubrication.
PME—Precision Measuring Equipment.
                                                               SFOMS—Ship's Force Overhaul Management Sys-
PMS—Planned Maintenance System.                                   tem.
PNEUMATIC—That which is operated or moved by                   SFWP—Ship's Force Work Package.
  the use of pressurized air.
                                                               SHEAR—A break in a part caused by an external
POWER PACKAGE—Provides and maintains the                         pressure.
  hydraulic pressure to raise and lower the barricade
                                                               SHIPALT—Ship Alteration.
  stanchions.
                                                               SI—Ship Installation,
PQS—Personnel Qualification Standards.
                                                               SIMA—Shore Intermediate Maintenance Activity.
PRESSURIZE—To compress air or hydraulic fluid to
  a pressure greater than normal.                              SLEP—Service Life Extension Program.
QA—Quality Assurance.                                          SM&R—Source, Maintenance, and Recovery Code.
QAI—Quality Assurance Inspector.                               SNAP—Shipboard Non-tactical ADP Program.
QDR—Quality Deficiency Report.                                 SPALLING OR FLAKING—A breakdown of the
                                                                  surface metal over a small area, resulting in the
RAC—Rapid Action Change.
                                                                  surface metal's becoming loose and detached from
                                                                  the base material.
                                                        AI-4
SRA—Selected Restricted Availability.                             TORQUE—A force applied to a part, using a twisting
                                                                    or rotating motion.
STAKE—To spread the head of a fastener, while in
   place, with a center punch or similar tool to prevent          TPDR—Technical Publication Deficiency Report.
   rotation of the fastener.
                                                                  TPL—Technical Publications Library.
STELLITE—A very hard metal composition used for
                                                                  TYCOM—Type Commander.
   facings.
                                                                  UIC—Unit Identification Code.
STRAIN—That force within a part that is caused by an
   external pressure.                                             VENT—To remove air or other gas or vapor from a
                                                                    system.
STRIP SIDE—The side of the launching-engine
   cylinders on which the sealing strip is located.               VIDS—Visual Information Display System.
SUPERHEATED STEAM—Steam that is hotter than                       V-RING PACKING—Chevron Packing.
   the boiling point of water and contains no moisture.
                                                                  VISCOSITY—Measure of resistance of a fluid to
SWAGE—To make a binding between a fitting and                        flow. (Thick liquids, such as syrup or glue, would
  wire rope by hammering the fitting until its                       have a higher viscosity than water.)
  diameter over the wire rope is reduced so that the
                                                                  VLA—Visual Landing Aid.
  fitting holds the wire rope tightly.
                                                                  VOLATILE—Passing off readily in the form of a
SWLIN—Ship's Work Line Item Number.
                                                                    vapor.
TAV—Technical Availability.
                                                                  VR—Voyage Repair.
TCP—Tool Control Program.
                                                                  VRT—Voyage Repair Team.
TD—Technical Directive.
                                                                  W/C—Work Center.
TFBR—Technical Feedback Report.
                                                                  WARNING—An emphatic notice requiring correct
THERMAL—Relating to or caused by heat.                              operating or maintenance procedures and the
                                                                    ensuring of safe conditions to prevent injury or loss
3-M—Maintenance and Material Management.
                                                                    of life.
TMDER—Technical Manual Deficiency/Evaluation
                                                                  WARPING—Bending or twisting out of shape.
  Report.
                                                                  WDC—Work Definition Conference.
TOLERANCE—The amount of variation permitted in
  the size of a part.                                             WET STEAM—Steam mixed with free water par-
                                                                    ticles.
                                                           AI-5
                             APPENDIX II
Chapter 1
Chapter 2
Use and Care of Hand Tools and Measuring Tools, NAVEDTRA 12085, Naval
   Education and Training Professional development and Technology Center,
   Pensacola, Fla., 1994.
Aircraft Launch and Recovery Equipment (ALRE) Tool Control Manual,
    NAEC-51-OR732.
Chapter 3
Chapte r 4
                                    AII-1
Operational and Organizational/Intermediate Maintenance Manual with Illustrated
   Parts Breakdown, For All Shipboard Steam Catapults, NAVAIR 51-15ABB-4.3.
Organizational and Intermediate Operation, Service, and Maintenance Instructions
   with Illustrated Parts Breakdown, Digital Endspeed Indicator System (DESI),
   NAVAIR 51-15ABE-2.
Chapter 5
Chapter 6
Chapter 7
                                    AII-2
                                APPENDIX III
 A1. The Tool Control Program is based on the concept of a family of specialized
     toolboxes and pouches configured for instant inventory before and after each
     maintenance action. The content and configuration of each container is
     tailored to the task, work center, and equipment maintained.
 A2. Good tool work habits include:
     1.   Keep each tool in its proper stowage place
     2.   Keep tools in good condition
     3.   Keep your tool allowance complete
     4.   Use each tool only for the job it was designed to do
 A3. Striking tools include:
     1.   Ball peen hammer
     2.   Cross peen hammer
     3.   Riveting hammer
     4.   Claw hammer
     5.   Mallets and sledges
 A4. Machinists' hammers are used on metal and machinery. Soft-faced hammers
     are used when there is a danger of damaging the surface of the work, such as
     when pounding on a machined surface. Mallets are used to drive wooden-
     handled chisels, gouges, and wooden pins. Short-handled sledges are used to
     drive driftpins, large nails, and to strike cold chisels and small hand-held rock
     drills. Long-handled sledges are used break rock and concrete, to drive spikes
     or stakes, and to strike rock drills and chisels. Claw hammers are used for
     carpentry work.
 A5. Striking tools should be kept clean and free of oil. The heads should be dressed
     to remove any battered edges. A light film of oil should be kept on mallets to
     maintain a little moisture in the head. Hammer handles should be kept tight.
 A6. Do not use a hammer handle for bumping parts in assembly, and never use it as
     a pry bar. Do not strike a hardened steel surface with a steel hammer.
 A7. The different types of wrenches are open end, box, combination, socket,
     ratchet, torque and, adjustable, such as the union nut, pipe, and strap
     wrenches. There are also spanner and setscrew wrenches.
 A8. Wrenches are used to turn nuts, bolts, pipes, and setscrews.
 A9. The safety precautions that apply to wrenches are:
     1. Always use a wrench that fits the nut properly
     2. Keep wrenches clean and free from oil
     3. Do not increase the leverage of a wrench by slipping a pipe over the
        handle
     4. Determine which way a nut should be turned before trying to loosen it
                                      AIII-1
A10. The different types of metal-cutting tools are:
     1. Snips and shears
     2.   Hacksaws
     3.   Chisels
     4.   Files
     5.   Twist drills
     6.   Punches
     7.   Taps and dies
A11. Hawks-bill snips are used for cutting circles
A12. Hacksaws are used to cut metal that is too heavy for snips or boltcutters.
A13. Taps and dies are used to cut threads in metal, plastics, or hard rubber.
A14. The different types of punches are:
     1.   Center punch
     2.   Prick punch
     3.   Drift or starting punch
     4.   Pin punch
     5.   Aligning punch
     6.   Hollow shank gasket punch
A15. The center punch is used to mark the center of a hole to be drilled.
A16. A prick punch is used to mark the intersection of two layout lines.
A17. The different types of taps are:
     1.   Taper
     2.   Plug
     3.   Bottoming
     4.   Pipe
A18. Taper taps are used for starting a tapping operation or for tapping through
      holes.
A19. The different types of dies are:
     1.   Rethreading dies
     2.   Round split adjustable dies
     3.   Two piece collet dies
     4.   Two piece rectangular pipe dies
A20. Two-piece rectangular pipe dies are used for cutting internal American
      Standard Pipe threads.
A21. Screw and tap extractors are used to remove screws and taps without
     damaging the material being worked on.
A22. Pipe cutters are used to cut pipe made of steel, brass, copper, wrought iron, or
     lead.
A23. Tube cutters are used to cut tubing made of iron, steel, brass, copper, or
     aluminum.
A24. Flaring tools are used to make flares in the ends of tubing.
A25. The different types of screwdrivers are the standard, clutch tip, Phillips, Reed
     and Prince, offset, and ratcheting.
                                        AIII-2
A26. Safety precautions that apply to screwdrivers include:
      1. Never use a screwdriver to check electrical circuits.
      2. Never try to turn a screw driver with a pair of pliers.
      3. Do not hold work in your hand while using a screwdriver.
A27. The different types of pliers are:
      1.   Slip-joint
      2.   Wrench
      3.   Water-pump
      4.   Groove-joint
      5.   Diagonal
      6.   Side-cutting
      7.   Duckbill pliers
      8.   Needle-nose
      9.   Wire-twister
A28. Wrench pliers are used for clamping and holding onto objects regardless of
     their shape.
A29. Side-cutting pliers are used for holding, bending, and cutting thin materials or
     small gauge wire.
A30. A small three-corner file is used to sharpen the serrations on the jaws of pliers.
A31. Mechanical fingers are used to retrieve small articles that have fallen into
     places that cannot be reached by hand.
A32. A standard Navy vaporproof two-cell flashlight belongs in every toolbox.
A33. Inspection mirrors are used to view areas that cannot be seen by a direct line of
      sight.
A34. Several principles that apply to the care of handtools are:
      1.   Clean tools after each use.
      2.   Never hammer with a wrench.
      3.   Never leave tools scattered about.
      4.   Apply a light film of oil after cleaning to prevent rust.
      5.   Inventory tools after each use to prevent loss.
A35. Personal safety equipment includes safety shoes, goggles, Gloves, and safety
     belts and straps.
A36. Common power tools include drills, Disk sanders, portable grinders, and
     electric impact wrenches.
A37. Although electric drills are designed for drilling holes, by adding accessories
     they can be adapted for sanding, sawing, buffing, polishing, screw driving,
     wire brushing, and paint mixing.
A38. Safety precautions that apply to power tools:
      1. Ensure electrical tools are inspected and approved for shipboard use.
      2. Wear safety goggles when using portable electric tools.
      3. Rubber gloves must be worn when using portable electric tools under
         hazardous conditions.
                                       AIII-3
A39. Safety precautions that apply to extension cords:
     1. Only use three-wire extension cords with three prong plugs.
     2. Plug the tool into the extension cord before the extension cord is plugged
        in.
     3. Replace damaged cords.
A40. Portable pneumatic power tools include pneumatic chipping hammers, rotary
     and needle impact scalers, and portable pneumatic impact wrenches.
A41. Rotary and needle impact scalers are used for removing rust, scale, and old
     paint from metallic and masonry surfaces.
A42. Safety precautions that apply to pneumatic tools include:
     1. Wear the appropriate protective devices.
     2. Only authorized and trained personnel should use pneumatic tools.
     3. Pneumatic tools should be laid down in such a way that no harm will be
        done if the switch is accidentally turn on.
     4. Never point the air hose at another person.
A43. The title block is located in the lower right corner on all blueprints and
     drawings prepared to military standards.
                                     AIII-4
ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOR LESSON 3
 A1. The constant runout control valve is considered the heart of the arresting en-
     gine.
 A2. The retract valve permits the return of hydraulic fluid from the accumulator to
     the main engine cylinder.
 A3. The capacity of the fluid stowage tank is 700 gallons.
 A4. The pitch diameter of the sheaves on the outboard shaft of the crosshead is 33
     inches.
 A5. The drive system transfer energy from an arresting aircraft to the arresting en-
     gine.
 A6. The sheave damper reduces peak cable tension.
 A7. The differences between the pendant engine and the barricade engine are:
     1.   No fluid coolers are installed.
     2.   Barricade engines are endless reeved.
     3.   No anchor dampers are installed.
     4.   A short stroke control valve cam is used.
 A8. Multiple release straps connects the upper and lower loads straps to the bar-
     ricade stanchions.
 A9. The counterbalancing springs are compressed when the stanchions are low-
     ered.
A10. The deck latch secures the barricade stanchions to the deck.
A11. The power package accumulator operating pressure is 1500 psi.
A12. Off, Automatic, and Run are the three position of the motor controller switch.
A13. One inch is the minimum allowable clearance between the crosshead and the
     crosshead stop.
A14. The age of all packing are based on the cure date.
A15. The shelf life of V-ring packing is three years.
A16. The open side of the packing face the pressure.
A17. Hookrunner should approach the aircraft from the front and side.
A18. Air in the main engine cylinder or the CRO valve not properly seated.
A19. The barricade stanchions safety brace must be installed.
A20. When the weight selector is set to light for the incoming aircraft two-blocking
     can occur.
A21. Fast retraction is an indication of excessive accumulator pressure.
 A1. The launching engine cylinders are heated by a pair of trough heaters located
     below each row of launching engine cylinders.
 A2. The trough steam smothering is actuated pneumatically by a valve located at
     deckedge or manually by a bypass located near the pneumatically operated
     steam supply valve.
                                     AIII-5
 A3. The launch valve steam valve admits and shuts off the flow of steam to the
     launching engine cylinders during operation.
 A4. The launch valve stroke timer electrical system measures launch valve per-
     formance.
 A5. To prevent the exhaust valve from opening while the launch valve is open.
 A6. The shuttle assembly by means of a launch bar attached to the aircraft nose
     gear and connected to the catapult NGL spreader?
 A7. The lubrication system provides a means of lubricating the launching engine
     cylinders?
 A8. The retract permissive and maneuver aft circuit.
 A9. Capacity of 90 gallons.
A10. The retraction engine and drive system is used to return the launching engine
     pistons and shuttle assembly to the battery position after each launch.
A11. Control is divided between the ICCS and the CCP.
A12. The deck edge signal box indicates the readiness of the catapult.
A13. No loads are conducted during the accomplishment of preoperational MRCs
     and may also be required during post maintenance check out.
A14. After 10 seconds.
 A1. The operating gear assembly provides the means of physically raising and
     lowering the JBD panels.
 A2. The Mk 7 Mod 0 JBD consists of 14 tube assemblies.
 A3. The swivel joint permits rotational movement of the piping during raising and
     lowering of the JBDs.
 A4. The maximum temperature of the cooling water is 210°F.
 A5. The four-way control valve (stack valve) controls the hydraulic fluid to and
     from the hydraulic cylinders.
 A6. The stack valve is a four-way, solenoid controlled pilot operated valve.
 A7. The difference between the deckedge and the auxiliary panels is none, because
     they are identical.
 A8. The double indicator light indicates low cooling water pressure and high cool-
     ing water temperature.
 A9. The “all” raise switch permits raising and lowering of all JBD panels simul-
     taneously.
A10. The panel support is used to lock the JBD panels in the raised position for
     maintenance or emergencies.
A11. The personnel required for an JBD emergency lowering are:
     1.   Topside safety Petty Officer (overall in charge)
     2.   Topside JBD phone talker
     3.   Below decks phone talker/valve operator
     4.   Two personnel to install emergency lowering device
                                    AIII-6
     5. Two safety observers (station at the port and starboard sides of the JBD
        panels
     6. Tractor driver
A12. The NGL guide tracks are:
     1.   Approach track
     2.   Buffer cylinder track
     3.   Aft slide-access track
     4.   Forward slide-access track
     5.   Forward track
A13. The slide is mechanically connected to the buffer cylinder piston rods by three
     links.
A14. The reset assembly resets the buffer hook.
A15. Inserts installed in the forward slide-access track ensures the launch bar makes
      contact with the buffer hook actuator roller.
A16. The orifice tube is located in the two outer cylinders.
A17. Fluid from the buffer accumulator assembly fills the void created as the piston
     rods move forward.
A18. The buffer fwd and buffer fwd pushbuttons are installed in the monitor control
     console, deckedge, and the central charging panel.
                                       AIII-7
 A8. Color codes are used to annotate the priority section of the ALRE MAF card.
 A9. The ALRE MAF is divided into seven areas.
A10. Copy 1 of the ALRE MAF is retained by QA.
A11. The primary role of maintenance support is to assist operating work centers by
     providing technical expertise in performing maintenance and repairs on
     critical equipment.
A12. The maintenance summary sheets must be retained for 2 years.
A13. Benefits of the tool control program are:
     1. Reduced initial outfitting and tool replacement costs
     2. Reduced tool pilferage
     3. Reduced man-hours required to complete each maintenance task
     4. Assurance that the proper tools are available to perform specific main-
        tenance tasks
A14. False: CDIs are assigned to their respective work centers.
A15. The work center supervisor is responsible for ensuring that the proper level of
     QA inspection is assigned to a maintenance action.
A16. QAIs and CDQAIs are designated in writing by the commanding officer.
A17. The categories of QA audits are:
     1. Work center
     2. Special
     3. Annual TYCOM
                                      AIII-8
 A9. The OPNAV 4790/2K is used to report all deferred maintenance actions and
     the completion of maintenance actions that do not result in configuration
     changes.
A10. The maintenance planning and estimating form (OPNAV 4790/2P) is used
     along with the OPNAV 4790/2K form for deferring maintenance to be done
     by an intermediate maintenance activity (IMA).
A11. The national stock number is made up of 13 digits.
A12. The Federal Supply Classification number occupies the first part of the
     national stock number.
A13. The cognizant (COG) symbol identifies the stores account and cognizant
     inventory manager of an item.
A14. The Afloat Shopping Guide (ASG) is designed to assist the fleet personnel in
     identifying the NSNs for items that are frequently requested by ships.
A15. The casualty report (CASREP) system contains four types of reports: Initial,
     Update, Correct, and Cancel.
A16. The workcenter maintenance logs are retained for a minimum of two years.
                                    AIII-9
                                                INDEX
A D
                                                 INDEX-1
L                                                           Pipe cutter, 1-43
                                                            Pliers, 1-18
Launching engine system, 4-3                                     duckbill, 1-29
     cylinder covers, 4-15                                       needle-nose, 1-30
     cylinder expansion and elongation indicators,               side-cutting, 1-29
        4-25                                                     slipjoint, 1-28
     cylinder sealing strips, 4-16                               wire-twister, 1-30
     launching cylinders, 4-15                                   wrench, 1-18
     sealing strip anchor and guide, 4-17                   PMS maintenance requirement status boards, 6-9
     sealing strip tensioner, 4-17                          Pneumatic tools, 1-40
     shuttle, 4-18                                               clipping hammer, 1-40
     steam piston assembly, 4-18                                 impact wrench, 1-41
     water-brake cylinders, 4-19                            Power tools, 1-37
     water-brake pressure-sensing switches, 4-21                 disk sander, 1-38
     water-brake pumps, 4-20                                     drills, 1-37
List of Effective Pages, 7-2                                     impact scalers, 1-40
     force revision, 7-2                                         portable grinders, 1-38
     maintenance index page, 7-3                            Punches, 1-32
Lubrication system, 4-27                                         aligning, 1-33
                                                                 drift, 1-33
M                                                                hollow shank gasket punch, 1-34
                                                                 prick, 1-33
Maintenance log, 7-42                                       Purchase cable, 3-27
Maintenance requirement description, 7-8                    Push-button station, 3-9
Main hydraulic pumps, 4-33                                       control valve weight selector indictor circuit, 3-9
    rotary retraction engine, 4-35                               deckedge control, 3-9
Maintain JBD equipment, 5-13
    cleaning, 5-14                                          Q
    hoses, seals, and o-rings, 5-14
    standard safety precautions, 5-14                       Quality assurance, 6-13
Maintenance procedures, 3-45                                    audits, 6-16
Maintenance types, levels, and responsibilities, 6-1            inspector qualifications, 6-15
    depot maintenance, 6-2                                  Quarterly schedule, 7-16
    intermediate maintenance, 6-1
    organizational maintenance, 6-2                         R
Material control codes, 7-33
Measuring tools, 2-1                                        Recovery log, 7-43
    rules and tapes, 2-1                                    Repairables, 7-36
Mechanical fingers, 1-46                                    Replacing packings, 3-63
Metal-cutting tools, 1-9                                        general precautions, 3-64
    files, 1-13                                                 gland installation, 3-59
    hacksaws, 1-11                                              installing new packings, 3-59
    snips and shears, 1-9                                   Replacing purchase cable, 3-46
Microfilm/aperture cards, 1-8                                   inspecting the terminal, 3-55
MK 2 nose-gear-launch system, 5-15                              preparing and pouring zinc, 3-53
    actuator reset assembly, 5-17                               testing the terminal, 3-56
    buffer accumulator, 5-18                                Retracting valve, 3-10
    buffer cylinder, 5-18                                       plunger, 3-11
    guide track, 5-15                                           retracting lever, 3-11
    shock absorber assembly, 5-20                               valve body, 3-10
MK 7 MOD 0 jet blast deflector, 5-2                             valve seat, 3-11
    control system, 5-9                                         valve stem, 3-11
    emergency procedures, 5-12                              Retraction system, 4-35
    water-cooled panel assembly, 5-4                            drum assembly, 4-36
                                                                screw and traverse carriage, 4-36
P
Part number, 7-35                                           S
Personal safety equipment, 1-2
     belts and straps, 1-2                                  Schematic diagrams, 1-8
     goggles, 1-2                                               electrical systems, 1-8
     safety shoes, 1-2                                          piping systems, 1-8
                                                       INDEX-2
Screwdrivers, 1-44                                         plug, 1-34
    offset, 1-46                                       Tool Control Program, 1-1,6-13
    reed and prince, 1-45                                  care of hand tools, 1-2
    standard, 1-44                                     Toolbox flashlight, 1-47
Setscrew wrenches, 1-26                                Torque wrenches, 1-23
    allen, 1-26                                            deflecting beam, 1-24
    bristol, 1-26                                          dial indicating, 1-24
Sheave damper, 3-24                                        micrometer setting, 1-24
Socket handles, 1-23                                   Transfer switches, 4-49
    sliding t-bar, 1-23                                    integrated catapult control system (ICCS), 4-44
    speedhandle, 1-23
Spanner wrenches, 1-26
    hook spanner, 1-26                                 V
    pin spanner, 1-26
Steam catapults, 4-1                                   V-2 maintenance organization structure and
    description, 4-1                                      responsibility, 6-2
    launching valve assemblies, 4-4                        ALRE maintenance support, 6-12
Steam cutoff pressure-switch installation, 4-22            maintenance control, 6-3
Steam system, 4-1                                          quality assurance branch, 6-13
capacity selector valve, 4-9                           Visual information display system (VIDS), 6-4
                                                           maintenance action form (MAF) Cards, 6-7
     launching valve assembly, 4-4
     launching-valve control valve, 4-9
Striking tools, 1-30                                   W
ball-peen hammer, 1-31
machinists’ hammers, 1-31                              Walkback, 3-60
                                                       Weekly schedule, 7-19
T                                                      Wrenches, 1-18
                                                          box, 1-21
Taps, 1-34                                                combination, 1-21
    bottoming, 1-34                                       open-end, 1-19
                                                          socket, 1-22
                                                  INDEX-3
Assignment Questions
Textbook Assignment: “Common Maintenance Tools and Their Uses,” Pages 1-1 through 1-48; and “Measuring
                      Tools and Techniques,” Pages 2-1 through 2-12.
1-1.   You demonstrate good work habits by doing              1-6.    What characteristic determines the size of an
       which of the following tasks?                                  open-end wrench?
       1. Stowing tools in their proper place                         1. The overall length of the wrench
       2. Using handtools for their intended                          2. The width of the opening between the
          purposes only                                                  wrench jaws
       3. Protecting tools against damage, breakage,                  3. The thickness of the wrench jaws
          and rust                                                    4. The minimum amount of "play" between
       4. All of the above                                               the jaws
1-2.   Ball-peen machinist's hammers are made in              1-7.    The most frequently used box-end wrench has
       different weights. They are also divided into                  how many "points" or notches that contact the
       hard-faced and soft-faced classifications.                     nut or bolt to be loosened or tightened?
       1. True                                                        1. 6
       2. False                                                       2. 8
                                                                      3. 10
1-3.   Which of the following tools is most suitable
                                                                      4. 12
       for driving a tight fitting shaft into its hole?
                                                              1-8.    Which of the following wrenches is best suited
       1.   A hard-faced hammer
                                                                      for breaking a nut loose and then unscrewing it
       2.   A soft-faced hammer
                                                                      quickly?
       3.   A carpenter's hammer
       4.   A sledge hammer                                           1.   An open-end "5" wrench
                                                                      2.   A 15-degree offset open-end wrench
1-4.   Which of the following statements best de-
                                                                      3.   A box-end wrench
       scribes the effect of choking up on a hammer
                                                                      4.   A combination box open-end wrench
       handle?
                                                              1-9.    A box-end wrench with a 15-degree offset has
       1.   It increases the lever arm
                                                                      what advantage, if any, over a straight-handle
       2.   It reduces the striking force of the blow
                                                                      box-end wrench?
       3.   It produces a more effective blow
       4.   It makes it easier to hold the hammer                     1. The offset allows more handle swing
            upright                                                   2. Increased leverage
                                                                      3. The offset allows clearance over nearby
1-5.   Which of the following is a recommended
                                                                         parts
       practice in the use and care of a rawhide
                                                                      4. None
       mallet?
                                                              1-10.   Which of the following socket handle is used to
       1. It may be used to drive nails or strike steel
                                                                      rapidly tighten or loosen nuts or bolts using a
          surfaces
                                                                      series of partial turns?
       2. The rawhide may be conditioned by
          exposure to sunlight                                        1.   Hinged handle
       3. The handle may be used for prying                           2.   Speed handle
       4. A light film of oil should be applied to the                3.   Ratchet handle
          head before storage                                         4    Sliding T-bar handle
                                                          1
1-11.   Which of the following socket handle is used             1-16.   How are the teeth arranged on a double
        for removing nuts or bolts that have been                        alternate set hacksaw blade?
        loosened first with another wrench?
                                                                         1. They are arranged in short sections on each
        1.   Hinged handle                                                  side of the blade
        2.   Speed handle                                                2. They are arranged so that every third tooth
        3.   Ratchet handle                                                 is in line with the blade
        4    Sliding T-bar handle                                        3. They are staggered in pairs, two to the left
                                                                            and two to the right
1-12.   Which of the following socket handle is used
                                                                         4. They are staggered, one to the left and one
        for applying the most leverage to break loose
                                                                            to the right
        tight nuts?
                                                                 1-17.   What term denotes the groove cut through the
        1.   Hinged handle
                                                                         head of a cap screw or machine bolt?
        2.   Speed handle
        3.   Ratchet handle                                              1.   Guide
        4    Sliding T-bar handle                                        2.   Step
                                                                         3.   Kerf
1-13.   When you are using a micrometer setting type
                                                                         4.   Set
        torque wrench, how is the amount of torque
        applied indicated?                                       1-18.   What chisel is used for cutting keyways and
                                                                         square corners?
        1. By pointer or needle movement
        2. The socket slips for a short distance                         1.   Round nose
        3. An audible click and free movement of the                     2.   Cape
           handle for a short distance                                   3.   Flat
        4. The user depends on a sense of touch or                       4.   Diamond point
           "feel" acquired through experience
                                                                 1-19.   What chisel is used for chipping inside
1-14.   What advantage is there to using an adjustable                   corners?
        wrench instead of a box-end wrench to tighten
                                                                         1.   Round nose
        or loosen a nut?
                                                                         2.   Cape
        1. An adjustable wrench can be made to fit                       3.   Flat
           odd-sized nuts or bolts                                       4.   Diamond point
        2. An adjustable wrench cannot damage hard
                                                                 1-20.   What chisel is used for cutting V-grooves and
           to turn nuts
                                                                         sharp corners?
        3. An adjustable wrench is less likely to be
           used improperly                                               1.   Round nose
        4. Either jaw of an adjustable wrench may be                     2.   Cape
           adjusted to fit any size or shape nut or bolt                 3.   Flat
                                                                         4.   Diamond point
1-15.   How should you guide straight hand tin snips
        when cutting light sheet metal, in relation to the       1-21.   What chisel is used for cutting rivets and thin
        layout line?                                                     medal sheets?
        1.   Guide snips on the inside of the line                       1.   Round nose
        2.   Guide snips on the outside of the line                      2.   Cape
        3.   Guide snips directly on the line                            3.   Flat
        4.   Guide snips either directly on the line or                  4.   Diamond point
             just inside of it                                   1-22.   Which of the following items should you wear
                                                                         when chipping metal with a chisel?
                                                                         1.   Canvas gloves
                                                                         2.   A shop apron
                                                                         3.   Safety goggles
                                                                         4.   Rubber gloves
                                                             2
1-23.   At what angle are the teeth of a single-cut file         1-30.   You have marked the intersection of two layout
        set?                                                             lines with a prick punch, but the punch mark is
                                                                         not at the exact center. How should you now
        1.   40°
                                                                         center the punch mark?
        2.   65°
        3.   75°                                                         1. Draw a new layout
        4.   90°                                                         2. Select a new center point in the layout
                                                                         3. Make a second punch mark opposite of the
1-24.   Alternate-position crossfiling is best suited to
                                                                            first mark
        perform which of the following operations?
                                                                         4. Slant the punch toward the intersection of
        1.   Filing round stock                                             the lines and enlarge the punch mark
        2.   Polishing a flat surface
                                                                 1-31.   Taps are used to cut internal threads, and dies
        3.   Locating high and low spots
                                                                         are used to cut external threads in metal,
        4.   Roughing a smooth surface
                                                                         plastics, and hard rubber.
1-25.   Rubbing chalk into the teeth of a file is the best
                                                                         1. True
        method used to prevent "pinning" of the file.
                                                                         2. False
        1. True
                                                                 1-32.   What sequence of taps should be used to tap a
        2. False
                                                                         blind hole?
1-26.   When polishing a metal surface with emery
                                                                         1.   Plug, taper, bottoming
        cloth, what substance should you apply to the
                                                                         2.   Taper, bottoming, plug
        surface?
                                                                         3.   Plug, bottoming, taper
        1.   Chalk dust                                                  4.   Taper, plug, bottoming
        2.   Bright work polish
                                                                 1-33.   A chamfer length of only 1 to 1 1/2 threads is
        3.   Prussian blue
                                                                         found on what type of tap?
        4.   Lubricating oil
                                                                         1.   Taper
1-27.   What are the spiral grooves of a twist drill
                                                                         2.   Bottoming
        called?
                                                                         3.   Plug
        1.   The body                                                    4.   Pipe
        2.   The flute
                                                                 1-34.   How should you make adjustments to a
        3.   The shank
                                                                         two-piece collet die?
        4.   The margin
                                                                         1.   Turn the collet cap
1-28.   What is the function of the lip on a twist drill?
                                                                         2.   Push a release button
        1. To cut away the metal or wood being                           3.   Turn setscrews
           drilled                                                       4.   Turn the guide
        2. To allow the twist drill to revolve without
                                                                 1-35.   What is the cutting capacity of a number 2 pipe
           binding
                                                                         cutter?
        3. To center the twist drill
        4. To provide shank clearance                                    1.   1     to 2 in.
                                                                         2.   1 1/2 to 3 in.
1-29.   A center punch is used primarily to perform
                                                                         3.   2     to 3 in.
        which of the following tasks?
                                                                         4.   2     to 4 in.
        1. To mark the center of a hole to be drilled
                                                                 1-36.   The single flaring tool is used to flare tubing
        2. To line up holes in mating assembly parts
                                                                         ranging in what sizes?
        3. To free pins that are stuck or "frozen" in
           their holes                                                   1.   3/16 through 3/8 in. only
        4. To scribe layout lines                                        2.   3/16 through 1/2 in.
                                                                         3.   1/4 through 7/16 in. only
                                                                         4.   1/4 through 1/2 in.
                                                             3
1-37.   Standard screwdrivers are classified by size           1-43.   Which of the following pneumatic tools is best
        according to the combined length of which of                   suited for use in scaling an irregular surface?
        their following parts?
                                                                       1.   Rotary scaler
        1.   Shank and blade only                                      2.   Needle scaler
        2.   Handle and shank only                                     3.   Shale scaler
        3.   Handle and blade only                                     4.   Jitterbug scaler
        4.   Handle, shank, and blade
                                                               1-44.   Generally, pneumatic impact wrenches operate
1-38.   How are combination slip-joint pliers                          most efficiently when the air supplied is in
        distinguished from regular slip-joint pliers?                  what pressure range?
        1. They have an adjustable pivot at the jaws                   1. 50 to 80 psi
        2. They are able to hold objects regardless of                 2. 80 to 90 psi
           their shape                                                 3. 80 to 100 psi
        3. They have a side cutter at the junction of                  4. 100 to 120 psi
           the jaws
                                                               1-45.   The term "blueprint reading" is best defined by
        4. They have dual joints allowing a larger
                                                                       which of the following statements?
           range of adjustment
                                                                       1. The reading aloud of the printed matter in
1-39.   Which type of pliers may be used as a clamp or
                                                                          the legends
        vice?
                                                                       2. The reading of related matter to help you
        1.   Slip-joint pliers                                            understand the blueprint symbols
        2.   Water pump pliers                                         3. The interpretation of the ideas expressed
        3.   Wrench pliers                                                on drawings
        4.   Groove-joint pliers                                       4. The interpretation of your ideas compared
                                                                          to the ideas expressed on the drawing
1-40.   Of the following operations, which one is best
        accomplished by using diagonal pliers?                 1-46.   In what corner of a blueprint is the revision
                                                                       block usually found?
        1. Grasping cylindrical objects
        2. Bending light gauge materials                               1.   Lower left
        3. Cutting small objects flush with the                        2.   Lower right
           surface                                                     3.   Upper left
        4. Straightening bent cotter pins                              4.   Upper right
1-41.   What type of file should be used to sharpen the        1-47.   Of the following types of blueprints, which one
        serrations on the jaws of pliers?                              would show the various parts of a machine and
                                                                       how the parts fit together?
        1.   A dead smooth file
        2.   A single cut flat file                                    1.   Detail print
        3.   A small triangular file                                   2.   Plan view
        4.   A small tapered square file                               3.   Assembly print
                                                                       4.   Unit print
1-42.   What is the maximum allowable length of an
        electric extension cord used on the flight deck?       1-48.   How should a 12-inch steel rule be held to
                                                                       obtain an accurate measurement of a surface?
        1. 25 ft
        2. 50 ft                                                       1. At a slight angle to the surface
        3. 75 ft                                                       2. With the edge at a slight distance from the
        4. 100 ft                                                         surface
                                                                       3. Flat along the surface
                                                                       4. With the edge along the surface
                                                           4
1-49.   What is the most practical means of measuring         1-55.   What type of micrometer is used to measure
        the outside diameter of a pipe?                               the diameter of solid round bar?
        1. Trace the circumference of the pipe on a                   1.   Inside
           piece of paper and measure across the                      2.   Outside
           tracing                                                    3.   Depth
        2. Stop one end of a rule at the pipe edge,                   4.   Screw thread
           swing the rule, and read the maximum
                                                              1-56.   What type of micrometer is used to measure
           measure
                                                                      the pitch diameter of a screw?
        3. Stop one end of the rule at the pipe edge,
           swing the rule, and read the minimum                       1.   Inside
           measure                                                    2.   Outside
        4. Wrap a flexible rule around the pipe                       3.   Depth
                                                                      4.   Screw thread
1-50.   Which of the following measuring tools is best
        used to measure the inside of a box frame or          1-57.   What type of micrometer is used to measure
        foot locker?                                                  the bore of a cylinder?
        1.   A folding rule with a sliding extension                  1.   Inside
        2.   A carpenter's square                                     2.   Outside
        3.   An inside caliper                                        3.   Depth
        4.   A flexible tape rule                                     4.   Screw thread
1-51.   Which of the following tools should you use to        1-58.   What type of micrometer is used to measure
        take a measurement over a long distance?                      piston travel in a cylinder?
        1.   A folding rule                                           1.   Inside
        2.   A folding rule with sliding extension                    2.   Outside
        3.   A hook rule                                              3.   Depth
        4.   A fiberglass tape rule                                   4.   Screw thread
1-52.   Which type of inside calipers should be used to       1-59.   Each of the 25 marks on the thimble of the
        measure a chamfered cavity?                                   standard outside micrometer represents what
                                                                      part of an inch?
        1.   Transfer firm joint
        2.   Adjustable firm joint                                    1.   0.001 in.
        3.   Spring                                                   2.   0.005 in.
        4.   Hermaphrodite                                            3.   0.025 in.
                                                                      4.   0.040 in.
1-53.   Which type of calipers should be used to locate
        the center of a shaft?                                1-60.   What characteristic of a micrometer deter-
                                                                      mines its range?
        1.   Transfer
        2.   Hermaphrodite                                            1. The length of its frame
        3.   Inside                                                   2. The distance that the spindle can travel
        4.   Outside                                                  3. The distance that the spindle travels with
                                                                         each revolution of the thimble
1-54.   Which of the following calipers may be used to
                                                                      4. The length of the work it will measure
        make inside and outside measurements?
        1.   Combination firm joint
        2.   Solid-joint
        3.   Spring
        4.   Adjustable firm joint
                                                          5
(THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK.)
                   6
                                          ASSIGNMENT 2
Textbook Assignment: "Mark 7 Aircraft Recovery Equipment and Emergency Recovery Equipment," Pages 3-1
                     throught 3-63.
2-1.   The Mk 7 recovery equipment is divided into a          2-6.   What is the purpose of the four vertical elon-
       total of how many major systems?                              gated holes machined into the retract valve
                                                                     seat?
       1.   Five
       2.   Two                                                      1. To allow fluid to pass through the valve
       3.   Three                                                       from the main engine cylinder
       4.   Four                                                     2. To allow fluid to pass through the valve
                                                                        from the accumulator
2-2.   What is the purpose of the Mk 7 arresting en-
                                                                     3. To allow fluid to pass through the valve
       gine constant runout control (CRO) valve?
                                                                        from the anchor dampers
       1. To control fluid flow from the engine                      4. To minimize the weight of the valve
          cylinder to the accumulator
                                                              2-7.   Which of the following statements best de-
       2. To control the hydraulic pressure
                                                                     scribes the action of the return spring of the
          maintained in the accumulator
                                                                     retract valve retraction lever?
       3. To reduce peak tension on the purchase
          cables during arrestment                                   1. The spring pulls up on the retract lever,
       4. To allow equal payout of both ends of the                     which in turn pulls down on the plunger
          deck pendant                                                  and valve stem
                                                                     2. The spring pulls up on the retract lever,
2-3.   The aircraft weight selector is adjusted while
                                                                        which in turn pulls up on the plunger and
       the arresting engine is in the battery position.
                                                                        valve stem
       This adjustment causes a change in the position
                                                                     3. The spring pulls down on the retract lever,
       of what component of the CRO valve?
                                                                        which in turn pulls down on the plunger
       1.   The cam                                                     and valve stem
       2.   The plunger                                              4. The spring pulls down on the retract lever,
       3.   The upper lever                                             which in turn pulls up on the plunger and
       4.   The lower lever                                             valve stem
2-4.   Which of the following statements is correct           2-8.   What device is installed on the retract valve
       concerning the valve sleeve and stem                          operating lever to eliminate chatter?
       movement of the CRO valve?
                                                                     1.   A return spring and tie rod
       1. At a 1:1 ratio, the sleeve and stem move 1/4               2.   A plunger
          in.                                                        3.   A shock absorber
       2. At a 1:1 ratio, the sleeve and stem move 1/2               4.   A 6-inch-square neoprene impact pad
          in.
                                                              2-9.   The Mk 7 Mod 3 arresting engines have what is
       3. At a 4:1 ratio, the sleeve and stem move 1/2
                                                                     described as a recirculating type hydraulic
          in.
                                                                     system.
       4. At a 4:1 ratio, the sleeve and stem move 1/4
          in.                                                        1. True
                                                                     2. False
2-5.   What controls the variation in the size of the
       opening of the CRO valve?
       1.   The drive system
       2.   The aircraft weight selector setting
       3.   The cam rotation
       4.   The plunger movement
                                                          7
2-10.   The accumulator fluid indicator will indicate            2-16.   The outer end of the ram is attached to the
        what reading, if any, if the piston striker rod is               crosshead by what device(s)?
        NOT in contact with the actuator rod?
                                                                         1.   A snap ring
        1.   Drain                                                       2.   A bearing sleeve and retainer
        2.   Fill                                                        3.   A split flange
        3.   Battery                                                     4.   Pressure clamps
        4.   None; no reading will be indicated
                                                                 2-17.   Which of the following parts enable lubricant
2-11.   What position must the arresting engine                          to be retained in the cage and roller bearing
        crosshead be in when you check the engine                        assemblies of the crosshead sheaves and the
        accumulator fluid level?                                         sheaves of the fixed sheave installation?
        1.   Drain                                                       1.   Leather spacers
        2.   Fill                                                        2.   Phenolic spacers
        3.   Off                                                         3.   Steel spacers
        4.   Battery                                                     4.   Inner steel disc spacers
2-12.   What is the purpose of the fluid replenishment           2-18.   What purpose do the crosshead mounted slip-
        system?                                                          pers serve during arresting engine operation?
        1. To replace or remove small amounts of                         1.   They absorb shock
           fluid in the hydraulic system                                 2.   They support the crosshead
        2. To replace large amounts of fluid lost due                    3.   They guide the crosshead
           to leakage                                                    4.   They act as a bearing surface
        3. To provide a means of hydraulically setting
                                                                 2-19.   What is the operating pressure of the automatic
           the CRO valve
                                                                         lubrication system?
        4. To allow adjustment of the battery position
           of the crosshead                                              1.   70 to 80 psi
                                                                         2.   75 to 85 psi
2-13.   Which of the following statements regarding
                                                                         3.   60 to 70 psi
        the fluid stowage system is INCORRECT?
                                                                         4.   40 to 50 psi
        1. Each arresting engine has its own stowage
                                                                 2-20.   What is the proper amount of spring tension to
           tank
                                                                         be maintained on the hose reel of the automatic
        2. The tank is common to all arresting
                                                                         lubrication system?
           engines
        3. The tank can stow all the fluid from one                      1. 20 lb ± 1/2 lb
           arresting engine                                              2. 14 lb ± 1 lb
        4. The capacity of the tank varies depending                     3. 9 lb ± 1/2 lb
           on the engine modification                                    4. 5 lb ± 1 lb
2-14.   What devices prevent corrosion of the cooling            2-21.   What is the function of the cable anchor
        tubes in the fluid cooler?                                       damper?
        1.   Copper baffles                                              1. To reduce vibration in the cable system by
        2.   Replaceable anodes                                             eliminating cable slack between the
        3.   Replaceable cathodes                                           crosshead and fixed sheave assembly
        4.   Rust inhibitors                                                during retraction
                                                                         2. To reduce vibration in the purchase cable
2-15.   Which components make up the actual engine
                                                                            system by eliminating cable slack between
        of the arresting gear?
                                                                            the crosshead and fixed sheave assembly at
        1.   The crosshead and ram assembly                                 the beginning of an arrestment
        2.   The CRO valve and drive system                              3. To provide a means of anchoring the
        3.   The CRO valve, cylinder, and fixed end                         purchase cable in the engine room
        4.   The cylinder and ram assembly                               4. To indicate that the arresting engine has
                                                                            returned to the battery position after
                                                                            arrestment
                                                             8
2-22.   What source provides the energy for the battery        2-28.   The adjustable torque limit switch is actuated
        positioner to operate?                                         by which of the following components?
        1.   Hydraulics                                                1.   The worm
        2.   Electricity                                               2.   The tripping plate washer
        3.   Pneumatics                                                3.   The torque spring
        4.   Electrohydraulics                                         4.   The wormshaft
2-23.   Which of the following is NOT a part of the            2-29.   What is the only function of the retractable
        sheave damper assembly?                                        deck sheave limit bevel gear?
        1.   The anchor assembly                                       1. To transmit the motor force to the
        2.   The buffer assembly                                          wormshaft
        3.   The charging panel                                        2. To engage the lugs of the clutch bevel gear
        4.   The damper piston                                         3. To rotate the sleeve
                                                                       4. To turn the pinion of the geared limit
2-24.   What is the purpose of the sheave damper flow
                                                                          switch
        control valve?
                                                               2-30.   The crossdeck pendant cable ends are equipped
        1. To allow free flow of fluid from the damper
                                                                       with what type of terminals?
           cylinder to the damper accumulator and a
           restricted flow from the damper                             1.   Swaged
           accumulator to the damper cylinder                          2.   Poured basket
        2. To allow restricted flow of fluid from the                  3.   Fiege
           damper cylinder to the damper                               4.   Clamp
           accumulator and free flow from the
                                                               2-31.   Wire supports are designed to maintain a
           damper accumulator to the damper
                                                                       crossdeck pendant height of 2 inches
           cylinder
                                                                       minimum. The maximum height should be
        3. To allow free flow of fluid to and from the
                                                                       measured between what two points?
           damper accumulator only
        4. To allow free flow of fluid from the damper                 1. From the top of the pendant to the deck at
           cylinder to the accumulator only                               the pendant's highest point
                                                                       2. From the top of the pendant to the deck at
2-25.   What is the primary function of the purchase
                                                                          the pendant's lowest point
        cables?
                                                                       3. From the bottom of the pendant to the deck
        1. To transmit the landing aircraft's force to                    at the pendant's highest point
           the arresting engine                                        4. From the bottom of the pendant to the deck
        2. To tension the crossdeck pendant                               at the pendant's lowest point
        3. To drive the control systems of the
                                                               2-32.   Which of the following components is/are
           arresting engine
                                                                       NOT found in a barricade arresting engine
        4. To retract the crossdeck pendant
                                                                       installation?
2-26.   If the purchase cable payout is 72 feet, the
                                                                       1.   Crossdeck pendant
        engine ram will travel a total of how many feet?
                                                                       2.   Sheave dampers
        1.   5                                                         3.   Retractable sheaves
        2.   2                                                         4.   Fluid cooler
        3.   3
                                                               2-33.   The polyurethane semicoated barricade
        4.   4
                                                                       webbing assembly consists of a total of how
2-27.   What two methods can be used to operate the                    many separate webbing systems?
        retractable deck sheaves?
                                                                       1.   Five
        1.   Hydraulically and manually                                2.   Six
        2.   Pneumatically and manually                                3.   Three
        3.   Electrically and manually                                 4.   Four
        4.   Hydraulically and pneumatically
                                                           9
2-34.   What raises      and   lowers   the   barricade        2-41.   Newly installed hydraulic seals should be
        stanchions?                                                    pressure tested for at least how long before
                                                                       recovery operations are resumed?
        1.   Hydraulic cylinder
        2.   Counterbalancing springs                                  1.   90 min
        3.   Tensioning pendants                                       2.   60 min
        4.   Stanchion latch                                           3.   45 min
                                                                       4.   30 min
2-35.   What cushions the barricade stanchions fall
        against the deck?                                      2-42.   What condition will result from the stretching
                                                                       of newly installed purchase cables?
        1.   Hydraulic cylinder
        2.   Counterbalancing springs                                  1. It causes the crosshead to move away from
        3.   Tensioning pendants                                          the crosshead stop, increasing the fluid
        4.   Stanchion latch                                              capacity of the hydraulic system
                                                                       2. It causes the crosshead to move away from
2-36.   What secures the barricade stanchions in the
                                                                          the crosshead stop, decreasing the fluid
        down position?
                                                                          capacity of the hydraulic system
        1.   Hydraulic cylinder                                        3. It causes the crosshead to move toward the
        2.   Counterbalancing springs                                     crosshead stop, increasing the fluid
        3.   Tensioning pendants                                          capacity of the hydraulic system
        4.   Stanchion latch                                           4. It causes the crosshead to move toward the
2-37.   What is the approximate fluid capacity of the                     crosshead stop, decreasing the fluid
        barricade power package gravity tank?                             capacity of the hydraulic system
        1. True
        2. False
                                                          10
2-46.   In terminal pouring, when, if ever, must the            2-51.   When repacking a component, how much
        solution in the ultrasonic degreaser and the                    clearance should be maintained to allow the
        rinsing solution be replaced?                                   packing freedom of movement?
        1. Replace both solutions after 10 terminals                    1.   5/32 to 8/32 in.
           have been degreased and rinsed                               2.   3/32 to 5/32 in.
        2. Replace the solutions only when they                         3.   3/64 to 3/8 in.
           become dirty                                                 4.   1/64 to 3/64 in.
        3. Replace the degreasing solution after 10
                                                                2-52.   The proper procedure used to proofload a
           terminals have been degreased; no limit on
                                                                        poured terminal is to gradually increase the test
           the rinse solution
                                                                        pressure to 200,000 pounds, hold the pressure
        4. Never; strain both solutions through 100
                                                                        for 2 minutes, and then gradually bleed down
           micron screen after each use and they may
                                                                        the pressure.
           be used indefinitely
                                                                        1. True
2-47.   The grit blast cabinet used for etching the wire
                                                                        2. False
        rope cables and terminals should be filled with
        how much grit prior to use?                             2-53.   What hazardous condition may be caused by
                                                                        entrapped air in the arresting engine cylinder?
        1.   100 lb maximum
        2.   100 to 200 lb                                              1.   Two-blocking
        3.   200 lb minimum                                             2.   Fast cable retraction
        4.   200 to 250 lb                                              3.   Walkback
                                                                        4.   Short runout
2-48.   The flux solution used in terminal pouring
        should be heated to what temperature range?             2-54.   Of the following conditions, which one is
                                                                        considered extremely critical?
        1.   550 to 600°F
        2.   460 to 510°F                                               1.   One broken wire in a crossdeck pendant
        3.   250 to 280°F                                               2.   Debris near a deck winch
        4.   160 to 210°F                                               3.   Sheaves slipping on races
                                                                        4.   Terminals jamming sheaves
2-49.   Before the molten zinc is poured into a
        terminal, the terminal must be heated to what           2-55.   Improper CRO valve cam alignment will cause
        temperature range?                                              which of the following conditions?
        1.   500 to 550°F                                               1. The actual setting of the valve will be
        2.   550 to 600°F                                                  different from that indicated by the weight
        3.   778 to 798°F                                                  selector
        4.   950 to 1000°F                                              2. Main engine cylinder pressure will
                                                                           increase above 650 psi during arrestment
2-50.   In terminal pouring, when, if ever, must the
                                                                        3. An accumulator pressure will be lower
        solution in the ultrasonic degreaser and the
                                                                           than its initial charging pressure
        rinsing solution be replaced?
                                                                        4. The CRO valve will always fully close
        1. Replace both solutions after 10 terminals                       prior to the aircraft's desired full runout
           have been degreased and rinsed
        2. Replace the solutions only when they
           become dirty
        3. Replace the degreasing solution after 10
           terminals have been degreased; no limit on
           the rinse solution
        4. Never; strain both solutions through 100
           micron screen after each use and they may
           be used indefinitely
                                                           11
(THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK.)
                   12
                                          ASSIGNMENT 3
3-1.   What are the most significant differences                3-7.    What determines the number of launching cyl-
       among the various types of steam catapults?                      inders that are mounted in the catapult trough?
       1.   Power strokes and lengths                                   1. Overall length of the catapult
       2.   Endspeeds and power strokes                                 2. Required amount of elongation for the type
       3.   Endspeeds and launching capacities                             of catapult
       4.   Lengths and launching capacities                            3. Number of base pads in the trough
                                                                        4. Number of lubricator nozzles required for
3-2.   What switch or valve controls the flow of
                                                                           the type of catapult
       steam from the ship's boilers to the catapult's
       wet-steam accumulator?                                   3-8.    What function is provided by the cylinder co-
                                                                        vers of the launching engine?
       1.   The steam launching valve
       2.   The capacity selector valve                                 1. Eliminates the need for external bracing of
       3.   The steam fill valve                                           the trough covers and track assembly
       4.   The steam pressure cutoff switch                            2. Prevents steam from escaping through the
                                                                           cylinder slots during the power stroke
3-3.   How far must the launch valve control assem-
                                                                        3. Prevents steam pressure from spreading
       bly crosshead travel to stop the number 2
                                                                           the cylinder in the area of the cylinder slot
       launch valve stroke timer clock?
                                                                        4. Provides a means of connecting the shuttle
       1. 3 1/2 in.                                                        to the piston assemblies
       2. 6      in.
                                                                3-9.    What force maintains the tension on the cata-
       3. 9      in.
                                                                        pult launching engine cylinder sealing strip?
       4. 11 1/2 in.
                                                                        1.   Hydraulic pressure
3-4.   What device controls the opening rate of the
                                                                        2.   Spring tension
       launch valves to allow the launching of various
                                                                        3.   Steam pressure
       types and weights of aircraft?
                                                                        4.   Air pressure
       1.   The launch valve control valve
                                                                3-10.   What component serves as the chassis for the
       2.   The capacity selector valve
                                                                        other components of the steam piston
       3.   The launch valve stroke timers
                                                                        assembly?
       4.   The steam pressure cutoff switch
                                                                        1.   The spear
3-5.   What mechanism prevents a steam buildup be-
                                                                        2.   The barrel
       hind the launching engine steam pistons?
                                                                        3.   The connector
       1.   The exhaust valve                                           4.   The support guide
       2.   The pressure-breaking orifice elbow
                                                                3-11.   What prevents the loss of steam from behind
       3.   The exhaust valve keeper valve
                                                                        the steam piston assemblies during the
       4.   The wet-steam accumulator
                                                                        catapult's power stroke?
3-6.   The exhaust valve hydraulic lock valve con-
                                                                        1.   Segmented seals
       trols the flow of fluid to which of the following
                                                                        2.   Piston rings
       components?
                                                                        3.   The piston barrel
       1.   The steam pressure cutoff switch                            4.   Bushings
       2.   The pressure breaking elbow
       3.   The exhaust valve limit switch
       4.   The exhaust valve hydraulic actuator
                                                           13
3-12.   What component serves as a bearing surface              3-18.   Which of the following information is NOT
        for the piston assembly?                                        displayed on the Digital Endspeed Indicator
                                                                        (DESI)?
        1.   The rubbing strip
        2.   The barrel                                                 1.   Time of day
        3.   The piston guide                                           2.   CSV setting
        4.   The strip guide                                            3.   Shuttle endspeed
                                                                        4.   Catapult number
3-13.   A total of how many rollers are mounted on the
        shuttle frame?                                          3-19.   The bridle tensioner fully aft limit switch is
                                                                        part of two catapult electrical circuits. One is
        1.   Six
                                                                        the retract permissive circuit. What is the other
        2.   Two
                                                                        one?
        3.   Eight
        4.   Four                                                       1.   The maneuver forward
                                                                        2.   The maneuver aft
3-14.   What component of the water brake cylinder
                                                                        3.   The military power
        installation forms the vortex at the open end of
                                                                        4.   The suspend circuit
        the water brake cylinder?
                                                                3-20.   Which of the following conditions would
        1.   The jet ring
                                                                        indicate a water loss in the catapult hydraulic
        2.   The striker ring
                                                                        fluid?
        3.   The annulus ring
        4.   The choke ring                                             1.   An increase in ph number
                                                                        2.   A decrease in ph number
3-15.   The term "elbow pressure" refers to what
                                                                        3.   An increase in viscosity
        specific pressure?
                                                                        4.   A decrease in viscosity
        1. The basket strainer inlet pressure
                                                                3-21.   What is the function of the catapult main
        2. The basket strainer outlet pressure
                                                                        hydraulic pump delivery control unit?
        3. The water pressure entering the water
           brake cylinder                                               1. To direct fluid to the gravity tank when the
        4. The pump discharge pressure                                     pump is on stroke only
                                                                        2. To direct fluid to the accumulator when the
3-16.   The contacts of the steam cutoff pressure
                                                                           pump is off stroke only
        switches close when the steam pressure in the
                                                                        3. To direct fluid to the accumulator when the
        launching engine cylinders reaches what
                                                                           pump is on stroke and to the gravity tank
        pressure?
                                                                           when the pump is off stroke
        1.   10 psi                                                     4. To direct fluid to the accumulator when the
        2.   20 psi                                                        pump is off stroke and to the gravity tank
        3.   30 psi                                                        when the pump is on stroke
        4.   40 psi
                                                                3-22.   The motion of the rotary retraction engine
3-17.   All catapult trough covers are designed to                      hydraulic motor is transferred to the drive
        withstand what total amount of vertical rolling                 system cables by what assembly?
        shuttle load?
                                                                        1.   The traverse carriage assembly
        1.   100,000 lb                                                 2.   The crosshead assembly
        2.   132,000 lb                                                 3.   The sheave and adapter assembly
        3.   200,000 lb                                                 4.   The drum assembly
        4.   264,000 lb
                                                                3-23.   Which of the following components prevents
                                                                        the cables from becoming crossed and tangled
                                                                        on the drum?
                                                                        1.   The cable tensioner assembly
                                                                        2.   The screw and traverse carriage assembly
                                                                        3.   The fairlead sheave assembly
                                                                        4.   The cable tensioner sheave assembly
                                                           14
3-24.   The forward motion of the rotary retraction            3-29.   During normal launching operations, when
        engine is stopped at the completion of the grab                will the grab release the shuttle?
        advance cycle by what force or device?
                                                                       1. When endspeed has been reached and the
        1.   By cable dead weight drag                                    unlocking mechanism is disengaged
        2.   By fluid acting on the carriage assembly                  2. When launch complete is reached and the
        3.   By the advance buffer                                        locking mechanism is actuated
        4.   By fluid braking of the hydraulic motor                   3. When both have returned to battery
                                                                          position and the unlocking mechanism is
3-25.   What is the function of the rotary retraction
                                                                          actuated
        engine maneuvering valve?
                                                                       4. When maximum load drag weight is
        1. To protect the engine from damage in the                       reached and the unlocking mechanism
           event of a malfunction                                         automatically disengages
        2. To control the bridle tensioner control
                                                               3-30.   Which of the following controls is NOT a
           valve
                                                                       momentary contact push button?
        3. To control the speed of the grab after
           advance or retract stroke braking has been                  1.   Fire
           completed                                                   2.   Maneuver aft
        4. To initiate the advance and retract stroke                  3.   Lube
           braking                                                     4.   Maneuver forward
3-26.   Which of the following components operates             3-31.   The controls for the integrated catapult control
        hydraulically to keep the retraction engine                    system (ICCS) are mainly divided between or
        cables taut?                                                   among how many control stations?
        1.   The cable tensioner assembly                              1.   Five
        2.   The screw and traverse carriage assembly                  2.   Two
        3.   The lead sheave assembly                                  3.   Three
        4.   The cable tensioner sheave assembly                       4.   Four
3-27.   Which of the following components guides the           3-32.   The malfunction and status lights are located
        cables between the retraction engine and the                   on what panel or console of the ICCS?
        catapult trough?
                                                                       1.   The central panel
        1.   The cable tensioner assembly                              2.   The cat officer control console
        2.   The screw and traverse carriage assembly                  3.   The emergency deckedge control console
        3.   The fairlead sheave assembly                              4.   The monitor panel
        4.   The cable tensioner sheave assembly
                                                               3-33.   What panel controls and monitors the
3-28.   The retraction engine drive system cables are                  pneumatic system?
        attached to what component(s)?
                                                                       1.   The left front panel
        1. The shuttle only                                            2.   The left intermediate front panel
        2. The grab only                                               3.   The right intermediate front panel
        3. The shuttle and launching engine steam                      4.   The right front panel
           pistons
                                                               3-34.   What panel controls and monitors the
        4. The grab and launching engine steam
                                                                       hydraulic system?
           pistons
                                                                       1.   The left front panel
                                                                       2.   The left intermediate front panel
                                                                       3.   The right intermediate front panel
                                                                       4.   The right front panel
                                                          15
3-35.   What panel provide emergency operational                QUESTIONS 41 THROUGH                 44   APPLY    TO
        capacity?                                               PROCEDURES FOR ICCS.
        1.   The left front panel                               3-41.   What personnel gives the tension signal to the
        2.   The left intermediate front panel                          catapult director?
        3.   The right intermediate front panel                         1.   The launching officer
        4.   The right front panel                                      2.   The deckedge operator
QUESTIONS 36 THROUGH 38 APPLY TO NON-                                   3.   The catapult safety observer
ICCS.                                                                   4.   The topside safety petty officer
3-36.   What main control console panel indicates the           3-42.   What personnel signal the launching officer to
        status of various catapult system pressures?                    take tension?
        1.   The steam panel                                            1.   The catapult director
        2.   The emergency panel                                        2.   The deckedge operator
        3.   The monitor panel                                          3.   The catapult safety observer
        4.   The operating panel                                        4.   The topside safety petty officer
3-37.   What main control console panel is used to              3-43.   What personnel signals suspend to the
        control the catapult fill valves?                               launching officer?
                                                                        1.   The launching officer
        1.   The steam charging panel
                                                                        2.   The deckedge operator
        2.   The emergency panel
                                                                        3.   The catapult safety observer
        3.   The auxiliary deckedge panel
                                                                        4.   The topside safety petty officer
        4.   The operating panel
                                                                3-44.   On ships where the ICCS is the primary mode
3-38.   What main control console panel contains all
                                                                        of controlling catapult launching operations,
        lights, switches, and pushbuttons that are found
                                                                        who depresses the FIRE push button to launch
        on the deckedge panel?
                                                                        an aircraft?
        1.   The gauge panel                                            1.   The launching officer
        2.   The emergency panel                                        2.   The deckedge operator
        3.   The auxiliary deckedge panel                               3.   The catapult safety observer
        4.   The operating panel                                        4.   The central charging panel operator
3-39.   What indicates the catapult readiness to the            QUESTIONS 45 THROUGH 48                   APPLY    TO
        launching officer during operations?                    PROCEDURES FOR NON-ICCS.
        1.   The gauge box                                      3-45.   Under normal launching conditions, what
        2.   The monitor panel                                          should be the last word(s) spoken over the
        3.   The deckedge signal box                                    sound powered phones?
        4.   The operating panel
                                                                        1.   FIRST READY
3-40.   The hydraulic fluid supply is shut off to what                  2.   TAKING TENSION
        valve during the firing of no-loads?                            3.   FINAL READY
        1.   The bridle tension regulator valve                         4.   FIRE
        2.   The maneuver aft valve                             3-46.   What signal is used by the deckedge operator
        3.   The lubrication valve                                      to indicate that the FINAL READY light has
        4.   The advance valve                                          come on at the deckedge panel and the catapult
                                                                        is in the FINAL READY condition?
                                                                        1. Both hands are held open and above the
                                                                           head
                                                                        2. One hand is held open and above the head
                                                                        3. One hand is held above the head with two
                                                                           fingers extended
                                                                        4. Both hands are held above the head with
                                                                           only the index fingers extended
                                                           16
3-47.   Which of the following actions must the                 3-48.   What immediate action must be taken by the
        deckedge operator take after receiving the                      deckedge operator if the catapult officer signals
        FIRE signal from the catapult officer?                          a hangfire?
        1. Immediately push the FIRE push button                        1. Push the MANEUVER AFT push button
        2. Hesitate for at least 10 seconds to ensure                      to release bridle tension
           that the aircraft is at full power, then push                2. Tell the console operator to actuate the
           the FIRE push button                                            SUSPEND switch
        3. Notify the console operator that he is firing                3. Close the EMERGENCY cutout valve and
           the catapult, then push the FIRE push                           then actuate the SUSPEND switch
           button                                                       4. Actuate the SUSPEND switch and tell the
        4. Perform a final safety scan of the flight                       console operator to ROTATE THE
           deck and catwalks, then push the FIRE                           EMERGENCY            CUTOUT     VALVE,
           push button                                                     ROTATE THE EMERGENCY CUTOUT
                                                                           VALVE
                                                           17
(THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK.)
                   18
                                          ASSIGNMENT 4
Textbook Assignment: “Associated Launching Equipment,” Pages 5-1 through 5-23; and “The Aircraft Launch and
                      Recovery Equipment Maintenance Program (ALREMP),” Pages 6-1 through 6-18.
4-1.   The Mk 7 Mod 0/2 JBD consists of a total of             4-7.    JBD control is transferred from the portable
       how many panel assemblies?                                      control box to the auxiliary control panel by
                                                                       what switch?
       1.   Six
       2.   Two                                                        1.   A manual override switch
       3.   Eight                                                      2.   The defeat interlock switch
       4.   Four                                                       3.   The portable control box suspend switch
                                                                       4.   A rotary type switch
4-2.   A total of how many hydraulic cylinders are
       used to raise and lower each pair of JBD                4-8.    In the event of an electrical power failure, how
       panels?                                                         may the Mk 7 JBDs be raised or lowered?
       1.   Six                                                        1. By the auxiliary control panel
       2.   Two                                                        2. By the portable control box group
       3.   Eight                                                         UP-DOWN toggle switch
       4.   Four                                                       3. By the manual override on the four-way
                                                                          control valves
4-3.   The removable module assemblies are attached
                                                                       4. By a tow tractor and cable
       to the JBD panel assembly by what devices?
                                                               4-9.    When it is necessary to remove a component
       1.   Welds
                                                                       from the hydraulic system, you should cap or
       2.   Clamps
                                                                       plug the open lines to prevent foreign matter
       3.   Edge-fitted brackets
                                                                       contamination.
       4.   Screws
                                                                       1. True
4-4.   What devices control the flow of cooling water
                                                                       2. False
       through the Mk 7 JBD panel module
       assemblies?                                             4-10.   What is/are the advantage(s) of the nose gear
                                                                       launch system over the conventional launch
       1.   Throttle valves
                                                                       system?
       2.   Vacuum breaker valves
       3.   Orifices                                                   1. It permits positive engagement of the
       4.   Manual hand valves                                            aircraft to the catapult
                                                                       2. It minimizes the number of personnel
4-5.   The JBD cooling water must be maintained at
                                                                          required to be near the aircraft during
       what minimum pressure?
                                                                          hookup operations
       1.   60 psi                                                     3. It permits automatic engagement of the
       2.   70 psi                                                        aircraft to the catapult
       3.   80 psi                                                     4. All of the above
       4.   90 psi
                                                               4-11.   Inserts in the NGL guide track ensure that the
4-6.   The emergency lowering hydraulic bypass                         aircraft launch bar makes positive contact with
       lines permit fluid to bypass what component of                  which of the following components?
       the JBD hydraulic system?
                                                                       1.   The slide
       1.   The lowering side of the hydraulic cylinder                2.   The buffer hook actuator roller
       2.   The solenoid manual override                               3.   The track seal
       3.   The stack valve                                            4.   The soft-stop buffer
       4.   The gravity tank
                                                          19
4-12.   What component of the Mk 2 NGL system                    4-18.   Which of the following is NOT a function of
        engages the aircraft holdback bar as the aircraft                organizational maintenance?
        taxis into position for launch?
                                                                         1. Inspection, operation, and servicing as
        1.   The buffer hook                                                defined and required by PMS
        2.   The slide                                                   2. Corrective and preventive maintenance
        3.   The launch actuator reset assembly                          3. Record keeping and report writing
        4.   The buffer cylinder                                         4. Type III calibration of designated
                                                                            equipment
4-13.   During NGL operation, when the slide
        assembly is forward, what device holds the               4-19.   What maintenance activity performs type III
        reset-assembly slider above the surface of the                   calibration?
        guide track deck housing cavity?
                                                                         1.   Organizational maintenance
        1.   The slider actuating spring                                 2.   Intermediate maintenance
        2.   The actuator assembly                                       3.   Depot maintenance
        3.   The buffer hook                                             4.   Navy ASO
        4.   The shuttle spreader
                                                                 4-20.   What type of maintenance is normally
4-14.   Which of the following statements best                           accomplished by the catapult and arresting
        describes the NGL shock absorber assembly?                       gear crew members?
        1. A self-contained, sealed unit that requires                   1.   Upkeep
           no maintenance or adjustments                                 2.   Overhaul
        2. A hydraulically operated, three-cylinder,                     3.   Intermediate maintenance
           buffer unit                                                   4.   Depot maintenance
        3. A hydraulically operated buffer unit that
                                                                 4-21.   In the V-2 maintenance organization, who has
           uses tube orifices to meter fluid flow
                                                                         the authority to certify that maintenance ac-
        4. A piston-type accumulator energy
                                                                         tions have been completed and that the equip-
           absorber
                                                                         ment can be returned to an operational status?
4-15.   What device controls the flow of hydraulic
                                                                         1. The division officer or maintenance officer
        fluid supplied from the catapult hydraulic
                                                                         2. The catapult officer or recovery officer
        system to the NGL buffer cylinder?
                                                                         3. The maintenance officer or maintenance
        1.   The NGL dump valves                                            control chief
        2.   The NGL pilot valve                                         4. The maintenance officer only
        3.   The NGL valve manifold
                                                                 4-22.   Which of the following personnel are
        4.   The NGL buffer cylinder control valve
                                                                         responsible for the day-to-day operations of
4-16.   ALRE maintenance functions are divided into                      the work center, the nomination of qualified
        what total number of maintenance levels?                         personnel to be collateral duty inspectors, and
                                                                         the assignment of work center personnel to
        1.   One
                                                                         specific maintenance tasks?
        2.   Two
        3.   Three #                                                     1. The maintenance officer, work center
        4.   Four                                                           group supervisors, and work center
                                                                            supervisors
4-17.   Maintenance tasks are assigned according to
                                                                         2. Work center group supervisors and work
        the complexity, scope, and range of the work to
                                                                            center supervisors only
        be performed.
                                                                         3. Work center group supervisors, the QA
        1. True                                                             work center supervisor, and the
        2. False                                                            maintenance support work center
                                                                            supervisor
                                                                         4. The maintenance officer, the maintenance
                                                                            control chief, and work center group
                                                                            supervisors
                                                            20
4-23.   Which of the following VIDs boards provides            4-28.   On the MAF card, what color is used for a
        information pertaining to the divisions's                      completed maintenance action awaiting a
        overall maintenance status?                                    functional check?
        1. The maintenance support work center                         1.   Blue
           board                                                       2.   Red
        2. The Quality Assurance work center board                     3.   Black
        3. The maintenance control work center                         4.   Yellow
           board
                                                               4-29.   What copy, if any, of the completed ALRE
        4. The material control work center board
                                                                       MAF is retained by the maintenance
4-24.   A total of how many information display                        responsible work center?
        columns are required on both the maintenance
                                                                       1.   One
        control and all other work center VIDs boards?
                                                                       2.   Two
        1.   Seven                                                     3.   Three
        2.   Six                                                       4.   None
        3.   Five
                                                               4-30.   Who is responsible for updating and
        4.   Four
                                                                       maintaining the work center maintenance
4-25.   What color is used to indicate limited                         requirement status board?
        capability on the Maintenance Action Form
                                                                       1.   The maintenance control chief
        (MAF) cards?
                                                                       2.   The work center group supervisor
        1.   Blue                                                      3.   The maintenance control officer
        2.   Red                                                       4.   The work center supervisor
        3.   Black
                                                               4-31.   What is the primary role of the V-2
        4.   Yellow
                                                                       maintenance support branch?
4-26.   On the MAF card, what color is used to
                                                                       1. To manage the division tool control
        indicate the equipment is out of commission?
                                                                          program
        1.   Yellow                                                    2. To provide technical expertise to operating
        2.   Red                                                          work centers
        3.   Black                                                     3. To reduce man-hours required to complete
        4.   Blue                                                         maintenance tasks
                                                                       4. To manage the division man-hour
4-27.   The priority section of the MAF card can be
                                                                          accounting program
        color coded to indicate the maintenance status
        and operational capability of specific                 4-32.   When the Maintenance Support (MS) branch
        equipment. What status is indicated if no color                assigns personnel to assist in maintenance
        code is used in the priority section?                          performed by the operating work center, who
                                                                       documents the MS man-hours?
        1. The equipment is out of commission
                                                                       1.   Maintenance Control
        2. The equipment may be used, but has only
                                                                       2.   Maintenance Support
           limited capability
                                                                       3.   The QA branch
        3. The maintenance is routine and does not
                                                                       4.   The operating work center
           affect equipment capability
        4. The maintenance has been completed and              4-33.   The tool control program was established to
           the equipment only needs a functional                       reduce the potential of tool-related foreign
           check to be returned to full operational                    object damage and to reduce the cost of tool
           capability                                                  replacement.
                                                                       1. True
                                                                       2. False
                                                          21
4-34.   Which of the following is NOT a benefit of the        4-39.   When it is necessary to augment the QA branch
        tool control program?                                         with Collateral Duty QA inspectors (CDQAIs)
                                                                      below the paygrade of E-6 for more than 90
        1.   Reduced tool replacement costs
                                                                      days, who must approve the continued
        2.   Reduced equipment failures
                                                                      augmentation?
        3.   Reduced tool pilferage
        4.   Assurance of tool availability to perform                1.   The maintenance officer
             maintenance                                              2.   The division officer
                                                                      3.   The commanding officer
4-35.   Detailed information concerning the ALRE
                                                                      4.   The type commander
        TCP can be found in what publication?
                                                              4-40.   Who is most directly concerned with, and
        1.   NAEC Miscellaneous Report 51/OR732
                                                                      responsible for, quality in workmanship?
        2.   NAEC Report No. CD-1025
        3.   NAVAIR 80R-14                                            1.   The maintenance officer
        4.   OPNAVINST 4790.4B                                        2.   The assigned quality assurance inspector
                                                                      3.   The work center supervisor
4-36.   The achievement of a properly functioning
                                                                      4.   The equipment operator
        quality assurance program exhibits which of
        the following characteristics?                        4-41.   Which of the following duties is NOT a
                                                                      responsibility of the quality assurance branch?
        1. The program is managed by the
           maintenance control officer, maintenance                   1. To prepare maintenance instructions
           control chief, and work center group                       2. To provide technical assistance to
           supervisors                                                   collateral duty inspectors
        2. Eliminates unnecessary man-hour and                        3. To manage the dispersed technical
           dollar expenses                                               publications libraries
        3. Uses prevention, knowledge, and special                    4. To develop audit checklists
           skills
                                                              4-42.   CDIs are designated in writing by which of the
        4. Stresses the gathering and maintaining of
                                                                      following officers?
           information on quality assurance
                                                                      1.   The air department officer
4-37.   What is the basis of maintenance and
                                                                      2.   The executive officer
        operational decisions through the Quality
                                                                      3.   The commanding officer
        Assurance (QA) program?
                                                                      4.   The maintenance officer
        1.   Memory
                                                              4-43.   How often are work center audits conducted?
        2.   Intuition
        3.   Factual data                                             1.   Weekly
        4.   The maintenance officer's experience                     2.   Monthly
                                                                      3.   Quarterly
4-38.   When it becomes necessary to augment the
                                                                      4.   Semi-annually
        quality assurance branch with CDQAIs, they
        must be designated in writing by which of the         4-44.   What type of audit is conducted to evaluate a
        following officers?                                           specific maintenance task?
        1.   The commanding officer                                   1.   Work center audit
        2.   The air department officer                               2.   Special audit
        3.   The V-2 division officer                                 3.   Internal audit
        4.   The V-2 maintenance officer                              4.   Type commander audit
                                                         22
4-45.   The quality assurance branch uses special
        audits for which of the following reasons?
        1. To evaluate the overall quality of
           performance of each work center
        2. To evaluate tool control program
           compliance
        3. To monitor programs specifically assigned
           to the QA branch for monitoring
        4. To establish follow-up procedures to
           ensure that previous audit discrepancies
           have been corrected
                                                       23
(THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK.)
                   24
                                         ASSIGNMENT 5
Textbook Assignment: “Maintenance Planning and Administration,” Pages 7-1 through 7-47.
5-1.   What factors must be considered in the plan-           5-7.    Entries made in the TOOLS, PARTS, MATE-
       ning and scheduling of maintenance?                            RIALS, TEST EQUIPMENT block of an
                                                                      MRC can be cross-referenced to the SPMIG
       1.   Operational requirements
                                                                      for stock number identification.
       2.   Available personnel
       3.   Equipment status                                          1. True
       4.   All of the above                                          2. False
5-2.   Which of the following statements best defines         5-8.    What information determines the number of
       preventive maintenance?                                        items to be listed on an Equipment Guide List?
       1. Any action that maintains equipment                         1. Skill level of the maintenance person
          warranties                                                  2. Time allotted to perform maintenance on
       2. Any action that maintains equipment in                         each item
          operating condition                                         3. Number of days required to complete
       3. Any action that is entered in the rough                        entire maintenance action
          work log                                                    4. All of the above
       4. Any action taken in addition to normal
                                                              5-9.    Who must approve a request to combine the
          workload
                                                                      PMS maintenance requirements of two or more
5-3.   Which of the following sources provides a list-                workcenters?
       ing of the MIPs assigned to each department?
                                                                      1.   Type commander
       1.   Workcenter PMS Manual                                     2.   Commanding officer
       2.   Divisional LOEP                                           3.   Department head
       3.   Departmental LOEP                                         4.   Division officer
       4.   Ship's cycle schedule
                                                              5-10.   Preparation of a PMS Cycle Schedule requires
5-4.   Which of the following sources contains de-                    use of all EXCEPT which of the following?
       tailed procedures used to perform a mainte-
                                                                      1.   Applicable MRCs
       nance action?
                                                                      2.   Blank cycle schedules
       1.   MIP                                                       3.   Previous quarterly schedule
       2.   LOEP                                                      4.   Master PMS Manual
       3.   MRC
                                                              5-11.   Which of the following schedules is NOT a
       4.   PMS Manual
                                                                      PMS schedule?
5-5.   What does the second part of the MRC code
                                                                      1.   Cycle
       represent?
                                                                      2.   Quarterly
       1.   Periodicity code                                          3.   Monthly
       2.   MIP series code                                           4.   Weekly
       3.   Ship's system code
                                                              5-12.   How are mandatory related maintenance
       4.   Equipment code
                                                                      checks indicated on the Cycle Schedule?
5-6.   An R-1W is an example of what type of period-
                                                                      1.   They are circled in red
       icity code?
                                                                      2.   They are circled in blue
       1.   Calendar-situation                                        3.   A star sign
       2.   Situation-calendar                                        4.   A pound sign
       3.   Situation
       4.   Calendar
                                                         25
5-13.   Which of the following information is NOT                5-19.   Which of the following provides information
        found on the quarterly PMS schedule?                             needed for workload planning and a means of
                                                                         evaluating and improving fleet installed
        1.   Workcenter code
                                                                         equipment?
        2.   Maintenance person's name
        3.   Quarter after overhaul                                      1.   Maintenance Data System
        4.   Department head's signature                                 2.   Planned Maintenance System
                                                                         3.   Failed Parts Reporting System
5-14.   How many columns are available on the
                                                                         4.   Configuration Accounting System
        quarterly schedule for the scheduling of
        weekly maintenance?                                      5-20.   Under MDS, Individual maintenance actions
                                                                         are identified by what number?
        1.   13
        2.   16                                                          1.   Maintenance Action Number
        3.   20                                                          2.   Job Control Number
        4.   24                                                          3.   Job Sequence Number
                                                                         4.   Job Serial Number
5-15.   When a ship's major overhaul is completed
        during the last two weeks of May, what months            5-21.   How is an error corrected when entries are
        are included on the first quarterly schedule                     made on an OPNAV 4790/2K form?
        after overhaul?
                                                                         1. "X" out the error and continue
        1.   April, May, and June                                        2. Make out a new OPNAV 4790/2K
        2.   May, June, and July                                         3. Draw a single line through the error and
        3.   June, July, and August                                         continue
        4.   The first full fiscal quarter after overhaul                4. Put white on the error and continue
5-16.   When the quarterly PMS schedule is prepared,             5-22.   What information is normally found in section
        how are the ship's underway periods indicated?                   V of an OPNAV 4790/2K forms?
        1. By writing "underway" on the schedule                         1.   Repair activity planning
           during these periods                                          2.   Equipment location
        2. By shading in the periods on the bottom                       3.   Availability of blueprints
           line of the schedule                                          4.   Reason for deferring maintenance
        3. By shading in the tick marks indicating the
                                                                 5-23.   Which of the following forms is used to report
           days of the quarter at the top of the
                                                                         a ship's configuration change?
           schedule
        4. By shading in the tick marks indicating the                   1.   OPNAV 4790/2K
           days of the quarter at the bottom of the                      2.   OPNAV 4790/2P
           schedule                                                      3.   OPNAV 4790/2Q
                                                                         4.   OPNAV 4790/CK
5-17.   Any maintenance requirement that cannot be
        completed within its periodicity during a                5-24.   What two-character code identifies the
        quarter must be circled on the front of the                      inventory manager and the stores account?
        quarterly schedule only to explain that it was                   1. The Purpose code
        not completed.                                                   2. The Special Material Identification code
        1. True                                                          3. The Cognizance Symbol code
        2. False                                                         4. The Fund code
5-18.   What PMS schedule is used by the workcenter              5-25.   What character of a cognizance symbol
        supervisor to assign and monitor PMS                             identifies the stores account?
        accomplishments?
                                                                         1.   First
        1.   Cycle                                                       2.   Second
        2.   Quarterly                                                   3.   Third
        3.   Weekly                                                      4.   Fourth
        4.   Daily
                                                            26
5-26.   Which of the following cognizance symbols              5-33.   What activity is responsible for assigning the
        identifies APA material?                                       NSN to material for supply department stock?
        1.   1R                                                        1.   The Defense Logistics Agency
        2.   3H                                                        2.   The Supply Department
        3.   5R                                                        3.   The Naval Supply Center
        4.   6R                                                        4.   The Defense Logistics Support Center
5-27.   Which of the following cognizance symbols              5-34.   Which of the following NSNs was assigned by
        identifies NSA material?                                       the U.S.?
        1.   1R                                                        1.   1234-21-012-3456
        2.   4R                                                        2.   1234-11-001-2345
        3.   6R                                                        3.   1234-01-234-5678
        4.   8R                                                        4.   1234-13-234-6543
5-28.   What activity manages the Federal Cataloging           5-35.   To properly identify material, you should know
        System within the DOD?                                         what number of digits of the NIIN?
        1.   DLA                                                       1.   The first four
        2.   DLSC                                                      2.   The first seven
        3.   ASO                                                       3.   The last seven
        4.   GSA                                                       4.   The last nine
5-29.   The first two digits of an FSC identifies which        5-36.   What account is paid the required use what for
        of the following items?                                        out of appropriations and is NOT chargeable to
                                                                       the user’s operating funds?
        1. The single item, component, or equipment
        2. The major division of commodities within                    1.   APA
           a group                                                     2.   NSA
        3. The commodities according to physical or                    3.   TFA
           performance characteristics                                 4.   OPTAR
        4. The group/category inventory managers
                                                               5-37.   Which of the following items are the same as
5-30.   What FSC groups are used by the Navy for                       NSA items?
        forms and publications?
                                                                       1.   APA items
        1.   90 through 99                                             2.   Repairable items
        2.   70 through 80                                             3.   Expense type items
        3.   30 through 40                                             4.   Remain-in-place items
        4.   01 through 09
                                                               5-38.   The forms and publications used by the Navy
5-31.   Which of the following FSC groups is NOT                       are under the inventory control of what
        included in the Federal Cataloging System?                     activity?
        1.   08                                                        1.   NPFD
        2.   28                                                        2.   SPCC
        3.   48                                                        3.   NAVAIR
        4.   58                                                        4.   ASO
5-32.   An NSN has what total number of digits?                5-39.   The technical responsibility for aircraft
                                                                       engines in the Navy belongs to what activity?
        1. 7
        2. 9                                                           1.   NAVAIR
        3. 13                                                          2.   SPCC
        4. 15                                                          3.   ASO
                                                                       4.   NPPS
                                                          27
5-40.   Aviation depot-level repairable material is            5-47.   What does NICN stand for?
        assigned what cognizance symbol?
                                                                       1.   National Item Control Number
        1.   1R                                                        2.   Navy Item Control Number
        2.   4R                                                        3.   Navy Integrated Control Number
        3.   5R                                                        4.   Navy Item Consolidation Number
        4.   7R
                                                               5-48.   Which of the following items are identified by
5-41.   What activity is the cognizant item manager for                NICNs?
        7R material?
                                                                       1.   Kit numbers
        1.   NAVICP PHIL                                               2.   Publications and forms
        2.   NAVAIR                                                    3.   NAC numbers
        3.   NAVFAC                                                    4.   All of the above
        4.   ASO
                                                               5-49.   In a 13-digit NICN, what code occupies the 5th
5-42.   The cataloging code assigned to defense                        and 6th positions?
        electronic material is equivalent to what
                                                                       1.   The Navy Item Control Number code
        cognizance symbol of Navy material?
                                                                       2.   The Material Control code
        1.   9C                                                        3.   The Supply Classification code
        2.   9D                                                        4.   The Special Material Identification code
        3.   9G
                                                               5-50.   Which of the following NIC codes identifies a
        4.   9N
                                                                       form?
5-43.   The Material Control code is assigned by what
                                                                       1.   LD
        person?
                                                                       2.   LK
        1.   The executive officer                                     3.   LP
        2.   The inventory manager                                     4.   LF
        3.   The technical advisor for the material
                                                               5-51.   What type of material is identified in NICN
        4.   The commanding officer
                                                                       1234-LK-123-4567?
5-44.   What Material Control code is assigned to an
                                                                       1.   A directive
        item that is field-level repairable?
                                                                       2.   A form
        1.   D                                                         3.   An aircraft change kit
        2.   E                                                         4.   A publication
        3.   H
                                                               5-52.   Locally assigned item control numbers contain
        4.   L
                                                                       what letters in the 5th and 6th positions?
5-45.   Depot-level repairable is assigned what
                                                                       1.   LF
        Material Control code?
                                                                       2.   LL
        1.   D                                                         3.   LQ
        2.   H                                                         4.   LX
        3.   L
                                                               5-53.   What format is used to order material identified
        4.   M
                                                                       by a NICN?
5-46.   What Material Control code is assigned to an
                                                                       1.   The DD 1348 format
        end item of ground support equipment?
                                                                       2.   The DD 1348-6 format
        1.   E                                                         3.   The DD 1384 format
        2.   H                                                         4.   The DD 1387 format
        3.   S
        4.   W
                                                          28
5-54.   A temporary NICN is assigned to material for           5-58.   What cognizance symbol is assigned to items
        which of the following purposes?                               listed in the GSA Federal Supply Catalog?
        1. To identify the items before the assignment                 1.   9C
           of an NSN                                                   2.   9D
        2. To control the items pending an NSN                         3.   9N
           assignment                                                  4.   9Q
        3. Both 1 and 2 above
                                                               5-59.   Which of the following lists is a catalog of
        4. To release the shipment from the
                                                                       Navy-managed repairable items and provides
           manufacturer
                                                                       shipping information for unserviceable
5-55.   What activity is responsible for maintaining                   components?
        the NICN to NSN cross-reference list?
                                                                       1.   ML-C
        1. ASO                                                         2.   ML-N
        2. DLIS                                                        3.   MRIL
        3. SPCC                                                        4.   MCRL
        4. NALC
                                                               5-60.   Why is the arresting gear maintenance log
5-56.   The cumulative listing of National Stock                       considered the most important record kept on
        Numbers for all armed services is identified by                the arresting gear equipment?
        which of the following letters?
                                                                       1. It contains recovery log information
        1.   ML-N                                                      2. It contains the names of maintenance
        2.   ML-C                                                         personnel
        3.   MRC                                                       3. It contains wire rope history report
        4.   MDC                                                          information
                                                                       4. It contains most of the information needed
5-57.   Which of the following lists provides
                                                                          to complete other reports and records
        cross-reference information from reference
        numbers to NSNs?
        1. ML-N
        2. ML-C
        3. MCRL
        4. MRIL
29